This is a modern-English version of The Story of the Malakand Field Force: An Episode of Frontier War, originally written by Churchill, Winston.
It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling,
and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If
you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.
Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.
THE STORY OF THE MALAKAND FIELD FORCE
AN EPISODE OF FRONTIER WAR
By Sir Winston S. Churchill
"They (Frontier Wars) are but the surf that marks the edge and the advance of the wave of civilisation." LORD SALISBURY, Guildhall, 1892
"They (Frontier Wars) are just the surf that indicates the boundary and the progress of the wave of civilization." LORD SALISBURY, Guildhall, 1892
CONTENTS
PREFACE
CHAPTER I. THE THEATRE OF WAR
CHAPTER II. THE MALAKAND CAMPS
CHAPTER III. THE OUTBREAK
CHAPTER IV. THE ATTACK ON THE MALAKAND
CHAPTER V. THE RELIEF OF CHAKDARA
CHAPTER VI. THE DEFENCE OF CHAKDARA
CHAPTER VII. THE GATE OF SWAT
CHAPTER VIII. THE ADVANCE AGAINST THE MOHMANDS
CHAPTER IX. RECONNAISSANCE
CHAPTER X. THE MARCH TO NAWAGAI
CHAPTER XI. THE ACTION OF THE MAMUND VALLEY, 16TH SEPTEMBER
CHAPTER XII. AT INAYAT KILA
CHAPTER XIII. NAWAGAI
CHAPTER XIV. BACK TO THE MAMUND VALLEY
CHAPTER XV. THE WORK OF THE CAVALRY
CHAPTER XVI. SUBMISSION
CHAPTER XVII. MILITARY OBSERVATIONS
CHAPTER XVIII. AND LAST... THE RIDDLE OF THE FRONTIER
CONTENTS
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_1__ THE THEATRE OF WAR
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_2__ THE MALAKAND CAMPS
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_3__ THE OUTBREAK
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_4__ THE ATTACK ON THE MALAKAND
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_5__ THE RELIEF OF CHAKDARA
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_6__ THE DEFENCE OF CHAKDARA
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_7__ THE GATE OF SWAT
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_8__ THE ADVANCE AGAINST THE MOHMANDS
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_9__ RECONNAISSANCE
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_10__ THE MARCH TO NAWAGAI
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_11__ THE ACTION IN THE MAMUND VALLEY, SEPTEMBER 16TH
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_12__ AT INAYAT KILA
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_13__ NAWAGAI
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_14__ BACK TO THE MAMUND VALLEY
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_15__ THE ROLE OF THE CAVALRY
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_16__ SUBMISSION
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_17__ MILITARY OBSERVATIONS
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_18__ AND FINALLY... THE PUZZLE OF THE FRONTIER
THIS BOOK IS INSCRIBED TO MAJOR-GENERAL SIR BINDON BLOOD, K.C.B. UNDER WHOSE COMMAND THE OPERATIONS THEREIN RECORDED WERE CARRIED OUT; BY WHOSE GENERALSHIP THEY WERE BROUGHT TO A SUCCESSFUL CONCLUSION; AND TO WHOSE KINDNESS THE AUTHOR IS INDEBTED FOR THE MOST VALUABLE AND FASCINATING EXPERIENCE OF HIS LIFE.
THIS BOOK IS INSCRIBED TO MAJOR-GENERAL SIR BINDON BLOOD, K.C.B. UNDER WHOSE COMMAND THE OPERATIONS IN THIS BOOK WERE CARRIED OUT; BY WHOSE LEADERSHIP THEY WERE BROUGHT TO A SUCCESSFUL END; AND TO WHOSE GENEROSITY THE AUTHOR OWES THE MOST VALUABLE AND CAPTIVATING EXPERIENCE OF HIS LIFE.
PREFACE
"According to the fair play of the world, Let me have an audience." "King John," Act v., Sc. 2.
"In the spirit of fairness in the world, Please let me speak to you." "King John," Act v., Sc. 2.
On general grounds I deprecate prefaces. I have always thought that if an author cannot make friends with the reader, and explain his objects, in two or three hundred pages, he is not likely to do so in fifty lines. And yet the temptation of speaking a few words behind the scenes, as it were, is so strong that few writers are able to resist it. I shall not try.
On general grounds, I’m not a fan of prefaces. I’ve always believed that if an author can’t connect with the reader and explain their goals in two or three hundred pages, they probably won’t manage it in fifty lines. Still, the urge to share a few behind-the-scenes thoughts is so strong that few writers can resist it. I won’t attempt to.
While I was attached to the Malakand Field Force I wrote a series of letters for the London Daily Telegraph. The favourable manner in which these letters were received, encouraged me to attempt a more substantial work. This volume is the result.
While I was with the Malakand Field Force, I wrote a series of letters for the London Daily Telegraph. The positive response to these letters motivated me to try creating something more significant. This book is the outcome.
The original letters have been broken up, and I have freely availed myself of all passages, phrases, and facts, that seemed appropriate. The views they contained have not been altered, though several opinions and expressions, which seemed mild in the invigorating atmosphere of a camp, have been modified, to suit the more temperate climate of peace.
The original letters have been divided up, and I've made use of all the parts, phrases, and facts that seemed fitting. The ideas they contained haven't been changed, though some opinions and expressions that seemed mild in the lively atmosphere of a camp have been adjusted to fit the calmer climate of peace.
I have to thank many gallant officers for the assistance they have given me in the collection of material. They have all asked me not to mention their names, but to accede to this request would be to rob the story of the Malakand Field Force of all its bravest deeds and finest characters.
I want to thank many brave officers for the help they've provided in gathering material. They've all asked me not to mention their names, but honoring that request would take away from the story of the Malakand Field Force and its most courageous acts and characters.
The book does not pretend to deal with the complications of the frontier question, nor to present a complete summary of its phases and features. In the opening chapter I have tried to describe the general character of the numerous and powerful tribes of the Indian Frontier. In the last chapter I have attempted to apply the intelligence of a plain man to the vast mass of expert evidence, which on this subject is so great that it baffles memory and exhausts patience. The rest is narrative, and in it I have only desired to show the reader what it looked like.
The book doesn’t aim to tackle all the complexities of the frontier issue, nor does it provide a comprehensive overview of its different aspects. In the opening chapter, I’ve tried to describe the general characteristics of the many influential tribes along the Indian Frontier. In the final chapter, I’ve attempted to use the perspective of an everyday person to make sense of the overwhelming amount of expert information, which is so vast that it can confuse the mind and test one's patience. The rest is narrative, and in it, I’ve simply wanted to give the reader a glimpse of what it was like.
As I have not been able to describe in the text all the instances of conduct and courage which occurred, I have included in an appendix the official despatches.
Since I haven't been able to detail all the examples of behavior and bravery that took place in the text, I’ve added the official reports in an appendix.
The impartial critic will at least admit that I have not insulted the British public by writing a party pamphlet on a great Imperial question. I have recorded the facts as they occurred, and the impressions as they arose, without attempting to make a case against any person or any policy. Indeed, I fear that assailing none, I may have offended all. Neutrality may degenerate into an ignominious isolation. An honest and unprejudiced attempt to discern the truth is my sole defence, as the good opinion of the reader has been throughout my chief aspiration, and can be in the end my only support.
The fair-minded critic will at least acknowledge that I haven't insulted the British public by writing a party pamphlet on a significant Imperial issue. I've documented the facts as they happened and the impressions as they came up, without trying to take a stand against anyone or any policy. In fact, I worry that by not attacking anyone, I might have upset everyone. Being neutral can sometimes lead to shameful isolation. My only defense is my honest and unbiased effort to uncover the truth, as gaining the reader's goodwill has always been my main goal, and ultimately, it will be my only support.
Winston S. Churchill Cavalry Barracks, Bangalore, 30th December, 1897
Winston S. Churchill Cavalry Barracks, Bangalore, December 30, 1897
CHAPTER I: THE THEATRE OF WAR
The Ghilzaie chief wrote answer: "Our paths are narrow and steep. The sun burns fierce in the valleys, and the snow-fed streams run deep; . . . . . . . . . . So a stranger needs safe escort, and the oath of a valiant friend." "The Amir's Message," SIR A. LYALL.
The Ghilzaie chief replied, "Our paths are narrow and steep. The sun beats down hard in the valleys, and the snow-fed streams run deep; . . . . . . . . . . . So a stranger needs a safe escort and the oath of a true friend." "The Amir's Message," SIR A. LYALL.
All along the north and north-west frontiers of India lie the Himalayas, the greatest disturbance of the earth's surface that the convulsions of chaotic periods have produced. Nearly four hundred miles in breadth and more than sixteen hundred in length, this mountainous region divides the great plains of the south from those of Central Asia, and parts as a channel separates opposing shores, the Eastern Empire of Great Britain from that of Russia. The western end of this tumult of ground is formed by the peaks of the Hindu Kush, to the south of which is the scene of the story these pages contain. The Himalayas are not a line, but a great country of mountains. By one who stands on some lofty pass or commanding point in Dir, Swat or Bajaur, range after range is seen as the long surges of an Atlantic swell, and in the distance some glittering snow peak suggests a white-crested roller, higher than the rest. The drenching rains which fall each year have washed the soil from the sides of the hills until they have become strangely grooved by numberless water-courses, and the black primeval rock is everywhere exposed. The silt and sediment have filled the valleys which lie between, and made their surface sandy, level and broad. Again the rain has cut wide, deep and constantly-changing channels through this soft deposit; great gutters, which are sometimes seventy feet deep and two or three hundred yards across. These are the nullahs. Usually the smaller ones are dry, and the larger occupied only by streams; but in the season of the rains, abundant water pours down all, and in a few hours the brook has become an impassable torrent, and the river swelled into a rolling flood which caves the banks round which it swirls, and cuts the channel deeper year by year.
All along the north and northwest borders of India are the Himalayas, the largest upheaval of the earth's surface caused by chaotic events over time. Stretching nearly four hundred miles wide and more than sixteen hundred miles long, this mountainous area separates the vast plains of the south from those of Central Asia. It acts as a channel dividing the Eastern Empire of Great Britain from that of Russia. At the western end of this tumultuous region are the peaks of the Hindu Kush, located south of which is where this story unfolds. The Himalayas aren't just a single line, but a massive expanse of mountains. From a high pass or viewpoint in Dir, Swat, or Bajaur, one can see range after range, rolling like the long waves of the Atlantic, and in the distance, a glimmering snow peak resembles a white-capped wave, standing out among the rest. The heavy rains that fall each year have worn away the soil from the hillsides, leaving them deeply grooved by countless streams, exposing the ancient black rock beneath. The silt and sediment have filled the valleys in between, creating sandy, flat, and wide landscapes. Additionally, the rain has carved out wide, deep, and ever-changing channels through this soft soil; these are large gutters, sometimes reaching seventy feet deep and two or three hundred yards across. These are the nullahs. Typically, the smaller ones are dry, and the larger ones are only filled with streams, but during the rainy season, water flows through all of them, transforming a gentle stream into an impassable torrent within hours, swelling rivers into rolling floods that erode their banks and cut ever-deeper channels year after year.
From the level plain of the valleys the hills rise abruptly. Their steep and rugged slopes are thickly strewn with great rocks, and covered with coarse, rank grass. Scattered pines grow on the higher ridges. In the water-courses the chenar, the beautiful eastern variety of the plane tree of the London squares and Paris boulevards, is occasionally found, and when found, is, for its pleasant shade, regarded with grateful respect. Reaching far up the sides of the hills are tiers of narrow terraces, chiefly the work of long-forgotten peoples, which catch the soil that the rain brings down, and support crops of barley and maize. The rice fields along both banks of the stream display a broad, winding strip of vivid green, which gives the eye its only relief from the sombre colours of the mountains.
From the flat valleys, the hills rise sharply. Their steep, rugged slopes are littered with large rocks and covered in coarse, wild grass. Scattered pines grow on the higher ridges. In the streambeds, the chenar, the beautiful eastern version of the plane tree seen in London squares and Paris boulevards, can occasionally be found and is appreciated for its pleasant shade. Along the hillsides are levels of narrow terraces, largely the work of long-gone peoples, which catch the soil eroded by rain and support crops of barley and maize. The rice fields on both sides of the stream show a broad, winding strip of bright green, providing the eye's only respite from the dark hues of the mountains.
In the spring, indeed, the valleys are brightened by many flowers—wild tulips, peonies, crocuses and several kinds of polyanthus; and among the fruits the water melon, some small grapes and mulberries are excellent, although in their production, nature is unaided by culture. But during the campaign, which these pages describe, the hot sun of the summer had burnt up all the flowers, and only a few splendid butterflies, whose wings of blue and green change colour in the light, like shot silk, contrasted with the sternness of the landscape.
In the spring, the valleys come alive with many flowers—wild tulips, peonies, crocuses, and various kinds of polyanthus. Among the fruits, watermelons, small grapes, and mulberries are amazing, though nature grows them without any help from people. However, during the campaign described in these pages, the scorching summer sun had wilted all the flowers, leaving only a few beautiful butterflies with wings that shimmer in blue and green, changing colors in the light like shot silk, standing out against the harshness of the landscape.
The valleys are nevertheless by no means barren. The soil is fertile, the rains plentiful, and a considerable proportion of ground is occupied by cultivation, and amply supplies the wants of the inhabitants.
The valleys are definitely not barren. The soil is rich, the rainfall is abundant, and a large portion of the land is used for farming, providing more than enough to meet the needs of the residents.
The streams are full of fish, both trout and mahseer. By the banks teal, widgeon and wild duck, and in some places, snipe, are plentiful. Chikor, a variety of partridge, and several sorts of pheasants, are to be obtained on the hills.
The streams are full of fish, including trout and mahseer. Along the banks, there are plenty of teal, widgeon, and wild ducks, and in some areas, snipe are abundant. You can find chikor, a type of partridge, and various kinds of pheasants in the hills.
Among the wild animals of the region the hunter may pursue the black or brown mountain bear, an occasional leopard, markhor, and several varieties of wild goat, sheep and antelope. The smaller quadrupeds include hares and red foxes, not unlike the British breed, only with much brighter coats, and several kinds of rats, some of which are very curious and rare. Destitute of beauty but not without use, the scaly ant-eater is frequently seen; but the most common of all the beasts is an odious species of large lizard, nearly three feet long, which resembles a flabby-skinned crocodile and feeds on carrion. Domestic fowls, goats, sheep and oxen, with the inevitable vulture, and an occasional eagle, complete the fauna.
In the wilds of the region, hunters can track black or brown mountain bears, the occasional leopard, markhor, and various types of wild goats, sheep, and antelope. Smaller animals include hares and red foxes, which are similar to the British variety but with much brighter fur, along with several kinds of rats, some of which are quite unique and rare. Although not beautiful, the scaly anteater is often spotted and serves a purpose in the ecosystem. However, the most common creature here is an unpleasant type of large lizard, nearly three feet long, resembling a flabby-skinned crocodile and feeding on carrion. Domestic chickens, goats, sheep, and oxen, along with the ever-present vulture and the occasional eagle, round out the local wildlife.
Over all is a bright blue sky and powerful sun. Such is the scenery of the theatre of war.
Above, a bright blue sky and a blazing sun stretch out. This is the landscape of the battlefield.
The inhabitants of these wild but wealthy valleys are of many tribes, but of similar character and condition. The abundant crops which a warm sun and copious rains raise from a fertile soil, support a numerous population in a state of warlike leisure. Except at the times of sowing and of harvest, a continual state of feud and strife prevails throughout the land. Tribe wars with tribe. The people of one valley fight with those of the next. To the quarrels of communities are added the combats of individuals. Khan assails khan, each supported by his retainers. Every tribesman has a blood feud with his neighbor. Every man's hand is against the other, and all against the stranger.
The people living in these wild but rich valleys belong to various tribes, yet they share similar characteristics and lifestyles. The plentiful crops produced by the warm sun and heavy rains from the fertile soil support a large population that exists in a state of constant readiness for battle. Except during planting and harvest times, there is an ongoing atmosphere of conflict and struggle throughout the region. One tribe fights another. The residents of one valley battle those in the next. On top of community disputes, there are also individual fights. One khan attacks another, each backed by their followers. Every tribesman has a personal vendetta against his neighbor. Everyone is against everyone else, especially against outsiders.
Nor are these struggles conducted with the weapons which usually belong to the races of such development. To the ferocity of the Zulu are added the craft of the Redskin and the marksmanship of the Boer. The world is presented with that grim spectacle, "the strength of civilisation without its mercy." At a thousand yards the traveller falls wounded by the well-aimed bullet of a breech-loading rifle. His assailant, approaching, hacks him to death with the ferocity of a South-Sea Islander. The weapons of the nineteenth century are in the hands of the savages of the Stone Age.
Nor are these struggles fought with the weapons typically associated with advanced civilizations. The ferocity of the Zulu is combined with the cunning of Native Americans and the marksmanship of the Boers. The world is faced with a grim scene: "the strength of civilization without its compassion." From a thousand yards away, the traveler is struck down by a well-aimed shot from a breech-loading rifle. As his attacker approaches, he is killed with the brutality of a South Sea Islander. The tools of the nineteenth century are wielded by the savages of the Stone Age.
Every influence, every motive, that provokes the spirit of murder among men, impels these mountaineers to deeds of treachery and violence. The strong aboriginal propensity to kill, inherit in all human beings, has in these valleys been preserved in unexampled strength and vigour. That religion, which above all others was founded and propagated by the sword—the tenets and principles of which are instinct with incentives to slaughter and which in three continents has produced fighting breeds of men—stimulates a wild and merciless fanaticism. The love of plunder, always a characteristic of hill tribes, is fostered by the spectacle of opulence and luxury which, to their eyes, the cities and plains of the south display. A code of honour not less punctilious than that of old Spain, is supported by vendettas as implacable as those of Corsica.
Every influence and every motive that stirs up the spirit of murder in people drives these mountain dwellers to acts of betrayal and violence. The strong natural tendency to kill, present in all humans, has been maintained in these valleys with exceptional strength and intensity. That religion, which was established and spread by the sword more than any other—the beliefs and principles of which are filled with calls to violence and which has created warrior cultures across three continents—fuels a wild and ruthless fanaticism. The desire for looting, always a trait of mountain tribes, is intensified by the sight of the wealth and luxury that the cities and plains to the south offer, which they see as impressive. A code of honor as strict as that of old Spain is upheld by feuds as relentless as those in Corsica.
In such a state of society, all property is held directly by main force. Every man is a soldier. Either he is the retainer of some khan—the man-at-arms of some feudal baron as it were—or he is a unit in the armed force of his village—the burgher of mediaeval history. In such surroundings we may without difficulty trace the rise and fall of an ambitious Pathan. At first he toils with zeal and thrift as an agriculturist on that plot of ground which his family have held since they expelled some former owner. He accumulates in secret a sum of money. With this he buys a rifle from some daring thief, who has risked his life to snatch it from a frontier guard-house. He becomes a man to be feared. Then he builds a tower to his house and overawes those around him in the village. Gradually they submit to his authority. He might now rule the village; but he aspires still higher. He persuades or compels his neighbors to join him in an attack on the castle of a local khan. The attack succeeds. The khan flies or is killed; the castle captured. The retainers make terms with the conqueror. The land tenure is feudal. In return for their acres they follow their new chief to war. Were he to treat them worse than the other khans treated their servants, they would sell their strong arms elsewhere. He treats them well. Others resort to him. He buys more rifles. He conquers two or three neighboring khans. He has now become a power.
In a society like this, all property is controlled by force. Every man is a soldier. He is either a servant of some khan—the armed man of a feudal lord—or he is part of the armed force of his village, akin to the townsfolk in medieval times. In this context, we can easily follow the rise and fall of an ambitious Pathan. At first, he works hard and saves as a farmer on the land his family acquired after driving out a previous owner. He secretly saves up some money. With this, he buys a rifle from a daring thief who risked his life to steal it from a guardhouse on the frontier. He becomes someone to be reckoned with. Then, he builds a tower next to his house, intimidating those around him in the village. Gradually, they submit to his authority. He could now rule the village, but he aims even higher. He convinces or forces his neighbors to join him in attacking the castle of a local khan. The attack is successful. The khan flees or is killed, and the castle is taken. The retainers negotiate terms with the conqueror. The land ownership becomes feudal. In exchange for their land, they follow their new leader into battle. If he treats them worse than the other khans treated their followers, they would take their strength elsewhere. He treats them well. Others come to him. He buys more rifles. He conquers two or three neighboring khans. He has now become a significant power.
Many, perhaps all, states have been founded in a similar way, and it is by such steps that civilisation painfully stumbles through her earlier stages. But in these valleys the warlike nature of the people and their hatred of control, arrest the further progress of development. We have watched a man, able, thrifty, brave, fighting his way to power, absorbing, amalgamating, laying the foundations of a more complex and interdependent state of society. He has so far succeeded. But his success is now his ruin. A combination is formed against him. The surrounding chiefs and their adherents are assisted by the village populations. The ambitious Pathan, oppressed by numbers, is destroyed. The victors quarrel over the spoil, and the story closes, as it began, in bloodshed and strife.
Many, perhaps all, states have been established in a similar manner, and it's through these steps that civilization slowly advances through its early stages. However, in these valleys, the aggressive nature of the people and their aversion to control hinder further development. We've observed a man, capable, resourceful, and courageous, fighting his way to power, integrating and laying the groundwork for a more complex and interconnected society. So far, he has succeeded. But now, his success leads to his downfall. A coalition is formed against him. The neighboring chiefs and their supporters are aided by the village populations. The ambitious Pathan, outnumbered, is defeated. The victors argue over the spoils, and the story ends as it began, in violence and conflict.
The conditions of existence, that have been thus indicated, have naturally led to the dwelling-places of these tribes being fortified. If they are in the valley, they are protected by towers and walls loopholed for musketry. If in the hollows of the hills, they are strong by their natural position. In either case they are guarded by a hardy and martial people, well armed, brave, and trained by constant war.
The living conditions mentioned have naturally resulted in these tribes building fortified dwellings. If they're in the valley, they're protected by towers and walls with openings for firearms. If they're in the hollows of the hills, their stronghold comes from the natural landscape. In either scenario, they’re defended by a resilient and warrior-like group, well-armed, brave, and honed through ongoing battles.
This state of continual tumult has produced a habit of mind which recks little of injuries, holds life cheap and embarks on war with careless levity, and the tribesmen of the Afghan border afford the spectacle of a people, who fight without passion, and kill one another without loss of temper. Such a disposition, combined with an absolute lack of reverence for all forms of law and authority, and a complete assurance of equality, is the cause of their frequent quarrels with the British power. A trifle rouses their animosity. They make a sudden attack on some frontier post. They are repulsed. From their point of view the incident is closed. There has been a fair fight in which they have had the worst fortune. What puzzles them is that "the Sirkar" should regard so small an affair in a serious light. Thus the Mohmands cross the frontier and the action of Shabkadr is fought. They are surprised and aggrieved that the Government are not content with the victory, but must needs invade their territories, and impose punishment. Or again, the Mamunds, because a village has been burnt, assail the camp of the Second Brigade by night. It is a drawn game. They are astounded that the troops do not take it in good part.
This ongoing chaos has created a mindset that doesn't care much about injuries, values life cheaply, and approaches war with a reckless attitude. The tribespeople along the Afghan border show us a community that fights without passion and kills each other without losing their cool. This mentality, along with a total disrespect for all forms of law and authority, and a strong belief in equality, leads to their frequent conflicts with British power. Even a small offense can trigger their anger. They launch a surprise attack on a border post. If they’re pushed back, they see the incident as done. From their perspective, it was a fair fight where they just had bad luck. What baffles them is why "the Sirkar" should take such a minor issue seriously. This is how the Mohmands cross the frontier, leading to the clash at Shabkadr. They’re shocked and upset that the Government isn’t satisfied with merely winning but feels the need to invade their lands and impose punishment. Alternatively, the Mamunds, upset that a village was burned, attack the camp of the Second Brigade at night. It's a standoff, and they’re astonished that the troops don’t take it lightly.
They, when they fight among themselves, bear little malice, and the combatants not infrequently make friends over the corpses of their comrades or suspend operations for a festival or a horse race. At the end of the contest cordial relations are at once re-established. And yet so full of contradictions is their character, that all this is without prejudice to what has been written of their family vendettas and private blood feuds. Their system of ethics, which regards treachery and violence as virtues rather than vices, has produced a code of honour so strange and inconsistent, that it is incomprehensible to a logical mind. I have been told that if a white man could grasp it fully, and were to understand their mental impulses—if he knew, when it was their honour to stand by him, and when it was their honour to betray him; when they were bound to protect and when to kill him—he might, by judging his times and opportunities, pass safely from one end of the mountains to the other. But a civilised European is as little able to accomplish this, as to appreciate the feelings of those strange creatures, which, when a drop of water is examined under a microscope, are revealed amiably gobbling each other up, and being themselves complacently devoured.
When they fight among themselves, they don't hold much malice, and the fighters often end up making friends over the bodies of their fallen comrades or take a break for a festival or a horse race. After the battle, they quickly restore friendly relations. Yet, their character is so full of contradictions that this doesn't take away from what's been said about their family feuds and personal blood disputes. Their code of ethics views treachery and violence as virtues instead of vices, resulting in a strange and inconsistent honour system that doesn't make sense to a logical mind. I've been told that if a white person could fully understand it and grasp their motivations—knowing when it was their honour to support him and when it was their honour to betray him; when they were obligated to protect him and when to kill him—they might, by choosing the right moments, manage to travel safely through the mountains. But a civilized European is just as unable to do this as he is to understand the feelings of those odd creatures that, when a drop of water is examined under a microscope, reveal themselves cheerfully consuming each other while also being contentedly devoured.
I remark with pleasure, as an agreeable trait in the character of the Pathans, the immunity, dictated by a rude spirit of chivalry, which in their ceaseless brawling, their women enjoy. Many forts are built at some distance from any pool or spring. When these are besieged, the women are allowed by the assailants to carry water to the foot of the walls by night. In the morning the defenders come out and fetch it—of course under fire—and are enabled to continue their resistance. But passing from the military to the social aspect of their lives, the picture assumes an even darker shade, and is unrelieved by any redeeming virtue. We see them in their squalid, loopholed hovels, amid dirt and ignorance, as degraded a race as any on the fringe of humanity: fierce as the tiger, but less cleanly; as dangerous, not so graceful. Those simple family virtues, which idealists usually ascribe to primitive peoples, are conspicuously absent. Their wives and their womenkind generally, have no position but that of animals. They are freely bought and sold, and are not infrequently bartered for rifles. Truth is unknown among them. A single typical incident displays the standpoint from which they regard an oath. In any dispute about a field boundary, it is customary for both claimants to walk round the boundary he claims, with a Koran in his hand, swearing that all the time he is walking on his own land. To meet the difficulty of a false oath, while he is walking over his neighbor's land, he puts a little dust from his own field into his shoes. As both sides are acquainted with the trick, the dismal farce of swearing is usually soon abandoned, in favor of an appeal to force.
I gladly note, as a positive aspect of the Pathans' character, the tradition of chivalry that allows their women some protection during their constant fighting. Many forts are built far from any water source. When these forts are under siege, the attackers let the women carry water to the foot of the walls at night. In the morning, the defenders come out to fetch it—of course under fire—and manage to keep fighting. However, shifting from the military to the social side of their lives reveals a much darker picture, lacking any redeeming qualities. They live in filthy, poorly constructed homes, surrounded by dirt and ignorance, as degraded a group as any on the edge of society: fierce as tigers, but less clean; just as dangerous, but not as graceful. The simple family values that idealists often attribute to primitive cultures are clearly missing. Their wives and female relatives hold no status other than that of animals. They can be easily bought and sold, and are often traded for rifles. Truth is foreign to them. A typical incident illustrates how they view an oath. In any dispute over a field boundary, both claimants usually walk around the area they assert is theirs, holding a Koran and swearing that they are on their own land the whole time. To get around the issue of a false oath, while walking on their neighbor's land, one of them puts a bit of dust from his own field into his shoes. Since both sides know this trick, the grim farce of swearing is usually quickly set aside in favor of resolving things with force.
All are held in the grip of miserable superstition. The power of the ziarat, or sacred tomb, is wonderful. Sick children are carried on the backs of buffaloes, sometimes sixty or seventy miles, to be deposited in front of such a shrine, after which they are carried back—if they survive the journey—in the same way. It is painful even to think of what the wretched child suffers in being thus jolted over the cattle tracks. But the tribesmen consider the treatment much more efficacious than any infidel prescription. To go to a ziarat and put a stick in the ground is sufficient to ensure the fulfillment of a wish. To sit swinging a stone or coloured glass ball, suspended by a string from a tree, and tied there by some fakir, is a sure method of securing a fine male heir. To make a cow give good milk, a little should be plastered on some favorite stone near the tomb of a holy man. These are but a few instances; but they may suffice to reveal a state of mental development at which civilisation hardly knows whether to laugh or weep.
Everyone is caught up in miserable superstitions. The power of the ziarat, or sacred tomb, is incredible. Sick children are carried on the backs of buffaloes, sometimes as far as sixty or seventy miles, to be placed in front of such a shrine, and then taken back—if they survive the trip—in the same manner. It’s painful to even think about what the poor child endures while being jolted over bumpy paths. But the tribespeople believe this treatment is much more effective than any outsider's medicine. Just visiting a ziarat and sticking a stick in the ground is enough to ensure a wish comes true. Swinging a stone or a colored glass ball, hung by a string from a tree and tied there by a religious figure, is a reliable method to secure a healthy male heir. To make a cow produce good milk, some should be smeared on a favorite stone near the tomb of a holy man. These are just a few examples, but they highlight a level of mental development where civilization barely knows whether to laugh or cry.
Their superstition exposes them to the rapacity and tyranny of a numerous priesthood—"Mullahs," "Sahibzadas," "Akhundzadas," "Fakirs,"—and a host of wandering Talib-ul-ilms, who correspond with the theological students in Turkey, and live free at the expense of the people. More than this, they enjoy a sort of "droit du seigneur," and no man's wife or daughter is safe from them. Of some of their manners and morals it is impossible to write. As Macaulay has said of Wycherley's plays, "they are protected against the critics as a skunk is protected against the hunters." They are "safe, because they are too filthy to handle, and too noisome even to approach."
Their superstition makes them vulnerable to the greed and oppression of a large group of priests—"Mullahs," "Sahibzadas," "Akhundzadas," "Fakirs,"—and many wandering Talib-ul-ilms, who connect with theological students in Turkey and live off the people. Furthermore, they enjoy a kind of "droit du seigneur," meaning no man’s wife or daughter is safe from them. Some of their behaviors and morals are too shocking to describe. As Macaulay remarked about Wycherley's plays, "they are protected against the critics as a skunk is protected against the hunters." They are "safe because they are too filthy to handle and too repulsive even to approach."
Yet the life even of these barbarous people is not without moments when the lover of the picturesque might sympathise with their hopes and fears. In the cool of the evening, when the sun has sunk behind the mountains of Afghanistan, and the valleys are filled with a delicious twilight, the elders of the village lead the way to the chenar trees by the water's side, and there, while the men are cleaning their rifles, or smoking their hookas, and the women are making rude ornaments from beads, and cloves, and nuts, the Mullah drones the evening prayer. Few white men have seen, and returned to tell the tale. But we may imagine the conversation passing from the prices of arms and cattle, the prospects of the harvest, or the village gossip, to the great Power, that lies to the southward, and comes nearer year by year. Perhaps some former Sepoy, of Beluchis or Pathans, will recount his adventures in the bazaars of Peshawar, or tell of the white officers he has followed and fought for in the past. He will speak of their careless bravery and their strange sports; of the far-reaching power of the Government, that never forgets to send his pension regularly as the months pass by; and he may even predict to the listening circle the day when their valleys will be involved in the comprehensive grasp of that great machine, and judges, collectors and commissioners shall ride to sessions at Ambeyla, or value the land tax on the soil of Nawagai. Then the Mullah will raise his voice and remind them of other days when the sons of the prophet drove the infidel from the plains of India, and ruled at Delhi, as wide an Empire as the Kafir holds to-day: when the true religion strode proudly through the earth and scorned to lie hidden and neglected among the hills: when mighty princes ruled in Bagdad, and all men knew that there was one God, and Mahomet was His prophet. And the young men hearing these things will grip their Martinis, and pray to Allah, that one day He will bring some Sahib—best prize of all—across their line of sight at seven hundred yards so that, at least, they may strike a blow for insulted and threatened Islam.
Yet the lives of these people, even though they may seem primitive, still have moments where someone who appreciates beauty could relate to their hopes and fears. In the cool of the evening, when the sun sets behind the mountains of Afghanistan and the valleys are bathed in a lovely twilight, the village elders lead everyone to the chenar trees by the water. There, while the men clean their rifles or smoke their hookahs, and the women craft simple ornaments from beads, cloves, and nuts, the Mullah calls out the evening prayer. Few white men have seen this scene and lived to tell the story. But we can imagine conversations shifting from the prices of weapons and livestock, the outlook for the harvest, or local gossip, to the great power looming to the south, getting closer each year. Perhaps a former soldier, whether a Beluchi or a Pathan, will share his experiences in the Peshawar bazaars, or talk about the white officers he has supported and fought for in the past. He will mention their carefree bravery and their unusual pastimes; about the reliable power of the Government that always ensures his pension arrives regularly each month; and he might even predict to the attentive listeners the day when their valleys will fall under the vast control of that formidable system, with judges, tax collectors, and officials coming to hold court in Ambeyla, or assessing land taxes in Nawagai. Then the Mullah will raise his voice to remind them of earlier days when the followers of the prophet expelled the infidels from the plains of India and ruled over a vast empire from Delhi, as extensive as the territory the Kafir holds today; when true faith proudly walked the earth and refused to remain hidden in the hills; when powerful rulers reigned in Baghdad, and everyone knew there was one God, and Muhammad was His prophet. Hearing this, the young men will grip their Martinis and pray to Allah for the day He sends a Sahib—an ultimate prize—into their line of sight at seven hundred yards, so they can at least take a stand for their insulted and threatened Islam.
The general aspect of the country and character of its inhabitants have thus been briefly described. At this stage it is not necessary or desirable to descend to detail. As the account proceeds the reader may derive a more lively impression of the sombre mountains, and of the peoples who dwell beneath their shadow.
The overall look of the country and the nature of its people have been briefly outlined. At this point, it's neither necessary nor helpful to go into detail. As the story continues, the reader will get a more vivid sense of the dark mountains and the communities that live under their shadow.
The tale that I have to tell is one of frontier war. Neither the importance of the issues, nor the numbers of the combatants, are on an European scale. The fate of empires does not hang on the result. Yet the narrative may not be without interest, or material for reflection. In the quarrels of civilised nations, great armies, many thousands strong, collide. Brigades and battalions are hurried forward, and come perhaps within some fire zone, swept by concentrated batteries, or massed musketry. Hundreds or thousands fall killed and wounded. The survivors struggle on blindly, dazed and dumfoundered, to the nearest cover. Fresh troops are continuously poured on from behind. At length one side or the other gives way. In all this tumult, this wholesale slaughter, the individual and his feelings are utterly lost. Only the army has a tale to tell. With events on such a scale, the hopes and fears, the strength and weakness, of man are alike indistinguishable. Amid the din and dust little but destruction can be discerned. But on the frontier, in the clear light of morning, when the mountain side is dotted with smoke puffs, and every ridge sparkles with bright sword blades, the spectator may observe and accurately appreciate all grades of human courage—the wild fanaticism of the Ghazi, the composed fatalism of the Sikh, the stubbornness of the British soldier, and the jaunty daring of his officers. He may remark occasions of devotion and self-sacrifice, of cool cynicism and stern resolve. He may participate in moments of wild enthusiasm, or of savage anger and dismay. The skill of the general, the quality of the troops, the eternal principles of the art of war, will be as clearly displayed as on historic fields. Only the scale of the statistics is reduced.
The story I have to share is about frontier warfare. The stakes and the number of fighters involved are not as significant as they would be in Europe. The outcome won’t determine the fate of empires. Still, this account is worth your attention and reflection. In the conflicts of civilized nations, large armies, numbering in the thousands, clash. Brigades and battalions are rushed to the frontlines, landing in fire zones targeted by concentrated artillery or massed gunfire. Hundreds, if not thousands, are killed or wounded. The survivors stumble blindly, stunned and confused, in search of the nearest shelter. Fresh troops are constantly sent in from the back. Eventually, one side or the other will break under the pressure. In all this chaos and widespread death, the individual and their emotions are completely overlooked. Only the army as a whole has a story to tell. With events happening on such a grand scale, the hopes and fears, strengths and weaknesses of individuals become indistinguishable. Amid the noise and dust, all that can be seen is destruction. But on the frontier, in the clear morning light, as the mountains are dotted with smoke and every ridge glints with bright swords, an observer can witness and appreciate all levels of human courage—the wild fanaticism of the Ghazi, the calm acceptance of fate by the Sikh, the determination of the British soldier, and the bold audacity of his officers. One can note instances of devotion and self-sacrifice, cold cynicism, and strong resolve. Moments of wild enthusiasm or brutal anger and shock can also be experienced. The general's skill, the troops' quality, and the timeless principles of warfare will be displayed just as clearly as on famous historical battlefields. The only difference is the scale of the numbers.
A single glass of champagne imparts a feeling of exhilaration. The nerves are braced, the imagination is agreeably stirred, the wits become more nimble. A bottle produces a contrary effect. Excess causes a comatose insensibility. So it is with war, and the quality of both is best discovered by sipping.
A single glass of champagne gives you a rush of excitement. Your nerves feel alive, your imagination kicks in, and your mind starts racing. But a whole bottle has the opposite effect. Too much leads to a dull, sluggish state. It’s the same with war; you really understand both by taking it slow.
I propose to chronicle the military operations of the Malakand Field Force, to trace their political results, and to give, if possible, some picture of the scenery and people of the Indian Highlands. These pages may serve to record the actions of brave and skilful men. They may throw a sidelight on the great drama of frontier war. They may describe an episode in that ceaseless struggle for Empire which seems to be the perpetual inheritance of our race. They may amuse an idle hour. But the ambition I shall associate with them is, that in some measure, however small, they may stimulate that growing interest which the Imperial Democracy of England is beginning to take, in their great estates that lie beyond the seas.
I plan to document the military operations of the Malakand Field Force, explore their political impacts, and provide, if possible, some insight into the scenery and people of the Indian Highlands. These pages may serve to highlight the actions of brave and skilled individuals. They may shed light on the larger narrative of frontier warfare. They may depict a moment in the ongoing struggle for Empire that seems to be the constant legacy of our people. They may entertain during a free moment. However, my main hope is that, in some small way, they will encourage the growing interest that the Imperial Democracy of England is starting to show in its vast territories beyond the seas.
CHAPTER II: THE MALAKAND CAMPS
Ibam forte via sacra.—HORACE.
I was walking along the sacred road.—HORACE.
The town and cantonment of Nowshera was the base from which all the operations of the Malakand Field Force were conducted. It is situated on the India side of the Cabul River and is six hours by rail from Rawal Pindi. In times of peace its garrison consists of one native cavalry regiment, one British, and one native infantry battalion. During the war these troops were employed at the front. The barracks became great hospitals. The whole place was crowded with transport and military stores; and only a slender force remained under the orders of Colonel Schalch, the Base Commandant.
The town and military camp of Nowshera was the hub from which all operations of the Malakand Field Force were carried out. It is located on the Indian side of the Cabul River and is a six-hour train ride from Rawalpindi. In peacetime, its garrison consists of one native cavalry regiment, one British regiment, and one native infantry battalion. During the war, these troops were sent to the front lines. The barracks turned into large hospitals. The entire area was packed with transport and military supplies, leaving only a small force under the command of Colonel Schalch, the Base Commandant.
The road from Nowshera to the Malakand Pass and camps is forty-seven miles long, and divided into four stages. Usually there is an excellent tonga service, and the distance is covered in about six hours; but while the Field Force was mobilised so much traffic and so many officers passed up and down the line, that the tonga ponies were soon reduced to a terrible condition of sores and emaciation, and could hardly drag the journey out in nine, ten, or even twelve hours. After leaving Nowshera, and crossing the Cabul River, a stage of fifteen miles brings the traveller to Mardan. This place—pronounced "Merdane"—is the permanent station of the Corps of Guides. It is shady and agreeable, though terribly hot in the summer months. It boasts an excellent polo ground and a comfortable rest-house. The passer-by should pause to see the Guides' cemetery, perhaps the only regimental cemetery in the world. To this last resting-place under the palm trees, close to the fields where they have played, and the barracks in which they lived, have been borne the bodies of successive generations of these wardens of the marches, killed in action across the frontier line. It is a green and pleasant spot. Nor is there any place in the world where a soldier might lie in braver company.
The road from Nowshera to the Malakand Pass and camps is 47 miles long and divided into four segments. Usually, there’s a great tonga service, and the trip takes about six hours. However, during the mobilization of the Field Force, so much traffic and so many officers moved up and down the route that the tonga ponies quickly became worn out and unhealthy, and they could barely manage the journey in nine, ten, or even twelve hours. After leaving Nowshera and crossing the Cabul River, a 15-mile stretch brings travelers to Mardan. This place—pronounced "Merdane"—is the permanent station of the Corps of Guides. It’s shady and pleasant, although extremely hot during the summer months. It features an excellent polo ground and a nice rest house. Passersby should take a moment to visit the Guides' cemetery, perhaps the only regimental cemetery in the world. This final resting place, under the palm trees and close to the fields where they played and the barracks where they lived, holds the remains of generations of these guardians of the borders who were killed in action across the frontier. It’s a green and peaceful spot. There’s no place in the world where a soldier could rest in braver company.
After Mardan the road becomes more dusty, and the surrounding country barren and arid. [This description applies to the autumn season. In the winter and spring the country for a time is green and the air cold.] The mountains are approached, and as the tonga advances their shapes and colours are more distinctly seen. A few knolls and ridges rising from the level plain, mark the outposts of that great array of hills. Crossing a shallow stream—a tributary of the Cabul River, Jalala, the second stage is reached. In peace time a small mud fort is the only indication, but this is expanded by the proximity of war to a considerable camp, with an entrenchment around it. Stopping only to change ponies, for it is a forsaken spot, the journey is resumed. The avenue of trees on either side has ceased. The road is seen simply as a white streak stretching towards the mountains. It is traversed in a sweltering heat and choking dust. All around the country is red, sterile and burnt up. In front the great wall of hills rises dark and ominous. At length Dargai at the foot of the pass is reached. It is another mud fort, swelled during the operations into an entrenched camp, and surrounded by a network of barbed wire entanglement. The Malakand Pass can now be seen—a great cleft in the line of mountains—and far up the gorge, the outline of the fort that guards it, is distinguishable.
After Mardan, the road gets dustier, and the surrounding land is dry and barren. [This description applies to the autumn season. In winter and spring, the land is green for a while, and the air is cold.] As the tonga moves closer to the mountains, their shapes and colors become clearer. A few small hills and ridges rise from the flat land, marking the outskirts of the vast range of hills. After crossing a shallow stream—a tributary of the Cabul River—Jalala, the second stage, is reached. Normally, a small mud fort indicates the place, but with the threat of war nearby, it has expanded into a substantial camp surrounded by fortifications. Stopping only to switch ponies, since it's an isolated area, the journey continues. The rows of trees on either side have disappeared. The road is now just a white line stretching toward the mountains, traveled in sweltering heat and choking dust. All around, the land is red, barren, and scorched. In front, the towering wall of hills looms dark and foreboding. Finally, Dargai at the base of the pass is reached. It’s another mud fort, which has swelled into a fortified camp during the military operations, surrounded by a web of barbed wire. The Malakand Pass can now be seen—a significant gap in the line of mountains—and up the gorge, the outline of the fort that protects it is visible.
The graded road winds up, with many a turn, the long ascent from Dargai to the top of the pass. The driver flogs the wretched, sore-backed ponies tirelessly. At length the summit is neared. The view is one worth stopping to look at. Behind and below, under the haze of the heat, is the wide expanse of open country—smooth, level, stretching away to the dim horizon. The tonga turns the corner and enters a new world. A cooler breeze is blowing. A single step has led from peace to war; from civilisation to savagery; from India to the mountains. On all sides the landscape is wild and rugged. Ridge succeeds ridge. Valley opens into valley. As far as the eye can reach in every direction are ragged peaks and spurs. The country of the plains is left, and we have entered a strange land, as tangled as the maze at Hampton Court, with mountains instead of hedges. So broken and so confused is the ground, that I despair of conveying a clear impression of it.
The graded road winds upwards, with many twists and turns, on the long climb from Dargai to the top of the pass. The driver relentlessly urges the poor, sore-backed ponies onward. Finally, we approach the summit. The view is definitely worth stopping for. Behind and below us, under the haze of heat, is a vast stretch of open country—flat and expansive, extending toward the distant horizon. The tonga rounds the corner and enters a whole new world. A cooler breeze greets us. With one step, we’ve moved from peace to conflict; from civilization to wilderness; from India to the mountains. All around, the landscape is wild and rugged. Ridge follows ridge. Valley opens into valley. As far as the eye can see in every direction are jagged peaks and spurs. We’ve left the flatlands behind and entered a strange land, as complicated as the maze at Hampton Court, but with mountains instead of hedges. The ground is so broken and disordered that I struggle to give a clear impression of it.
The Malakand is like a great cup, of which the rim is broken into numerous clefts and jagged points. At the bottom of this cup is the "crater" camp. The deepest cleft is the Malakand Pass. The highest of the jagged points is Guides Hill, on a spur of which the fort stands. It needs no technical knowledge to see, that to defend such a place, the rim of the cup must be held. But in the Malakand, the bottom of the cup is too small to contain the necessary garrison. The whole position is therefore, from the military point of view, bad and indefensible. In the revised and improved scheme of defence, arrangements have been made, to command the available approaches, and to block such as cannot be commanded with barbed wire entanglements and other obstructions; and by a judicious system of works much of the rim is now held. But even now I am told by competent judges that the place is a bad one for defence; that the pass could be held by the fort alone, and that the brigade stationed there would be safer and equally useful, if withdrawn to Dargai. At the time this story opens the Malakand South Camp was an impossible place to put troops in. It was easy of access. It was cramped and commanded by neighbouring heights. [Under the arrangements which have been made since the war, the Malakand position and the works at Chakdara and Dargai will be held by two battalions and some details. These will be supported by a flying column, the exact location and composition of which are as yet undetermined.]
The Malakand resembles a large cup with its rim broken into many gaps and sharp points. At the bottom of this cup is the "crater" camp. The deepest gap is the Malakand Pass, while the highest jagged point is Guides Hill, where the fort is located. It's clear that to defend such a place, the rim of the cup needs to be secured. However, in the Malakand, the bottom of the cup is too small to hold the necessary troops. So, from a military perspective, the entire position is poor and indefensible. The revised and improved defense plan has made arrangements to secure the available routes and block those that can’t be controlled with barbed wire and other obstacles; and through a strategic system of fortifications, much of the rim is now held. Yet, I’ve been told by knowledgeable sources that the location is still not ideal for defense; that the pass could only be held by the fort alone, and that the brigade stationed there would be safer and just as effective if moved to Dargai. When this story begins, the Malakand South Camp was not a suitable place to station troops. It was easily accessible, cramped, and overlooked by nearby heights. [According to the arrangements made since the war, the Malakand position and the works at Chakdara and Dargai will be held by two battalions and some support units. They will be backed by a mobile unit, the exact location and composition of which are still to be determined.]
The small area of the camp on the Kotal necessitated the formation of a second encampment in the plain of Khar. This was close under the north outer edge of the cup. It was called for political reasons North Malakand. As a military position it, also, was radically bad. It was everywhere commanded, and surrounded by ravines and nullahs, which made it easy for an enemy to get in, and difficult for troops to get out. It was, of course, of no strategic value, and was merely used as a habitation for the troops intended to hold Malakand, for whom there was no room in the crater and fort. The north camp has now been definitely abandoned.
The small section of the camp at Kotal required setting up a second camp in the Khar plain. This was located just beneath the northern outer edge of the basin. For political reasons, it was named North Malakand. However, as a military position, it was fundamentally poor. It was overlooked from all sides and surrounded by ravines and dry streams, making it easy for an enemy to invade and difficult for troops to escape. It had no strategic value and was just used as living quarters for the soldiers meant to secure Malakand, as there wasn't enough space in the crater and fort. The northern camp has now been permanently abandoned.
Nobody, however—least of all those who selected the site—would seem to have contemplated the possibility of an attack. Indeed the whole situation was regarded as purely temporary. The vacillation, caused by the change of parties and policies in England, led to the Malakand garrison remaining for two years in a position which could not be well defended either on paper or in reality. At first, after the Chitral campaign of 1895, it was thought that the retention of the brigade in this advanced post, was only a matter of a few weeks. But as the months passed by the camp began, in spite of the uncertainty, to assume an appearance of permanency. The officers built themselves huts and mess rooms. A good polo ground was discovered near Khar, and under careful management rapidly improved. A race-course was projected. Many officers who were married brought their wives and families to the camp among the mountains, and the whole place was rapidly becoming a regular cantonment. No cases of Ghazi outrage broke the tranquillity. The revolvers, which all persons leaving camp were by regulations obliged to take, were either unloaded or carried by a native groom. Shooting parties were organised to the hills. A well-contested polo tournament was held in Christmas week. Distinguished travellers—even a member of Parliament—visited this outpost of empire, and observed with interest the swiftness and ease with which the Anglo-Saxon adapts every situation to his sports and habits.
Nobody, however—especially not those who chose the location—seemed to have considered the possibility of an attack. In fact, the entire situation was seen as purely temporary. The uncertainty, brought on by the shift in political parties and policies in England, resulted in the Malakand garrison staying in a position that couldn’t be effectively defended, either on paper or in reality, for two years. Initially, after the Chitral campaign of 1895, it was believed that keeping the brigade at this forward post would only last a few weeks. But as the months went by, the camp began to take on an air of permanence, despite the uncertainty. The officers built themselves huts and mess halls. They discovered a great polo ground near Khar, which improved quickly under good management. They planned a racecourse. Many married officers brought their wives and families to the camp in the mountains, and the whole area was quickly becoming a proper cantonment. No incidents of Ghazi violence disrupted the calm. The revolvers that everyone was required to take when leaving the camp were either unloaded or carried by a local servant. Shooting parties were organized in the hills. A well-fought polo tournament was held during Christmas week. Notable visitors—even a member of Parliament—came to this outpost of the empire and watched with interest how easily and quickly the Anglo-Saxon adapts every situation to their sports and lifestyle.
At the same time the station of the Malakand Brigade was far from being a comfortable one. For two years they lived under canvas or in rude huts. They were exposed to extremes of climate. They were without punkahs or ice in the hot weather. They were nearly fifty miles from the railway, and in respect of companionship and amusements were thrown entirely on their own resources. When the British cavalry officer succeeds, in spite of official opposition, expense and discouragement, in getting on service across the frontier, he is apt to look with envious eyes at the officers of the Frontier Force, who are taken as a matter of course and compelled to do by command, what he would solicit as a favour. But he must remember that this is their compensation for long months of discomfort and monotony in lonely and out-of-the-way stations, and for undergoing hardships which, though honourable and welcome in the face of the enemy, become obnoxious in times of peace.
At the same time, the Malakand Brigade's station was anything but comfortable. For two years, they lived in tents or basic huts. They faced extreme weather conditions, without fans or ice during the hot months. They were nearly fifty miles from the railway, relying completely on themselves for companionship and entertainment. When a British cavalry officer manages to get deployed across the frontier despite official pushback, costs, and challenges, he tends to be envious of the Frontier Force officers, who are routinely assigned to do what he would ask for as a favor. However, he must remember that this is their reward for enduring long months of discomfort and monotony in isolated stations, and for facing hardships that, while honorable when in the line of duty, become burdensome in peacetime.
After crossing the Malakand Pass the first turning to the right leads to the Swat Valley. The traveller is now within the mountains. In every direction the view is restricted or terminated by walls of rock. The valley itself is broad, level and fertile. The river flows swiftly through the middle. On either side of it, is a broad strip of rice fields. Other crops occupy the drier ground. Numerous villages, some of which contain large populations, are scattered about. It is a beautiful scene. The cool breezes of the mountains temper the heat of the sun. The abundant rains preserve the verdure of the earth.
After crossing the Malakand Pass, the first turn to the right leads to the Swat Valley. The traveler is now surrounded by mountains. The view in every direction is blocked by towering rock walls. The valley itself is wide, flat, and fertile. The river flows quickly through the center. On either side of it, there’s a wide strip of rice fields. Other crops grow in the drier areas. Numerous villages, some quite large, are spread throughout. It’s a stunning scene. The cool mountain breezes ease the heat of the sun. The plentiful rains keep the earth lush and green.
In ancient times this region was the seat of a Buddhistic kingdom, and was known as Woo-Chang or "Udyana," which means "the Park," and proclaims the appreciation which its former possessors had of their pleasant valley. "The people," says the Chinese pilgrim Fa-hien, who visited the country in the fifth century, "all use the language of Central India, 'Central India' being what we should call the 'Middle Kingdom.' The food and clothes of the common people are the same as in that Central Kingdom. The law of Buddha is very flourishing in Woo-Chang." "The Park," which includes all the country on both banks of the Swat River—then called the Subhavastu—but which perhaps applies more particularly to the upper end of the valley, was famous for its forests, flowers and fruit. But though the valley retains much of its beauty, its forests have been destroyed by the improvidence, and its flowers and fruit have declined through the ignorance, of the fierce conquerors into whose hands it fell.
In ancient times, this area was the center of a Buddhist kingdom and was known as Woo-Chang or "Udyana," meaning "the Park," which reflects how much its former inhabitants appreciated their beautiful valley. "The people," says the Chinese traveler Fa-hien, who visited in the fifth century, "all speak the language of Central India, which we would refer to as the 'Middle Kingdom.' The food and clothing of the common people are the same as in that Central Kingdom. The teachings of Buddha are thriving in Woo-Chang." "The Park," which encompasses all the land on both sides of the Swat River—then known as the Subhavastu—but likely refers more specifically to the upper part of the valley, was renowned for its forests, flowers, and fruit. However, despite the valley still holding onto much of its beauty, its forests have been wiped out due to wastefulness, and its flowers and fruits have dwindled because of the ignorance of the fierce conquerors who took over.
The reputation which its present inhabitants enjoy is evil. Their treacherous character has distinguished them even among peoples notoriously faithless and cruel. Among Pathans it is a common saying: "Swat is heaven, but the Swatis are hell-fiends." For many years they had lain under the stigma of cowardice, and were despised as well as distrusted by the tribes of the border; but their conduct in the recent fighting has cleared them at least from this imputation.
The reputation of the current residents is terrible. Their deceitful nature sets them apart even among groups known for being untrustworthy and brutal. Among the Pathans, a common saying goes: "Swat is paradise, but the Swatis are hellish." For many years, they were labeled as cowards, looked down upon and mistrusted by the tribes along the border; however, their actions in the recent conflict have at least redeemed them from that accusation.
Several minor chieftains now divide authority in the Swat Valley, but till 1870 it was governed by a single ruler. The Ahkund of Swat was by origin a cowherd, an office considered most honourable in India. The cow is a sacred beast. His service is acceptable to the Gods and men. Princes glory in the name—though they do not usually carry their enthusiasm further. "Guicowar" translated literally means "cowherd." From such employment the future Ahkund received his inspiration. He sat for many years by the banks of the Indus, and meditated. Thus he became a saint. The longer his riparian reflections were continued, the greater his sanctity became. The fame of his holiness spread throughout all the region. The Swatis besought him to come and live in their valley. After dignified and diplomatic reluctance, he consented to exchange the banks of the Indus for those of the Swat. For some years, he lived in the green valley, and enjoyed the reverence of its people. At the time of the great mutiny, Said Akbar, the King of Swat, died, and the saint succeeded to the temporal as well as the spiritual authority. In 1863 he preached the Jehad against the British, and headed the Swatis and Bunerwals in the Ambeyla campaign. The power which the Sirkar so extravagantly displayed to bring the war to an end, evidently impressed the old man, for at its close he made friends with the Government and received from them many tokens of respect.
Several minor chieftains now share authority in the Swat Valley, but until 1870, it was ruled by a single leader. The Ahkund of Swat originally came from a cowherding background, a job regarded as very honorable in India. Cows are sacred animals, and serving them is deemed acceptable by both the Gods and people. Princes take pride in the title—though they typically don’t show much enthusiasm beyond that. "Guicowar" literally means "cowherd." From this work, the future Ahkund found his inspiration. He spent many years by the banks of the Indus, meditating. This led him to become a saint. The longer he contemplated by the river, the more his holiness grew. His fame spread throughout the region, and the people of Swat urged him to come and live in their valley. After some dignified and diplomatic hesitance, he agreed to leave the Indus for Swat. He lived in the lush valley for a few years, enjoying the respect of its inhabitants. During the time of the great mutiny, Said Akbar, the King of Swat, passed away, and the saint took on both temporal and spiritual authority. In 1863, he called for a jihad against the British and led the Swatis and Bunerwals in the Ambeyla campaign. The power that the government displayed to end the war clearly made an impression on the elderly man, for after it was over, he reconciled with the government and received many symbols of respect from them.
Before he died in 1870, he summoned his people around him and declared to them that one day their valley would be the scene of a struggle between the Russians and the British. When that came to pass he charged them to fight on our side. The saying is firmly fixed in the hearts of the tribesmen, and is associated with the memory of their famous priest, known to English minds chiefly through the medium of the "Bab Ballads."
Before he died in 1870, he called his people together and told them that one day their valley would be the site of a battle between the Russians and the British. When that happened, he urged them to fight on our side. This saying is deeply embedded in the hearts of the tribesmen and is linked to the memory of their famous priest, recognized by the English mainly through the "Bab Ballads."
His two sons are dead, but his two grandsons, [the Mianguls of Swat] both quite young, live on in the valley, and are the owners of the Ahkund's freeholds, which are in every section of the Swat country. They have very little political influence; but their persons and property are respected by the people and by the British for the sake of their grandfather, who sleeps in an odour of sanctity at Saidu, near Mingaora.
His two sons are gone, but his two grandsons, [the Mianguls of Swat], both quite young, continue to live in the valley and own the Ahkund's landholdings, which are spread across different parts of Swat. They don’t have much political power, but people respect them and their property, including the British, because of their grandfather, who is honored and remembered in Saidu, near Mingaora.
From the Malakand the signal tower of Chakdara can be seen eight miles away to the eastward. Thither the broad graded road runs like a ribbon across the plain. Seven miles from the Kotal Camp, it crosses the Amandara Pass, a gap in a considerable underfeature, which juts from the southern mountains. After this it turns more to the north and leads to the fortified bridge across the river. I invite the reader to remark this road, for it is historic. It is not only the route by which the Malakand Field Force was able to advance, but it is the very reason of their existence. Without this road there would have been no Malakand Camps, no fighting, no Malakand Field Force, no story. It is the road to Chitral.
From the Malakand, you can see the signal tower of Chakdara eight miles to the east. The wide, smooth road stretches like a ribbon across the plain. Seven miles from the Kotal Camp, it crosses the Amandara Pass, a gap in a significant ridge that sticks out from the southern mountains. After this, it turns more toward the north and leads to the fortified bridge over the river. I invite the reader to notice this road because it's historic. It's not just the route that allowed the Malakand Field Force to move forward; it's the very reason for their existence. Without this road, there would have been no Malakand Camps, no fighting, no Malakand Field Force, no story. It’s the road to Chitral.
Here then, at once, the whole vast question of frontier policy is raised. We hold the Malakand Pass to keep the Chitral road open. We keep the Chitral road open because we have retained Chitral. We retain Chitral in accordance with the "Forward Policy." I am thus confronted at the very outset of this book, which was intended to be devoted chiefly to the narration of military events and small incidents, with that wide political question, on which the keenest intellects in England are in doubt, and the most valuable expert evidence in India is divided. The reader must not think me pusillanimous or weak if I postpone the discussion of so great and controversial a matter till a later chapter, when I may perhaps enjoy a larger measure of his sympathy and agreement. After the story has been told, it may not be inappropriate to point the moral.
Here, then, the entire vast issue of frontier policy comes up. We hold the Malakand Pass to keep the Chitral road open. We keep the Chitral road open because we've retained Chitral. We retain Chitral based on the "Forward Policy." I'm confronted right at the beginning of this book, which was meant mainly to describe military events and small incidents, with this significant political question, on which the smartest minds in England are uncertain, and the most valuable expert opinions in India are divided. The reader shouldn't see me as timid or weak if I put off discussing such a major and controversial topic until a later chapter, when I might have a greater measure of your sympathy and agreement. After the story has been told, it may not be out of place to point out the moral.
Prudence encourages procrastination. But while the consideration of the advisability of the retention of Chitral may be deferred, a description of the means is convenient, if not necessary, to the present chapter.
Prudence promotes procrastination. However, while it's possible to delay thinking about whether keeping Chitral is a good idea, it’s helpful, if not essential, to describe the methods for the current chapter.
Nowshera is the railway base of the road. Thence we have followed it to Mardan and across the frontier. Here the new and disputed portion begins. Passing at first through the Lower Ranizai country, it climbs the Malakand Pass, descends into the valley beyond and runs thence through Upper Ranizai territory and Lower Swat to Chakdara. Here it crosses the Swat River by the fine suspension bridge which the fort guards. The three spans of this bridge are together nearly 1500 feet long. It was constructed in 1895, during the operations, in about six weeks, and is a very remarkable piece of military engineering. Beyond the Swat the road runs through the territories of the Khan of Dir, north and east to Sadu, an obscure village thirty-five miles from Malakand. This marks the end of the first section, and further than this wheeled traffic cannot go. The road, now become a camel track, winds along the left bank of the Panjkora River to within five miles of Dir, where it crosses to the right bank by another suspension bridge. Thence it continues to the junction of the Dir stream, along which it finds its way to Dir itself, some fifty miles from Sadu. Beyond Dir camels cannot proceed, and here begins the third section—a path practicable only for mules, and about sixty miles long. From Dir the road is a triumph of engineering. In many places it is carried on wooden galleries perched on the faces of steep and tremendous cliffs, and at others it works round spurs by astounding zig-zags, or is scarped from the mountain side. At the end of the road is Fort Chitral with a garrison of two battalions, one company of sappers, and two mountain guns.
Nowshera is the railway hub for the road. From there, we traveled to Mardan and across the border. This is where the new and contested area begins. Initially passing through the Lower Ranizai region, it climbs the Malakand Pass, descends into the valley, and then continues through Upper Ranizai territory and Lower Swat to Chakdara. Here, it crosses the Swat River using the impressive suspension bridge protected by the fort. The three spans of this bridge total nearly 1500 feet in length. It was built in 1895 during military operations in about six weeks, and it's a remarkable feat of military engineering. Beyond the Swat, the road goes through the territories of the Khan of Dir, heading north and east to Sadu, a small village thirty-five miles from Malakand. This marks the end of the first section, and from here, wheeled traffic cannot continue. The road, which becomes a camel track, winds along the left bank of the Panjkora River to within five miles of Dir, where it crosses to the right bank via another suspension bridge. From there, it leads to the junction of the Dir stream, making its way to Dir itself, about fifty miles from Sadu. Beyond Dir, camels cannot continue, and this is where the third section begins—a path suitable only for mules, measuring around sixty miles. From Dir, the road is a marvel of engineering. In many places, it's built on wooden galleries perched on steep and towering cliffs, while in others, it navigates around spurs with incredible zig-zags or is cut into the mountainside. At the end of the road is Fort Chitral, which has a garrison of two battalions, one company of sappers, and two mountain guns.
The road is maintained and protected by the tribes through whose territories it passes; but the two principal points where it might be closed are held by Imperial garrisons. The Malakand Fort guards the passage of the mountains. Chakdara holds the bridge across the river. The rest is left to the tribal levies. The Ranizai tribe receive an annual subsidy from the Indian Government of 30,000 rupees, out of which they maintain 200 irregulars armed with Sniders, and irreverently called by the British officers, "Catch-'em-alive-Os." These drive away marauders and discourage outrage and murder. The Khan of Dir, through whose territory the road runs for seventy-three miles, also receives a subsidy from Government of 60,000 rupees, in consideration of which he provides 400 irregulars for its service.
The road is looked after and secured by the tribes whose lands it crosses; however, the two main points where it could be blocked are controlled by Imperial troops. The Malakand Fort protects the mountain pass, while Chakdara oversees the bridge across the river. Everything else is handled by the local tribal forces. The Ranizai tribe gets an annual payment from the Indian Government of 30,000 rupees, which they use to maintain 200 irregulars armed with Sniders, and they’re cheekily referred to by British officers as "Catch-'em-alive-Os." These forces fend off intruders and help prevent violence and murder. The Khan of Dir, through whose territory the road goes for seventy-three miles, also receives a payment from the Government of 60,000 rupees, for which he provides 400 irregulars for service.
Until the great rising these arrangements worked admirably. The tribesmen interested in the maintenance of the route, were most reluctant to engage in hostilities against the Government. The Lower Ranizais, south of Malakand, abstained altogether. The elders of the tribe collected all the arms of their hot-headed youths, and forbade them to attack the troops. The Upper Ranizais were nearer the scene of the disturbance, and were induced by superstition and fear to join the Mullah; but very half-heartedly. The Swatis were carried away by fanaticism. The Khan of Dir throughout behaved loyally, as he is entirely dependent on British support, and his people realise the advantages of the subsidy.
Until the great uprising, these arrangements worked perfectly. The tribesmen who cared about keeping the route safe were very reluctant to fight against the Government. The Lower Ranizais, south of Malakand, didn't engage at all. The tribal elders gathered all the weapons from their hot-headed youth and banned them from attacking the troops. The Upper Ranizais, being closer to the conflict, were swayed by superstition and fear to side with the Mullah, but they did so reluctantly. The Swatis were swept up by fanaticism. The Khan of Dir remained loyal throughout since he completely relies on British support, and his people understand the benefits of the subsidy.
If the road is interesting its story is more so, and a summary of the events and causes which have led to its construction, may also throw some light on the political history and methods of the border tribes.
If the road is interesting, its story is even more captivating, and a summary of the events and reasons behind its construction can shed some light on the political history and strategies of the border tribes.
The uncertainty and insecurity of their power, has always led petty chiefs to seek the support of some powerful suzerain. In 1876 the Mehtar of Chitral, Aman-ul-Mulk, was encouraged to seek the protection, and become the vassal of our vassal, the Maharaja of Cashmere. In accordance with the general scheme of advance, then already adopted by the Indian Government, a British agency was at once established at Gilgit on the Chitral-Cashmere frontier. Aman-ul-Mulk was presented with a certain supply of arms and ammunition, and an annual subsidy of 6000 rupees, afterwards raised to 12,000 rupees. The British thus obtained an interest in Chitral, and a point of observation on its borders. In 1881 the agency was withdrawn, but the influence remained, and in 1889 it was re-established with a much larger garrison. Meanwhile Aman-ul-Mulk ruled in Chitral, showing great respect to the wishes of the Government, and in the enjoyment of his subsidy and comparative peace. But in 1892 he died, leaving many sons, all equally ferocious, ambitious and unscrupulous. One of these, Afzal by name, though not the eldest or acknowledged heir, had the good fortune to be on the spot. He seized the reins of power, and having murdered as many if his brothers as he could catch, proclaimed himself Mehtar, and invited the recognition of the Indian Government. He was acknowledged chief, as he seemed to be "a man of courage and determination," and his rule afforded a prospect of settled government. Surviving brothers fled to neighbouring states.
The uncertainty and insecurity of their power have always pushed petty chiefs to seek the backing of a more powerful suzerain. In 1876, Aman-ul-Mulk, the Mehtar of Chitral, was encouraged to seek protection and become a vassal of our vassal, the Maharaja of Kashmir. As part of the overall strategy that the Indian Government had already adopted, a British agency was quickly set up at Gilgit on the Chitral-Kashmir border. Aman-ul-Mulk was given a supply of arms and ammunition, along with an annual subsidy of 6,000 rupees, which was later increased to 12,000 rupees. This allowed the British to gain an interest in Chitral and a point of observation on its borders. The agency was withdrawn in 1881, but British influence remained, and in 1889, it was re-established with a much larger garrison. During this time, Aman-ul-Mulk governed Chitral, showing great respect for the wishes of the Government while enjoying his subsidy and a relatively peaceful rule. However, he died in 1892, leaving behind many sons, all equally fierce, ambitious, and ruthless. One of them, named Afzal, though not the eldest or the recognized heir, was fortunate to be present. He seized power and, after killing as many of his brothers as he could, declared himself Mehtar and sought recognition from the Indian Government. He was acknowledged as the chief because he appeared to be "a man of courage and determination," and his leadership provided a chance for stable governance. The surviving brothers fled to neighboring states.
Nizam, the eldest, came to Gilgit and appealed to the British. He got no help. The blessing had already been bestowed. But in November, 1892, Sher Afzul, a brother of the late Aman, returned by stealth to Chitral, whence fraternal affection had driven him, and killed the new Mehtar and another brother, both of whom were his nephews. The "wicked uncle" then ascended the throne, or its equivalent. He was, however, opposed. The Indian Government refused to recognise him. Nizam, at Gilgit, urged his claims, and was finally allowed to go and try to regain his inheritance. The moral support of 250 Cashmere rifles brought him many adherents. He was joined by the people. It was the landing of William of Orange on a reduced scale, and with Cashmere troops instead of Dutch Guards. Twelve hundred men sent by Sher Afzul to oppose him, deserted to his side. The avuncular usurper, realising that it might be dangerous to wait longer, fled to Afghanistan, as James II had fled to France, was received by the ruler with hospitality, and carefully preserved as an element of future disorder.
Nizam, the oldest brother, went to Gilgit and asked the British for assistance. He received none. The favor had already been granted. However, in November 1892, Sher Afzul, a brother of the late Aman, secretly returned to Chitral, from where his brotherly love had driven him, and killed the new Mehtar and another brother, both of whom were his nephews. The "wicked uncle" then took the throne, or what was left of it. He faced opposition, though. The Indian Government refused to recognize him. Nizam, in Gilgit, pushed his claims and was eventually allowed to return and try to reclaim his inheritance. The moral support of 250 Kashmir rifles attracted many followers to him. The people joined him. It was like a smaller version of William of Orange's landing, but with Kashmir troops instead of Dutch Guards. Twelve hundred men sent by Sher Afzul to fight him deserted and joined his side. The usurping uncle, realizing it was too risky to stay any longer, fled to Afghanistan, just like James II had fled to France. He was welcomed by the ruler, who received him with hospitality and kept him as a potential source of future unrest.
Nizam now became Mehtar according to his desire. But he did not greatly enjoy his power, and may have evolved some trite reflections on the vanity of earthly ambition. From the first he was poor and unpopular. With the support of the Government of India, however, he managed to maintain a weak, squalid rule for a space. To give him countenance, and in accordance with the Policy, Captain Younghusband was sent to the country with a hundred bayonets. The Gilgit garrison was increased by a battalion, and several posts were established between that place and Mastuj.
Nizam finally became Mehtar as he wanted. However, he didn’t really enjoy his power and may have developed some clichéd thoughts about the emptiness of earthly ambition. From the start, he was both poor and unpopular. With the backing of the Government of India, he managed to maintain a weak and grim rule for a while. To support him, and following the Policy, Captain Younghusband was sent to the area with a hundred soldiers. The Gilgit garrison was strengthened by an additional battalion, and several outposts were set up between that location and Mastuj.
Thus the Imperial forces had entered Chitral. Their position was soon to become one of danger. They were separated from Gilgit by many miles of bad road, and warlike tribesmen. To move troops from Gilgit would always be slow and difficult. Another route was however possible, the route I have described—a route northwards from Peshawar through Dir—shorter and easier, starting from British territory and the railway. Towards this line of communication the Indian Government now looked. If British troops or agents were to be retained in Chitral, if in other words their recognised policy was to be continued, this route must be opened up. They sounded the Home Government. Lord Kimberley replied, deprecating increase of responsibilities, of territory and expenditure, and declining to pledge himself to support such a scheme. At the same time he sanctioned the temporary retention of the troops, and the agent, in the hopes of strengthening Nizam. [Despatch from Secretary of State, No.34, 1st Sept., 1893.]
Thus, the Imperial forces had entered Chitral. Their position was soon going to become dangerous. They were many miles away from Gilgit, separated by rough roads and hostile tribesmen. Moving troops from Gilgit would always be slow and challenging. However, there was another possible route, the one I described—a northern route from Peshawar through Dir—shorter and easier, starting from British territory and the railway. The Indian Government was now looking at this line of communication. If British troops or agents were to remain in Chitral, in other words, if their recognized policy was to continue, this route needed to be opened up. They consulted the Home Government. Lord Kimberley replied, expressing concern over increasing responsibilities, territory, and expenses, and he declined to commit to supporting such a plan. At the same time, he approved the temporary retention of the troops and the agent, in hopes of strengthening Nizam. [Despatch from Secretary of State, No.34, 1st Sept., 1893.]
At this point Umra Khan must enter the story. The Gilgit agency report, dated 28th April, 1890, speaks of this chief, who was the Khan of Jandul, but whose influence pervaded the whole of Bajaur as "the most important man between Chitral and Pashawar." To this powerful ruler, another of the sons of Aman, named Amir, had fled from the family massacre which followed his father's death. Umra Khan protected him and determined to turn him to his own advantage. In May, 1894, this youth—he was about twenty years of age—returned to Chitral, professing to have escaped from the hands of Umra Khan. He was kindly received by Nizam, who seems to have been much hampered throughout his career by his virtue. On 1st January, 1895, Amir availed himself of his welcome, to murder his brother, and the principal members of the Chitral Cabinet. He proclaimed himself Mentar and asked for recognition. The Imperial officers, though used to frontier politics, refused to commit themselves to any arrangement with such a villain, until the matter had been considered in India.
At this point, Umra Khan needs to be introduced into the story. The Gilgit agency report, dated April 28, 1890, describes this chief, who was the Khan of Jandul, but whose influence extended throughout Bajaur as "the most important man between Chitral and Peshawar." To this powerful ruler, another son of Aman named Amir had fled after the family massacre that followed his father's death. Umra Khan took him in and decided to use him to his own advantage. In May 1894, this young man—about twenty years old—returned to Chitral, claiming to have escaped from Umra Khan. He was warmly welcomed by Nizam, who seemed to have been significantly hindered throughout his career by his own virtue. On January 1, 1895, Amir took advantage of this welcome to murder his brother and key members of the Chitral Cabinet. He declared himself Mentar and sought recognition. The Imperial officers, though familiar with frontier politics, refused to engage in any arrangement with such a villain until the issue had been discussed in India.
Umra Khan now advanced with a large force to the head of the Chitral Valley, nominally to assist his dear friend and ally, Amir, to consolidate his rule, really in the hopes of extending his own territories. But Amir, knowing Umra well, and having won his kingdom, did not desire to share it. Fighting ensued. The Chitrals were beaten. As he could not make any use of Amir, Umra Khan invited the wicked uncle to return. Sher Afzul accepted. A bargain was struck. Sher Afzul claimed to be made Mehtar, Umra supported his claims. Both threatened force in the event of opposition.
Umra Khan moved forward with a large army to the top of the Chitral Valley, supposedly to help his close friend and ally, Amir, strengthen his rule, but really hoping to expand his own lands. However, Amir, knowing Umra well and having fought for his kingdom, didn’t want to share it. Fighting broke out. The Chitrals were defeated. Since he could no longer use Amir, Umra Khan brought back the corrupt uncle. Sher Afzul agreed. A deal was made. Sher Afzul insisted on being made Mehtar, and Umra backed his claims. Both threatened to use force if there was any opposition.
But the Imperial Government rose in wrath, refused to have anything to do with the new claimant, informed him that his language was impertinent, and warned Umra Khan to leave Chitral territory forthwith or take the consequences. The answer was war. The scanty garrisons and scattered parties of British troops were attacked. A company of the 14th Sikhs was cut to pieces. Lieutenants Fowler and Edwards were taken prisoners. Fort Chitral, into which the rest of the Chitral mission and their escort had thrown themselves, was closely and fiercely besieged. To rescue them was imperative. The 1st Division of the Field Army was mobilised. A force of nearly 16,000 men crossed the frontier on the 1st April, from Mardan, to advance to the relief by the shortest route—the route through Swat and Dir—the line of the present Chitral road. The command of the expedition was confided to Sir Robert Low. Sir Bindon Blood was Chief of the Staff.
But the Imperial Government was furious, refused to engage with the new claimant, told him his tone was disrespectful, and warned Umra Khan to leave Chitral territory immediately or face the consequences. The response was war. The small garrisons and scattered groups of British troops were attacked. A company of the 14th Sikhs was annihilated. Lieutenants Fowler and Edwards were captured. Fort Chitral, where the rest of the Chitral mission and their escort had taken refuge, was intensely and closely besieged. Rescuing them became essential. The 1st Division of the Field Army was mobilized. A force of nearly 16,000 troops crossed the frontier on April 1st from Mardan, taking the shortest route to provide relief—through Swat and Dir, along the current Chitral road. The command of the expedition was given to Sir Robert Low, with Sir Bindon Blood as Chief of Staff.
So far the tale has been of the steady increase of British influence, in accordance with an avowed and consistent policy—primarily in Chitral, and ultimately throughout the border tribes. One movement has been followed by another. All have been aimed at a common end. Now suddenly we are confronted with an act by which the Government of India with open eyes placed an obstacle in the path, which they had so long pursued, to follow which they had made so many efforts themselves and demanded so many sacrifices from their subjects. Perhaps from compunction, but probably to soothe the Liberal Government, by appearing to localise the disturbances, and disclaiming any further acquisition of territory, they issued a proclamation to "all the people of Swat and the people of Bajaur, who do not side with Umra Khan," in which they declared that they had "no intention of permanently occupying any territory through which Umra Khan's misconduct" might "force them to pass, or of interfering with the independence of the tribes." [Proclamation, 14th March, 1895.]
So far, the story has been about the steady rise of British influence, following a clear and consistent policy—mainly in Chitral and eventually across the border tribes. One action has led to another, all aimed at the same goal. Now, out of nowhere, we face a situation where the Government of India, fully aware, has put up a barrier in the path they've been following for so long, after making so many efforts and asking for many sacrifices from their people. Perhaps out of guilt, but likely to appease the Liberal Government by appearing to localize the unrest and stating they have no intention of acquiring more territory, they issued a proclamation to "all the people of Swat and the people of Bajaur, who do not side with Umra Khan," claiming they had "no intention of permanently occupying any territory that Umra Khan's actions" might "force them to pass through, or of interfering with the independence of the tribes.” [Proclamation, 14th March, 1895.]
If this proclamation was intended for political purposes in England, it, from one point of view, succeeded most admirably, for there has been nearly as much written about it as about all the soldiers who have been killed and wounded in the war. It had, however, no effect upon the tribesmen, who were infuriated by the sight if the troops and paid no attention to the protestations of the Government. Had they watched with care the long, steady, deliberate advance, which I have so briefly summarised; had they read the avowed and recorded determination of the Indian Administration "to extend and, by degrees, to consolidate their influence" [Letter from Government of India, No.407, 28th February, 1879.] in the whole drainage system of the Indus, they might have even doubted their sincerity. Instead, and being unable to make fine distinctions, they saw only invasion in the military movements.
If this proclamation was meant for political reasons in England, it was, from one perspective, extremely successful, as there has been nearly as much written about it as about all the soldiers who have been killed and wounded in the war. However, it had no impact on the tribesmen, who were enraged by the sight of the troops and ignored the government’s protests. If they had carefully observed the long, steady, deliberate advance, which I have summarized briefly; if they had read the explicit and documented determination of the Indian Administration "to extend and, by degrees, to consolidate their influence" [Letter from Government of India, No.407, 28th February, 1879.] throughout the entire Indus drainage system, they might have even questioned their sincerity. Instead, being unable to draw subtle distinctions, they viewed the military movements as nothing but invasion.
They gathered accordingly, to oppose the advance of the troops. To the number of 12,000 they occupied the Malakand Pass—a tremendous position. From this they were driven with great slaughter on the 3rd of April, by the two leading brigades of Sir Robert Low's force. Further operations resulted in the passage of the Swat and Panjkora Rivers being effected. The road to Chitral was open. The besiegers of the fort fled, and a small relieving force was able to push through from Gilgit under Colonel Kelly. Umra Khan fled to Afghanistan, and the question of future policy came before the Government of India.
They gathered to resist the advance of the troops. They numbered 12,000 and took position at the Malakand Pass—a crucial location. On April 3rd, they were driven out with heavy losses by the first two brigades of Sir Robert Low's force. Further operations led to the successful crossing of the Swat and Panjkora Rivers. The route to Chitral was clear. The attackers of the fort retreated, and a small relief force managed to come through from Gilgit under Colonel Kelly. Umra Khan fled to Afghanistan, and the issue of future policy was presented to the Government of India.
Two alternatives presented themselves: either they must "abandon the attempt to keep up any effective control" over Chitral, or they must put a sufficient garrison there. In pursuance of their recognised policy, the Council decided unanimously that to maintain British influence in Chitral was "a matter of first importance." In a despatch [Despatch of Government of India, No.240, 8th May, 1895.] to the Home Government they set forth all their reasons, and at the same time declared that it was impossible to garrison Chitral without keeping up the road from Peshawar, by which the Relief force had advanced.
Two options presented themselves: either they had to "give up on trying to maintain any real control" over Chitral, or they needed to establish a strong enough garrison there. Following their established policy, the Council unanimously decided that maintaining British influence in Chitral was "of utmost importance." In a dispatch [Despatch of Government of India, No.240, 8th May, 1895.] to the Home Government, they outlined all their reasons and also stated that it was impossible to garrison Chitral without keeping the road from Peshawar open, which was the route the Relief force had taken.
On the 13th of June Lord Rosebery's Cabinet replied decisively, with courage if not with wisdom, that "no military force or European agent should be kept at Chitral, that Chitral should not be fortified, and that no road should be made between Peshawar and Chitral." By this they definitely and finally repudiated the policy which had been consistently followed since 1876. They left Chitral to stew in its own juice. They over-ruled the Government of India. It was a bold and desperate attempt to return to the old frontier line. The Indian Government replied: "We deeply regret but loyally accept decision," and began to gather up the severed strings of their policy and weave another web.
On June 13th, Lord Rosebery's Cabinet responded firmly, showing courage if not wisdom, that "no military force or European agent should be stationed at Chitral, that Chitral should not be fortified, and that no road should be built between Peshawar and Chitral." With this decision, they clearly rejected the policy that had been followed since 1876. They left Chitral to manage its own issues. They went against the Government of India. It was a bold and risky move to revert to the previous frontier line. The Indian Government replied: "We deeply regret but loyally accept the decision," and began to pick up the broken threads of their policy and create a new plan.
But in the nick of time the Liberal Administration fell, and Lord Salisbury's Cabinet reversed their decision. It is interesting, in reading the Blue Books on Indian questions, to watch the emotions of party principles, stirring beneath the uniform mask of official responsibility—which the most reckless of men are compelled to wear as soon as they become ministers. The language, the style, the tone of the correspondence is the same. It is always a great people addressing and instructing their pro-consuls and administrators. But the influence inclines backwards and forwards as the pendulum of politics swings. And as the swing in 1895 was a very great one, a proportionate impulse was given to the policy of advance. "It seemed" to the new ministry "that the policy... continuously pursued by successive Governments ought not to be lightly abandoned unless its maintenance had become clearly impossible." [Despatch, Secretary of State, No.30, 16th Aug., 1895.] Thus the retention of Chitral was sanctioned, and the road which that retention necessitated was completed.
But just in time, the Liberal Administration fell, and Lord Salisbury's Cabinet changed their decision. It’s interesting, while reading the Blue Books on Indian issues, to observe the emotions of party principles stirring beneath the official mask of responsibility that even the most reckless people have to wear once they become ministers. The language, style, and tone of the correspondence remain the same. It’s always a large group addressing and instructing their pro-consuls and administrators. But the influence shifts back and forth as political tides change. And since the shift in 1895 was significant, a similar push was given to the policy of progress. "It seemed" to the new ministry "that the policy... continuously pursued by successive Governments ought not to be lightly abandoned unless its maintenance had become clearly impossible." [Despatch, Secretary of State, No.30, 16th Aug., 1895.] As a result, the retention of Chitral was approved, and the road that needed to be built for that retention was completed.
I approach with nervousness so great a matter as the "Breach of Faith" question. In a book devoted chiefly to the deeds of soldiers it seems almost presumptuous to discuss an affair which involves the political honour of statesmen. In their unnecessary and gratuitous proclamation the Government of India declared, that they had no intention of interfering with the tribes, or of permanently occupying any territory, the troops might march through; whereas now they do interfere with the tribesmen, and have established garrisons at Dargai, Malakand and Chakdara, all of which are in the territory through which the troops passed. But it takes two to make a bargain or a breach of faith. The tribes took no notice of the proclamation. They did not understand it. They did not believe it. Where there is no faith there can be no breach of faith. The border peoples resisted the advance. That position annulled the proclamation, and proved that it was not credited by the tribesmen. They do not think they have been tricked. They do not regard the road as a "breach of faith." What they do regard it as, is a menace to their independence, and a prelude to annexation. Nor are they wrong. Looking at the road, as I have seen it, and have tried to describe it, running broad and white across the valley; at the soldiers moving along it; at the political officers extending their influence in all directions; at the bridge and fort of Chakdara; and at the growing cantonment on the Malakand Pass, it needs no education to appreciate its significance. Nor can any sophistry obscure it.
I approach the important topic of the "Breach of Faith" with a lot of nervousness. In a book mainly focused on the actions of soldiers, it feels a bit presumptuous to discuss an issue that touches on the political honor of statesmen. In their unnecessary and unwarranted announcement, the Government of India stated that they had no plans to interfere with the tribes or to permanently occupy any territory through which the troops might pass. Yet, they are now interfering with the tribesmen and have established garrisons at Dargai, Malakand, and Chakdara, all located in the territory the troops passed through. But it takes two to form a deal or to break faith. The tribes ignored the proclamation. They didn’t understand it and didn’t believe it. Where there is no faith, there can be no breach of faith. The border people resisted the advance, which invalidated the proclamation and showed that the tribesmen did not trust it. They don’t feel they’ve been deceived. They don’t see the road as a "breach of faith." Instead, they view it as a threat to their independence and a precursor to annexation. And they aren't wrong. Looking at the road, as I have seen it and tried to describe it, broad and white across the valley; at the soldiers moving along it; at the political officers spreading their influence in all directions; at the bridge and fort of Chakdara; and at the growing military base at Malakand Pass, it doesn’t take much to see its significance. No amount of argument can obscure that.
CHAPTER III: THE OUTBREAK
Tantum religio potuit suadere malorum. LUCRETIUS.
Tantum religio potuit suadere malorum. LUCRETIUS.
The historian of great events is always oppressed by the difficulty of tracing the silent, subtle influences, which in all communities precede and prepare the way for violent outbursts and uprisings. He may discover many causes and record them duly, but he will always be sensible that others have escaped him. The changing tides of public opinion, the undercurrents of interest, partisanship and caprice, the whirlpools of illogical sentiment or ignorant prejudice, exert forces so complex and numerous, that to observe and appreciate them all, and to estimate the effect of each in raising the storm, is a task beyond the intellect and industry of man. The chronicler of small things lies under even greater disabilities. He has fewer facts to guide his judgment, nor is it as easy to read small print as capital letters.
The historian of major events is always challenged by the difficulty of tracing the quiet, subtle influences that in every community come before and set the stage for violent outbursts and uprisings. He might uncover many causes and document them properly, but he'll always be aware that others have eluded him. The shifting tides of public opinion, the underlying currents of interest, bias, and whims, the whirlpools of illogical emotions or ignorance, exert forces so complex and numerous that recognizing and understanding them all, and judging the impact of each in fueling the turmoil, is a task beyond the capability and effort of any individual. The chronicler of minor events faces even greater challenges. He has fewer facts to inform his judgment, and it's not as straightforward to interpret small print as it is to read capital letters.
In an attempt to state the causes of the great tribal upheaval of 1897, these difficulties are increased by the fact that no European can gauge the motives or assume the points of view of Asiatics. It is, however, impossible to pass the question by, and ignoring the detail, I shall endeavour to indicate some at least of the most important and apparent forces, which have led to the formidable combination with which the British power in India has been confronted.
In trying to explain the reasons behind the major tribal uprising of 1897, it’s challenging because no European can fully understand the motivations or perspectives of Asians. Nevertheless, it’s important to address this issue, and while leaving out some specifics, I will aim to highlight at least some of the key and obvious forces that have resulted in the significant challenge faced by British authority in India.
The most marked incident in the "Forward Policy" has been the retention of Chitral. The garrisons, the road, the tribal levies have made the tribesmen realise the proximity and the advance of civilisation. It is possible—even probable—that with all their love of independence, the majority of the inhabitants of the mountains would have been willing, until their liberties were actually curtailed, to remain in passive submission, soothed by the increase of material prosperity. During the two years that the British flag had floated over Chakdara and the Malakand the trade of the Swat Valley had nearly doubled. As the sun of civilisation rose above the hills, the fair flowers of commerce unfolded, and the streams of supply and demand, hitherto congealed by the frost of barbarism, were thawed. Most of the native population were content to bask in the genial warmth and enjoy the new-found riches and comforts. For two years reliefs had gone to and from Chitral without a shot being fired. Not a post-bag had been stolen, not a messenger murdered. The political officers riding about freely among the fierce hill men were invited to settle many disputes, which would formerly have been left to armed force.
The most significant event in the "Forward Policy" has been the retention of Chitral. The garrisons, the road, and the tribal forces have made the tribesmen aware of the nearness and advancement of civilization. It is likely—even probable—that despite their love of independence, most of the mountain inhabitants would have been willing to remain passively compliant, enjoying the growth of material wealth, until their freedoms were actually restricted. During the two years that the British flag flew over Chakdara and the Malakand, trade in the Swat Valley nearly doubled. As the light of civilization rose over the hills, the beautiful blossoms of commerce emerged, and the flows of supply and demand, previously frozen by the cold of barbarism, began to thaw. Most of the local population were happy to bask in the pleasant warmth and enjoy the newly found wealth and comforts. For two years, reliefs traveled to and from Chitral without a single shot being fired. Not a single post-bag was stolen, and no messenger was killed. The political officers, freely riding among the fierce mountain men, were invited to resolve many disputes that would have previously required the use of force.
But a single class had viewed with quick intelligence and intense hostility the approach of the British power. The priesthood of the Afghan border instantly recognised the full meaning of the Chitral road. The cause of their antagonism is not hard to discern. Contact with civilisation assails the ignorance, and credulity, on which the wealth and influence of the Mullah depend. A general combination of the religious forces of India against that civilising, educating rule, which unconsciously saps the strength of superstition, is one of the dangers of the future. Here Mahommedanism was threatened and resisted. A vast, but silent agitation was begun. Messengers passed to and fro among the tribes. Whispers of war, a holy war, were breathed to a race intensely passionate and fanatical. Vast and mysterious agencies, the force of which is incomprehensible to rational minds, were employed. More astute brains than the wild valleys of the North produce conducted the preparations. Secret encouragement came from the South—from India itself. Actual support and assistance was given from Cabul.
But a single group recognized with quick insight and strong hostility the approach of British power. The priesthood on the Afghan border immediately understood the full significance of the Chitral road. Their opposition is easy to understand. Contact with civilization challenges the ignorance and gullibility that support the wealth and influence of the Mullah. A united front of India's religious forces against this civilizing, educational authority, which unknowingly weakens superstition, poses one of the dangers of the future. Here, Islam was threatened and pushed back. A huge, but quiet movement began. Messengers traveled back and forth among the tribes. Whispers of war, a holy war, circulated among a race that is extremely passionate and fanatical. Vast and mysterious forces, which are beyond the grasp of rational minds, were mobilized. More shrewd thinkers than those in the wild valleys of the North organized the preparations. Secret support came from the South—from India itself. Actual aid and assistance were provided from Cabul.
In that strange half light of ignorance and superstition, assailed by supernatural terrors and doubts, and lured by hopes of celestial glory, the tribes were taught to expect prodigious events. Something was coming. A great day for their race and faith was at hand. Presently the moment would arrive. They must watch and be ready. The mountains became as full of explosives as a magazine. Yet the spark was lacking.
In that strange half-light of ignorance and superstition, troubled by supernatural fears and uncertainties, and tempted by dreams of heavenly glory, the tribes were taught to anticipate incredible events. Something was on the way. A significant day for their people and beliefs was near. Soon, the moment would come. They needed to watch and be prepared. The mountains were packed with explosives like a magazine. But the spark was missing.
At length the time came. A strange combination of circumstances operated to improve the opportunity. The victory of the Turks over the Greeks; the circulation of the Amir's book on "Jehad"; his assumption of the position of a Caliph of Islam, and much indiscreet writing in the Anglo-Indian press, [Articles in Anglo-Indian papers on such subjects as "The Recrudescence if Mahommedanism" produce more effect on the educated native mind than the most seditious frothings of the vernacular press.] united to produce a "boom" in Mahommedanism.
At last, the moment arrived. A strange mix of circumstances came together to create the perfect opportunity. The Turks' victory over the Greeks, the release of the Amir's book on "Jihad," his claiming the title of Caliph of Islam, and a lot of careless writing in the Anglo-Indian press, [Articles in Anglo-Indian papers on topics like "The Resurgence of Mohammedanism" have a greater impact on the educated native mind than the most seditious outbursts of the vernacular press.] all combined to spark a "boom" in Mohammedanism.
The moment was propitious; nor was the man wanting. What Peter the Hermit was to the regular bishops and cardinals of the Church, the Mad Mullah was to the ordinary priesthood of the Afghan border. A wild enthusiast, convinced alike of his Divine mission and miraculous powers, preached a crusade, or Jehad, against the infidel. The mine was fired. The flame ran along the ground. The explosions burst forth in all directions. The reverberations have not yet died away.
The moment was right; and the man was ready. Just like Peter the Hermit was to the bishops and cardinals of the Church, the Mad Mullah was to the regular priests of the Afghan border. A passionate believer, convinced of his divine mission and miraculous abilities, he preached a crusade, or Jehad, against the nonbelievers. The spark was ignited. The fire spread along the ground. The explosions went off in every direction. The echoes haven't faded away yet.
Great and widespread as the preparations were, they were not visible to the watchful diplomatic agents who maintained the relations of the Government with the tribesmen. So extraordinary is the inversion of ideas and motives among those people that it may be said that those who know them best, know them least, and the more logical the mind of the student the less he is able to understand of the subject. In any case among these able men who diligently collected information and observed the state of feeling, there were none who realised the latent forces that were being accumulated on all sides. The strange treachery at Maizar in June was a flash in the pan. Still no one saw the danger. It was not until the early days of July that it was noticed that there was a fanatical movement in Upper Swat. Even then its significance was disregarded and its importance underrated. That a Mad Fakir had arrived was known. His power was still a secret. It did not long remain so.
As extensive as the preparations were, they went unnoticed by the alert diplomatic agents who managed the Government's relations with the tribesmen. The twist in ideas and motives among these people is so remarkable that it can be said that the ones who understand them best know them the least, and the more logical the observer's mind, the less they grasp the topic. Among these skilled individuals who actively gathered information and monitored the mood, none recognized the hidden forces building up around them. The unusual betrayal at Maizar in June was just a brief incident. Still, no one perceived the threat. It wasn’t until the early days of July that a fanatical movement in Upper Swat was noticed. Even then, its significance was ignored and its importance undervalued. It was known that a Mad Fakir had arrived, but his influence was still a mystery. That didn’t last long.
It is, thank heaven, difficult if not impossible for the modern European to fully appreciate the force which fanaticism exercises among an ignorant, warlike and Oriental population. Several generations have elapsed since the nations of the West have drawn the sword in religious controversy, and the evil memories of the gloomy past have soon faded in the strong, clear light of Rationalism and human sympathy. Indeed it is evident that Christianity, however degraded and distorted by cruelty and intolerance, must always exert a modifying influence on men's passions, and protect them from the more violent forms of fanatical fever, as we are protected from smallpox by vaccination. But the Mahommedan religion increases, instead of lessening, the fury of intolerance. It was originally propagated by the sword, and ever since, its votaries have been subject, above the people of all other creeds, to this form of madness. In a moment the fruits of patient toil, the prospects of material prosperity, the fear of death itself, are flung aside. The more emotional Pathans are powerless to resist. All rational considerations are forgotten. Seizing their weapons, they become Ghazis—as dangerous and as sensible as mad dogs: fit only to be treated as such. While the more generous spirits among the tribesmen become convulsed in an ecstasy of religious bloodthirstiness, poorer and more material souls derive additional impulses from the influence of others, the hopes of plunder and the joy of fighting. Thus whole nations are roused to arms. Thus the Turks repel their enemies, the Arabs of the Soudan break the British squares, and the rising on the Indian frontier spreads far and wide. In each case civilisation is confronted with militant Mahommedanism. The forces of progress clash with those of reaction. The religion of blood and war is face to face with that of peace. Luckily the religion of peace is usually the better armed.
Fortunately, it's tough, if not impossible, for the modern European to fully grasp the extent of fanaticism among an uneducated, warlike, and Eastern population. It's been several generations since Western nations have taken up arms in religious disputes, and the painful memories of that dark past have largely faded away in the bright, clear light of rational thought and human compassion. Clearly, Christianity—despite being twisted and degraded by cruelty and intolerance—always has a moderating influence on people's passions, shielding them from the more extreme types of fanatical frenzy, much like how vaccination protects us from smallpox. In contrast, the Muslim faith fuels rather than diminishes the fire of intolerance. It was originally spread by force, and ever since, its followers have been more prone than those of any other faith to this kind of madness. In an instant, the rewards of hard work, the prospects for a better life, and even the fear of death are discarded. The more emotional Pathans are unable to resist. All logical thoughts are ignored. Grabbing their weapons, they become Ghazis—just as dangerous and irrational as rabid dogs: only fit to be treated as such. While the more noble individuals among the tribes become engulfed in a frenzy of religious bloodlust, those with more basic desires are driven by the influence of others, fueled by the hopes of plunder and the thrill of battle. This is how entire nations are stirred to fight. This is how the Turks fend off their foes, how the Arabs in Sudan break the British formations, and how unrest on the Indian frontier spreads far and wide. In each instance, civilization confronts aggressive Islam. Forces of progress collide with those of regression. The religion of violence and war stands against the religion of peace. Fortunately, the religion of peace is often better equipped.
The extraordinary credulity of the people is hardly conceivable. Had the Mad Mullah called on them to follow him to attack Malakand and Chakdara they would have refused. Instead he worked miracles. He sat at his house, and all who came to visit him, brought him a small offering of food or money, in return for which he gave them a little rice. As his stores were continually replenished, he might claim to have fed thousands. He asserted that he was invisible at night. Looking into his room, they saw no one. At these things they marvelled. Finally he declared he would destroy the infidel. He wanted no help. No one should share the honours. The heavens would open and an army would descend. The more he protested he did not want them, the more exceedingly they came. Incidentally he mentioned that they would be invulnerable; other agents added arguments. I was shown a captured scroll, upon which the tomb of the Ghazi—he who has killed an infidel—is depicted in heaven, no fewer than seven degrees above the Caaba itself. Even after the fighting—when the tribesmen reeled back from the terrible army they had assailed, leaving a quarter of their number on the field—the faith of the survivors was unshaken. Only those who had doubted had perished, said the Mullah, and displayed a bruise which was, he informed them, the sole effect of a twelve-pound shrapnel shell on his sacred person.
The incredible gullibility of the people is hard to believe. If the Mad Mullah had asked them to follow him to attack Malakand and Chakdara, they would have said no. Instead, he worked miracles. He sat at his house, and everyone who visited him brought a small gift of food or money, and in return, he gave them a little rice. Since his supplies were constantly restocked, he could claim to have fed thousands. He claimed that he was invisible at night. When they looked into his room, they saw no one. They were amazed by these things. Finally, he announced he would destroy the infidels. He didn’t want any help. No one should share in the glory. Heaven would open up, and an army would come down. The more he insisted he didn’t want them, the more they showed up. He casually mentioned that they would be invulnerable; others added their own convincing points. I saw a captured scroll that showed the tomb of the Ghazi—who killed an infidel—in heaven, no less than seven levels above the Kaaba itself. Even after the fighting—when the tribesmen staggered back from the devastating army they had attacked, leaving a quarter of their number dead on the field—the faith of the survivors remained unshaken. Only those who had doubted perished, the Mullah said, and he showed off a bruise that, he claimed, was the only result of a twelve-pound shrapnel shell hitting his sacred person.
I pass with relief from the tossing sea of Cause and Theory to the firm ground of Result and Fact. The rumours and reports which reached the Malakand of the agitation in Upper Swat and among the surrounding tribes were fully appreciated by the Pathan Sepoys of the garrison. As July advanced, several commanding officers were warned by their men, that great events were impending. Major Deane, the political agent, watched with great anxiety the daily progress of the fanatical movement. No one desires to be thought an alarmist, least of all on the frontier where there is always danger. At length, however, he felt compelled to officially report the disquieting signs. Warnings were then issued to the officers in charge of the various posts, and the troops were practised in taking up alarm stations. By the 23rd of July all had been informed that the aspect of affairs was threatening, and ordered to observe every precaution. But to the last everybody doubted that there would be a rising, nor did any one imagine that even should one occur, it would lead to more than a skirmish. The natives were friendly and respectful. The valley smiled in fertile prosperity. It was not strange, that none could foresee the changes a week would bring, or guess that in a few days they would be fighting for their lives; that they would carry fire and sword through the peaceful landscape; that the polo ground would be the scene of a cavalry charge, or that the cheery barbarians among whom they had lived quietly for so many months would become maddened and ferocious savages. Never was transformation of scene more complete, or more rapid.
I breathe a sigh of relief as I move from the chaotic world of Ideas and Theories to the solid ground of Results and Facts. The rumors and reports that made their way to Malakand about the unrest in Upper Swat and among the nearby tribes were fully understood by the Pathan Sepoys in the garrison. As July progressed, several commanding officers were alerted by their men that major events were on the horizon. Major Deane, the political agent, closely monitored the daily developments of the fanatical movement with great concern. No one wants to be seen as an alarmist, especially on the frontier where dangers always lurk. Eventually, he felt the need to officially report the troubling signs. Warnings were then sent to the officers in charge of various posts, and troops practiced moving to alarm stations. By July 23rd, everyone was aware that the situation looked dire and was instructed to take every precaution. However, until the last moment, everyone doubted there would be an uprising, and no one thought that if one did occur, it would escalate beyond a skirmish. The locals were friendly and respectful. The valley was thriving in lush prosperity. It was not surprising that no one could foresee the drastic changes a week would bring, or imagine that in just a few days they would be fighting for their lives; that they would unleash destruction across the peaceful landscape; that the polo ground would become the backdrop for a cavalry charge, or that the cheerful locals they had peacefully coexisted with for so many months would turn into enraged and brutal savages. Never has a transformation been so complete or so swift.
And all the while the rumours of coming war grew stronger and stronger. The bazaars of India, like the London coffee-houses of the last century, are always full of marvellous tales—the invention of fertile brains. A single unimportant fact is exaggerated, and distorted, till it becomes unrecognisable. From it, a thousand wild, illogical, and fantastic conclusions are drawn. These again are circulated as facts. So the game goes on. But amid all this falsehood, and idle report, there often lies important information. The bazaar stories not only indicate the state of native opinion, but not infrequently contain the germ of truth. In Eastern lands, news travels by strange channels, and often with unaccountable rapidity. As July advanced the bazaar at Malakand became full of tales of the Mad Fakir. His miracles passed from mouth to mouth, with suitable additions.
And all the while, the rumors of an impending war grew stronger and stronger. The markets of India, like the coffee houses of London from the last century, are always buzzing with incredible stories—created by imaginative minds. A single insignificant fact gets exaggerated and twisted until it’s unrecognizable. From that, a thousand wild, irrational, and unbelievable conclusions are drawn. These are then shared as facts. And so the cycle continues. But among all this misinformation and idle chatter, there’s often important information. The stories from the markets not only reflect the mood of the locals but also frequently contain a kernel of truth. In Eastern countries, news travels through unusual channels and often at an astonishing speed. As July progressed, the market at Malakand became filled with tales about the Mad Fakir. His miracles spread from person to person, with added embellishments.
A great day for Islam was at hand. A mighty man had arisen to lead them. The English would be swept away. By the time of the new moon, not one would remain. The Great Fakir had mighty armies concealed among the mountains. When the moment came these would sally forth—horse, foot and artillery—and destroy the infidel. It was even stated that the Mullah had ordered that no one should go near a certain hill, lest the heavenly hosts should be prematurely revealed. So ran the talk. But among all these frothy fabrications there lay a solemn warning.
A great day for Islam was coming. A powerful leader had emerged to guide them. The English would be driven out. By the time the new moon arrived, not a single one would be left. The Great Fakir had huge armies hiding in the mountains. When the time was right, they would come out—cavalry, infantry, and artillery—and defeat the unbelievers. It was even said that the Mullah had instructed everyone to stay away from a certain hill, so the heavenly forces wouldn’t be revealed too soon. That was the gossip. But beneath all these exaggerated tales, there was a serious warning.
Though the British military and political officers were compelled to take official notice of the reports received with reference to the tribal gathering, and to make arrangements for the safety of their posts, they privately scouted the idea that any serious events were impending.
Though the British military and political officials had to officially acknowledge the reports about the tribal gathering and make plans to secure their posts, they secretly dismissed the idea that any significant events were on the horizon.
On the afternoon of the 26th July the subalterns and younger officers of the Malakand garrison proceeded to Khar to play polo. Thither also came Lieutenant Rattray, riding over from Chakdara fort. The game was a good one, and the tribesmen of the neighbouring village watched it as usual in little groups, with a keen interest. Nothing in their demeanour betrayed their thoughts or intentions. The young soldiers saw nothing, knew nothing, and had they known would have cared less. There would be no rising. If there was, so much the better. They were ready for it. The game ended and the officers cantered back to their camps and posts.
On the afternoon of July 26th, the junior officers and younger soldiers of the Malakand garrison went to Khar to play polo. Lieutenant Rattray also showed up, riding over from Chakdara fort. The match was exciting, and the local tribesmen from the nearby village watched in small groups, showing intense interest. Their expressions gave away nothing about their thoughts or plans. The young soldiers saw nothing, knew nothing, and even if they had known, they wouldn’t have cared. There wouldn't be an uprising. If there was, that would be fine with them. They were ready for it. When the game finished, the officers rode back to their camps and posts.
It was then that a strange incident occurred—an incident eminently characteristic of the frontier tribes. As the syces were putting the rugs and clothing on the polo ponies, and loitering about the ground after the game, the watching natives drew near and advised them to be off home at once, for that there was going to be a fight. They knew, these Pathans, what was coming. The wave of fanaticism was sweeping down the valley. It would carry them away. They were powerless to resist. Like one who feels a fit coming on, they waited. Nor did they care very much. When the Mad Fakir arrived, they would fight and kill the infidels. In the meantime there was no necessity to deprive them of their ponies. And so with motives, partly callous, partly sportsmanlike, and not without some faint suspicion of chivalry, they warned the native grooms, and these taking the hint reached the camp in safety.
It was then that a strange incident happened—an incident typical of the frontier tribes. As the horse handlers were putting the rugs and clothes on the polo ponies and hanging around after the game, the watching locals approached and urged them to head home immediately, as a fight was about to break out. The Pathans knew what was coming. A wave of fanaticism was sweeping down the valley. It would engulf them. They felt powerless to resist. Like someone sensing a seizure coming on, they waited. And they didn't really care much. When the Mad Fakir showed up, they would fight and kill the infidels. In the meantime, there was no need to take their ponies away. So, with motives that were partly indifferent, partly sportsmanlike, and with a hint of chivalry, they warned the local grooms, who then took the hint and made it back to camp safely.
Late on this same afternoon Major Deane reported to Brigadier-General Meiklejohn, who commanded the Malakand garrison, that matters had assumed a very grave aspect; that a great armed gathering had collected around the Mad Mullah's standard, and that an attack was probable. He advised that the Guides should be called up to reinforce the brigade. A telegram was immediately despatched to Mardan ordering them to march without delay. At 8.30 Lieutenant P. Eliott-Lockhart, who was the senior officer then with the regiment, received the order. At 1.30 A.M. they began their now famous march.
Late that afternoon, Major Deane informed Brigadier-General Meiklejohn, who was in charge of the Malakand garrison, that the situation had become very serious; a large armed group had gathered around the Mad Mullah's banner, and an attack seemed likely. He recommended that the Guides be called up to support the brigade. A telegram was quickly sent to Mardan instructing them to march without delay. At 8:30, Lieutenant P. Eliott-Lockhart, the senior officer present with the regiment, received the order. They began their now-famous march at 1:30 A.M.
After sending for the Guides, the brigadier, at about seven o'clock, interviewed his different commanding officers, and instructed them to be prepared to turn out at any moment. Major Deane now reported that the Mad Mullah and his gathering were advancing down the valley, and recommended that the Amandara Pass, four miles away, should be held. General Meiklejohn accordingly issued orders for a movable column, to be formed as follows:—
After calling for the Guides, the brigadier met with his various commanding officers around seven o'clock and told them to be ready to deploy at any moment. Major Deane then reported that the Mad Mullah and his group were moving down the valley and suggested that they should secure the Amandara Pass, which was four miles away. General Meiklejohn then gave orders to set up a mobile unit, to be organized as follows:—
45th Sikhs. 2 Cos. 31st Punjaub Infantry. 2 Guns No. 8 Mountain Battery. 1 Squadron 11th Bengal Lancers.
45th Sikhs. 2 Companies 31st Punjab Infantry. 2 Guns No. 8 Mountain Battery. 1 Squadron 11th Bengal Lancers.
This force, under command of Lieutenant-Colonel McRae, 45th Sikhs, was to start at midnight and would be supported by the rest of the troops under command of the brigadier at 3 A.M.
This force, led by Lieutenant-Colonel McRae of the 45th Sikhs, was set to begin at midnight and would have support from the other troops under the brigadier's command at 3 A.M.
All preparations were swiftly made. At 9.45 a telegram from Chakdara—which got through just before the wire was cut—reported that large forces of Pathans were rapidly moving towards the camps. A quarter of an hour later a Jemadar of the Levies galloped in with the news that, to quote the official despatch: "The Fakir had passed Khar and was advancing on Malakand, that neither Levies nor people would act against him, and that the hills to the east of the camp were covered with Pathans."
All preparations were quickly completed. At 9:45, a telegram from Chakdara—received just before the line was cut—reported that large groups of Pathans were rapidly approaching the camps. A quarter of an hour later, a Jemadar of the Levies rode in with the update that, to quote the official dispatch: "The Fakir had passed Khar and was advancing on Malakand, that neither the Levies nor the people would take action against him, and that the hills to the east of the camp were filled with Pathans."
As soon as the officers had returned from polo, they found plenty of work waiting for them. Bandsmen and boys incapable of carrying arms had to be hurried up to the fort. Indents had to be made out for transport, rations and ammunition. There was much to do, and little time to do it in. At length all was finished, and the troops were in readiness for their early morning start. At 9.30 the officers sat down to dinner, still in their polo kit, which there had been no time to change. At 10 o'clock they were discussing the prospects of the approaching march, and eagerly weighing the chances of a skirmish. The more sanguine asserted that there would be a fight—a small one, it was true—but still a skirmish. Many of those who had never been in action before congratulated themselves on the unlooked-for opportunity. The older and more experienced regarded the matter in the light of a riot. They might have to fire on the tribesmen, but Swatis were such cowards that they would never stand up to the troops. Still it was a chance.
As soon as the officers got back from polo, they found a lot of work waiting for them. They had to rush the bandsmen and boys who couldn't carry weapons up to the fort. They needed to fill out requests for transport, supplies, and ammo. There was a lot to do and not much time to do it. Finally, everything was done, and the troops were ready for their early morning departure. At 9:30, the officers sat down for dinner still in their polo gear, as there hadn’t been time to change. At 10 o'clock, they were discussing the upcoming march and eagerly weighing the chances of a skirmish. The more optimistic ones claimed there would be a fight—small, sure—but still a skirmish. Many who had never been in combat before congratulated themselves on the unexpected opportunity. The older and more experienced ones viewed the situation as more of a riot. They might have to fire on the tribesmen, but Swatis were such cowards that they wouldn’t stand up to the troops. Still, it was a chance.
Suddenly in the stillness of the night a bugle-call sounded on the parade ground of the "crater" camp. Everyone sprang up. It was the "Assembly." For a moment there was silence while the officers seized their swords and belts and hurriedly fastened them on. Several, thinking that it was merely the warning for the movable column to fall in, waited to light their cigarettes. Then from many quarters the loud explosion of musketry burst forth, a sound which for six days and nights was to know no intermission.
Suddenly, in the quiet of the night, a bugle call echoed across the parade ground of the "crater" camp. Everyone jumped up. It was time for the "Assembly." For a moment, there was silence as the officers grabbed their swords and belts and quickly put them on. A few, thinking it was just a signal for the movable column to gather, took their time lighting cigarettes. Then, from various directions, the deafening sound of gunfire erupted, a noise that would continue without pause for the next six days and nights.
The attack on the Malakand and the great frontier war had begun.
The attack on Malakand and the major frontier war had started.
The noise of firing echoed among the hills. Its echoes are ringing still. One valley caught the waves of sound and passed them to the next, till the whole wide mountain region rocked with the confusion of the tumult. Slender wires and long-drawn cables carried the vibrations to the far-off countries of the West. Distant populations on the Continent of Europe thought that in them they detected the dull, discordant tones of decline and fall. Families in English homes feared that the detonations marked the death of those they loved—sons, brothers or husbands. Diplomatists looked wise, economists anxious, stupid people mysterious and knowledgeable. All turned to have the noise stopped. But that was a task which could not be accomplished until thousands of lives had been sacrificed and millions of money spent.
The sound of gunfire echoed through the hills. The echoes are still ringing. One valley caught the waves of sound and passed them to the next, until the entire mountain range shook with the chaos. Slender wires and long cables carried the vibrations to distant countries in the West. People far away in Europe thought they could hear the dull, discordant signs of decline and collapse. Families in English homes worried that the explosions signaled the deaths of their loved ones—sons, brothers, or husbands. Diplomats appeared wise, economists looked anxious, and clueless people acted mysterious and knowledgeable. Everyone wanted the noise to stop. But that task couldn't be completed until thousands of lives were lost and millions of dollars were spent.
CHAPTER IV: THE ATTACK ON THE MALAKAND
Cry "Havoc" and let slip the dogs of war. "JULIUS CAESAR," Act iii., Sc.i.
Cry "Chaos" and unleash the hounds of war. "JULIUS CAESAR," Act iii., Sc.i.
It has long been recognised by soldiers of every nation that, to resist a vigorous onslaught by night, is almost the hardest task that troops can be called upon to perform. Panics, against which few brave men are proof, arise in a moment from such situations. Many a gallant soldier has lost his head. Many an experienced officer has been borne down unheeded by a crowd of fugitives. Regiments that have marched unflinchingly to almost certain death on the battlefield, become in an instant terrified and useless.
Soldiers from every nation have long understood that defending against a strong nighttime attack is one of the toughest challenges troops face. Panic, which can overwhelm even the bravest individuals, can arise in an instant during these situations. Many courageous soldiers have lost their composure, and experienced officers have been ignored and pushed aside by fleeing soldiers. Regiments that have marched fearlessly towards almost certain death on the battlefield can suddenly become terrified and ineffective.
In the attack on the Malakand camp, all the elements of danger and disorder were displayed. The surprise, the darkness, the confused and broken nature of the ground; the unknown numbers of the enemy; their merciless ferocity; every appalling circumstance was present. But there were men who were equal to the occasion. As soon as the alarm sounded Lieutenant-Colonel McRae of the 45th Sikhs, a holder of the Gold Medal of the Royal Humane Society and of long experience in Afghanistan and on the Indian frontier, ran to the Quarter Guard, and collecting seven or eight men, sent them under command of Major Taylor, of the same regiment, down the Buddhist road to try and check the enemy's advance. Hurriedly assembling another dozen men, and leaving the Adjutant, Lieutenant Barff, with directions to bring on more, he ran with his little party after Taylor in the direction of the entrance gorge of the Kotal camp. Two roads give access to the Malakand camp, from the plain of Khar. At one point the Buddhist road, the higher of the two, passes through a narrow defile then turns a sharp corner. Here, if anywhere, the enemy might be held or at least delayed until the troops got under arms. Overtaking Major Taylor, Colonel McRae led the party, which then amounted to perhaps twenty men, swiftly down the road, It was a race on which the lives of hundreds depended. If the enemy could turn the corner, nothing could check their rush, and the few men who tried to oppose them would be cut to pieces. The Sikhs arrived first, but by a very little. As they turned the corner they met the mass of the enemy, nearly a thousand strong, armed chiefly with swords and knives, creeping silently and stealthily up the gorge, in the hope and assurance of rushing the camp and massacring every soul in it. The whole road was crowded with the wild figures. McRae opened fire at once. Volley after volley was poured into the dense mass, at deadly range. At length the Sikhs fired independently. This checked the enemy, who shouted and yelled in fury at being thus stopped. The small party of soldiers then fell back, pace by pace, firing incessantly, and took up a position in a cutting about fifty yards behind the corner. Their flanks were protected on the left by high rocks, and on the right by boulders and rough ground, over which in the darkness it was impossible to move. The road was about five yards wide. As fast as the tribesmen turned the corner they were shot down. It was a strong position.
In the attack on the Malakand camp, all elements of danger and chaos were evident. The surprise, the darkness, the confusing and broken terrain; the unknown number of enemies; their ruthless ferocity; every horrifying circumstance was present. But there were men who rose to the challenge. As soon as the alarm went off, Lieutenant-Colonel McRae of the 45th Sikhs, a recipient of the Gold Medal from the Royal Humane Society and with extensive experience in Afghanistan and on the Indian frontier, rushed to the Quarter Guard. He gathered seven or eight men and sent them, under Major Taylor's command, down the Buddhist road to try to halt the enemy's advance. Quickly assembling another dozen men and leaving the Adjutant, Lieutenant Barff, with instructions to bring more, he hurried with his small group after Taylor toward the entrance gorge of the Kotal camp. There are two roads leading to the Malakand camp from the Khar plain. At one point, the higher Buddhist road passes through a narrow gap and then turns sharply. Here, if anywhere, the enemy might be held back or at least delayed until the troops were ready. Catching up with Major Taylor, Colonel McRae led the party, which had now grown to about twenty men, swiftly down the road. It was a race that could determine the lives of hundreds. If the enemy could round the corner, nothing could stop their charge, and any few men who tried to confront them would be slaughtered. The Sikhs arrived first, but only just in time. As they turned the corner, they encountered a massive force of nearly a thousand enemies, mostly armed with swords and knives, moving silently and stealthily up the gorge, intent on rushing the camp and slaughtering everyone inside. The entire road was filled with wild figures. McRae opened fire immediately. Volley after volley was unleashed into the dense mass at close range. Eventually, the Sikhs fired independently. This momentarily stopped the enemy, who yelled in fury at being thwarted. The small group of soldiers then fell back slowly, firing constantly, and took up a position in a cut about fifty yards behind the corner. Their flanks were secured on the left by high rocks and on the right by boulders and rough terrain, which made movement in the dark almost impossible. The road was about five yards wide. As soon as the tribesmen turned the corner, they were shot down. It was a strong position.
In that strait path a thousand Might well be stopped by three
In that narrow path, a thousand Could easily be blocked by three
Being thus effectively checked in their direct advance, the tribesmen began climbing up the hill to the left and throwing down rocks and stones on those who barred their path. They also fired their rifles round the corner, but as they were unable to see the soldiers without exposing themselves, most of their bullets went to the right.
Being effectively stopped in their direct advance, the tribesmen began climbing up the hill to the left and tossing down rocks and stones on those blocking their way. They also fired their rifles around the corner, but since they couldn’t see the soldiers without exposing themselves, most of their bullets went to the right.
The band of Sikhs were closely packed in the cutting, the front rank kneeling to fire. Nearly all were struck by stones and rocks. Major Taylor, displaying great gallantry, was mortally wounded. Several of the Sepoys were killed. Colonel McRae himself was accidentally stabbed in the neck by a bayonet and became covered with blood. But he called upon the men to maintain the good name of "Rattray's Sikhs," and to hold their position till death or till the regiment came up. And the soldiers replied by loudly shouting the Sikh warcry, and defying the enemy to advance.
The group of Sikhs were tightly packed in the trench, the front line kneeling to shoot. Almost all of them were hit by stones and rocks. Major Taylor, showing incredible bravery, was fatally injured. Several of the Sepoys were killed. Colonel McRae accidentally got stabbed in the neck by a bayonet and was covered in blood. But he urged the men to uphold the good name of "Rattray's Sikhs" and to hold their ground until death or until the regiment arrived. The soldiers responded by loudly chanting the Sikh war cry, daring the enemy to come forward.
After twenty minutes of desperate fighting, Lieutenant Barff arrived with thirty more men. He was only just in time. The enemy had already worked round Colonel McRae's right, and the destruction of the few soldiers left alive could not long have been delayed. The reinforcement, climbing up the hillside, drove the enemy back and protected the flank. But the remainder of the regiment was now at hand. Colonel McRae then fell back to a more extended position along a ridge about fifty yards further up the road, and reinforcing Lieutenant Barff's party, repulsed all attacks during the night. About 2 A.M. the tribesmen, finding they could make no progress, drew off, leaving many dead.
After twenty minutes of intense fighting, Lieutenant Barff showed up with thirty more men. He arrived just in time. The enemy had already flanked Colonel McRae's right, and the destruction of the few surviving soldiers could not have been delayed much longer. The reinforcements, climbing up the hillside, pushed the enemy back and secured the flank. However, the rest of the regiment was now arriving. Colonel McRae then pulled back to a more spread-out position along a ridge about fifty yards further up the road, and by bolstering Lieutenant Barff's group, they fended off all attacks throughout the night. Around 2 A.M., the tribesmen, realizing they weren't making any headway, withdrew, leaving behind many dead.
The presence of mind, tactical knowledge and bravery displayed in this affair are thus noticed in the official despatches by General Meiklejohn:—
The presence of mind, tactical knowledge, and bravery shown in this situation are noted in the official reports by General Meiklejohn:—
"There is no doubt that the gallant resistance made by this small body in the gorge, against vastly superior numbers, till the arrival of the rest of the regiment, saved the camp from being rushed on that side, and I cannot speak too highly of the behaviour of Lieutenant-Colonel McRae and Major Taylor on this occasion."
"There’s no doubt that the brave stand taken by this small group in the gorge, against much larger numbers, until the rest of the regiment arrived, saved the camp from being overwhelmed on that side. I can’t praise Lieutenant-Colonel McRae and Major Taylor's actions in this situation enough."
While these things were passing on the right, the other attacks of the enemy had met with more success. The camp was assaulted simultaneously on the three sides. The glow of the star shells showed that the north camp was also engaged. The enemy had been checked on the Buddhist road, by Colonel McRae and the 45th Sikhs, but another great mass of men forced their way along the Graded road in the centre of the position. On the first sound of firing the inlying picket of the 24th Punjaub Infantry doubled out to reinforce the pickets on the road, and in the water-gorge. They only arrived in time to find these being driven in by overpowering numbers of the enemy. Hundreds of fierce swordsmen swarmed unto the bazaar and into the serai, a small enclosure which adjoined. Sharpshooters scrambled up the surrounding hills, and particularly from one ragged, rock-strewn peak called Gibraltar, kept up a tremendous fire.
While all of this was happening on the right, the enemy's other attacks were meeting with more success. The camp was being attacked simultaneously on three sides. The brightness of the star shells indicated that the northern camp was also under fire. The enemy had been held back on the Buddhist road by Colonel McRae and the 45th Sikhs, but a large group of soldiers pushed through along the Graded road in the center of the position. At the first sound of gunfire, the inlying picket of the 24th Punjaub Infantry rushed out to strengthen the pickets on the road and in the water gorge. They arrived just in time to see their comrades being pushed back by overwhelming enemy numbers. Hundreds of fierce swordsmen swarmed into the bazaar and the adjacent serai, a small enclosed area. Sharpshooters climbed the surrounding hills, particularly from one jagged, rocky peak known as Gibraltar, and maintained heavy fire.
The defence of the left and centre or the camp was confided to the 24th Punjaub Infantry. One company of this regiment under Lieutenant Climo, charging across the football ground, cleared the bazaar at the point of the bayonet. The scene at this moment was vivid and terrible. The bazaar was crowded with tribesmen. The soldiers rushing forward amid loud cheers, plunged their bayonets into their furious adversaries. The sound of the hacking of swords, the screams of the unfortunate shopkeepers, the yells of the Ghazis were plainly heard above the ceaseless roll of musketry. The enemy now tried to force their way back into the bazaar, but the entrance was guarded by the troops and held against all assaults till about 10.45. The left flank of the company was then turned, and the pressure became so severe that they were withdrawn to a more interior line of defence, and took up a position along the edge of the "Sappers' and Miners' enclosure." Another company held the approaches from the north camp. The remainder of the regiment and No.5 company Sappers and Miners, were kept in readiness to reinforce any part of the line.
The defense of the left and center of the camp was entrusted to the 24th Punjab Infantry. One company of this regiment, led by Lieutenant Climo, charged across the football ground and cleared the bazaar at the point of their bayonets. The scene at that moment was vivid and horrifying. The bazaar was packed with tribesmen. The soldiers rushed forward amidst loud cheers, plunging their bayonets into their furious opponents. The sounds of swords clashing, the screams of unfortunate shopkeepers, and the yells of the Ghazis could be clearly heard above the continuous gunfire. The enemy then attempted to push their way back into the bazaar, but the entrance was secured by the troops and held against all assaults until about 10:45. The left flank of the company was then turned, and the pressure became so intense that they had to withdraw to a deeper line of defense, taking up a position along the edge of the "Sappers' and Miners' enclosure." Another company guarded the approaches from the northern camp. The rest of the regiment and No.5 company Sappers and Miners were kept ready to reinforce any part of the line.
It is necessary to record the actual movements of the troops in detail, but I am anxious above all things to give the reader a general idea. The enemy had attacked in tremendous strength along the two roads that gave access on the eastern side to the great cup of the Malakand. On the right road, they were checked by the brilliant movement of Colonel McRae and the courage of his regiment. Pouring in overwhelming force along the left road, they had burst into the camp itself, bearing down all opposition. The defenders, unable to hold the extended line of the rim, had been driven to take up a central position in the bottom of the cup. This central position comprised the "Sappers' and Miners' enclosure," the commissariat lines and the Field Engineer Park. It was commanded on every side by the fire from the rim. But the defenders stood at bay, determined at all costs to hold their ground, bad though it was.
It’s important to record the actual movements of the troops in detail, but more than anything, I want to give the reader a general idea. The enemy launched a massive attack along the two roads leading to the eastern side of the great bowl of the Malakand. On the right road, they were held back by Colonel McRae’s brilliant maneuver and the bravery of his regiment. Flooding in with overwhelming force along the left road, they broke into the camp itself, overpowering all resistance. The defenders, unable to maintain the extended line at the edge, were forced to take up a central position at the bottom of the bowl. This central position included the "Sappers' and Miners' enclosure," the supply lines, and the Field Engineer Park. They were surrounded on every side by fire from the edge. But the defenders stood firm, determined to hold their ground, no matter how tough the situation was.
Meanwhile the enemy rushed to the attack with wild courage and reckless fury. Careless of life, they charged the slender line of defence. Twice they broke through and penetrated the enclosure. They were met by men as bold as they. The fighting became desperate. The general himself hurried from point to point, animating the soldiers and joining in the defence with sword and revolver. As soon as the enemy broke into the commissariat lines they rushed into the huts and sheds eager for plunder and victims.
Meanwhile, the enemy charged into the attack with wild bravery and reckless fury. Ignoring their own lives, they rushed at the thin line of defense. Twice they broke through and got into the enclosure. They were met by men just as fearless. The fighting turned desperate. The general himself rushed from one spot to another, cheering on the soldiers and joining in the defense with his sword and pistol. As soon as the enemy broke into the supply lines, they stormed into the huts and sheds, eager for loot and victims.
Lieutenant Manley, the Brigade Commissariat Officer, stuck stubbornly to his post, and with Sergeant Harrington endeavoured to hold the hut in which he lived. The savage tribesmen burst in the door and crowded into the room. What followed reads like a romance.
Lieutenant Manley, the Brigade Commissariat Officer, stubbornly stayed at his post, and with Sergeant Harrington tried to defend the hut where he lived. The fierce tribesmen barged through the door and filled the room. What happened next feels like something out of a novel.
The officer opened fire at once with his revolver. He was instantly cut down and hacked to pieces. In the struggle the lamp was smashed. The room became pitch dark. The sergeant, knocking down his assailants, got free for a moment and stood against the wall motionless. Having killed Manley, the tribesmen now began to search for the sergeant, feeling with their hands along the wall and groping in the darkness. At last, finding no one, they concluded he had escaped, and hurried out to look for others. Sergeant Harrington remained in the hut till it was retaken some hours later, and so saved his life.
The officer fired his revolver immediately. He was quickly shot down and cut to pieces. During the struggle, the lamp was broken. The room turned completely dark. The sergeant, taking down his attackers, managed to break free for a moment and pressed against the wall, unmoving. After killing Manley, the tribesmen began searching for the sergeant, feeling along the wall and searching in the darkness. Eventually, finding no one, they assumed he had escaped and rushed out to look for others. Sergeant Harrington stayed in the hut until it was retaken a few hours later, which saved his life.
Another vigorous attack was made upon the Quarter Guard. Lieutenant Watling, who met it with his company of sappers, transfixed a Ghazi with his sword, but such was the fury of the fanatic that as he fell dead he cut at the officer and wounded him severely. The company were driven back. The Quarter Guard was captured, and with it the reserve ammunition of the sappers. Lieutenant Watling was carried in by his men, and, as soon as he reached the dressing station, reported the loss of this important post.
Another intense attack was launched against the Quarter Guard. Lieutenant Watling, who responded with his team of sappers, impaled a Ghazi with his sword, but the fanatic fought back furiously, and as he fell dead, he managed to injure the officer severely. The team was pushed back. The Quarter Guard was taken, along with the reserve ammunition of the sappers. Lieutenant Watling was brought in by his men, and as soon as he arrived at the medical station, he reported the loss of this crucial position.
Brigadier-General Meiklejohn at once ordered a party of the 24th to retake it from the enemy. Few men could be spared from the line of defence. At length a small but devoted band collected. It consisted of Captain Holland, Lieutenant Climo, Lieutenant Manley, R.E., the general's orderly, a Sepoy of the 45th Sikhs, two or three sappers and three men of the 24th; in all about a dozen.
Brigadier-General Meiklejohn immediately ordered a group from the 24th to reclaim it from the enemy. There were hardly any men available from the defensive line. Eventually, a small but dedicated team gathered. This included Captain Holland, Lieutenant Climo, Lieutenant Manley, R.E., the general's orderly, a Sepoy from the 45th Sikhs, a few sappers, and three men from the 24th; in total, about a dozen.
The general placed himself at their head. The officers drew their revolvers. The men were instructed to use the bayonet only. Then they advanced. The ground is by nature broken and confused to an extraordinary degree. Great rocks, undulations and trees rendered all movements difficult. Frequent tents, sheds and other buildings increased the intricacies. Amidst such surroundings were the enemy, numerous and well armed. The twelve men charged. The tribesmen advanced to meet them. The officers shot down man after man with their pistols. The soldiers bayoneted others. The enemy drew off discomfited, but half the party were killed or wounded. The orderly was shot dead. A sapper and a havildar of the 24th were severely wounded. The general himself was struck by a sword on the neck. Luckily the weapon turned in his assailant's hand, and only caused a bruise. Captain Holland was shot through the back at close quarters by a man concealed in a tent. The bullet, which caused four wounds, grazed his spine. The party were now too few to effect anything. The survivors halted. Lieutenant Climo took the wounded officer back, and collecting a dozen more men of the 24th, returned to the attack. The second attempt to regain the Quarter Guard was also unsuccessful, and the soldiers recoiled with further loss; but with that undaunted spirit which refuses to admit defeat they continued their efforts, and at the third charge dashed across the open space, bowling over and crushing back the enemy, and the post was recovered. All the ammunition had, however, been carried off by the enemy, and as the expenditure of that night had already been enormous, it was a serious loss. The commissariat lines were at length cleared of the tribesmen, and such of the garrison as could be spared were employed in putting up a hasty defence across the south entrance of the enclosure, and clearing away the cook-houses and other shelters, which might be seized by the enemy.
The general took charge. The officers pulled out their revolvers. The soldiers were told to use their bayonets only. They advanced. The terrain was extremely uneven and chaotic. Massive rocks, hills, and trees made movement difficult. Frequent tents, sheds, and other structures complicated things further. The enemy was present, numerous and well-armed. The twelve men charged. The tribesmen moved to confront them. The officers fired their pistols, taking down one enemy after another. The soldiers used their bayonets on others. The enemy retreated, but half of the group was either killed or injured. The orderly was shot dead. A sapper and a havildar from the 24th were badly wounded. The general himself was struck with a sword on the neck. Fortunately, the weapon turned in the attacker’s hand, only leaving a bruise. Captain Holland was shot in the back at close range by someone hidden in a tent. The bullet caused four wounds and barely missed his spine. The remaining soldiers were not enough to achieve anything. The survivors stopped. Lieutenant Climo took the wounded officer back and gathered a dozen more soldiers from the 24th to continue the fight. The second attempt to reclaim the Quarter Guard also failed, and the soldiers fell back with more losses; however, with their persistent spirit that wouldn't accept defeat, they continued trying. On the third charge, they sprinted across the open area, pushing back the enemy and reclaiming the post. Unfortunately, the enemy had taken all the ammunition, which was a significant loss since the consumption that night had already been huge. The commissariat lines were eventually cleared of the tribesmen, and those in the garrison who could be spared helped set up a quick defense across the south entrance of the enclosure and removed the cook-houses and other shelters that the enemy might seize.
The next morning no fewer than twenty-nine corpses of tribesmen were found round the cookhouse, and in the open space over which the three charges had taken place. This, when it is remembered that perhaps twice as many had been wounded and had crawled away, enables an estimate to be formed of the desperate nature of the fight for the Quarter Guard.
The next morning, no fewer than twenty-nine corpses of tribesmen were found around the cookhouse and in the open area where the three charges had occurred. Considering that perhaps twice as many had been wounded and had crawled away, this gives an idea of the desperate nature of the fight for the Quarter Guard.
All this time the fire from rim into the cup had been causing severe and continual losses. The enemy surrounding the enclosure on three sides, brought a cross fire to bear on its defenders, and made frequent charges right up to the breastwork. Bullets were flying in all directions, and there was no question of shelter. Major Herbert, D.A.A.G., was hit early in the night. Later on Lieutenant-Colonel Lamb received the dangerous wound in his thigh which caused his death a few days afterwards. Many Sepoys were also killed and wounded. The command of the 24th Punjaub Infantry devolved upon a subaltern officer, Lieutenant Climo. The regiment, however, will never be in better hands.
All this time, the fire from the rim into the cup had been causing significant and ongoing losses. The enemy surrounded the area on three sides, directing crossfire at its defenders and frequently charging right up to the barricade. Bullets were flying everywhere, and there was no chance of finding shelter. Major Herbert, D.A.A.G., got hit early in the night. Later, Lieutenant-Colonel Lamb sustained a serious wound in his thigh that led to his death a few days later. Many Sepoys were also killed and wounded. Command of the 24th Punjaub Infantry fell to a junior officer, Lieutenant Climo. However, the regiment could not be in better hands.
At about one o'clock, during a lull in the firing, the company which was lining the east face of the enclosure heard feeble cries of help. A wounded havildar of the 24th was lying near the bazaar. He had fallen in the first attack, shot in the shoulder. The tribesmen, giving him two or three deep sword cuts to finish him, had left him for dead. He now appealed for help. The football ground on which he lay was swept by the fire of the troops, and overrun by the enemy's swordsmen, yet the cry for help did not pass unheeded. Taking two Sepoys with him, Lieutenant E.W. Costello, 24th Punjaub Infantry, ran out into the deadly space, and, in spite of the heavy fire, brought the wounded soldier in safety. For this heroic action he has since received the Victoria Cross.
At around one o’clock, during a break in the shooting, the troops stationed along the east side of the enclosure heard weak cries for help. A wounded havildar from the 24th was lying near the bazaar. He had been shot in the shoulder during the initial attack and had collapsed. The tribesmen had given him a few deep sword cuts to finish him off and left him for dead. Now, he was calling out for assistance. The football field where he lay was under fire from the troops and overrun by enemy swordsmen, but his cry for help didn’t go ignored. Lieutenant E.W. Costello of the 24th Punjaub Infantry took two Sepoys with him and dashed into the dangerous area, managing to bring the wounded soldier back to safety despite the heavy fire. For this courageous act, he has since been awarded the Victoria Cross.
As the night wore on, the attack of the enemy became so vigorous, that the brigadier decided to call for a reinforcement of a hundred men from the garrison of the fort. This work stood high on a hill, and was impregnable to an enemy unprovided with field guns. Lieutenant Rawlins volunteered to try and reach it with the order. Accompanied by three orderlies, he started. He had to make his way through much broken ground infested by the enemy. One man sprang at him and struck him on the wrist with a sword, but the subaltern, firing his revolver, shot him dead, reached the fort in safety, and brought back the sorely-needed reinforcement.
As the night continued, the enemy's attacks became so intense that the brigadier decided to request a reinforcement of a hundred men from the fort's garrison. The fort was located on a hill and was impenetrable to an enemy without field guns. Lieutenant Rawlins volunteered to deliver the order. Accompanied by three orderlies, he set off. He had to navigate through difficult terrain infested by the enemy. One man lunged at him and hit him on the wrist with a sword, but the lieutenant shot him dead with his revolver, reached the fort safely, and brought back the much-needed reinforcements.
It was thought that the enemy would make a final effort to capture the enclosure before dawn, that being the hour which Afghan tribesmen usually select. But they had lost heavily, and at about 3.30 A.M. began to carry away their dead and wounded. The firing did not, however, lessen until 4.15 A.M., when the sharpshooters withdrew to the heights, and the fusillade dwindled to "sniping" at long range.
It was believed that the enemy would make one last attempt to take the enclosure before dawn, as that was the time Afghan tribesmen typically chose. However, they had suffered significant losses, and around 3:30 A.M. started to remove their dead and wounded. The gunfire didn’t decrease until 4:15 A.M., when the snipers retreated to the heights, and the barrage shifted to long-range "sniping."
The first night of the defence of the Malakand camp was over. The enemy, with all the advantages of surprise, position and great numbers, had failed to overcome the slender garrison. Everywhere they had been repulsed with slaughter. But the British losses had been severe.
The first night of defending the Malakand camp was finished. Despite having the upper hand with surprise, better positioning, and greater numbers, the enemy couldn't defeat the small garrison. They were pushed back violently everywhere. However, the British had suffered significant losses.
BRITISH OFFICERS. Killed—Hon. Lieutenant L. Manley, Commissariat Department. Wounded dangerously—Major W.W. Taylor, 45th Sikhs. Wounded severely—Lieut.-Colonel J. Lamb, 24th P.I. " " Major L. Herbert, D.A.A.G. " " Captain H.F. Holland, 24th P.I. " " Lieutenant F.W. Watling, Q.O. Sappers and Miners. Of these Lieut.-Colonel Lamb and Major Taylor died of their wounds. NATIVE RANKS. Killed...... 21 Wounded..... 31
BRITISH OFFICERS. Killed—Hon. Lieutenant L. Manley, Commissariat Department. Seriously Wounded—Major W.W. Taylor, 45th Sikhs. Severely Wounded—Lieut.-Colonel J. Lamb, 24th P.I. " " Major L. Herbert, D.A.A.G. " " Captain H.F. Holland, 24th P.I. " " Lieutenant F.W. Watling, Q.O. Sappers and Miners. Of these, Lieut.-Colonel Lamb and Major Taylor died from their injuries. NATIVE RANKS. Killed...... 21 Wounded..... 31
As soon as the first light of morning began to grow in the valley, two companies of the 24th advanced and cleared the bazaar of such of the enemy as had remained behind to plunder. The whole place had been thoroughly ransacked, and everything of value destroyed or carried off. The native manager had had a strange experience, and one which few men would envy. He had remained hidden in the back of a tent during the whole night in equal danger and terror of the bullets of the soldiers and the swords of the enemy. Hearing the friendly voices, he emerged uninjured from his retreat.
As soon as the first light of morning spread across the valley, two companies of the 24th moved in and cleared the bazaar of any enemies who had stayed behind to loot. The entire place had been thoroughly searched, and everything of value was either destroyed or taken away. The local manager had a strange experience, one that few would envy. He had stayed hidden at the back of a tent all night, facing equal danger and fear from both the soldiers’ bullets and the enemy’s swords. Hearing the familiar voices, he came out unharmed from his hiding spot.
Desultory firing was maintained by the tribesmen all day.
The tribesmen kept firing sporadically throughout the day.
While the close and desperate fighting, which has been described, was raging in the south camp, the north camp had not been seriously involved, and had spent a quiet, though anxious night. On the sound of the firing on the Kotal being heard, four guns of No.8 Mountain Battery were moved over to the south-east side of the camp, and several star shells were fired. No large body of the enemy was however discovered. Twice during the night the camp was approached by the tribesmen, but a few rounds of shrapnel were sufficient to drive these away.
While the intense and desperate fighting that has been described was ongoing in the south camp, the north camp remained largely unaffected and spent a quiet, albeit anxious night. When the sounds of gunfire from the Kotal were heard, four guns from No.8 Mountain Battery were moved to the southeast side of the camp, and several star shells were fired. However, no significant enemy presence was found. Twice during the night, the camp was approached by tribesmen, but a few rounds of shrapnel were enough to drive them away.
When General Meiklejohn found that the garrison of the north camp had not been severely engaged, he ordered a force consisting of two guns and the 31st Punjaub Infantry, under Major Gibbs, covered by forty sowars of the 11th Bengal Lancers, and supported by a wing of the 24th, to move out, reconnoitre the valley and clear it, as much as possible, of the enemy. The column advanced in pursuit as far as Bedford Hill. Here they came upon a large gathering of tribesmen, and as it was now evident that a great tribal rising had broken out, Major Gibbs was ordered to return and to bring his stores and troops into the Kotal camp without delay. The infantry and guns thereupon retired and fell back on the camp, covered by the 24th Punjaub Infantry.
When General Meiklejohn realized that the garrison at the north camp had not been heavily engaged, he ordered a force made up of two cannons and the 31st Punjaub Infantry, led by Major Gibbs, protected by forty cavalry from the 11th Bengal Lancers, and supported by a wing of the 24th, to move out, scout the valley, and clear it of enemy forces as much as possible. The column advanced in pursuit as far as Bedford Hill. There, they encountered a large group of tribesmen, and since it was now clear that a significant tribal uprising had begun, Major Gibbs was instructed to return and bring his supplies and troops back to the Kotal camp without delay. The infantry and cannons then pulled back to the camp, covered by the 24th Punjaub Infantry.
As this regiment was being withdrawn, a sudden attack was made from the high ground above the Buddhist road, and directed against the left flank of the troops. A front was immediately shown, and the 24th advanced to meet their assailants. Lieutenant Climo, who commanded, detached a company to the right, and by this turning movement drove them off, inflicting some loss and capturing a standard. This officer's skill and conduct in this retirement was again the subject of commendation in despatches. The troops reached their respective camps at about 11 o'clock. Meanwhile the cavalry had been ordered to push on, if possible, to Chakdara and reinforce the garrison at that post. The task was one of considerable danger, but by crossing and recrossing the Swat River, the squadron managed to cut their way through the tribesmen and reached the fort with slight loss. This brilliant ride will receive a fuller description in a later chapter.
As this regiment was being pulled back, a sudden attack came from the high ground above the Buddhist road, targeting the left flank of the troops. A front was quickly shown, and the 24th moved forward to confront their attackers. Lieutenant Climo, who was in charge, sent a company to the right, and with this maneuver, drove them off, causing some casualties and capturing a standard. This officer's skill and actions during this withdrawal were once again praised in reports. The troops reached their respective camps around 11 o'clock. In the meantime, the cavalry had been instructed to advance, if possible, to Chakdara and reinforce the garrison at that location. The task was quite dangerous, but by crossing and recrossing the Swat River, the squadron managed to break through the tribesmen and reached the fort with minimal losses. This impressive ride will be described in more detail in a later chapter.
The evacuation of the north camp proceeded very slowly. The troops packed up their kits with great deliberation, and applications were made for transport. None was, however, available. All the camels were at Dargai, on the Indian side of the mountains. Repeated orders to hurry were sent from the Kotal. All hated leaving their belongings behind, having no confidence in the liberality of a paternal Government. As the afternoon passed, the aspect of the enemy became very threatening and formidable. Great numbers drew near to the camp, and the guns were compelled to fire a good many rounds. At length, at 4 o'clock, imperative orders were sent that the north camp was to be at once abandoned, that the force there was to march to the Kotal, and that all baggage and stores, not yet removed, were to be left where they were.
The evacuation of the north camp was moving really slowly. The troops packed their gear with a lot of care, and they requested transportation. However, none was available. All the camels were at Dargai, on the Indian side of the mountains. They received repeated orders to rush from the Kotal. Everyone hated the idea of leaving their belongings behind, mistrusting the generosity of a paternal Government. As the afternoon went on, the enemy looked increasingly threatening and powerful. Large numbers approached the camp, and the guns had to fire quite a few rounds. Finally, at 4 o'clock, urgent orders were sent that the north camp was to be abandoned immediately, that the troops there were to march to the Kotal, and that all baggage and supplies not yet removed were to be left where they were.
All the tents were struck, but nothing else could be done, and to the deep disgust of all—officers and men—their property was left to the mercies of the enemy. During the night it was all looted and burnt. Many of the officers thus lost every stitch of clothing they possessed. The flames rising from the scene of destruction were visible far and wide, and the tribesmen in the most distant valleys were encouraged to hurry to complete the slaughter of the accursed infidels.
All the tents were taken down, but there was nothing else that could be done, and to the great dismay of everyone—both officers and soldiers—their belongings were left at the mercy of the enemy. During the night, everything was looted and burned. Many of the officers lost every piece of clothing they had. The flames rising from the destruction could be seen for miles, and tribesmen in the most distant valleys were spurred on to finish off the cursed infidels.
It cannot be doubted, however, that the concentration of the troops was a wise and judicious step. The garrison of the Kotal and south camp was insufficient, and, whatever happened, it was better for the troops to stand or fall together. The situation was also aggravated by the appearance of large numbers of tribesmen from the Utman Khel country, who crowded the hills to the west of the camp, and thus compelled the defenders to hold a greatly extended line. The abandonment of the north camp was carried out none too soon, for the enemy pressed the withdrawal of the troops, and they reached the south camp under cover of the fire of the 24th Punjaub Infantry, and the Guides Cavalry. These latter had arrived in camp at 8.30 that morning after marching all night. They found plenty of employment.
It’s clear that bringing the troops together was a smart and sensible decision. The forces at the Kotal and south camp were too few, and, no matter what happened, it was better for the troops to either stand or fall as one. The situation worsened with the large number of tribesmen from the Utman Khel area, who filled the hills to the west of the camp, forcing the defenders to stretch their line significantly. Abandoning the north camp happened just in time, as the enemy pressed the troops' withdrawal, and they made it to the south camp while being covered by the fire from the 24th Punjaub Infantry and the Guides Cavalry. The latter arrived at the camp at 8:30 that morning after marching all night and found plenty of work to do.
The telegraph had carried the news of the events of the night to all parts of the world. In England those returning from Goodwood Races read the first details of the fighting on the posters of the evening papers. At Simla, the Government of India awoke to find themselves confronted with another heavy task. Other messages recalled all officers to their regiments, and summoned reinforcements to the scene by road and rail. In the small hours of the 27th, the officers of the 11th Bengal Lancers at Nowshera were aroused by a frantic telegraph operator, who was astounded by the news his machine was clicking out. This man in his shirt sleeves, with a wild eye, and holding an unloaded revolver by the muzzle, ran round waking everyone. The whole country was up. The Malakand garrison was being overwhelmed by thousands of tribesmen. All the troops were to march at once. He brandished copies of the wires he had received. In a few moments official instructions arrived. The 11th Bengal Lancers, the 38th Dogras and the 35th Sikhs started at dawn. No.1 and No.7 British Mountain Batteries were also ordered up. The Guides Cavalry had already arrived. Their infantry under Lieutenant Lockhart reached the Kotal at 7.30 P.M. on the 27th, having, in spite of the intense heat and choking dust, covered thirty-two miles in seventeen and a half hours. This wonderful feat was accomplished without impairing the efficiency of the soldiers, who were sent into the picket line, and became engaged as soon as they arrived. An officer who commanded the Dargai post told me, that, as they passed the guard there, they shouldered arms with parade precision, as if to show that twenty-six miles under the hottest sun in the world would not take the polish off the Corps of Guides. Then they breasted the long ascent to the top of the pass, encouraged by the sound of the firing, which grew louder at every step.
The telegraph had spread the news of the night's events to every corner of the globe. In England, those returning from the Goodwood Races read the first details of the fighting on the posters of the evening papers. In Simla, the Government of India woke up to find themselves faced with another major challenge. Other messages called all officers back to their regiments and summoned reinforcements to the scene by road and rail. In the early hours of the 27th, the officers of the 11th Bengal Lancers in Nowshera were awakened by a frantic telegraph operator, who was shocked by the news his machine was relaying. This man, in his shirt sleeves, with a wild look in his eyes and holding an unloaded revolver by the muzzle, ran around waking everyone up. The whole country was on alert. The Malakand garrison was being overwhelmed by thousands of tribesmen. All the troops were to march immediately. He waved copies of the messages he had received. In a few moments, official orders came in. The 11th Bengal Lancers, the 38th Dogras, and the 35th Sikhs set out at dawn. No.1 and No.7 British Mountain Batteries were also called up. The Guides Cavalry had already arrived. Their infantry, under Lieutenant Lockhart, reached the Kotal at 7:30 P.M. on the 27th, having covered thirty-two miles in seventeen and a half hours despite the intense heat and choking dust. This remarkable achievement was accomplished without diminishing the soldiers' efficiency, as they were sent straight into the picket line and engaged in battle as soon as they arrived. An officer who commanded the Dargai post told me that as they passed the guard, they shouldered arms with parade precision, as if to show that walking twenty-six miles under the hottest sun in the world wouldn’t dull the shine of the Corps of Guides. Then they tackled the long climb to the top of the pass, spurred on by the sound of the gunfire, which grew louder with every step.
Help in plenty was thus approaching as fast as eager men could march, but meanwhile the garrison had to face the danger as best they could alone. As the 31st Punjaub Infantry, who had been the last to leave the north camp, were arriving at the Kotal, about 1000 tribesmen descended in broad daylight and with the greatest boldness, and threatened their left flank. They drove in two pickets of the 24th, and pressed forward vigorously. Lieutenant Climo with two companies advanced up the hill to meet them, supported by the fire of two guns of the Mountain Battery. A bayonet charge was completely successful. The officers were close enough to make effective use of their revolvers. Nine bodies of the enemy were left on the ground, and a standard was captured. The tribesmen then drew off, and the garrison prepared for the attack, which they knew would come with the dark.
Help was on the way as quickly as eager men could march, but in the meantime, the garrison had to face the danger as best they could on their own. As the 31st Punjab Infantry, who had been the last to leave the north camp, arrived at the Kotal, about 1,000 tribesmen descended in broad daylight with great boldness and threatened their left flank. They pushed in on two pickets of the 24th and pressed forward vigorously. Lieutenant Climo, with two companies, advanced up the hill to meet them, supported by the fire of two guns from the Mountain Battery. A bayonet charge was completely successful. The officers were close enough to effectively use their revolvers. Nine enemy bodies were left on the ground, and a flag was captured. The tribesmen then pulled back, and the garrison prepared for the attack they knew would come with the darkness.
As the evening drew on the enemy were observed assembling in ever-increasing numbers. Great crowds of them could be seen streaming along the Chakdara road, and thickly dotting the hills with spots of white. They all wore white as yet. The news had not reached Buner, and the sombre-clad warriors of Ambeyla were still absent. The glare of the flames from the north camp was soon to summon them to the attack of their ancient enemies. The spectacle as night fell was strange, ominous, but not unpicturesque. Gay banners of every colour, shape and device, waved from the surrounding hills. The sunset caught the flashing of swordblades behind the spurs and ridges. The numerous figures of the enemy moved busily about preparing for the attack. A dropping fire from the sharpshooters added an appropriate accompaniment. In the middle, at the bottom of the cup, was the "crater" camp and the main enclosure with the smoke of the evening meal rising in the air. The troops moved to their stations, and, as the shadows grew, the firing swelled into a loud, incessant roar.
As the evening went on, we saw the enemy gathering in larger and larger groups. Huge crowds were streaming down the Chakdara road, dotted in white all over the hills. They all still wore white. News hadn't reached Buner yet, so the dark-clad warriors of Ambeyla were still missing. The bright flames from the northern camp were about to call them to confront their old foes. The scene as night approached was strange, threatening, yet oddly beautiful. Colorful banners of all shapes and designs waved from the surrounding hills. The sunset reflected off the sword blades behind the hills and ridges. The enemy was moving around quickly, getting ready for the attack. Sporadic gunfire from sharpshooters provided a fitting background noise. In the center, at the bottom of the valley, was the "crater" camp and the main enclosure, with smoke from the evening meal rising into the air. The troops settled into their positions, and as the shadows deepened, the gunfire swelled into a loud, continuous roar.
The disposition of the troops on the night of the 27th was as follows:—
The arrangement of the troops on the night of the 27th was as follows:—
1. On the right Colonel McRae, with 45th Sikhs and two guns supported by 100 men of the Guides Infantry, held almost the same position astride the Buddhist road as before.
1. On the right, Colonel McRae, with the 45th Sikhs and two artillery pieces, supported by 100 men from the Guides Infantry, maintained nearly the same position across the Buddhist road as before.
2. In the centre the enclosure and Graded road were defended by—
2. In the center, the enclosure and graded road were defended by—
31st Punjaub Infantry. No.5 Company Q.O. Sappers and Miners. The Guides. Two Guns.
31st Punjab Infantry. No. 5 Company Q.O. Sappers and Miners. The Guides. Two Guns.
3. On the left the 24th Punjaub Infantry, with the two remaining guns under Lieutenant Climo, held the approaches from the abandoned north camp and the fort.
3. On the left, the 24th Punjab Infantry, along with the two remaining guns led by Lieutenant Climo, secured the routes from the deserted north camp and the fort.
Most of this extended line, which occupied a great part of the rim, was formed by a chain of pickets, detached from one another, and fortified by stone breastworks, with supports in rear. But in the centre the old line of the "Sappers' and Miners' enclosure" was adhered to. The bazaar was left to the enemy, but the serai, about a hundred yards in front of the main entrenchment, was held by a picket of twenty-four men of the 31st Punjaub Infantry, under Subadar Syed Ahmed Shah. Here it was that the tragedy of the night occurred.
Most of this long line, which took up a large part of the edge, was made up of a series of individual pickets, spaced apart from each other and protected by stone barricades, with reinforcements behind. But in the center, they stuck to the old line of the "Sappers' and Miners' enclosure." The bazaar was left to the enemy, but the serai, about a hundred yards in front of the main fortification, was held by a picket of twenty-four soldiers from the 31st Punjaub Infantry, led by Subadar Syed Ahmed Shah. This was the spot where the tragedy of the night happened.
At eight o'clock, the tribesmen attacked in tremendous force all along the line. The firing at once became intense and continuous. The expenditure of ammunition by the troops was very great, and many thousands of rounds were discharged. On the right Colonel McRae and his Sikhs were repeatedly charged by the swordsmen, many of whom succeeded in forcing their way into the pickets and perished by the bayonet. Others reached the two guns and were cut down while attacking the gunners. All assaults were however beaten off. The tribesmen suffered terrible losses. The casualties among the Sikhs were also severe. In the morning Colonel McRae advanced from his defences, and, covered by the fire of his two guns, cleared the ground in his front of the enemy.
At eight o'clock, the tribesmen launched a massive attack all along the line. The firing immediately became intense and continuous. The troops used an enormous amount of ammunition, with many thousands of rounds fired. On the right, Colonel McRae and his Sikhs were repeatedly charged by swordsmen, many of whom managed to break through the pickets and were killed by bayonets. Others reached the two guns and were taken down while trying to attack the gunners. However, all assaults were repelled. The tribesmen suffered heavy losses. The casualties among the Sikhs were also significant. In the morning, Colonel McRae moved out from his defenses and, shielded by the fire from his two guns, cleared the area in front of him of the enemy.
The centre was again the scene of severe fighting. The tribesmen poured into the bazaar and attacked the serai on all sides. This post was a mud-walled enclosure about fifty yards square. It was loopholed for musketry, but had no flank defences. The enemy made determined efforts to capture the place for several hours. Meanwhile, so tremendous was the fire of the troops in the main enclosure, that the attack upon the serai was hardly noticed. For six hours the picket there held out against all assaults, but the absence of flank defences enabled the enemy to come close up to the walls. They then began to make holes through them, and to burrow underneath. The little garrison rushed from place to place repelling these attacks. But it was like caulking a sieve. At length the tribesmen burst in from several quarters, and the sheds inside caught fire. When all the defenders except four were killed or wounded, the Subadar, himself struck by a bullet, ordered the place to be evacuated, and the survivors escaped by a ladder over the back wall, carrying their wounded with them. The bodies of the killed were found next morning, extraordinarily mutilated.
The center was once again the scene of intense fighting. Tribesmen flooded into the bazaar and attacked the serai from all sides. This outpost was a mud-walled area about fifty yards square. It was built with openings for musket fire, but had no side defenses. The enemy made strong efforts to take the place for several hours. Meanwhile, the troops' fire in the main enclosure was so powerful that the attack on the serai went mostly unnoticed. For six hours, the picket there held out against all assaults, but the lack of side defenses allowed the enemy to get close to the walls. They then began to create holes through them and dig underneath. The small garrison rushed from place to place repelling these attacks, but it was like trying to plug a sieve. Eventually, the tribesmen broke in from several directions, and the sheds inside caught fire. When all the defenders except for four were killed or wounded, the Subadar, who had been hit by a bullet, ordered the evacuation, and the survivors escaped over the back wall using a ladder, taking their wounded with them. The bodies of the dead were found the next morning, brutally mutilated.
The defence of this post to the bitter end must be regarded as a fine feat of arms. Subadar Syed Ahmed Shah was originally promoted to a commission for an act of conspicuous bravery, and his gallant conduct on this occasion is the subject of a special paragraph in despatches. [The Subadar and the surviving Sepoys have since received the "Order of Merit."]
The defense of this post to the very end should be seen as a remarkable achievement. Subadar Syed Ahmed Shah was initially promoted to a commission for an act of outstanding bravery, and his courageous actions during this event are highlighted in a special paragraph in the reports. [The Subadar and the surviving Sepoys have since received the "Order of Merit."]
On the left, the 24th Punjaub Infantry were also hotly engaged, and Lieutenant Costello received his first severe wound from a bullet, which passed through his back and arm. Towards morning the enemy began to press severely. Whereupon Lieutenant Climo, always inclined to bold and vigorous action, advanced from the breastworks to meet them with two companies. The tribesmen held their ground and maintained a continual fire from Martini-Henry rifles. They also rolled down great stones upon the companies. The 24th continued to advance, and drove the enemy from point to point, and position to position, pursuing them for a distance of two miles. "Gallows Tree" hill, against which the first charge of the counter attack was delivered, was held by nearly 1000 tribesmen. On such crowded masses, the fire of the troops was deadly. The enemy left forty dead in the path of Lieutenant Climo's counter attack, and were observed carrying off many wounded. As they retreated, many took refuge in the village of Jalalkot. The guns were hurried up, and ten shells were thrown into their midst, causing great slaughter. The result of this bold stroke was, that the enemy during the rest of the fighting invariably evacuated the hills before daylight enabled the troops to assume the offensive.
On the left, the 24th Punjaub Infantry were also heavily engaged, and Lieutenant Costello received his first serious wound from a bullet that passed through his back and arm. As morning approached, the enemy began to press hard. Lieutenant Climo, always inclined to act boldly and decisively, advanced from the breastworks to meet them with two companies. The tribesmen held their ground and kept up a steady fire from Martini-Henry rifles, also rolling down large stones onto the companies. The 24th continued to advance, driving the enemy from location to location, pursuing them for about two miles. "Gallows Tree" hill, where the first charge of the counterattack was launched, was held by nearly 1,000 tribesmen. The troops’ fire was deadly against such large crowds. The enemy left forty dead in the path of Lieutenant Climo's counterattack and were seen carrying away many wounded. As they retreated, many took shelter in the village of Jalalkot. The artillery was quickly moved up, and ten shells were fired into their midst, causing significant casualties. The result of this daring maneuver was that during the rest of the fighting, the enemy consistently evacuated the hills before daylight allowed the troops to take the offensive.
Thus the onslaught of the tribesmen had again been successfully repelled by the Malakand garrison. Many had been killed and wounded, but all the tribes for a hundred miles around were hurrying to the attack, and their number momentarily increased. The following casualties occurred on the night of the 27th:—
Thus, the attack from the tribesmen was once again successfully held off by the Malakand garrison. Many were killed and injured, but all the tribes from a hundred miles around were rushing to attack, and their numbers were growing by the moment. The following casualties occurred on the night of the 27th:—
BRITISH OFFICER. Wounded—Lieutenant E.W. Costello. NATIVE RANKS. Killed...... 12 Wounded..... 29
BRITISH OFFICER. Injured—Lieutenant E.W. Costello. NATIVE RANKS. Killed...... 12 Injured..... 29
During the day the enemy retired to the plain of Khar to refresh themselves. Great numbers of Bunerwals now joined the gathering. The garrison were able to distinguish these new-comers from the Swatis, Utman Khels, Mamunds, Salarzais and others, by the black or dark-blue clothes they wore. The troops were employed in strengthening the defences, and improving the shelters. The tribesmen kept up a harassing and annoying long-range fire, killing several horses of the Guides Cavalry. Towards evening they advanced to renew the attack, carrying hundreds of standards.
During the day, the enemy fell back to the Khar plain to rest. A large number of Bunerwals joined the gathering. The garrison could tell these newcomers apart from the Swatis, Utman Khels, Mamunds, Salarzais, and others by the black or dark-blue clothing they wore. The troops worked on reinforcing the defenses and improving the shelters. The tribesmen maintained a constant and irritating long-range fire, which killed several horses belonging to the Guides Cavalry. As evening approached, they moved forward to launch another attack, bringing hundreds of flags with them.
As darkness fell, heavy firing recommenced along the whole front. The enemy had apparently plenty of ammunition, and replied with effect to the heavy fire of the troops. The arrangement of the regiments was the same as on the previous night. On the right, Colonel McRae once more held his own against all attacks. In the centre, severe fighting ensued. The enemy charged again and again up to the breastwork of the enclosure. They did not succeed in penetrating. Three officers and several men were however wounded by the fire. Lieutenant Maclean, of the Guides Cavalry, who was attached temporarily to the 31st Punjaub Infantry, had a wonderful escape. A bullet entered his mouth and passed through his cheek without injuring the bone in any way. He continued on duty, and these pages will record his tragic but glorious death a few weeks later at Landakai.
As night fell, heavy gunfire started up again along the entire front. The enemy seemed to have plenty of ammunition and responded effectively to the troops' intense fire. The regiments were arranged just like the previous night. On the right, Colonel McRae once again held his ground against all assaults. In the center, intense fighting broke out. The enemy charged repeatedly up to the barricade. They didn't manage to break through. Three officers and several soldiers were, however, injured by the gunfire. Lieutenant Maclean of the Guides Cavalry, who was temporarily assigned to the 31st Punjaub Infantry, had an incredible escape. A bullet entered his mouth and went through his cheek without damaging the bone at all. He continued with his duties, and these pages will note his tragic yet heroic death a few weeks later at Landakai.
Lieutenant Ford was dangerously wounded in the shoulder. The bullet cut the artery, and he was bleeding to death when Surgeon-Lieutenant J.H. Hugo came to his aid. The fire was too hot to allow of lights being used. There was no cover of any sort. It was at the bottom of the cup. Nevertheless the surgeon struck a match at the peril of his life and examined the wound. The match went out amid a splutter of bullets, which kicked up the dust all around, but by its uncertain light he saw the nature of the injury. The officer had already fainted from the loss of blood. The doctor seized the artery, and, as no other ligature was forthcoming, he remained under fire for three hours holding a man's life, between his finger and thumb. When at length it seemed that the enemy had broken into the camp he picked up the still unconscious officer in his arms, and, without relaxing his hold, bore him to a place of safety. His arm was for many hours paralysed with cramp from the effects of the exertion of compressing the artery.
Lieutenant Ford was critically injured in the shoulder. The bullet hit an artery, and he was bleeding out when Surgeon-Lieutenant J.H. Hugo arrived to help him. The gunfire was too intense to allow any lights to be used. There was no protection whatsoever. It was at the bottom of the ravine. Still, the surgeon risked his life to strike a match and examine the wound. The match went out amidst a barrage of bullets that kicked up dust all around, but with its faint light, he assessed the injury. The officer had already passed out from blood loss. The doctor grabbed the artery, and since there were no other supplies available, he stayed under fire for three hours, holding a man's life together with just his fingers. When it finally seemed that the enemy was about to overrun the camp, he picked up the still unconscious officer in his arms and, without loosening his grip, carried him to safety. His arm was paralyzed with cramp for many hours from the strain of applying pressure to the artery.
I think there are few, whatever may be their views or interests, who will not applaud this splendid act of devotion. The profession of medicine, and surgery, must always rank as the most noble that men can adopt. The spectacle of a doctor in action among soldiers, in equal danger and with equal courage, saving life where all others are taking it, allaying pain where all others are causing it, is one which must always seem glorious, whether to God or man. It is impossible to imagine any situation from which a human being might better leave this world, and embark on the hazards of the Unknown.
I believe there are very few people, regardless of their beliefs or interests, who wouldn't admire this incredible act of dedication. The fields of medicine and surgery will always be regarded as the most honorable professions one can pursue. Watching a doctor in action alongside soldiers, facing the same dangers with equal bravery, saving lives while others are taking them, and easing pain while others are inflicting it, is undoubtedly a glorious sight, both to God and humanity. It's hard to envision any situation where a person could leave this world in a more admirable way and venture into the uncertainties of the Unknown.
All through the night, the enemy continued their attacks. They often succeeded in reaching the breastworks—only to die on the bayonets of the defenders. The guns fired case shot, with terrible effect, and when morning dawned the position was still held by the Imperial Forces. The casualties of the night were as follows:—
All through the night, the enemy kept launching their attacks. They frequently managed to reach the barricades—only to be killed by the defenders' bayonets. The cannons fired explosive projectiles, causing devastating damage, and when morning came, the position was still in the hands of the Imperial Forces. The casualties of the night were as follows:—
BRITISH OFFICERS. Wounded severely—Lieutenant H.B. Ford, 31st Punjaub Infantry. " H.L.S. Maclean, the Guides. Wounded slightly—Lieutenant G. Swinley, 31st Punjaub Infantry. NATIVE RANKS. Killed....... 2 Wounded...... 13
BRITISH OFFICERS. Severely Wounded—Lieutenant H.B. Ford, 31st Punjaub Infantry. " H.L.S. Maclean, the Guides. Slightly Wounded—Lieutenant G. Swinley, 31st Punjaub Infantry. NATIVE RANKS. Killed....... 2 Wounded...... 13
On the morning of the 29th signalling communication with Chakdara was for a few moments re-established. The garrison of that post announced their safety, and that all attacks had been repulsed with heavy loss, but they reported that ammunition and food were both running short. During the day the enemy again retired to the plain to rest, and prepare for the great attack, which they intended making that night. The hour would be propitious. It was Jumarat, on which day the prophet watches with especial care over the interests of those who die for the faith. Besides, the moon was full, and had not the Great Fakir declared that this should be the moment of victory? The Mullah exhorted them all to the greatest efforts, and declared that he would himself lead the assault. To-night the infidels would be utterly destroyed.
On the morning of the 29th, communication with Chakdara was briefly restored. The garrison reported that they were safe and had successfully repelled all attacks with heavy losses for the enemy, but they warned that their ammunition and food supplies were running low. During the day, the enemy withdrew to the plain to rest and prepare for a major attack planned for that night. The timing was favorable; it was Jumarat, a day when the prophet pays special attention to those who die for their faith. Additionally, the moon was full, and hadn’t the Great Fakir proclaimed that this would be the time of victory? The Mullah urged everyone to put in their best effort and announced that he would lead the charge. Tonight, the infidels would be completely defeated.
Meanwhile the troops were busily employed, in spite of their terrible fatigues, in strengthening the defences. The bazaar and the serai were levelled. Trees were blown up, and a clear field of fire was obtained in front of the central enclosure. Great bonfires were also prepared on the approaches, to enable the soldiers to take good aim at their assailants, while they were silhouetted against the light. In such occupations the day passed.
Meanwhile, the troops were hard at work, despite their extreme exhaustion, strengthening the defenses. The market and the inn were demolished. Trees were uprooted, creating a clear line of fire in front of the main enclosure. Huge bonfires were also set up on the approach to help the soldiers aim accurately at their attackers as they appeared against the light. The day went on with these tasks.
The tribesmen continued to fire at long range and shot several horses and mules. These sharpshooters enjoyed themselves immensely. After the relief of Chakdara, it was found that many of them had made most comfortable and effective shelters among the rocks. One man, in particular, had ensconced himself behind an enormous boulder, and had built a little wall of stone, conveniently loopholed, to protect himself when firing. The overhanging rock sheltered him from the heat of the sun. By his side were his food and a large box of cartridges. Here for the whole week he had lived, steadily dropping bullets unto the camp and firing at what an officer described as all "objects of interest." What could be more attractive?
The tribesmen kept shooting from a distance, hitting several horses and mules. These sharpshooters were having a great time. After the rescue of Chakdara, it turned out that many of them had created really comfortable and effective hideouts among the rocks. One guy, in particular, had settled in behind a massive boulder and had built a small stone wall with loopholes to shield himself while he shot. The overhanging rock kept him cool from the sun's heat. Next to him were his food and a big box of ammunition. He lived here for the entire week, continuously firing bullets into the camp and targeting what an officer referred to as "objects of interest." What could be more enticing?
At four o'clock in the afternoon Major Stuart Beatsen, commanding the 11th Bengal Lancers, arrived with his leading squadron. He brought a small supply of ammunition, which the garrison was in sore need of, the expenditure each night being tremendous, some regiments firing as much as 30,000 rounds. The 35th Sikhs and 38th Dogras under Colonel Reid arrived at Dargai, at the foot of the pass, in the evening. They had marched all day in the most intense heat. How terrible that march must have been, may be judged from the fact, that in the 35th Sikhs twenty-one men actually died on the road of heat apoplexy. The fact that these men marched till they dropped dead, is another proof of the soldierly eagerness displayed by all ranks to get to the front. Brigadier-General Meiklejohn, feeling confidence in his ability to hold his own with the troops he had, ordered them to remain halted at Dargai, and rest the next day.
At four o'clock in the afternoon, Major Stuart Beatsen, who was in charge of the 11th Bengal Lancers, arrived with his leading squadron. He brought a small supply of ammunition that the garrison desperately needed, as they used an enormous amount each night, with some regiments firing as many as 30,000 rounds. The 35th Sikhs and 38th Dogras, led by Colonel Reid, reached Dargai at the base of the pass in the evening. They had marched all day in extreme heat. The harshness of that march can be highlighted by the fact that twenty-one men from the 35th Sikhs died on the way from heatstroke. The fact that these men marched until they collapsed is further proof of the determination shown by all ranks to reach the front lines. Brigadier-General Meiklejohn, confident in his ability to hold his position with the troops he had, ordered them to stay halted at Dargai and rest the next day.
The attack came with the night, but the defences in the centre had been much improved, and the tribesmen were utterly unable to cross the cleared glacis, which now stretched in front of the enclosure. They, however, assailed both flanks with determination, and the firing everywhere became heavy. At 2 A.M. the great attack was delivered. Along the whole front and from every side enormous numbers swarmed to the assault. On the right and left, hand-to-hand fighting took place. Colonel McRae again held his position, but many of the tribesmen died under the very muzzles of the rifles. The 24th Punjaub Infantry on the left were the most severely engaged. The enemy succeeded in breaking into the breastworks, and close fighting ensued, in which Lieutenant Costello was again severely wounded. But the fire of the troops was too hot for anything to live in their front. At 2.30 the Mad Mullah being wounded, another Mullah killed and several hundreds of tribesmen slain, the whole attack collapsed. Nor was it renewed again with vigor. The enemy recognised that their chance of taking the Malakand had passed.
The attack came at night, but the defenses in the center had been greatly improved, and the tribesmen couldn't get past the cleared area in front of the enclosure. However, they fiercely attacked both flanks, and gunfire erupted everywhere. At 2 A.M., the major assault began. Huge numbers swarmed from all sides to attack the front. Hand-to-hand combat took place on the right and left. Colonel McRae maintained his position, but many tribesmen fell right at the muzzles of the rifles. The 24th Punjaub Infantry on the left faced the heaviest fighting. The enemy managed to breach the breastworks, leading to close combat, during which Lieutenant Costello was seriously wounded again. But the troops' fire was too intense for anyone to survive in front of them. At 2:30, after the Mad Mullah was wounded, another Mullah was killed, and several hundred tribesmen were slain, the entire attack fell apart. They did not renew the assault with any energy. The enemy realized that their opportunity to take Malakand had passed.
The casualties were as follows on the night of the 29th:—
The casualties were as follows on the night of the 29th:—
BRITISH OFFICERS. Wounded severely—Lieutenant E.W. Costello, 24th P.I., who had already been severely wounded, but continued to do duty. " " Lieutenant F.A. Wynter, R.A. NATIVE RANKS. Killed...... 1 Wounded..... 17
BRITISH OFFICERS. Severely injured—Lieutenant E.W. Costello, 24th P.I., who had already been seriously injured but kept serving. " " Lieutenant F.A. Wynter, R.A. NATIVE RANKS. Killed...... 1 Wounded..... 17
All the next day the enemy could be seen dragging the dead away, and carrying the wounded over the hills to their villages. Reinforcements, however, joined them, and they renewed their attack, but without much spirit, at 9.30 P.M. They were again repulsed with loss. Once, during a thunderstorm that broke over the camp, they charged the 45th Sikhs' position, and were driven off with the bayonet. Only two men were wounded during the night.
All the next day, the enemy could be seen dragging away the dead and carrying the injured over the hills to their villages. However, reinforcements joined them, and they renewed their attack at 9:30 P.M., but it lacked enthusiasm. They were once again pushed back with losses. At one point, during a thunderstorm that hit the camp, they charged the 45th Sikhs' position and were driven off with bayonets. Only two men were injured during the night.
In the morning the 38th Dogras and 35th Sikhs marched into the camp. The enemy continued firing into the entrenchments at long range, but without effect. They had evidently realised that the Malakand was too strong to be taken. The troops had a quiet night, and the weary, worn-out men got a little needed sleep. Thus the long and persistent attack on the British frontier station of Malakand languished and ceased. The tribesmen, sick of the slaughter at this point, concentrated their energies on Chakdara, which they believed must fall into their hands. To relieve this hard-pressed post now became the duty of the garrison of Malakand.
In the morning, the 38th Dogras and 35th Sikhs marched into the camp. The enemy kept firing at the trenches from a distance, but it didn’t have any effect. They clearly realized that Malakand was too strong to capture. The troops had a peaceful night, and the exhausted, worn-out soldiers managed to get some much-needed sleep. Thus, the long and ongoing attack on the British frontier station of Malakand faded and came to an end. The tribesmen, tired of the bloodshed at this location, focused their efforts on Chakdara, which they believed would eventually fall into their hands. Relieving this beleaguered post became the responsibility of the Malakand garrison.
The chapter, which may now appropriately end, has described in detail, and, necessarily, at length, the defence of an outpost of our Empire. A surprise, followed by a sustained attack, has been resisted. The enemy, repulsed at every point, have abandoned the attempt, but surround and closely watch the defences. The troops will now assume the offensive, and the hour of reprisals will commence.
The chapter, which can now properly conclude, has thoroughly explained, and, of course, in detail, the defense of an outpost in our Empire. A surprise attack, followed by an ongoing siege, was successfully resisted. The enemy, pushed back at every turn, has given up their efforts, but continues to encircle and closely observe the defenses. The troops will now take the initiative, and the time for retaliation will begin.
The casualties sustained by the Malakand garrison between 26th July and 1st August were as follows:—
The casualties suffered by the Malakand garrison between July 26th and August 1st were as follows:—
BRITISH OFFICERS KILLED AND DIED OF WOUNDS—3. Lieutenant-Colonel J. Lamb, 24th Punjaub Infantry. Major W.W. Taylor, 45th Sikhs. Lieutenant L. Manley, Commissariat. WOUNDED—10. Major L. Herbert, D.A.A.G. Captain G. Baldwin, D.S.O., Guides Cavalry. Captain H.F. Holland, 24th Punjaub Infantry. Lieutenant F.A. Wynter, R.A. " F.W. Watling, R.E. " E.W. Costello, 24th Punjaub Infantry. " H.B. Ford, 31st Punjaub Infantry. " H.L.S. Maclean, Guides Cavalry. 2nd Lieutenant G. Swinley, 31st Punjaub Infantry. " C.V. Keyes, Guides Cavalry. NATIVE OFFICERS WOUNDED—7. TOTAL OFFICERS KILLED AND WOUNDED—20. BRITISH NON-COMMISSIONED OFFICER KILLED. Sergeant F. Byrne, R.E. NATIVE NON-COMMISSIONED OFFICERS AND PRIVATES. Killed. Wounded. No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery . . 0 5 11th Bengal Lancers . . . 0 3 No.5 Company Q.O. Sappers and Miners. 3 18 24th Punjaub Infantry . . . 3 14 31st " " . . . . 12 32 38th Dogras . . . . . 0 1 45th Sikhs . . . . . 4 28 Q.O. Corps of Guides. . . . 3 27 TOTAL NON-COMMISSIONED OFFICERS AND MEN KILLED AND WOUNDED—153.
BRITISH OFFICERS KILLED AND DIED OF WOUNDS—3. Lieutenant-Colonel J. Lamb, 24th Punjaub Infantry. Major W.W. Taylor, 45th Sikhs. Lieutenant L. Manley, Commissariat. WOUNDED—10. Major L. Herbert, D.A.A.G. Captain G. Baldwin, D.S.O., Guides Cavalry. Captain H.F. Holland, 24th Punjaub Infantry. Lieutenant F.A. Wynter, R.A. " F.W. Watling, R.E. " E.W. Costello, 24th Punjaub Infantry. " H.B. Ford, 31st Punjaub Infantry. " H.L.S. Maclean, Guides Cavalry. 2nd Lieutenant G. Swinley, 31st Punjaub Infantry. " C.V. Keyes, Guides Cavalry. NATIVE OFFICERS WOUNDED—7. TOTAL OFFICERS KILLED AND WOUNDED—20. BRITISH NON-COMMISSIONED OFFICER KILLED. Sergeant F. Byrne, R.E. NATIVE NON-COMMISSIONED OFFICERS AND PRIVATES. Killed. Wounded. No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery . . 0 5 11th Bengal Lancers . . . 0 3 No.5 Company Q.O. Sappers and Miners. 3 18 24th Punjaub Infantry . . . 3 14 31st " " . . . . 12 32 38th Dogras . . . . . 0 1 45th Sikhs . . . . . 4 28 Q.O. Corps of Guides. . . . 3 27 TOTAL NON-COMMISSIONED OFFICERS AND MEN KILLED AND WOUNDED—153.
CHAPTER V: THE RELIEF OF CHAKDARA
While the events described in the last chapter had been watched with interest and attention in all parts of the world, they were the subject of anxious consultation in the Council of the Governor-General. It was only natural that the Viceroy, himself, should view with abhorrence the prospect of military operations on a large scale, which must inevitably lead to closer and more involved relations with the tribes of the Afghan border. He belonged to that party in the State which has clung passionately, vainly, and often unwisely to a policy of peace and retrenchment. He was supported in his reluctance to embark on warlike enterprises by the whole force of the economic situation. No moment could have been less fitting: no man more disinclined. That Lord Elgin's Viceroyalty and the Famine year should have been marked by the greatest Frontier War in the history of the British Empire in India, vividly displays how little an individual, however earnest his motives, however great his authority, can really control the course of public affairs.
While the events from the last chapter were closely followed with interest around the world, they sparked serious discussions in the Governor-General's Council. It was completely understandable for the Viceroy to find the idea of large-scale military operations repulsive, as such actions would inevitably complicate relationships with the Afghan border tribes. He was part of a faction in the government that has stubbornly and often unreasonably embraced a policy of peace and budget cuts. His hesitation to engage in military ventures was reinforced by the entire economic situation. There couldn't have been a worse time, and he was certainly the least enthusiastic about it. That Lord Elgin's time as Viceroy and the year of the famine were marked by the largest Frontier War in the history of the British Empire in India illustrates how little control an individual, no matter how passionate or authoritative, can truly exert over public affairs.
The Council were called upon to decide on matters, which at once raised the widest and most intricate questions of frontier policy; which might involve great expense; which might well influence the development and progress of the great populations committed to their charge. It would be desirable to consider such matters from the most lofty and commanding standpoints; to reduce detail to its just proportions; to examine the past, and to peer into the future. And yet, those who sought to look thus on the whole situation, were immediately confronted with the picture of the rock of Chakdara, fringed and dotted with the white smoke of musketry, encircled by thousands of fierce assailants, its garrison fighting for their lives, but confident they would not be deserted. It was impossible to see further than this. All Governments, all Rulers, meet the same difficulties. Wide considerations of principle, of policy, of consequences or of economics are brushed aside by an impetuous emergency. They have to decide off-hand. The statesman has to deal with events. The historian, who has merely to record them, may amuse his leisure by constructing policies, to explain instances of successful opportunism.
The Council was called to make decisions on issues that immediately raised the most significant and complex questions about frontier policy, which could involve substantial costs and potentially affect the development and progress of the large populations they were responsible for. It would be ideal to view these issues from the highest and most authoritative perspectives, to consider the details appropriately, to reflect on the past, and to look ahead into the future. Yet, those who tried to take such a broad view were quickly faced with the scene of Chakdara rock, surrounded by the white smoke of gunfire and encircled by thousands of fierce attackers, with its garrison fighting for their lives but assured they wouldn’t be abandoned. It was impossible to see beyond this. All governments and rulers face the same challenges. Broad considerations of principles, policies, consequences, or economics are overshadowed by urgent emergencies. They have to make decisions on the spot. The statesman must confront events as they unfold, while the historian, whose job is just to record them, can spend their time creating policies to explain examples of effective opportunism.
On the 30th of July the following order was officially published: "The Governor-General in Council sanctions the despatch of a force, to be styled the Malakand Field Force, for the purpose of holding the Malakand, and the adjacent posts, and of operating against the neighbouring tribes as may be required."
On July 30th, the following order was officially released: "The Governor-General in Council approves the deployment of a force, called the Malakand Field Force, to secure the Malakand and nearby posts, and to take action against the neighboring tribes as needed."
The force was composed as follows:—
The force was made up as follows:—
1st Brigade. Commanding—Colonel W.H. Meiklejohn, C.B., C.M.G., with the local rank of Brigadier-General. 1st Battalion Royal West Kent Regiment. 24th Punjaub Infantry. 31st Punjaub Infantry. 45th (Rattray's) Sikhs. Sections A and B of No.1 British Field Hospital. No.38 Native Field Hospital. Sections A and B of No.50 Native Field Hospital. 2nd Brigade. Commanding—Brigadier-General P.D. Jeffreys, C.B. 1st Battalion East Kent Regiment (the Buffs). 35th Sikhs. 38th Dogras. Guides Infantry. Sections C and D of No.1 British Field Hospital. No.37 Native Field Hospital. Sections C and D of No.50 Native Field Hospital. Divisional Troops. 4 Squadrons 11th Bengal Lancers. 1 " 10th " " 2 " Guides Cavalry. 22nd Punjaub Infantry. 2 Companies 21st Punjaub Infantry. 10th Field Battery. 6 Guns No.1 British Mountain Battery. 6 " No.7 " " " 6 " No.8 Bengal " " No.5 Company Madras Sappers and Miners. No.3 " Bombay " " " Section B of No.13 British Field Hospital. Sections A and B of No.35 Native Field Hospital. Line of Communications. No.34 Native Field Hospital. Section B of No.1 Native Field Hospital.
1st Brigade. Commanding—Colonel W.H. Meiklejohn, C.B., C.M.G., with the local rank of Brigadier-General. 1st Battalion Royal West Kent Regiment. 24th Punjab Infantry. 31st Punjab Infantry. 45th (Rattray's) Sikhs. Sections A and B of No.1 British Field Hospital. No.38 Native Field Hospital. Sections A and B of No.50 Native Field Hospital. 2nd Brigade. Commanding—Brigadier-General P.D. Jeffreys, C.B. 1st Battalion East Kent Regiment (the Buffs). 35th Sikhs. 38th Dogras. Guides Infantry. Sections C and D of No.1 British Field Hospital. No.37 Native Field Hospital. Sections C and D of No.50 Native Field Hospital. Divisional Troops. 4 Squadrons 11th Bengal Lancers. 1 " 10th " " 2 " Guides Cavalry. 22nd Punjab Infantry. 2 Companies 21st Punjab Infantry. 10th Field Battery. 6 Guns No.1 British Mountain Battery. 6 " No.7 " " " 6 " No.8 Bengal " " No.5 Company Madras Sappers and Miners. No.3 " Bombay " " " Section B of No.13 British Field Hospital. Sections A and B of No.35 Native Field Hospital. Line of Communications. No.34 Native Field Hospital. Section B of No.1 Native Field Hospital.
[This complete division amounted to a total available field strength of 6800 bayonets, 700 lances or sabres, with 24 guns.]
[This complete division had a total available strength of 6,800 soldiers, 700 lances or sabers, and 24 cannons.]
The command of this powerful force was entrusted to Brigadier-General Sir Bindon Blood, K.C.B., who was granted the local rank of Major-General.
The leadership of this powerful force was given to Brigadier-General Sir Bindon Blood, K.C.B., who was
As this officer is the principal character in the tale I have to tell, a digression is necessary to introduce him to the reader. Born of an old Irish family, a clan that has been settled in the west of Ireland for 300 years, and of which he is now the head, Sir Bindon Blood was educated privately, and at the Indian Military College at Addiscombe, and obtained a commission in the Royal Engineers in December, 1860. For the first eleven years he was stationed in England, and it was not until 1871 that he proceeded to India, where he first saw active service in the Jawaki Afridi Expedition (medal with clasp). In 1878 he returned home, but the next year was ordered to the Zulu War. On the conclusion of hostilities, for which he received a second medal and clasp, he again sailed for India and served throughout the Afghan war of 1880, being for some time with the troops at Cabul. In 1882 he accompanied the Army to Egypt, and was with the Highland Brigade, which was the most severely engaged at Tel-el-Kebir. He received the medal and clasp, Khedive's star and the 3rd class of the Medjidie. After the campaign he went home for two years, and in 1885 made another voyage to the East, over which the Russian war-cloud was then hanging. Since then the general has served in India, at first with the Sappers and Miners, with whose reorganisation he was closely associated, and latterly in command of the Agra District. In 1895 he was appointed Chief of the Staff to Sir Robert Low in the Chitral Expedition, and was present at all the actions, including the storming of the Malakand Pass. For his services he received a degree of knighthood of the Military Order of the Bath and the Chitral medal and clasp. He was now marked as a man for high command on the frontier at the first opportunity. That opportunity the great rising of 1897 has presented.
Since this officer is the main character in the story I’m about to share, I need to take a moment to introduce him to you. Sir Bindon Blood, the head of an old Irish family that has been settled in the west of Ireland for 300 years, was educated privately and at the Indian Military College in Addiscombe. He received a commission in the Royal Engineers in December 1860. For the first eleven years, he was stationed in England, and it wasn’t until 1871 that he went to India, where he first saw active duty in the Jawaki Afridi Expedition (medal with clasp). He returned home in 1878, but the following year, he was sent to the Zulu War. After the conflict, for which he earned a second medal and clasp, he sailed back to India and fought throughout the Afghan War of 1880, spending some time with the troops in Cabul. In 1882, he joined the Army in Egypt and was part of the Highland Brigade, which faced the fiercest fighting at Tel-el-Kebir. He received the medal and clasp, the Khedive's star, and the 3rd class of the Medjidie. After the campaign, he returned home for two years, and in 1885, he traveled back to the East during a time when the threat of war with Russia loomed. Since then, he has served in India, initially with the Sappers and Miners, in which he played a key role in their reorganization, and later in charge of the Agra District. In 1895, he was appointed Chief of Staff to Sir Robert Low during the Chitral Expedition, participating in all the battles, including the assault on the Malakand Pass. For his services, he was knighted in the Military Order of the Bath and received the Chitral medal and clasp. He was now recognized as someone destined for high command on the frontier at the first chance. That chance was provided by the major uprising of 1897.
Thirty-seven years of soldering, of war in many lands, of sport of every kind, have steeled alike muscle and nerve. Sir Bindon Blood, himself, till warned by the march of time, a keen polo player, is one of those few officers of high rank in the army, who recognise the advantages to soldiers of that splendid game. He has pursued all kinds of wild animals in varied jungles, has killed many pig with the spear and shot every species of Indian game, including thirty tigers to his own rifle.
Thirty-seven years of soldering, of war in many countries, of every kind of sport, have toughened both muscle and nerves. Sir Bindon Blood, himself, until reminded by the passage of time, is an enthusiastic polo player and one of the few high-ranking officers in the army who see the benefits of that great game for soldiers. He has hunted all sorts of wild animals in different jungles, has speared many pigs, and has shot every type of Indian game, including thirty tigers with his own rifle.
It would not be fitting for me, a subaltern of horse, to offer any criticism, though eulogistic, on the commander under whom I have had the honour to serve in the field. I shall content myself with saying, that the general is one of that type of soldiers and administrators, which the responsibilities and dangers of an Empire produce, a type, which has not been, perhaps, possessed by any nation except the British, since the days when the Senate and the Roman people sent their proconsuls to all parts of the world.
It wouldn't be appropriate for me, a low-ranking officer, to offer any kind of critique, even if it's complimentary, about the commander I have the privilege of serving under in the field. I'll just say that the general is one of those soldiers and leaders that the challenges and risks of an Empire create, a type that, perhaps, hasn't been found in any nation except Britain, since the time when the Senate and the Roman people dispatched their proconsuls all over the world.
Sir Bindon Blood was at Agra, when, on the evening of the 28th of July, he received the telegram from the Adjutant-General in India, appointing him to the command of the Malakand Field Force, and instructing him to proceed at once to assume it. He started immediately, and on the 31st formally took command at Nowshera. At Mardan he halted to make arrangements for the onward march of the troops. Here, at 3 A.M. on the 1st of August, he received a telegram from Army Headquarters informing him, that Chakdara Fort was hard pressed, and directing him to hurry on to Malakand, and attempt its relief at all costs. The great numbers of the enemy, and the shortness of ammunition and supplies from which the garrison were suffering, made the task difficult and the urgency great. Indeed I have been told, that at Simla on the 1st of August it was feared, that Chakdara was doomed, and that sufficient troops to fight their way to its relief could not be concentrated in time. The greatest anxiety prevailed. Sir Bindon Blood replied telegraphically that "knowing the ground" as he did, he "felt serenely confident." He hurried on at once, and, in spite of the disturbed state of the country, reached the Malakand about noon on the 1st of August.
Sir Bindon Blood was in Agra when, on the evening of July 28th, he received a telegram from the Adjutant-General in India, appointing him to lead the Malakand Field Force and instructing him to leave immediately to take command. He left right away, and on the 31st, he officially took charge in Nowshera. In Mardan, he stopped to organize the troops for the next leg of their journey. At 3 A.M. on August 1st, he received a telegram from Army Headquarters saying that Chakdara Fort was under heavy pressure and instructing him to rush to Malakand to try to relieve it at all costs. The large enemy forces and the shortage of ammunition and supplies for the garrison made the mission challenging and urgent. In fact, I’ve been told that on August 1st in Simla, there were serious fears that Chakdara was doomed, and that there wouldn't be enough troops available in time to fight their way to its relief. There was a great deal of concern. Sir Bindon Blood responded via telegram that "knowing the ground" as he did, he "felt serenely confident." He immediately pressed on and, despite the unstable situation in the area, arrived in Malakand around noon on August 1st.
The desperate position of the garrison of Chaldara was fully appreciated by their comrades at the Malakand. As the night of the 31st had been comparatively quiet, Brigadier-General Meiklejohn determined to attempt to force his way to their relief the next day. He accordingly formed a column as follows:—
The urgent situation of the garrison in Chaldara was well understood by their fellow soldiers at Malakand. Since the night of the 31st had been relatively calm, Brigadier-General Meiklejohn decided to try to reach them for support the following day. He organized a column as follows:—
45th Sikhs. 24th Punjaub Infantry. No.5 Company Sappers and Miners. 4 Guns of No.8 Mountain Battery.
45th Sikhs. 24th Punjab Infantry. No. 5 Company Sappers and Miners. 4 Guns of No. 8 Mountain Battery.
At 11 A.M. he sent the cavalry, under Lieutenant-Colonel Adams of the Guides, to make a dash for the Amandara Pass, and if it were unoccupied to seize it. The three squadrons started by the short road to the north camp. As soon as the enemy saw what was going on, they assembled in great numbers to oppose the advance. The ground was most unsuitable for cavalry. Great boulders strewed the surface. Frequent nullahs intersected the plain, and cramped the action of the horsemen. The squadrons soon became hotly engaged. The Guides made several charges. The broken nature of the ground favoured the enemy. Many of them were, however, speared or cut down. In one of these charges Lieutenant Keyes was wounded. While he was attacking one tribesman, another came up from behind, and struck him a heavy blow on the shoulder with a sword. Though these Swatis keep their swords at razor edge, and though the blow was sufficiently severe to render the officer's arm useless for some days, it raised only a thin weal, as if from a cut of a whip. It was a strange and almost an inexplicable escape.
At 11 A.M., he sent the cavalry, led by Lieutenant-Colonel Adams of the Guides, to quickly seize the Amandara Pass if it was empty. The three squadrons took the short route to the northern camp. Once the enemy spotted the movement, they gathered in large numbers to block the advance. The terrain was not suited for cavalry; large boulders covered the ground, and numerous gullies crisscrossed the plain, limiting the horsemen's maneuverability. The squadrons quickly found themselves in a fierce fight. The Guides launched several charges, but the rugged landscape worked to the enemy's advantage. Many were speared or cut down in the skirmish. During one of the charges, Lieutenant Keyes was wounded. While he was attacking one tribesman, another came up from behind and struck him hard on the shoulder with a sword. Despite the Swatis keeping their swords exceptionally sharp and the blow being serious enough to incapacitate the officer's arm for several days, it only left a thin mark, similar to a whip cut. It was a strange and nearly inexplicable escape.
The enemy in increasing numbers pressed upon the cavalry, who began to get seriously involved. The tribesmen displayed the greatest boldness and determination. At length Lieut.-Colonel Adams had to order a retirement. It was none too soon. The tribesmen were already working round the left flank and thus threatening the only line of retreat. The squadrons fell back, covering each other by dismounted fire. The 24th Punjaub Infantry protected their flank as they reached the camp. The cavalry losses were as follows:—
The enemy, growing in numbers, pressed hard against the cavalry, who started to get seriously engaged. The tribesmen showed incredible courage and determination. Finally, Lieut.-Colonel Adams had to order a retreat. It was just in time. The tribesmen were already moving around the left flank and threatening the only escape route. The squadrons fell back, covering each other with gunfire while dismounted. The 24th Punjaub Infantry covered their side as they made their way back to the camp. The cavalry losses were as follows:—
BRITISH OFFICERS. Wounded severely—Captain G.M. Baldwin, the Guides. " slightly—Lieutenant C.V. Keyes, the Guides. NATIVE RANKS. Killed Wounded 11th Bengal Lancers.... 0 3 Horses........ 1 4 Guides Cavalry...... 1 10 Horses........ 3 18 Total casualties—16 men and 26 horses.
BRITISH OFFICERS. Seriously injured—Captain G.M. Baldwin, the Guides. " slightly injured—Lieutenant C.V. Keyes, the Guides. NATIVE RANKS. Killed Wounded 11th Bengal Lancers.... 0 3 Horses........ 1 4 Guides Cavalry...... 1 10 Horses........ 3 18 Total casualties—16 men and 26 horses.
The vigorous resistance which the cavalry had encountered, and the great numbers and confidence that the enemy had displayed, effectually put an end to any idea of relieving Chakdara that day. The tribesmen were much elated by their temporary success, and the garrison, worn and wearied by the incessant strain, both mental and physical, were proportionately cast down. Every one anticipated tremendous fighting on the next day. Make the attempt, they must at all hazards. But there were not wanting those who spoke of "forlorn hopes" and "last chances." Want of sleep and rest had told on all ranks. For a week they had grappled with a savage foe. They were the victors, but they were out of breath.
The strong resistance faced by the cavalry, along with the enemy's large numbers and confidence, completely dashed any hopes of relieving Chakdara that day. The tribesmen felt a surge of pride from their temporary victory, while the garrison, exhausted both mentally and physically from the constant pressure, felt equally defeated. Everyone expected fierce fighting the next day. They had to make the attempt, no matter the risks. However, there were those who mentioned "lost causes" and "final chances." Lack of sleep and rest had taken a toll on everyone. For a week, they had battled a fierce enemy. They were the winners, but they were out of breath.
It was at this moment, that Sir Bindon Blood arrived and assumed the command. He found General Meiklejohn busily engaged in organising a force of all arms, which was to move to the relief of Chakdara on the following day. As it was dangerous to denude the Malakand position of troops, this force could not exceed 1000 rifles, the available cavalry and four guns. Of these arrangements Sir Bindon Blood approved. He relieved Brigadier-General Meiklejohn of the charge of the Malakand position, and gave him the command of the relieving column. Colonel Reid was then placed in command of Malakand, and instructed to strengthen the pickets at Castle Rock, as far as possible, and to be ready with a force taken from them, to clear the high ground on the right of the Graded road. The relieving column was composed as follows:—
It was at this moment that Sir Bindon Blood arrived and took command. He found General Meiklejohn busy organizing a force of all arms that was set to move to relieve Chakdara the next day. Since it was risky to strip the Malakand position of troops, this force could not exceed 1,000 rifles, the available cavalry, and four guns. Sir Bindon Blood approved of these arrangements. He relieved Brigadier-General Meiklejohn of his duties at the Malakand position and assigned him to lead the relieving column. Colonel Reid was then put in charge of Malakand and instructed to strengthen the pickets at Castle Rock as much as possible and to be ready with a force taken from them to clear the high ground on the right of the Graded road. The relieving column was composed as follows:—
400 Rifles 24th Punjaub Infantry. 400 " 45th Sikhs. 200 " Guides Infantry. 2 Squadrons 11th Bengal Lancers (under Lieut.-Col. R.B. Adams.) 2 " Guides Cavalry " " " 4 Guns No.8 Mountain Battery. 50 Sappers of No.5 Company. Hospital details.
400 Rifles 24th Punjab Infantry. 400 " 45th Sikhs. 200 " Guides Infantry. 2 Squadrons 11th Bengal Lancers (under Lieut.-Col. R.B. Adams.) 2 " Guides Cavalry " " " 4 Guns No.8 Mountain Battery. 50 Sappers of No.5 Company. Hospital details.
Sir Bindon Blood ordered General Meiklejohn to assemble this force before dark near the centre of the camp at a grove of trees called "Gretna Green," to bivouac there for the night, and to be ready to start with the first light of morning. During the afternoon the enemy, encouraged by their success with the cavalry in the morning, advanced boldly to the pickets and the firing was continuous. So heavy indeed did it become between eleven and twelve o'clock at night, that the force at "Gretna Green" got under arms. But towards morning the tribesmen retired.
Sir Bindon Blood instructed General Meiklejohn to gather this force before dark near the center of the camp at a grove of trees called "Gretna Green," to set up camp there for the night, and to be ready to move with the first light of morning. In the afternoon, the enemy, boosted by their earlier success with the cavalry, boldly approached the pickets and the firing was constant. It became so intense between eleven and midnight that the force at "Gretna Green" was put on alert. However, by morning, the tribesmen pulled back.
The reader may, perhaps, have in his mind the description of the Malakand as a great cup with jagged clefts in the rim. Much of this rim was still held by the enemy. It was necessary for any force trying to get out of the cup, to fight their way along the narrow roads through the clefts, which were commanded by the heights on either side. For a considerable distance it was impossible to deploy. Therein lay the difficulty of the operation, which the General had now to perform. The relieving column was exposed to the danger of being stopped, just as Colonel McRae had stopped the first attack of the tribesmen along the Buddhist road. On the 1st of August the cavalry had avoided these difficulties by going down the road to the North camp, and making a considerable detour. But they thus became involved in bad ground and had to retire. The "Graded" road, if any, was the road by which Chakdara was to be relieved. Looking at the tangled, rugged nature of the country, it seems extraordinary to an untrained eye, that among so many peaks and points, one should be of more importance than another. Yet it is so. On the high ground, in front of the position that Colonel McRae and the 45th Sikhs had held so well, was a prominent spur. This was the key which would unlock the gate and set free the troops, who were cramped up within. Every one realised afterwards how obvious this was and wondered they had not thought of it before. Sir Bindon Blood selected the point as the object of his first attack, and it was against this that he directed Colonel Goldney with a force of about 300 men to move, as soon as he should give the signal to advance.
The reader might picture the Malakand as a large cup with jagged notches around the edge. Much of this edge was still held by the enemy. For any force trying to escape the cup, they had to fight their way along the narrow roads through the notches, which were controlled by the high ground on both sides. For quite a stretch, it was impossible to spread out. This was the challenge the General now had to face. The relief column was at risk of being blocked, just like Colonel McRae had blocked the first attack from the tribesmen along the Buddhist road. On August 1st, the cavalry avoided these challenges by taking the road to the North camp, but they ended up making a major detour. This led them into difficult terrain, forcing them to pull back. The "Graded" road, if there was one, was supposed to be the route for relieving Chakdara. Looking at the complex, rugged landscape, it seems surprising to an untrained eye that among so many peaks, one would be more crucial than the others. But it is true. On the high ground in front of the position that Colonel McRae and the 45th Sikhs had defended so effectively was a prominent ridge. This was the key that would unlock the gate and free the troops who were cramped inside. Everyone realized later how obvious this was and wondered why they hadn't thought of it sooner. Sir Bindon Blood chose this point as the target for his first attack, and he directed Colonel Goldney with about 300 men to move there as soon as he gave the signal to advance.
At half-past four in the morning of the 2nd of August he proceeded to "Gretna Green" and found the relieving column fallen in, and ready to march at daybreak. All expected a severe action. Oppressed with fatigue and sleeplessness, there were many who doubted that it would be successful. But though tired, they were determined, and braced themselves for a desperate struggle. The General-in-chief was, as he had said, confident and serene. He summoned the different commanding officers, explained his plans, and shook hands all round. It was a moment of stern and high resolve. Slowly the first faint light of dawn grew in the eastern sky. The brightness of the stars began to pale. Behind the mountains was the promise of the sun. Then the word was given to advance. Immediately the relieving column set off, four deep, down the "Graded" road. Colonel Goldney simultaneously advanced to the attack of the spur, which now bears his name, with 250 men of the 35th Sikhs and 50 of the 38th Dogras. He moved silently towards the stone shelters, that the tribesmen had erected on the crest. He got to within a hundred yards unperceived. The enemy, surprised, opened an irregular and ineffective fire. The Sikhs shouted and dashed forward. The ridge was captured without loss of any kind. The enemy fled in disorder, leaving seven dead and one prisoner on the ground.
At 4:30 in the morning on August 2nd, he headed to "Gretna Green" and found the support column ready to move out at daybreak. Everyone expected a tough fight. Many, worn out from fatigue and lack of sleep, doubted it would be successful. But even though they were tired, they were determined and prepared for a fierce battle. The General-in-chief remained confident and calm, as he had promised. He called the various commanding officers together, laid out his plans, and shook hands with everyone. It was a moment of strong resolve. Slowly, the first hints of dawn started to light up the eastern sky. The brightness of the stars began to fade. Behind the mountains, the sun was on the way. Then the order to advance was given. The support column immediately set off, four men deep, down the "Graded" road. Colonel Goldney also moved to attack the spur that now bears his name, leading 250 men from the 35th Sikhs and 50 from the 38th Dogras. He approached the stone shelters the tribesmen had built on the ridge without being noticed. He got within a hundred yards without being seen. The enemy, caught off guard, fired back in a disorganized and ineffective manner. The Sikhs shouted and charged forward. The ridge was taken with no losses. The enemy fled in chaos, leaving seven dead and one prisoner behind.
Then the full significance of the movement was apparent alike to friend and foe. The point now gained, commanded the whole of the "Graded" road, right down to its junction with the road to the North camp. The relieving column, moving down the road, were enabled to deploy without loss or delay. The door was open. The enemy, utterly surprised and dumfoundered by this manoeuvre, were seen running to and fro in the greatest confusion: in the graphic words of Sir Bindon Blood's despatch, "like ants in a disturbed ant-hill." At length they seemed to realise the situation, and, descending from the high ground, took up a position near Bedford Hill in General Meiklejohn's front, and opened a heavy fire at close range. But the troops were now deployed and able to bring their numbers to bear. Without wasting time in firing, they advanced with the bayonet. The leading company of the Guides stormed the hill in their front with a loss of two killed and six wounded. The rest of the troops charged with even less loss. The enemy, thoroughly panic-stricken, began to fly, literally by thousands, along the heights to the right. They left seventy dead behind them. The troops, maddened by the remembrance of their fatigues and sufferings, and inspired by the impulse of victory, pursued them with a merciless vigour.
Then the full significance of the movement was clear to both friends and enemies. The position now secured controlled the entire "Graded" road, all the way to its junction with the road leading to the North camp. The relieving column, moving down the road, could spread out without loss or delay. The way was open. The enemy, completely taken by surprise and stunned by this maneuver, was seen running back and forth in utter chaos; in the vivid words of Sir Bindon Blood's dispatch, "like ants in a disturbed ant-hill." Eventually, they seemed to grasp the situation and, coming down from the high ground, took a position near Bedford Hill in front of General Meiklejohn and opened heavy fire at close range. But the troops were now deployed and could effectively use their numbers. Without spending time firing, they advanced with bayonets. The leading company of the Guides charged up the hill ahead with the loss of two killed and six wounded. The rest of the troops charged with even fewer casualties. The enemy, thoroughly panic-stricken, began to flee, literally by the thousands, up the heights to the right. They left seventy dead behind them. The troops, driven by the memory of their exhaustion and suffering, and fueled by the rush of victory, pursued them with relentless energy.
Sir Bindon Blood had with his staff ascended the Castle Rock, to superintend the operations generally. From this position the whole field was visible. On every side, and from every rock, the white figures of the enemy could be seen in full flight. The way was open. The passage was forced. Chakdara was saved. A great and brilliant success had been obtained. A thrill of exultation convulsed every one. In that moment the general, who watched the triumphant issue of his plans, must have experienced as fine an emotion as is given to man on earth. In that moment, we may imagine that the weary years of routine, the long ascent of the lower grades of the service, the frequent subordination to incompetence, the fatigues and dangers of five campaigns, received their compensation. Perhaps, such is the contrariness of circumstances, there was no time for the enjoyment of these reflections. The victory had been gained. It remained to profit by it. The enemy would be compelled to retire across the plain. There at last was the chance of the cavalry. The four squadrons were hurried to the scene.
Sir Bindon Blood and his team had climbed Castle Rock to oversee the operations. From this spot, the entire battlefield was visible. All around, the white figures of the enemy were seen fleeing in every direction. The way was clear. The passage was forced. Chakdara was saved. A significant and brilliant success had been achieved. A wave of excitement swept through everyone. In that moment, the general, who observed the successful outcome of his plans, must have felt one of the greatest emotions a person can experience on earth. We can imagine that, in this moment, the exhausting years of routine, the gradual rise through the ranks, the constant subordination to incompetence, and the struggles and risks of five campaigns were finally worthwhile. However, perhaps, due to the nature of circumstances, there was no time to savor these thoughts. The victory had been secured. Now it was time to take advantage of it. The enemy would have to retreat across the plain. Finally, there was an opportunity for the cavalry. The four squadrons were rushed to the scene.
The 11th Bengal Lancers, forming line across the plain, began a merciless pursuit up the valley. The Guides pushed on to seize the Amandara Pass and relieve Chakdara. All among the rice fields and the rocks, the strong horsemen hunted the flying enemy. No quarter was asked or given, and every tribesman caught, was speared or cut down at once. Their bodies lay thickly strewn about the fields, spotting with black and green patches, the bright green of the rice crop. It was a terrible lesson, and one which the inhabitants of Swat and Bajaur will never forget. Since then their terror of Lancers has been extraordinary. A few sowars have frequently been sufficient to drive a hundred of these valiant savages in disorder to the hills, or prevent them descending into the plain for hours.
The 11th Bengal Lancers formed a line across the plain and launched a relentless chase up the valley. The Guides pressed on to take the Amandara Pass and relieve Chakdara. Among the rice fields and rocks, the skilled horsemen hunted down the fleeing enemy. No mercy was asked for or given, and every tribesman who was caught was either speared or cut down instantly. Their bodies were scattered across the fields, mingling with the bright green of the rice crop. It was a brutal lesson, one that the people of Swat and Bajaur will never forget. Since then, their fear of the Lancers has been intense. A few sowars have often been enough to scatter a hundred of these brave warriors in chaos to the hills, or to keep them from descending into the plain for hours.
Meanwhile the infantry had been advancing swiftly. The 45th Sikhs stormed the fortified village of Batkhela near the Amandara Pass, which the enemy held desperately. Lieut.-Colonel McRae, who had been relieved from the command of the regiment by the arrival of Colonel Sawyer, was the first man to enter the village. Eighty of the enemy were bayoneted in Batkheka alone. It was a terrible reckoning.
Meanwhile, the infantry was moving quickly. The 45th Sikhs charged the fortified village of Batkhela near the Amandara Pass, which the enemy fiercely defended. Lieutenant Colonel McRae, who had been replaced in command by Colonel Sawyer’s arrival, was the first person to enter the village. Eighty enemy soldiers were bayoneted in Batkhela alone. It was a brutal reckoning.
I am anxious to finish with this scene of carnage. The spectator, who may gaze unmoved on the bloodshed of the battle, must avert his eyes from the horrors of the pursuit, unless, indeed, joining in it himself, he flings all scruples to the winds, and, carried away by the impetus of the moment, indulges to the full those deep-seated instincts of savagery, over which civilisation has but cast a veil of doubtful thickness.
I can't wait to be done with this scene of violence. The onlooker, who might watch the chaos of the battle without flinching, has to look away from the horrors of the chase, unless, of course, he decides to join in and throws all his moral concerns aside, swept up by the excitement of the moment, letting loose those primal urges that civilization has only thinly disguised.
The casualties in the relief of Chakdara were as follows:—
The casualties in the relief of Chakdara were as follows:—
11th Bengal Lancers—killed and died from wounds, 3; wounded,3. Killed. Wounded. Guides Infantry....... 2 7 35th Sikhs......... 2 3 45th Sikhs......... 0 7 24th Punjaub Infantry..... 0 5 No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery... 0 1 Total Casualties—33
11th Bengal Lancers—killed and died from wounds, 3; wounded, 3. Killed. Wounded. Guides Infantry....... 2 7 35th Sikhs......... 2 3 45th Sikhs......... 0 7 24th Punjab Infantry..... 0 5 No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery... 0 1 Total Casualties—33
The news of the relief of Chakdara was received with feelings of profound thankfulness throughout India. And in England, in the House of Commons, when the Secretary of State read out the telegram, there were few among the members who did not join in the cheers. Nor need we pay much attention to those few.
The news of the relief of Chakdara was met with deep gratitude across India. In England, when the Secretary of State read the telegram in the House of Commons, most members joined in the cheers. We don't need to focus on the few who didn't.
CHAPTER VI: THE DEFENCE OF CHAKDARA
... That tower of strength Which stood four-square to all the winds that blew. TENNYSON.
... That tower of strength Which stood firmly against all the winds that blew. TENNYSON.
The episode with which this chapter is concerned is one that has often occurred on the out-post line of civilisation, and which is peculiarly frequent in the history of a people whose widespread Empire is fringed with savage tribes. A small band of soldiers or settlers, armed with the resources of science, and strengthened by the cohesion of mutual trust, are assailed in some isolated post, by thousands of warlike and merciless enemies. Usually the courage and equipment of the garrison enable them to hold out until a relieving force arrives, as at Rorke's Drift, Fort Chitral, Chakdara or Gulistan. But sometimes the defenders are overwhelmed, and, as at Saraghari or Khartoum, none are left to tell the tale. There is something strangely terrible in the spectacle of men, who fight—not for political or patriotic reasons, not for the sake of duty or glory—but for dear life itself; not because they want to, but because they have to. They hold the dykes of social progress against a rising deluge of barbarism, which threatens every moment to overflow the banks and drown them all. The situation is one which will make a coward valorous, and affords to brave men opportunities for the most sublime forms of heroism and devotion.
The episode discussed in this chapter is one that frequently happens on the fringes of civilization, especially in the history of a people whose vast Empire borders savage tribes. A small group of soldiers or settlers, equipped with scientific knowledge and bound by mutual trust, is attacked at an isolated outpost by thousands of fierce and relentless enemies. Typically, the bravery and resources of the garrison allow them to hold out until reinforcements arrive, like at Rorke's Drift, Fort Chitral, Chakdara, or Gulistan. However, sometimes the defenders are overwhelmed, and, as in the cases of Saraghari or Khartoum, no one survives to recount the events. There’s something unsettlingly tragic about the sight of men fighting—not for political or patriotic reasons, not out of duty or for glory—but for their very lives; not because they want to, but because they have to. They stand as a barrier against a rising tide of barbarism that threatens to overflow and engulf them. This scenario can turn a coward into a hero and offers brave individuals chances to display incredible acts of heroism and devotion.
Chakdara holds the passage of the Swat River—a rapid, broad, and at most seasons of the year an unfordable torrent. It is built on a rocky knoll that rises abruptly from the plain about a hundred yards from the mountains. Sketches and photographs usually show only the knoll and buildings on it, and any one looking at them will be struck by the picturesque and impregnable aspect of the little fort, without observing that its proportions are dwarfed, and its defences commanded, by the frowning cliffs, under which it stands. In its construction the principles of defilade have been completely ignored. Standing on the mountain ridge, occupied by the signal tower, it is possible to look or fire right into the fort. Every open space is commanded. Every parapet is exposed. Against an enemy unprovided with artillery, however, it could be held indefinitely; but the fact that all interior communications are open to fire, makes its defence painful to the garrison, and might, by gradually weakening their numbers, lead to its capture.
Chakdara is located at the crossing of the Swat River—a fast, wide, and usually an unfordable torrent for most of the year. It’s built on a rocky hill that rises sharply from the flat land about a hundred yards from the mountains. Sketches and photos typically show just the hill and the buildings on it, and anyone looking at them will be struck by the picturesque yet formidable appearance of the small fort, without realizing that its size is overshadowed, and its defenses are dominated, by the looming cliffs beneath it. The design completely ignores the principles of defilade. From the mountain ridge, where the signal tower is situated, it's possible to look into or fire directly at the fort. Every open space is under threat. Every parapet is vulnerable. Against an enemy without artillery, though, it could be held indefinitely; however, the fact that all internal communications are exposed to fire makes defense tough for the garrison and could gradually deplete their numbers, leading to the fort’s capture.
The narrow, swinging, wire bridge across the Swat is nearly 500 yards long. At the southern end it is closed by a massive iron door, loopholed for musketry, and flanked by two stone towers, in one of which a Maxim gun is mounted. On the further side is the fort itself, which consists of the fortified knoll, a strong stone horn-work, an enclosure for horses, protected by a loopholed wall and much tangled barbed wire, and the signal tower, a detached post 200 yards up the cliff.
The narrow, swinging wire bridge over the Swat is almost 500 yards long. At the southern end, it's sealed off by a heavy iron door with openings for gunfire and is flanked by two stone towers, one of which has a Maxim gun installed. On the other side is the fort, which includes a fortified hill, a strong stone structure, a corral for horses protected by a wall with loopholes and a lot of tangled barbed wire, plus a signal tower, a separate post 200 yards up the cliff.
The garrison of the place consisted at the time of the outbreak of twenty sowars of the 11th Bengal Lancers and two strong companies of the 45th Sikhs, in all about 200 men, under the command of Lieutenant H.B. Rattray. [The actual strength was as follows: 11th Bengal Lancers, 20 sabres; 45th Sikhs, 180 rifles; 2 British telegraphists; 1 Hospital Havildar; 1 Provost Naick (24th Punjaub Infantry); 1 Jemadar (Dir Levies). British officers—45th Sikhs, Lieutenants Rattray and Wheatley; Surgeon-Captain V. Hugo; Political Agent, Lieutenant Minchin.] As the rumours of an impending rising grew stronger and stronger, and the end of July approached, this officer practised his men in taking stations in the event of an alarm, and made such preparations as he thought necessary for eventualities. On the 23rd he received an official warning from the D.A.A.G. [Deputy-Assistant-Adjutant-General. Surely this astounding title, with that of the Deputy-Assistant-Quarter-Master-General, might be replaced with advantage by the more sensible and appropriate terms "Brigade Adjutant" and "Brigade Quartermaster"!], Major Herbert, that a tribal rising was "possible but not probable." Every precaution was henceforth taken in the fort. On the 26th, a Sepoy, who was out sketching, hurried in with the news that a large body of tribesmen were advancing down the valley, and that he himself had been robbed of his compass, his field-glasses and some money.
The garrison at the time of the outbreak included twenty sowars from the 11th Bengal Lancers and two strong companies from the 45th Sikhs, totaling about 200 men, under the command of Lieutenant H.B. Rattray. [The actual strength was as follows: 11th Bengal Lancers, 20 sabres; 45th Sikhs, 180 rifles; 2 British telegraphists; 1 Hospital Havildar; 1 Provost Naick (24th Punjab Infantry); 1 Jemadar (Dir Levies). British officers—45th Sikhs, Lieutenants Rattray and Wheatley; Surgeon-Captain V. Hugo; Political Agent, Lieutenant Minchin.] As rumors of an impending uprising intensified and the end of July approached, this officer trained his men to take positions in case of an alarm and made preparations he felt were necessary for various situations. On the 23rd, he received an official warning from the D.A.A.G. [Deputy-Assistant-Adjutant-General. Surely this confusing title, along with that of the Deputy-Assistant-Quarter-Master-General, could be better replaced with the more straightforward and appropriate terms "Brigade Adjutant" and "Brigade Quartermaster"!], Major Herbert, that a tribal uprising was "possible but not probable." From then on, every precaution was taken in the fort. On the 26th, a Sepoy who was out sketching rushed in with the news that a large group of tribesmen was advancing down the valley and that he had been robbed of his compass, field-glasses, and some money.
But, in spite of the disturbed and threatening situation, the British officers of the Malakand garrison, though they took all military precautions for the defence of their posts, did not abandon their practice of riding freely about the valley, armed only with revolvers. Nor did they cease from their amusements. On the evening of the 26th, Lieutenant Rattray went over to Khar as usual to play polo. Just as the game was ended, he received a letter, brought in haste by two sowars, from Lieutenant Wheatley, the other subaltern at Chakdara, warning him that a great number of Pathans with flags were advancing on the fort. He at once galloped back at full speed, passing close to one large gathering of tribesmen, who for some reason of their own took no notice of him, and so reached the fort in safety, and just in time. Formidable masses of men were then closing in on it. He telegraphed to the staff officer at the Malakand reporting the impending attack. Immediately afterwards the wire was cut by the enemy and the little garrison got under arms.
But despite the tense and threatening situation, the British officers at the Malakand garrison, while taking all necessary military precautions to defend their posts, didn’t give up their routine of riding around the valley with only revolvers for protection. They also continued to enjoy their leisure activities. On the evening of the 26th, Lieutenant Rattray went to Khar as usual to play polo. Just as the game ended, he received a letter, quickly delivered by two sowars, from Lieutenant Wheatley, the other subaltern at Chakdara, warning him that a large number of Pathans with flags were approaching the fort. He immediately rode back at full speed, passing closely by a large gathering of tribesmen, who for some reason ignored him, and safely made it back to the fort just in time. Large groups of men were then surrounding it. He sent a telegram to the staff officer at the Malakand reporting the upcoming attack. Shortly after that, the enemy cut the wire, and the small garrison prepared for action.
A havildar of the Khan of Dir's Levies had promised the political agent to give warning of any actual assault, by lighting a fire on the opposite hills. At 10.15 a solitary flame shot up. It was the signal. The alarm was sounded. The garrison went to their posts. For a space there was silence, and then out of the darkness began a fusillade, which did not stop until the 2nd of August. Immediately the figures of the tribesmen, as they advanced to the attack on the western face of the fort, became visible. The defenders opened fire with effect. The enemy pressed on vigorously. Their losses were severe. At length they retreated repulsed.
A havildar from the Khan of Dir's Levies had promised the political agent to signal any real attack by lighting a fire on the distant hills. At 10:15, a single flame rose up. It was the signal. The alarm rang out. The garrison took their positions. For a while, there was silence, and then from the darkness, a barrage of gunfire erupted, which continued until August 2nd. Soon, the figures of the tribesmen, as they moved to assault the western side of the fort, became visible. The defenders opened fire effectively. The enemy pushed forward with determination. Their losses were heavy. Eventually, they fell back, defeated.
A second attack was immediately delivered against the north-east corner and again beaten off by the garrison. At 4 A.M. a third assault was made upon the cavalry enclosure. The tribesmen, carrying scaling ladders, advanced with great determination. They were received with a deadly fire. They then drew off, and the first night of the siege was terminated by desultory firing. The garrison remained at their posts all night, and when it became day the enemy were seen to have retired, to the hills to the north-west, whence they maintained a ceaseless fire. Although the defenders were protected by their stone walls, many had strange escapes from the bullets, which fell incessantly into the interior.
A second attack was launched right away on the northeast corner, but the garrison fended it off again. At 4 A.M., a third assault targeted the cavalry enclosure. The tribesmen, carrying scaling ladders, approached with strong determination. They were met with deadly gunfire. They then pulled back, and the first night of the siege ended with sporadic shooting. The garrison stayed at their posts all night, and when day broke, the enemy was spotted retreating to the hills in the northwest, where they continued to fire relentlessly. Even though the defenders were shielded by their stone walls, many had miraculous escapes from the bullets that rained down into the area continuously.
Meanwhile, in spite of the vigorous attack that was being made on the Malakand, it had been decided to send some assistance to the little band at Chakdara. Captain Wright and forty sowars of the 11th Bengal Lancers with Captain Baker of the 2nd Bombay Grenadiers and transport officer at the Malakand, started at dawn on the 27th, by the road from the north camp. Before they had gone very far they came under the fire of the enemy on the hills. These did not dare to venture into the plain, but availed themselves of the broken nature of the country. As the squadron reached the road leading to the polo ground, Captain Wright received information that the enemy were collected on the plain and immediately the pace was quickened in the hopes of a charge being possible. But the tribesmen ran to the hills at the sight of the Lancers, and maintained a constant, though luckily, an ill-aimed fire. At length the village of Batkhela was reached, and beyond it the Amandara Pass came in sight. This is a gap in a long spur, which runs from the southern side of the valley to the rapid river in the middle. As the river was then in full flood and unfordable, the only road to Chakdara lay over or through the spur. But the pass was held by the enemy.
Meanwhile, despite the intense assault on the Malakand, it was decided to send some support to the small group at Chakdara. Captain Wright and forty sowars from the 11th Bengal Lancers, along with Captain Baker from the 2nd Bombay Grenadiers and transport officer at the Malakand, set out at dawn on the 27th, taking the road from the north camp. They hadn't gone far before they came under enemy fire from the hills. The enemies didn't risk entering the plain but took advantage of the rugged terrain. As the squadron reached the road leading to the polo ground, Captain Wright learned that the enemy was gathered on the plain, so they quickened their pace, hoping for a chance to charge. However, the tribesmen retreated to the hills at the sight of the Lancers and kept up a steady, though fortunately inaccurate, fire. Eventually, they reached the village of Batkhela, and beyond that, the Amandara Pass came into view. This pass is a gap in a long spur that runs from the southern side of the valley to the swift river in the middle. Since the river was in full flood and couldn't be crossed, the only route to Chakdara was over or through the spur, but the pass was occupied by the enemy.
Captain Wright had by this time realised, what probably no one at the Malakand then knew, that the enemy's numbers were enormous. The whole way from Malakand to Amandara—every ridge and hill was crowned with their banners. Wherever the ground protected them from the horsemen they gathered thickly. Cemeteries [Cemeteries are frequent and prominent features of Frontier landscapes. Some of them are of great extent: all of remarkable sanctity.], nullahs and villages swarmed with men. Their figures could be seen in all directions. Far beyond the Amandara Pass bands of tribesmen, of varying strengths, could be observed hurrying with their standards to the attack. But these formidable signs, far from deterring the cavalry soldier, only added, by displaying how great was the need of Chakdara, to his determination to force his way through at all costs.
Captain Wright had by this time realized what probably no one at Malakand knew: that the enemy's numbers were enormous. All the way from Malakand to Amandara—every ridge and hill was lined with their banners. Wherever the ground offered protection from horsemen, they gathered in large numbers. Cemeteries, nullahs, and villages were full of men. Their figures could be seen in every direction. Far beyond the Amandara Pass, groups of tribesmen, with varying strengths, could be spotted rushing to the attack. But these intimidating signs, rather than scaring off the cavalry soldier, only strengthened his resolve to push through to Chakdara at all costs.
Under a dropping fire from the cemetery on the right of the road, a brief consultation was held. The Amandara defile was occupied on both sides by the enemy. With the loss of perhaps a dozen men the squadron might gallop through. But this meant leaving all who fell, to perish miserably, by torture and mutilation. To attempt to pick up the wounded, would lead to the annihilation of the squadron. Any alternative was preferable, though if there were no other way, the dash would have to be made, and the wounded left. A Sowar now said there was a path round the rock by the bank of the river. Captain Wright determined to take it.
Under heavy fire from the cemetery on the right side of the road, a quick meeting was held. The Amandara pass was occupied by the enemy on both sides. With maybe a dozen men lost, the squadron could make a run for it. But that would mean leaving anyone who fell behind to suffer a terrible fate through torture and mutilation. Trying to rescue the wounded would lead to the squadron's destruction. Any other option was better, but if there was no other way, they would have to push through and leave the wounded behind. One of the Sowars mentioned a path around the rock by the riverbank. Captain Wright decided to take it.
The path was bad. After about half the spur had been passed, it ended abruptly in a steep white rock. It was, in fact, a path leading to a point where the natives were in the habit of floating across the river upon "mussucks" (inflated skins). To go back now was to fail. Without hesitation, the horsemen turned to the right up the hill and among the rocks, trusting to get through somehow. After passing over ground which would be difficult to move across on foot, they saw a gorge to their left which appeared as if it would lead to the open plain, on the other side of the ridge. Down this gorge forty horses huddled together, with no room to pick their way, were scrambling and jumping from rock to rock, apparently as conscious as their riders that their lives depended on their cleverness—when, suddenly, the enemy appeared.
The path was rough. After they got past about half of the spur, it ended suddenly at a steep white rock. It was actually a route that led to a spot where the locals used to float across the river on "mussucks" (inflated hides). Turning back now would mean failure. Without hesitation, the horsemen veered right up the hill and among the rocks, hoping to get through somehow. After covering ground that would have been tough to navigate on foot, they spotted a gorge to their left that looked like it might lead to the open plain on the other side of the ridge. Down this gorge, forty horses were huddled together, with no room to maneuver, scrambling and jumping from rock to rock, clearly aware that their lives depended on their agility—when suddenly, the enemy appeared.
As soon as the tribesmen, who were holding the pass, saw the squadron trot off to their right towards the river, they realised that they intended to make a desperate effort to get through to Chakdara. They knew what the ground was like, and confident they would kill them all, if they could get there soon enough, ran swiftly along the spur. It was a race. The leading tribesmen arrived in time to fire on the cavalry, while they were in the gorge. So close were they, that the officers used their revolvers. But the Pathans were out of breath and shot badly. Several horses were hit, including Captain Wright's, but though the large thigh bone was penetrated, the gallant beast held on, and carried his rider to Chakdara safely.
As soon as the tribesmen who were guarding the pass saw the squadron move off to their right toward the river, they realized the cavalry was making a desperate attempt to reach Chakdara. They were familiar with the terrain and, confident they could kill them all if they got there quickly enough, rushed along the ridge. It turned into a race. The lead tribesmen arrived just in time to shoot at the cavalry while they were in the gorge. They were so close that the officers had to use their revolvers. However, the Pathans were out of breath and their aim was poor. Several horses were hit, including Captain Wright's, but even though the large thigh bone was broken, the brave horse pressed on and safely carried its rider to Chakdara.
By the extraordinary activity of the horses the rocks were cleared before the enemy could collect in any strength. But, to the dismay of all, the gorge was found to lead, not to the plain, but to a branch of the river. A broad, swift channel of water of unknown depth confronted the cavalry. To go back was now, however, out of the question. They plunged in. The 11th Bengal Lancers are perhaps better mounted than any native cavalry regiment in India. Their strong horses just held their own against the current. Several were nearly swept away. Captain Wright was the last to cross. All this time the enemy were firing and approaching. At length the passage was made and the squadron collected on an island of flooded rice fields, in which the horses sank up to their hocks. Beyond this ran another arm of the river about fifty yards wide, and apparently almost as deep as the first. The bullets of the enemy made "watery flashes" on all sides. After passing this second torrent the squadron found themselves again on the same bank of the river as the enemy. They were in swampy ground. Captain Wright dismounted his men and returned the fire. Then he turned back himself, and riding into the stream again, rescued the hospital assistant, whose pony, smaller than the other horses, was being carried off its legs by the force of the water. After this the march was resumed. The squadron kept in the heavy ground, struggling along painfully. The enemy, running along the edge of the rice fields, maintained a continual fire, kneeling down to take good aim. A sowar threw up his hands and fell, shot through the back. Several more horses were hit. Then another man reeled in his saddle and collapsed on the ground. A halt was made. Dismounted fire was opened upon the enemy. The wounded were picked up, and by slow degrees Chakdara was approached, when the Bridgehead Maxim gun compelled the tribesmen to draw off. [For the particulars of this affair I am indebted to Captain Baker, 2nd Bombay Grenadiers, who shared its perils.]
By the amazing effort of the horses, the rocks were cleared before the enemy could gather their forces. But, much to everyone's surprise, it turned out that the gorge didn’t lead to the plain but to a branch of the river. A wide, fast-flowing channel of water with an unknown depth faced the cavalry. Going back was now not an option. They charged in. The 11th Bengal Lancers are probably better mounted than any native cavalry unit in India. Their strong horses just managed to keep up against the current. Several nearly got swept away. Captain Wright was the last to cross. All this time, the enemy was firing and closing in. Eventually, they made it across and gathered on a flooded rice field island, where the horses sank up to their hocks. Beyond that was another arm of the river about fifty yards wide and seemingly almost as deep as the first. Enemy bullets created "watery flashes" all around. After crossing this second torrent, the squadron found themselves back on the same riverbank as the enemy, but in swampy ground. Captain Wright dismounted his men and returned fire. Then he turned back, riding into the stream again to rescue the hospital assistant, whose pony, smaller than the other horses, was being swept off its legs by the force of the water. After this, the march continued. The squadron stuck to the heavy ground, struggling along painfully. The enemy, running along the edge of the rice fields, kept up a constant fire, kneeling down to take aim. A sowar raised his hands and fell, shot in the back. Several more horses were hit. Then another man swayed in his saddle and collapsed on the ground. They stopped. Dismounted fire was opened against the enemy. The wounded were picked up, and gradually they approached Chakdara, where the Bridgehead Maxim gun forced the tribesmen to pull back. [I owe the details of this event to Captain Baker, 2nd Bombay Grenadiers, who experienced its dangers.]
Thus the garrison of the fort received a needed reinforcement. I have given a somewhat long description of this gallant ride, because it shows that there are few obstacles that can stop brave men and good horses. Captain Wright now assumed command of Chakdara, but the direction of the defense he still confided to Lieutenant Rattray, as fighting behind walls is a phase of warfare with which the cavalry soldier is little acquainted.
Thus, the fort’s garrison got a much-needed reinforcement. I’ve given a somewhat lengthy description of this brave ride because it shows that there are few obstacles that can stop courageous men and good horses. Captain Wright now took command of Chakdara, but he still entrusted the defense strategy to Lieutenant Rattray, as fighting behind walls is an aspect of warfare that cavalry soldiers aren’t very familiar with.
At 11.30, in the heat of the day the tribesmen attacked again. They surrounded the north and east sides of the fort, and made strenuous efforts to get in. They suffered heavy losses from the musketry of the defence, and their dead lay scattered thickly on the approaches. Nor were they removed till nightfall. Many Ghazis, mad with fanaticism, pressed on carrying standards, heedless of the fire, until they fell riddled with bullets under the very walls.
At 11:30, during the heat of the day, the tribesmen launched another attack. They surrounded the north and east sides of the fort and made strong efforts to break in. They suffered heavy casualties from the gunfire of the defenders, and their bodies were scattered thickly along the approaches. They weren't taken away until nightfall. Many Ghazis, driven by fanaticism, kept pushing forward carrying banners, ignoring the gunfire, until they fell, riddled with bullets, right at the walls.
To communicate with the Malakand was now almost impossible. To heliograph, it was necessary that the operator should be exposed to a terrible fire. In the evening the signal tower was surrounded by men in stone sungars, who kept up an incessant fusillade, and made all exposure, even for an instant, perilous.
To communicate with the Malakand was now nearly impossible. To use the heliograph, the operator had to be exposed to intense gunfire. In the evening, the signal tower was surrounded by men in stone fortifications, who maintained a constant barrage, making any exposure, even for a moment, extremely dangerous.
At midday, after the repulse of the main attack, the guard of the signal tower was reinforced by six men, and food and water were also sent up. This difficult operation was protected by the fire of both the Maxims, and of all the garrison who could be spared from other points. Until the 1st of August, water was sent up daily to the signal tower in this way. The distance was long and the road steep. The enemy's fire was persistent. Looking at the ground it seems wonderful that supplies could have been got through at all.
At noon, after the main attack was pushed back, the guard at the signal tower was increased by six men, and food and water were also sent up. This challenging operation was covered by the fire from both the Maxims and all the soldiers who could be spared from other positions. Until August 1st, water was sent up to the signal tower daily this way. The distance was long, and the path was steep. The enemy's fire was relentless. Looking at the terrain, it’s remarkable that supplies were able to get through at all.
As night approached, the defenders prepared to meet a fresh attack. Lieutenant Wheatley, observing the points behind which the enemy usually assembled, trained the fort Maxim and the 9-pounder gun on them, while daylight lasted. At 11 P.M. the tribesmen advanced with shouts, yells and the beating of drums. The gun and the Maxims were fired, and it is said that no fewer than seventy men perished by the single discharge. At any rate the assault was delayed for an hour and a half. All day long the garrison had remained at their posts. It was hoped they would now get a little rest. But at 1 o'clock the attack was renewed on the north-east corner. Again the enemy brought up scaling ladders and charged with desperate ferocity. They were shot down.
As night fell, the defenders got ready to face a renewed attack. Lieutenant Wheatley, watching the spots where the enemy typically gathered, aimed the fort’s Maxim and the 9-pounder gun at those positions while there was still daylight. At 11 P.M., the tribesmen surged forward, shouting, yelling, and drumming. The gun and the Maxims were fired, and it's reported that at least seventy men fell from a single shot. In any case, the assault was held off for an hour and a half. The garrison had stayed at their posts all day, and they hoped to finally catch a little rest. But at 1 o'clock, the attack restarted at the north-east corner. Once more, the enemy brought up scaling ladders and charged with fierce determination. They were shot down.
Meanwhile every spare moment was devoted to improving the cover of the garrison. Captain Baker applied himself to this task, and used every expedient. Logs, sand bags, stones, boxes filled with earth were piled upon the walls. It is due to these precautions that the loss of life was no larger.
Meanwhile, every free moment was dedicated to reinforcing the garrison’s defenses. Captain Baker focused on this task and tried every method he could think of. Logs, sandbags, stones, and boxes filled with dirt were stacked on the walls. Thanks to these precautions, the loss of life was not greater.
Continuous firing occupied the 28th, and at 5.30 P.M. the enemy again assaulted. As in previous attacks, they at first advanced by twos and threes, making little dashes over the open ground, for bits of natural cover, and for the stone sungars they had built all round the fort under cover of darkness. Some of these were within 200 yards of the wall. As they advanced the fire became intense. Then the main rush was delivered. In a great semi-circle round the face of the fort held by the cavalry, and displaying nearly 200 standards whose gay colours were representative of every tribe on the border, they charged right up to the walls. Some of them actually got across the tangled barbed wire and were destroyed in the enclosure. But all efforts were defeated by the garrison, and towards morning the attack melted away, and only the usual sharpshooters remained. Some of these displayed a singular recklessness. One man climbed up into the barbed wire and fired three shots at the defenders at close quarters before he was killed.
Continuous firing occupied the 28th, and at 5:30 PM, the enemy once again launched an assault. As with previous attacks, they initially advanced in groups of two or three, making quick dashes over the open ground to find bits of natural cover and the stone barriers they had built around the fort under the cover of night. Some of these were within 200 yards of the wall. As they moved forward, the gunfire intensified. Then the main assault was launched. In a large semicircle around the section of the fort held by the cavalry, showcasing nearly 200 flags representing every tribe on the border, they charged right up to the walls. Some of them even managed to get through the tangled barbed wire and were taken out inside the enclosure. However, all efforts were thwarted by the garrison, and by morning, the attack subsided, leaving only the usual sharpshooters. Some of these showed remarkable recklessness; one man climbed up into the barbed wire and fired three shots at the defenders at close range before he was killed.
Thursday morning dawned on similar scenes. The garrison employed such intervals as occurred in strengthening their defences and improving their cover, particularly in the approaches to the Maxim and field gun platforms. At 3 P.M. the enemy came out of Chakdara village, and, carrying ladders to scale the walls, and bundles of grass to throw on the barbed wire, made a formidable effort. They directed the attack mainly against the signal station. This building is a strong, square, stone tower. Its entrance is above six feet from the ground. All around the top runs a machiconlis gallery, a kind of narrow balcony, with holes in the floor to fire through. It is well provided with loopholes. At 4 o'clock it was closely assailed. The garrison of the fort aided the tower guard by their fire. So bold were the enemy in their efforts, that they rushed in under the musketry of the defence, and lighted a great heap of grass about three yards from the doorway. The flames sprang up. A howl of ferocious delight arose. But the tribesmen relapsed into silence, when they saw that no real harm was done. At sunset the fore sight of the fort Maxim was shot away, and the defenders were temporarily deprived of the service of that powerful weapon. They soon managed, however, to rig up a makeshift, which answered all practical purposes. At 8 P.M. the enemy wearied of the struggle, and the firing died away to desultory skirmishing. They toiled all night carrying away their dead, but next morning over fifty bodies were still lying around the signal tower. Their losses had been enormous.
Thursday morning brought similar scenes. The garrison used whatever breaks they had to strengthen their defenses and improve their cover, especially around the Maxim and field gun platforms. At 3 PM, the enemy emerged from Chakdara village, carrying ladders to scale the walls and bundles of grass to throw onto the barbed wire, making a strong push. They focused their attack mainly on the signal station. This building is a sturdy, square stone tower with its entrance more than six feet off the ground. A narrow balcony runs around the top, equipped with holes in the floor for firing. It also has plenty of loopholes. At 4 o'clock, it came under heavy attack. The garrison helped the tower guard with their fire. The enemy was so bold in their attempts that they rushed in under the fire from defenders and set a huge pile of grass ablaze about three yards from the doorway. Flames shot up, and a howl of fierce joy erupted. But the tribesmen fell silent when they realized it caused no real damage. By sunset, the foresight of the fort Maxim was shot away, temporarily disabling that powerful weapon. They quickly managed to set up a makeshift solution that worked for all practical purposes. By 8 PM, the enemy grew tired of the fight, and the gunfire faded to sporadic skirmishing. They worked all night to carry away their dead, but by the next morning, over fifty bodies were still lying around the signal tower. Their losses had been massive.
The morning of the 30th brought no cessation of the fighting, but the enemy, disheartened by their losses of the previous night, did not attack until 7 P.M. At that hour they advanced and made a fresh effort. They were again repulsed. Perhaps the reader is tired of the long recital of the monotonous succession of assaults and repulses. What must the garrison have been by the reality? Until this day—when they snatched a few hours' sleep—they had been continually fighting and watching for ninety-six hours. Like men in a leaking ship, who toil at the pumps ceaselessly and find their fatigues increasing and the ship sinking hour by hour, they cast anxious, weary eyes in the direction whence help might be expected. But none came. And there are worse deaths than by drowning.
The morning of the 30th showed no signs of the fighting letting up, but the enemy, discouraged by their losses from the night before, didn't launch an attack until 7 P.M. At that time, they pushed forward and made another attempt. They were once again driven back. Perhaps the reader is weary of the lengthy account of the endless cycle of attacks and defenses. What must the soldiers have felt in reality? Until that day—when they finally got a few hours of sleep—they had been engaged in combat and keeping watch for ninety-six hours straight. Like men on a sinking ship, tirelessly working the pumps as their exhaustion grew and the vessel sank deeper, they cast anxious, tired glances toward the horizon where help might arrive. But none came. And there are worse ways to die than by drowning.
Men fell asleep at the loopholes and at the service of the field gun. Even during the progress of the attacks, insulted nature asserted itself, and the soldiers drifted away from the roar of the musketry, and the savage figures of the enemy, to the peaceful unconsciousness of utter exhaustion. The officers, haggard but tireless, aroused them frequently.
Men dozed off at the openings and while manning the field gun. Even amid the ongoing attacks, the harsh reality pushed through, and the soldiers pulled away from the noise of gunfire and the fierce enemy figures, seeking the calm oblivion of complete exhaustion. The officers, worn out but relentless, kept waking them up.
At other times the brave Sepoys would despair. The fort was ringed with the enemy. The Malakand, too, was assailed. Perhaps it was the same elsewhere. The whole British Raj seemed passing away in a single cataclysm. The officers encouraged them. The Government of the Queen-Empress would never desert them. If they could hold out, they would be relieved. If not, they would be avenged. Trust in the young white men who led them, and perhaps some dim half-idolatrous faith in a mysterious Sovereign across the seas, whose soldiers they were, and who would surely protect them, restored their fainting strength. The fighting continued.
At times, the brave Sepoys would lose hope. The fort was surrounded by the enemy. The Malakand was also under attack. Maybe it was the same everywhere. The entire British Raj seemed to be crumbling in a single disaster. The officers motivated them. The Government of the Queen-Empress would never abandon them. If they could hold on, help would arrive. If not, they would be avenged. They placed their trust in the young white leaders, and perhaps had a vague, half-idolizing belief in a mysterious Sovereign across the ocean, whose soldiers they were, and who would definitely protect them, restoring their fading strength. The fighting went on.
During the whole time of the siege the difficulty of maintaining signalling communication with the Malakand was extreme. But for the heroism of the signallers, it would have been insuperable. One man in particular, Sepoy Prem Singh, used every day at the risk of his life to come out through a porthole of the tower, establish his heliograph, and, under a terrible fire from short range, flash urgent messages to the main force. The extreme danger, the delicacy of the operation of obtaining connection with a helio, the time consumed, the composure required, these things combined to make the action as brave as any which these or other pages record. [A proposal has recently been made, to give the Victoria Cross to native soldiers who shall deserve it. It would seem that the value of such a decoration must be enhanced by making it open to all British subjects. The keener the competition, the greater the honor of success. In sport, in courage, and in the sight of heaven, all men meet on equal terms.] Early on Saturday morning a supply of water was sent to the guard of the signal tower. It was the last they got until 4.30 on Monday afternoon.
During the entire siege, it was extremely difficult to maintain signaling communication with the Malakand. Without the bravery of the signallers, it would have been impossible. One man in particular, Sepoy Prem Singh, risked his life every day to come out through a porthole of the tower, set up his heliograph, and, under intense fire at close range, send urgent messages to the main force. The extreme danger, the delicate operation of getting a connection with the heliograph, the time it took, and the calm needed made this task as brave as any recorded on these or other pages. [A proposal has recently been made to award the Victoria Cross to native soldiers who deserve it. It seems that the value of such a decoration would be increased by making it available to all British subjects. The fiercer the competition, the greater the honor of success. In sports, in bravery, and in the eyes of heaven, everyone stands on equal footing.] Early on Saturday morning, a supply of water was sent to the guard of the signal tower. That was the last they received until 4:30 on Monday afternoon.
When the attack on the fort began, the enemy numbered perhaps 1500 men. Since then they had been increasing every day, until on the 1st and 2nd, they are estimated to have been between 12,000 and 14,000 strong. Matters now began to assume a still graver aspect. At 5 o'clock on the evening of the 31st a renewed attack was made in tremendous force on the east side of the fort. But it was beaten back with great loss by the Maxims and the field gun. All night long the firing continued, and Sunday morning displayed the enemy in far larger numbers than hitherto. They now captured the Civil Hospital, a detached building, the walls of which they loopholed, and from which they maintained a galling fire. They also occupied the ridge, leading to the signal tower, thus cutting off all communication with its guard. No water reached those unfortunate men that day. The weather was intensely hot. The fire from the ridge made all interior communication difficult and dangerous. The enemy appeared armed to a great extent with Martini-Henry rifles and Sniders, and their musketry was most harassing. The party in the tower kept sending by signal pressing requests for water, which could not be supplied. The situation became critical. I quote the simple words of Lieutenant Rattray's official report:—
When the attack on the fort started, the enemy had around 1,500 men. Since then, their numbers grew daily, and by the 1st and 2nd, they were estimated to be between 12,000 and 14,000 strong. The situation now looked even more serious. At 5 o'clock on the evening of the 31st, a renewed attack with tremendous force hit the east side of the fort. However, it was pushed back with heavy losses by the Maxims and the field gun. The firing continued all through the night, and Sunday morning revealed the enemy in much larger numbers than before. They captured the Civil Hospital, which was a separate building, and loopholed its walls to maintain a relentless fire. They also took control of the ridge that led to the signal tower, cutting off all communication with its guard. No water reached those unfortunate men that day, and the weather was extremely hot. The fire from the ridge made all internal communication difficult and dangerous. The enemy appeared to be heavily armed with Martini-Henry rifles and Sniders, and their gunfire was extremely bothersome. The team in the tower kept sending urgent signals asking for water, which could not be provided. The situation became critical. I quote the simple words of Lieutenant Rattray's official report:—
"Matters now looked so serious that we decided to send an urgent appeal for help, but owing to the difficulty and danger of signalling we could not send a long message, and made it as short as possible, merely sending the two words, 'Help us.'"
"Things looked so serious now that we decided to send an urgent request for help, but because of the difficulty and danger of signaling, we couldn't send a long message, so we made it as short as possible, just sending the two words, 'Help us.'"
Still the garrison displayed a determined aspect, and though the tribesmen occupied the ridge, the Civil Hospital and an adjoining nullah, none set foot within the defences.
Still, the garrison showed a determined stance, and even though the tribesmen occupied the ridge, the Civil Hospital, and a nearby stream, none dared to enter the defenses.
At length the last day of the struggle came. At daybreak the enemy in tremendous numbers came on to the assault, as if resolute to take the place at any cost. They carried scaling ladders and bundles of grass. The firing became intense. In spite of the cover of the garrison several men were killed and wounded by the hail of bullets which was directed against the fort, and which splashed and scarred the walls in every direction.
At last, the final day of the battle arrived. At dawn, the enemy, overwhelming in numbers, launched an attack as if determined to capture the place at any cost. They brought scaling ladders and bundles of grass. The gunfire was fierce. Despite the garrison's cover, several men were killed and injured by the barrage of bullets aimed at the fort, which splattered and marred the walls everywhere.
Then suddenly, as matters were approaching a crisis, the cavalry of the relieving column appeared over the Amandara ridge. The strong horsemen mercilessly pursued and cut down all who opposed them. When they reached the Bridgehead on the side of the river remote from the fort, the enemy began to turn and run. The garrison had held out stubbornly and desperately throughout the siege. Now that relief was at hand, Lieutenant Rattray flung open the gate, and followed by half a dozen men charged the Civil Hospital. Captain Baker and Lieutenant Wheatley followed with a few more. The hospital was recaptured. The enemy occupying it, some thirty in number, were bayoneted. It was a finish in style. Returning, the sallying party found the cavalry—the 11th Bengal Lancers—checked by a sungar full of tribesmen. This they charged in flank, killing most of its occupants, and driving the rest after their comrades in rout and ruin. The last man to leave the sungar shot Lieutenant Rattray in the neck, but that officer, as distinguished for physical prowess as for military conduct, cut him down. This ended the fighting. It is not possible to think of a more fitting conclusion.
Then suddenly, as things were reaching a breaking point, the cavalry from the relief column appeared over the Amandara ridge. The skilled horsemen ruthlessly chased down and eliminated anyone who stood in their way. When they arrived at the bridgehead on the far side of the river from the fort, the enemy began to flee. The garrison had held out stubbornly and desperately throughout the siege. Now that help was finally here, Lieutenant Rattray threw open the gate and, followed by half a dozen men, charged the Civil Hospital. Captain Baker and Lieutenant Wheatley came behind with a few more men. The hospital was retaken. The enemy occupying it, about thirty in number, were bayoneted. It was quite a dramatic finish. When they returned, the attacking group found the cavalry—the 11th Bengal Lancers—held up by a sungar full of tribesmen. They charged in from the side, killing most of the occupants and driving the rest away in panic and chaos. The last man to leave the sungar shot Lieutenant Rattray in the neck, but that officer, known for his physical strength as much as his military skill, cut him down. This ended the fighting. It’s hard to imagine a more fitting conclusion.
The casualties in the siege were as follows:—
The casualties in the siege were as follows:—
Killed Wounded 11th B.L...... 1 1 45th Sikhs..... 4 10 Dir Levies..... 1 0 Followers..... 1 2 Total, all ranks—20
Killed Wounded 11th B.L...... 1 1 45th Sikhs..... 4 10 Dir Levies..... 1 0 Followers..... 1 2 Total, all ranks—20
This was the loss; but every man in the fort had held death at arm's length, for seven nights, and seven days.
This was the loss; but every man in the fort had faced death head-on for seven nights and seven days.
It is a significant fact, that, though the cavalry horses were exposed to the enemy's fire the whole time, hardly any were killed or wounded. The tribesmen, feeling sure that the place was theirs, and hoping that these fine beasts would fall unto their hands alive, had abstained from shooting them.
It’s notable that, even though the cavalry horses were under enemy fire the entire time, very few were killed or injured. The tribesmen, confident that the area would soon be theirs and hoping to capture these great animals alive, held back from shooting them.
As far as could be ascertained by careful official inquiries the enemy lost over 2000 men in the attack upon Chakdara.
As far as could be determined by thorough official investigations, the enemy lost more than 2,000 men in the attack on Chakdara.
[The following statistics as to the expenditure of ammunition may be of interest:—
[The following statistics on ammunition spending might be of interest:]
Rounds. 28th July. Maxim...... 843 " Martini-Henry... 7170 29th July. Maxim...... 667 " Martini-Henry... 4020 30th July. Maxim...... 1200 " Martini-Henry... 5530 31st July. Maxim...... 180 " Martini-Henry... 2700
Rounds. July 28. Maxim...... 843 " Martini-Henry... 7170 July 29. Maxim...... 667 " Martini-Henry... 4020 July 30. Maxim...... 1200 " Martini-Henry... 5530 July 31. Maxim...... 180 " Martini-Henry... 2700
This is approximately twenty rounds per man per diem. The fire control must have been excellent.]
This is about twenty rounds per person per day. The fire control must have been excellent.
CHAPTER VII: THE GATE OF SWAT
The Malakand Pass gives access to the valley of the Swat, a long and wide trough running east and west, among the mountains. Six miles further to the east, at Chakdara, the valley bifurcates. One branch runs northward towards Uch, and, turning again to the west, ultimately leads to the Panjkora River and beyond to the great valley of Nawagai. For some distance along this branch lies the road to Chitral, and along it the Malakand Field Force will presently advance against the Mohmands. The other branch prolongs the valley to the eastward. A few miles beyond Chakdara a long spur, jutting from the southern mountains, blocks the valley. Round its base the river has cut a channel. The road passes along a narrow stone causeway between the river and the spur. Here is the Landakai position, or as the tribesmen have for centuries called it, the "Gate of Swat." Beyond this gate is Upper Swat, the ancient, beautiful and mysterious "Udyana." This chapter will describe the forcing of the gate and the expedition to the head of the valley.
The Malakand Pass leads into the Swat Valley, a long, wide trough running east to west among the mountains. Six miles further east, at Chakdara, the valley splits. One branch goes north toward Uch and then turns west, eventually leading to the Panjkora River and beyond to the vast Nawagai Valley. For a ways along this branch is the road to Chitral, where the Malakand Field Force will soon move against the Mohmands. The other branch continues the valley eastward. A few miles beyond Chakdara, a long spur extending from the southern mountains blocks the valley. The river has carved a channel around its base. The road runs along a narrow stone causeway between the river and the spur. This is the Landakai position, known for centuries to the tribesmen as the "Gate of Swat." Beyond this gate lies Upper Swat, the ancient, beautiful, and mysterious "Udyana." This chapter will detail the breach of the gate and the expedition to the end of the valley.
The severe fighting at the Malakand and Chakdara had shown how formidable was the combination, which had been raised against the British among the hill tribes. The most distant and solitary valleys, the most remote villages, had sent their armed men to join in the destruction of the infidels. All the Banjaur tribes had been well represented in the enemy's ranks. The Bunerwals and the Utman Khels had risen to a man. All Swat had been involved. Instead of the two or three thousand men that had been estimated as the extreme number, who would follow the Mad Fakir, it was now known that over 12,000 were in arms. In consequence of the serious aspect which the military and political situation had assumed, it was decided to mobilise a 3rd and Reserve Brigade composed as follows:—
The intense fighting at Malakand and Chakdara demonstrated how powerful the coalition against the British was among the hill tribes. The most remote valleys and isolated villages sent their fighters to participate in the attack against the foreigners. All the Banjaur tribes were well represented in the enemy's ranks. The Bunerwals and the Utman Khels had all joined in. The entire Swat region was involved. Instead of the two or three thousand men that had been expected to follow the Mad Fakir, it was now clear that over 12,000 were armed. Due to the serious military and political situation, it was decided to mobilize a 3rd and Reserve Brigade composed as follows:—
3rd Brigade. Commanding—Brigadier-General J.H. Wodehouse, C.B., C.M.G. 2nd Battalion Highland Light Infantry. 1st " Gordon Highlanders. 21st Punjaub Infantry. 2nd Battalion 1st Gurkhas. No. 3 Company Bombay Sappers and Miners. " 14 British Field Hospital. " 45 Native " " " 1 Field Medical Depot.
3rd Brigade. Commanding—Brigadier-General J.H. Wodehouse, C.B., C.M.G. 2nd Battalion Highland Light Infantry. 1st " Gordon Highlanders. 21st Punjaub Infantry. 2nd Battalion 1st Gurkhas. No. 3 Company Bombay Sappers and Miners. " 14 British Field Hospital. " 45 Native " " " 1 Field Medical Depot.
The fighting of the preceding fortnight had left significant and terrible marks on the once smiling landscape. The rice crops were trampled down in all directions. The ruins of the villages which had been burned looked from a distance like blots of ink. The fearful losses which the enemy had sustained, had made an appreciable diminution, not of an army, but of a population. In the attacks upon the Malakand position, about 700 tribesmen had perished. In the siege of Chakdara, where the open ground had afforded opportunity to the modern weapons and Maxim guns, over 2000 had been killed and wounded. Many others had fallen in the relief of Chakdara and in the cavalry pursuit. For days their bodies lay scattered about the country. In the standing crops, in the ruins of villages, and among the rocks, festering bodies lay in the blazing sun, filling the valley with a dreadful smell. To devour these great numbers of vultures quickly assembled and disputed the abundant prey with the odious lizards, which I have mentioned in an earlier chapter, and which emerged from holes and corners to attack the corpses. Although every consideration of decency and health stimulated the energy of the victors in interring the bodies of their enemies, it was some days before this task could be accomplished, and even then, in out-of-the-way places, there remained a good many that had escaped the burying parties.
The fighting over the last two weeks had left serious and terrible scars on the once beautiful landscape. The rice fields were trampled in every direction. The ruins of the burned villages looked like dark stains from a distance. The severe losses the enemy suffered didn't just reduce an army but the population as a whole. In the assaults on the Malakand position, about 700 tribesmen had died. During the siege of Chakdara, where the open land allowed for the use of modern weapons and Maxim guns, over 2000 were killed or wounded. Many more fell during the relief of Chakdara and in the cavalry pursuit. For days, their bodies lay scattered across the land. In the standing crops, in the ruins of villages, and among the rocks, decaying bodies lay in the scorching sun, filling the valley with a terrible stench. Large numbers of vultures quickly gathered to feast on the dead, competing with the disgusting lizards I mentioned in an earlier chapter, which came out from their hiding places to scavenge the corpses. Even though the victors were driven by decency and health to bury their enemies, it took several days to complete this task, and even then, many bodies remained in remote areas that the burial teams missed.
Meanwhile the punishment that the tribesmen of the Swat Valley had received, and their heavy losses, had broken the spirit of many, and several deputations came to make their submission. The Lower Swatis surrendered unconditionally, and were allowed to return to their villages. Of this permission they at once availed themselves, and their figures could be seen moving about their ruined homes and endeavouring to repair the damage. Others sat by the roadside and watched in sullen despair the steady accumulation of troops in their valley, which had been the only result of their appeal to arms.
Meanwhile, the punishment that the tribesmen of the Swat Valley faced, along with their heavy losses, had broken the spirit of many, leading several delegations to come and submit. The Lower Swatis surrendered unconditionally and were allowed to return to their villages. They quickly took advantage of this permission, and their figures could be seen moving around their ruined homes, trying to repair the damage. Others sat by the roadside, watching in sullen despair as troops steadily accumulated in their valley, which had been the only outcome of their attempt to take up arms.
It is no exaggeration to say, that perhaps half the tribesmen who attacked the Malakand, had thought that the soldiers there, were the only troops that the Sirkar [The Government] possessed. "Kill these," they said, "and all is done." What did they know of the distant regiments which the telegraph wires were drawing, from far down in the south of India? Little did they realise they had set the world humming; that military officers were hurrying 7000 miles by sea and land from England, to the camps among the mountains; that long trains were carrying ammunition, material and supplies from distant depots to the front; that astute financiers were considering in what degree their action had affected the ratio between silver and gold, or that sharp politicians were wondering how the outbreak in Swat might be made to influence the impending bye-elections. These ignorant tribesmen had no conception of the sensitiveness of modern civilisation, which thrills and quivers in every part of its vast and complex system at the slightest touch.
It's no exaggeration to say that maybe half the tribesmen who attacked Malakand thought the soldiers there were the only troops the government had. "Kill these," they said, "and it's all over." They had no idea about the distant regiments that the telegraph wires were bringing in from far down in southern India. They little realized they had set the world in motion; military officers were rushing 7,000 miles by sea and land from England to the camps in the mountains; long trains were transporting ammunition, materials, and supplies from far-off depots to the front lines; clever financiers were contemplating how their actions had impacted the ratio between silver and gold, and sharp politicians were speculating on how the situation in Swat might influence the upcoming by-elections. These unaware tribesmen had no understanding of how sensitive modern civilization is, responding and reacting at every level of its vast and intricate system to the slightest touch.
They only saw the forts and camps on the Malakand Pass and the swinging bridge across the river.
They only saw the forts and camps at Malakand Pass and the swinging bridge over the river.
While the people of Lower Swat, deserted by the Mad Mullah, and confronted with the two brigades, were completely humbled and subdued, the Upper Swatis, encouraged by their priests, and, as they believed, safe behind their "gate," assumed a much more independent air. They sent to inquire what terms the Government would offer, and said they would consider the matter. Their contumacious attitude, induced the political officers to recommend the movement of troops through their country, to impress them with the determination and power of the Sirkar.
While the people of Lower Swat, abandoned by the Mad Mullah and facing two brigades, were completely defeated and subdued, the Upper Swatis, motivated by their priests and believing they were safe behind their "gate," took on a much more independent stance. They sent a message to ask what terms the Government would offer and said they would think about it. Their defiant attitude led the political officers to suggest moving troops through their territory to show them the determination and strength of the Government.
The expedition into the Upper Swat Valley was accordingly sanctioned, and Sir Bindon Blood began making the necessary preparations for the advance. The prospects of further fighting were eagerly welcomed by the troops, and especially by those who had arrived too late for the relief of Chakdara, and had had thus far, only long and dusty marches to perform. There was much speculation and excitement as to what units would be selected, every one asserting that his regiment was sure to go; that it was their turn; and that if they were not taken it would be a great shame.
The mission into the Upper Swat Valley was officially approved, and Sir Bindon Blood started getting everything ready for the move forward. The soldiers were excited about the possibility of more fighting, especially those who had shown up too late to help at Chakdara and had only been on long, dusty marches so far. There was a lot of chatter and anticipation about which units would be chosen, with everyone insisting that their regiment was certain to go; they believed it was their time, and that it would be a huge embarrassment if they weren’t selected.
Sir Bindon Blood had however already decided. He had concentrated a considerable force at Amandara in view of a possible advance, and as soon as the movement was sanctioned organised the column as follows:—
Sir Bindon Blood had already made up his mind, though. He had gathered a significant force at Amandara in anticipation of a potential advance, and as soon as the movement was approved, he organized the column as follows:—
1st Brigade. Commanding—Brigadier-General Meiklejohn. Royal West Kent Regiment. 24th Punjaub Infantry. 31st " " 45th Sikhs With the following divisional troops:— 10th Field Battery. No.7 British Mountain Battery. " 8 Bengal " " " 5 Company Madras Sappers and Miners. 2 Squadrons Guides Cavalry. 4 " 11th Bengal Lancers.
1st Brigade. Commanding—Brigadier-General Meiklejohn. Royal West Kent Regiment. 24th Punjab Infantry. 31st " " 45th Sikhs With the following divisional troops—: 10th Field Battery. No.7 British Mountain Battery. " 8 Bengal " " " 5 Company Madras Sappers and Miners. 2 Squadrons Guides Cavalry. 4 " 11th Bengal Lancers.
This force amounted to an available fighting strength of 3500 rifles and sabres, with eighteen guns. Supplies for twelve days were carried, and the troops proceeded on "the 80 lb. scale" of baggage, which means, that they did not take tents, and a few other comforts and conveniences.
This force had a fighting strength of 3,500 rifles and sabers, along with eighteen cannons. They carried enough supplies for twelve days and traveled on a "80 lb. scale" of baggage, meaning they didn't bring tents and only a few other comforts and conveniences.
Before the force started, a sad event occurred. On the 12th of August, Lieut.-Colonel J. Lamb, who had been wounded on the night of the 26th of July, died. An early amputation might have saved his life; but this was postponed in the expectation that the Rontgen Rays would enable the bullet to be extracted. The Rays arrived from India after some delay. When they reached Malakand, the experiment was at once made. It was found, however, that the apparatus had been damaged in coming up, and no result was obtained. Meanwhile mortification had set in, and the gallant soldier died on the Sunday, from the effects of an amputation which he was then too weak to stand. His thigh bone had been completely shattered by the bullet. He had seen service in Afghanistan and the Zhob Valley and had been twice mentioned in despatches.
Before the force began, a tragic event took place. On August 12th, Lieutenant Colonel J. Lamb, who had been injured on the night of July 26th, passed away. An early amputation could have saved his life, but this was delayed in the hope that the Röntgen Rays would make it possible to remove the bullet. The Rays finally arrived from India after some delay. When they reached Malakand, the experiment was conducted immediately. Unfortunately, it turned out that the equipment had been damaged during transport, and no results were achieved. In the meantime, gangrene had set in, and the brave soldier died on Sunday from the effects of an amputation he was too weak to endure. His thigh bone had been completely shattered by the bullet. He had served in Afghanistan and the Zhob Valley and had been mentioned in dispatches twice.
On the 14th Sir Bindon Blood joined the special force, and moved it on the 16th to Thana, a few miles further up the valley. At the same time he ordered Brigadier-General Wodehouse to detach a small column in the direction of the southern passes of Buner. The Highland Light Infantry, No.3 Company Bombay Sappers and Miners, and one squadron of the 10th Bengal Lancers accordingly marched from Mardan, where the 3rd Brigade then was, to Rustum. By this move they threatened the Bunerwals and distracted their attention from the Upper Swat Valley. Having thus weakened the enemy, Sir Bindon Blood proceeded to force the "Gate of Swat."
On the 14th, Sir Bindon Blood joined the special force and moved it on the 16th to Thana, a few miles further up the valley. At the same time, he ordered Brigadier-General Wodehouse to send a small unit toward the southern passes of Buner. The Highland Light Infantry, No.3 Company Bombay Sappers and Miners, and one squadron of the 10th Bengal Lancers marched from Mardan, where the 3rd Brigade was located, to Rustum. This move put pressure on the Bunerwals and shifted their focus away from the Upper Swat Valley. With the enemy weakened, Sir Bindon Blood pushed to take the "Gate of Swat."
On the evening of the 16th, a reconnaissance by the 11th Bengal Lancers, under Major Beatson, revealed the fact, that the Landakai position was strongly held by the enemy. Many standards were displayed, and on the approach of the cavalry, shots were fired all along the line. The squadron retired at once, and reported the state of affairs. The general decided to attack at day-break.
On the evening of the 16th, a scout mission by the 11th Bengal Lancers, led by Major Beatson, discovered that the Landakai position was heavily defended by the enemy. Numerous flags were visible, and as the cavalry approached, shots rang out along the entire line. The squadron quickly withdrew and reported back on the situation. The general made the decision to launch an attack at dawn.
At 6.30 A.M. on the 17th, the cavalry moved off, and soon came in contact with the tribesmen in some Buddhist ruins near a village, called Jalala. A skirmish ensued. Meanwhile the infantry were approaching. The main position of the enemy was displayed. All along the crest of the spur of Landakai could be seen a fringe of standards, dark against the sky. Beneath them the sword blades of the tribesmen glinted in the sunlight. A long line of stone sungars crowned the ridge, and behind the enemy clustered thickly. It is estimated that over 5000 were present.
At 6:30 A.M. on the 17th, the cavalry set out and soon encountered the tribesmen in some Buddhist ruins near a village called Jalala. A skirmish broke out. Meanwhile, the infantry were getting closer. The main enemy position was revealed. Along the top of the spur of Landakai, a line of standards could be seen, dark against the sky. Below them, the blades of the tribesmen's swords sparkled in the sunlight. A long line of stone sungars topped the ridge, with the enemy clustered thickly behind them. It's estimated that there were over 5,000 present.
It is not difficult to realise what a strong position this was. On the left of the troops was an unfordable river. On their right the mountains rose steeply. In front was the long ridge held by the enemy. The only road up the valley was along the causeway, between the ridge and the river. To advance further, it was necessary to dislodge the enemy from the ridge. Sir Bindon Blood rode forward, reconnoitered the ground, and made his dispositions.
It’s easy to see how strong their position was. On the left side of the troops was a river that couldn’t be crossed. On the right, the mountains rose sharply. In front was the long ridge held by the enemy. The only road up the valley ran along the causeway between the ridge and the river. To move further, they needed to push the enemy off the ridge. Sir Bindon Blood rode forward, surveyed the area, and organized their plans.
To capture the position by a frontal attack would involve heavy loss. The enemy were strongly posted, and the troops would be exposed to a heavy fire in advancing. On the other hand, if the ridge could once be captured, the destruction of the tribesmen was assured. Their position was good, only as long as they held it. The moment of defeat would be the moment of ruin. The reason was this. The ground behind the ridge was occupied by swampy rice fields, and the enemy could only retire very slowly over it. Their safe line of retreat lay up the spur, and on to the main line of hills. They were thus formed with their line of retreat in prolongation of their front. This is, of course, tactically one of the worst situations that people can get into.
Launching a frontal attack to take the position would result in significant losses. The enemy was well entrenched, and the troops would be vulnerable to heavy fire while advancing. However, if the ridge could be seized, the defeat of the tribesmen would be guaranteed. Their position was strong, but only as long as they maintained control. The moment they faltered would be the beginning of their downfall. The reason for this was the terrain behind the ridge, which was made up of swampy rice fields, making it difficult for the enemy to retreat quickly. Their safe escape route was up the spur and onto the main line of hills. This meant their retreat line extended directly behind their front lines, which, tactically, is one of the worst situations to be in.
Sir Bindon Blood, who knew what the ground behind the ridge was like, perceived at once how matters stood, and made his plans accordingly. He determined to strike at the enemy's left, thus not only turning their flank, but cutting off their proper line of retreat. If once his troops held the point, where the long ridge ran into the main hills, all the tribesmen who had remained on the ridge would be caught. He accordingly issued orders as follows:—
Sir Bindon Blood, familiar with the terrain behind the ridge, immediately understood the situation and organized his strategy accordingly. He decided to attack the enemy's left side, which would not only flank them but also block their main escape route. If his troops secured the spot where the long ridge met the main hills, all the tribesmen still on the ridge would be trapped. He then issued the following orders:—
The Royal West Kent were to mask the front and occupy the attention of the enemy. The rest of the infantry, viz., 24th and 31st Punjaub Infantry and the 45th Sikhs, were to ascend the hills to the right, and deliver a flank attack on the head of the ridge. The cavalry were to be held in readiness to dash forward along the causeway—to repair which a company of sappers was posted—as soon as the enemy were driven off the ridge which commanded it, and pursue them across the rice fields into the open country beyond. The whole of the powerful artillery was to come into action at once.
The Royal West Kent were meant to distract the enemy. The rest of the infantry, including the 24th and 31st Punjaub Infantry and the 45th Sikhs, were to climb the hills on the right and launch a flank attack on the top of the ridge. The cavalry were to be ready to charge down the causeway—being repaired by a company of sappers—once the enemy was pushed off the ridge that overlooked it, and then chase them across the rice fields into the open country beyond. All of the powerful artillery was to be brought into action at the same time.
The troops then advanced. The Royal West Kent Regiment began the fight, by driving some of the enemy from the Buddhist ruins on a small spur in advance of the main position. The 10th Field Battery had been left in rear in case the guns might stick in the narrow roads near Thana village. It had, however, arrived safely, and now trotted up, and at 8.50 A.M. opened fire on the enemy's position and at a stone fort, which they occupied strongly. A few minutes later No.7 Mountain Battery came into action from the spur, which the Royal West Kent had taken. A heavy artillery fire thus prepared the way for the attack. The great shells of the Field Artillery astounded the tribesmen, who had never before witnessed the explosion of a twelve-pound projectile. The two mountain batteries added to their discomfiture. Many fled during the first quarter of an hour of the bombardment. All the rest took cover on the reverse slope and behind their sungars.
The troops then advanced. The Royal West Kent Regiment started the fight by driving some of the enemy out from the Buddhist ruins on a small ridge ahead of the main position. The 10th Field Battery had been held back in case the guns got stuck on the narrow roads near Thana village. However, it arrived safely and quickly moved up, opening fire on the enemy's position and a stone fort they were strongly occupying at 8:50 A.M. A few minutes later, No. 7 Mountain Battery came into action from the ridge the Royal West Kent had secured. A heavy artillery fire paved the way for the attack. The powerful shells from the Field Artillery stunned the tribesmen, who had never before seen the explosion of a twelve-pound projectile. The two mountain batteries added to their confusion. Many fled during the first fifteen minutes of the bombardment, while the rest took cover on the reverse slope and behind their sungars.
Meanwhile the flank attack was developing. General Meiklejohn and his infantry were climbing up the steep hillside, and moving steadily towards the junction of the ridge with the main hill. At length the tribesmen on the spur perceived the danger that was threatening them. They felt the grip on their line of retreat. They had imagined that the white troops would try and force their path along the causeway, and had massed considerable reserves at the lower end of the ridge. All these now realised that they were in great danger of being cut off. They were on a peninsula, as it were, while the soldiers were securing the isthmus. They accordingly began streaming along the ridge towards the left, at first with an idea of meeting the flank attack, but afterwards, as the shell fire grew hotter, and the musketry increased, only in the hope of retreat. Owing to the great speed with which the mountaineers move about the hills, most of them were able to escape before the flank attack could cut them off. Many however, were shot down as they fled, or were killed by the artillery fire. A few brave men charged the 31st Punjaub Infantry, but were all destroyed.
Meanwhile, the flank attack was underway. General Meiklejohn and his infantry were climbing the steep hillside, steadily moving toward where the ridge met the main hill. Eventually, the tribesmen on the spur realized the danger they were in. They sensed their escape route tightening. They had thought the white troops would try to push through the causeway and had gathered significant reserves at the lower end of the ridge. Now, they all understood they were at great risk of being surrounded. They were, in a sense, on a peninsula while the soldiers secured the isthmus. They started moving along the ridge to the left, initially hoping to counter the flank attack, but as the shelling intensified and the gunfire increased, they began to retreat in desperation. Thanks to their speed in navigating the hills, most of the mountaineers managed to escape before the flank attack could cut them off. However, many were shot down as they fled, or were killed by the artillery fire. A few brave men charged the 31st Punjaub Infantry, but they were all killed.
Seeing the enemy in full flight, Sir Bindon Blood ordered the Royal West Kent to advance against the front of the now almost deserted ridge. The British infantry hurrying forward climbed the steep hill and captured the stone sungars. From this position they established touch with the flank attack, and the whole force pursued the flying tribesmen with long-range fire.
Seeing the enemy in full retreat, Sir Bindon Blood commanded the Royal West Kent to move forward against the nearly empty ridge. The British infantry rushed up the steep hill and took control of the stone sungars. From this vantage point, they connected with the flank attack, and the entire force chased down the fleeing tribesmen with long-range gunfire.
The "Gate of Swat" had been forced. It was now possible for troops to advance along the causeway. This had, however, been broken in various places by the enemy. The sappers and miners hastened forward to repair it. While this was being done, the cavalry had to wait in mad impatience, knowing that their chance lay in the plains beyond. As soon as the road was sufficiently repaired to allow them to pass in single file, they began struggling along it, and emerged at the other end of the causeway in twos and threes.
The "Gate of Swat" had been breached. Now, troops could move forward along the causeway. However, the enemy had damaged it in several spots. The engineers quickly moved in to fix it. While this repair was underway, the cavalry waited in extreme impatience, aware that their opportunity awaited them in the plains ahead. As soon as the road was fixed enough for them to pass in single file, they began to make their way along it and emerged at the other end of the causeway in pairs and threes.
An incident now ensued, which, though it afforded an opportunity for a splendid act of courage, yet involved an unnecessary loss of life, and must be called disastrous. As the cavalry got clear of the broken ground, the leading horsemen saw the tribesmen swiftly running towards the hills, about a mile distant. Carried away by the excitement of the pursuit, and despising the enemy for their slight resistance, they dashed impetuously forward in the hope of catching them before they could reach the hills.
An incident happened that, while it provided a chance for a brave act, also resulted in needless loss of life and was truly disastrous. As the cavalry emerged from the rough terrain, the front horsemen spotted the tribesmen quickly heading for the hills, about a mile away. Caught up in the thrill of the chase and underestimating the enemy due to their minimal resistance, they impulsively charged forward, hoping to catch them before they reached the hills.
Lieutenant-Colonel Adams, on entering the plain, saw at once that if he could seize a small clump of trees near a cemetery, he would be able to bring effective dismounted fire to bear on the retreating tribesmen. He therefore collected as many men as possible, and with Lieutenant Maclean, and Lord Fincastle, the Times correspondent, rode in the direction of these points. Meanwhile Captain Palmer, who commanded the leading squadron, and Lieutenant Greaves of the Lancashire Fusiliers, who was acting war correspondent of the Times of India, galloped across the rice fields after the enemy. The squadron, unable to keep up, straggled out in a long string, in the swampy ground.
Lieutenant-Colonel Adams, upon entering the field, quickly realized that if he could take control of a small group of trees near a cemetery, he could effectively fire on the retreating tribesmen from horseback. He gathered as many men as he could and, along with Lieutenant Maclean and Lord Fincastle, the Times correspondent, rode toward these locations. Meanwhile, Captain Palmer, who led the first squadron, and Lieutenant Greaves of the Lancashire Fusiliers, who was covering the war for the Times of India, raced across the rice fields after the enemy. The squadron, unable to keep pace, fell into a long line across the muddy ground.
At the foot of the hills the ground was firmer, and reaching this, the two officers recklessly dashed in among the enemy. It is the spirit that loses the Empire many lives, but has gained it many battles. But the tribesmen, who had been outmanoeuvred rather than outfought, turned savagely on their pursuers. The whole scene was witnessed by the troops on the ridge. Captain Palmer cut down a standard-bearer. Another man attacked him. Raising his arm for a fresh stroke, his wrist was smashed by a bullet. Another killed his horse. Lieutenant Greaves, shot through the body, fell at the same moment to the ground. The enemy closed around and began hacking him, as he lay, with their swords. Captain Palmer tried to draw his revolver. At this moment two sowars got clear of the swampy rice fields, and at once galloped, shouting, to the rescue, cutting and slashing at the tribesmen. All would have been cut to pieces or shot down. The hillside was covered with the enemy. The wounded officers lay at the foot. They were surrounded. Seeing this Lieutenant-Colonel Adams and Lord Fincastle, with Lieutenant Maclean and two or three sowars, dashed to their assistance. At their charge the tribesmen fell back a little way and opened a heavy fire. Lord Fincastle's horse was immediately shot and he fell to the ground. Rising, he endeavoured to lift the wounded Greaves on to Colonel Adams' saddle, but at this instant a second bullet struck that unfortunate officer, killing him instantly. Colonel Adams was slightly, and Lieutenant Maclean mortally, wounded while giving assistance, and all the horses but two were shot. In spite of the terrible fire, the body of Lieutenant Greaves and the other two wounded officers were rescued and carried to the little clump of trees.
At the base of the hills, the ground was more solid, and once there, the two officers charged recklessly into the enemy. It's the spirit that costs the Empire countless lives but has won it many battles. However, the tribesmen, who had been outmaneuvered instead of out-fought, violently turned on their pursuers. The entire scene was watched by the troops on the ridge. Captain Palmer took down a standard-bearer. Another man lunged at him. As he raised his arm for another strike, a bullet shattered his wrist. Another shot killed his horse. At that same moment, Lieutenant Greaves was shot through the body and fell to the ground. The enemy closed in and began to hack at him with their swords while he lay there. Captain Palmer attempted to draw his revolver. Just then, two sowars broke free from the muddy rice fields and rushed in, shouting, to rescue them, slashing at the tribesmen. They would have all been cut to pieces or shot down; the hillside was swarming with the enemy. The wounded officers lay at the bottom, surrounded. Observing this, Lieutenant-Colonel Adams and Lord Fincastle, along with Lieutenant Maclean and two or three sowars, charged to help. At their advance, the tribesmen fell back for a moment and opened heavy fire. Lord Fincastle’s horse was immediately shot, and he fell to the ground. Getting up, he tried to lift the injured Greaves onto Colonel Adams' saddle, but at that instant, a second bullet struck that unfortunate officer, killing him instantly. Colonel Adams was slightly and Lieutenant Maclean mortally wounded while providing assistance, and all but two horses were shot down. Despite the fierce gunfire, they managed to rescue the body of Lieutenant Greaves and the other two wounded officers and carried them to a small group of trees.
For this gallant feat of arms both the surviving officers, Colonel Adams and Lord Fincastle, were recommended for, and have since received, the Victoria Cross. It was also officially announced, that Lieutenant Maclean would have received it, had he not been killed. There are many, especially on the frontier, where he was known as a fine soldier and a good sportsman, who think that the accident of death should not have been allowed to interfere with the reward of valour.
For this brave act of valor, both surviving officers, Colonel Adams and Lord Fincastle, were recommended for and have since received the Victoria Cross. It was also officially announced that Lieutenant Maclean would have received it if he hadn’t been killed. Many people, especially on the frontier, where he was recognized as an excellent soldier and a good sportsman, believe that his untimely death shouldn’t have prevented him from being honored for his courage.
The extremes of fortune, which befell Lord Fincastle and Lieutenant Greaves, may well claim a moment's consideration. Neither officer was employed officially with the force. Both had travelled up at their own expense, evading and overcoming all obstacles in an endeavour to see something of war. Knights of the sword and pen, they had nothing to offer but their lives, no troops to lead, no duties to perform, no watchful commanding officer to report their conduct. They played for high stakes, and Fortune never so capricious as on the field of battle, dealt to the one the greatest honour that a soldier can hope for, as some think, the greatest in the gift of the Crown, and to the other Death.
The dramatic twists of fate that hit Lord Fincastle and Lieutenant Greaves deserve a moment of attention. Neither officer was officially part of the force. Both traveled at their own expense, overcoming every obstacle in their quest to witness war. As knights of both the sword and the pen, they had nothing to offer but their lives—no troops to command, no duties to fulfill, and no watchful superior to report to about their actions. They took big risks, and Fortune, known for being unpredictable on the battlefield, handed one of them the highest honor a soldier could hope for, which some consider the greatest gift from the Crown, while the other faced Death.
The flight of the enemy terminated the action of Landakai. Thus in a few hours and with hardly any loss, the "Gate of Swat," which the tribesmen had regarded as impregnable, had been forced. One squadron of the Guides cavalry, under Captain Brasier Creagh, pursuing the enemy had a successful skirmish near the village of Abueh, and returned to camp about 6.30 in the evening. [This officer was mentioned in despatches for his skill and judgment in this affair; but he is better known on the frontier for his brilliant reconnaissance towards Mamani, a month later, in which in spite of heavy loss he succeeded in carrying out General Hammond's orders and obtained most valuable information.] During the fight about 1000 tribesmen had threatened the baggage column, but these were but poor-spirited fellows, for they retired after a short skirmish with two squadrons of the 11th Bengal Lancers, with a loss of twenty killed and wounded. The total casualties of the day were as follows:—
The enemy's retreat ended the action at Landakai. In just a few hours and with minimal losses, the "Gate of Swat," which the tribesmen thought was unbeatable, had been taken. One squadron of the Guides cavalry, led by Captain Brasier Creagh, successfully clashed with the enemy near the village of Abueh and returned to camp around 6:30 in the evening. [This officer was noted in reports for his skill and judgment during this event; however, he is better recognized on the frontier for his impressive reconnaissance towards Mamani a month later, where, despite significant losses, he successfully executed General Hammond's orders and gathered valuable information.] During the conflict, about 1,000 tribesmen threatened the baggage column, but they were not very determined and withdrew after a brief skirmish with two squadrons of the 11th Bengal Lancers, suffering twenty killed and wounded. The total casualties of the day were as follows:—
BRITISH OFFICERS. Killed—Lieutenant R.T. Greaves, Lancs. Fusiliers. " " H.L.S. Maclean, Guides. Wounded severely—Captain M.E. Palmer, Guides. Wounded slightly—Lieutenant-Colonel R.B. Adams, Guides. NATIVE RANKS—Wounded—5. FOLLOWERS—Wounded—2. Total Casualties—11.
BRITISH OFFICERS. Killed—Lieutenant R.T. Greaves, Lancs. Fusiliers. " " H.L.S. Maclean, Guides. Severely Wounded—Captain M.E. Palmer, Guides. Slightly Wounded—Lieutenant-Colonel R.B. Adams, Guides. NATIVE RANKS—Wounded—5. FOLLOWERS—Wounded—2. Total Casualties—11.
It must be remembered, that but for the incident which resulted in the deaths of the officers, and which Sir Bindon Blood described in his official despatch as an "unfortunate contretemps," the total casualties would have only been seven wounded. That so strong a position should have been captured with so little loss, is due, firstly, to the dispositions of the general; and secondly, to the power of the artillery which he had concentrated. The account of the first attempt to storm the Dargai position on the 20th of October, before it had been shaken by artillery fire, when the Dorsetshire Regiment suffered severe loss, roused many reflections among those who had witnessed the action of Landakai.
It should be noted that if it weren't for the incident that led to the deaths of the officers, which Sir Bindon Blood referred to in his official report as an "unfortunate contretemps," the total casualties would have only been seven wounded. The fact that such a strong position was captured with so few losses is largely due to the general's strategy and the power of the artillery he had focused. The account of the first attempt to storm the Dargai position on October 20, before it was softened by artillery fire, when the Dorsetshire Regiment faced heavy losses, sparked many thoughts among those who had witnessed the action at Landakai.
The next morning, the 18th, the force continued their march up the valley of the Upper Swat. The natives, thoroughly cowed, offered no further opposition and sued for peace. Their losses at Landakai were ascertained to have exceeded 500, and they realised that they had no chance against the regular troops, when these were enabled to use their powerful weapons.
The next morning, the 18th, the troops continued their march up the Upper Swat valley. The locals, completely intimidated, offered no more resistance and sought peace. Their losses at Landakai were found to be over 500, and they understood that they stood no chance against the regular forces when those troops were able to use their powerful weapons.
As the troops advanced up the fertile and beautiful valley, all were struck by the numerous ruins of the ancient Buddhists. Here in former times were thriving cities, and civilised men. Here, we learn from Fa-hien, [Record Of Buddhistic Kingdoms. Translated by James Legge, M.A., LL.D.] were "in all 500 Sangharamas," or monasteries. At these monasteries the law of hospitality was thus carried out: "When stranger bhikshus (begging monks) arrive at one of them, their wants are supplied for three days, after which they are told to find a resting-place for themselves." All this is changed by time. The cities are but ruins. Savages have replaced the civilised, bland-looking Buddhists, and the traveller who should apply for hospitality, would be speedily shown "a resting-place," which would relieve his hosts from further trouble concerning him.
As the soldiers moved forward through the lush and beautiful valley, everyone was amazed by the many ruins left by the ancient Buddhists. In the past, there were thriving cities and civilized people here. From Fa-hien, we learn that there were "in all 500 Sangharamas," or monasteries. At these monasteries, the rule of hospitality was practiced like this: "When unfamiliar bhikshus (begging monks) arrive at one of them, their needs are met for three days, after which they are told to find a place to stay on their own." All of this has changed with time. The cities are now just ruins. Savages have taken the place of the peaceful-looking Buddhists, and a traveler seeking hospitality would quickly be shown "a resting place," which would remove any further concern for his hosts.
"There is a tradition," continues the intrepid monk, who travelled through some of the wildest countries of the earth in the darkest ages of its history, "that when Buddha came to North India, he came to this country, and that he left a print of his foot, which is long or short according to the ideas of the beholder." Although the learned Fa-hien asserts that "it exists, and the same thing is true about it at the present day," the various cavalry reconnaissances failed to discover it, and we must regretfully conclude that it has also been obliterated by the tides of time. Here too, says this Buddhistic Baedeker, is still to be seen the rock on which "He dried his clothes; and the place where He converted the wicked dragon (Naga)." "The rock is fourteen cubits high and more than twenty broad, with one side of it smooth." This may well be believed; but there are so many rocks of all dimensions that the soldiers were unable to make certain which was the scene of the dragon's repentance, and Buddha's desiccation.
“There’s a tradition,” continues the brave monk, who journeyed through some of the wildest lands during the darkest times in history, “that when Buddha came to North India, he visited this country and left a footprint that varies in size depending on who’s looking.” Although the knowledgeable Fa-hien claims, “it exists, and it’s still true today,” the various cavalry searches couldn’t find it, and we must sadly conclude that it has been erased by the passage of time. Here too, this Buddhist guidebook says, is the rock where “He dried his clothes and the spot where He converted the wicked dragon (Naga).” “The rock is fourteen cubits high and more than twenty wide, with one side smooth.” This could very well be true; however, there are so many rocks of all shapes and sizes that the soldiers couldn’t determine which one was the site of the dragon’s repentance and Buddha’s drying off.
His companions went on ahead towards Jellalabad, or some city in that locality, but Fa-hien, charmed with the green and fertile beauties of "the park," remained in the pleasant valley and "kept the summer retreat." Then he descended into the land of So-hoo-to, which is perhaps Buner.
His friends went ahead towards Jellalabad or some nearby city, but Fa-hien, enchanted by the lush and fertile beauty of "the park," stayed in the pleasant valley and "enjoyed the summer retreat." Then he went down into the land of So-hoo-to, which might be Buner.
Even in these busy, practical, matter-of-fact, modern times, where nothing is desirable unless economically sound, it is not unprofitable for a moment to raise the veil of the past, and take a glimpse of the world as it was in other days. The fifth century of the Christian era was one of the most gloomy and dismal periods in the history of mankind. The Great Roman Empire was collapsing before the strokes of such as Alaric the Goth, Attila the Hun, and Genseric the Vandal. The art and valour of a classical age had sunk in that deluge of barbarism which submerged Europe. The Church was convulsed by the Arian controversy. That pure religion, which it should have guarded, was defiled with the blood of persecution and degraded by the fears of superstition. Yet, while all these things afflicted the nations of the West, and seemed to foreshadow the decline or destruction of the human species, the wild mountains of Northern India, now overrun by savages more fierce than those who sacked Rome, were occupied by a placid people, thriving, industrious, and intelligent; devoting their lives to the attainment of that serene annihilation which the word nirvana expresses. When we reflect on the revolutions which time effects, and observe how the home of learning and progress changes as the years pass by, it is impossible to avoid the conclusion, perhaps a mournful one, that the sun of civilisation can never shine all over the world at once.
Even in these busy, practical, and straightforward modern times, where nothing seems worthwhile unless it makes economic sense, it's still valuable to momentarily lift the curtain on the past and take a glimpse at how the world used to be. The fifth century of the Christian era was one of the darkest and most depressing times in human history. The Great Roman Empire was falling apart due to the attacks from leaders like Alaric the Goth, Attila the Hun, and Genseric the Vandal. The culture and bravery of a classical age had drowned in the wave of barbarism that engulfed Europe. The Church was shaken by the Arian controversy. The pure faith it should have protected was tarnished by persecution and weakened by superstitious fears. Yet, while all these troubles plagued the nations of the West and hinted at a decline or even the end of humanity, the wild mountains of Northern India, now inhabited by even fiercer savages than those who looted Rome, were home to a peaceful, thriving, industrious, and intelligent people; they dedicated their lives to achieving the serene state of annihilation that the word nirvana represents. When we think about the changes that time brings and notice how the center of learning and progress shifts as the years roll on, it's hard not to feel that the light of civilization can never shine everywhere in the world at the same time.
On the 19th, the force reached Mingaora, and here for five days they waited in an agreeable camp, to enable Major Deane to receive the submission of the tribes. These appeared much humbled by their defeats, and sought to propitiate the troops by bringing in supplies of grain and forage. Over 800 arms of different descriptions were surrendered during the halt. A few shots were fired into the camp on the night of the arrival at Mingaora, but the villagers, fearing lest they should suffer, turned out and drove the "snipers" away. On the 21st a reconnaissance as far as the Kotke Pass afforded much valuable information as to the nature of the country. All were struck with the beauty of the scenery, and when on the 24th the force marched back to Barikot, they carried away with them the memory of a beautiful valley, where the green of the rice fields was separated from the blue of the sky by the glittering snow peaks of the Himalayas.
On the 19th, the troops arrived in Mingaora, where they camped comfortably for five days while Major Deane received the tribes' surrender. The tribes seemed humbled by their defeats and tried to win favor with the troops by bringing in supplies of grain and forage. Over 800 weapons of various kinds were surrendered during this time. A few shots were fired into the camp on the night they arrived in Mingaora, but the villagers, worried about their safety, came out and chased the "snipers" away. On the 21st, a reconnaissance mission as far as the Kotke Pass provided valuable information about the land. Everyone was impressed by the beautiful scenery, and when the troops marched back to Barikot on the 24th, they left with memories of a stunning valley, where the green rice fields met the blue sky, framed by the shining snow-capped peaks of the Himalayas.
While the troops rested at Barikot, Sir Bindon Blood personally reconnoitred the Karakar Pass, which leads from the Swat Valley into the country of the Bunerwals. The Bunerwals belong to the Yusaf section, of the Yusafzai tribe. They are a warlike and turbulent people. To their valley, after the suppression of the Indian Mutiny, many of the Sepoys and native officers who had been in revolt fled for refuge. Here, partly by force and partly by persuasion, they established themselves. They married women of the country and made a settlement. In 1863 the Bunerwals came into collision with the British Government and much severe fighting ensued, known to history as the Ambeyla Campaign. The refugees from India renewed their quarrel with the white troops with eagerness, and by their extraordinary courage and ferocity gained the name of the "Hindustani Fanatics." At the cost of thirty-six officers and eight hundred men Buner was subdued. The "Crag Picket" was taken for the last time by the 101st Fusiliers, and held till the end of the operations. Elephants, brought at great expense from India, trampled the crops. Most of the "Hindustani Fanatics" perished in the fighting. The Bunerwals accepted the Government terms, and the troops retired. Since then, in 1868, in 1877 and again in 1884 they raided border villages, but on the threat of an expedition paid a fine and made good the damage. The reputation they have enjoyed since their stout resistance in 1863, has enabled them to take a leading position among the frontier tribes; and they have availed themselves of this to foment and aggravate several outbreaks against the British. Their black and dark-blue clothes had distinguished them from the other assailants of Malakand and Chakdara. They had now withdrawn to their valley and thence defied the Government and refused all terms.
While the troops were resting at Barikot, Sir Bindon Blood personally explored the Karakar Pass, which connects the Swat Valley to the territory of the Bunerwals. The Bunerwals are part of the Yusaf section of the Yusafzai tribe and are known for being fierce and unsettled. After the Indian Mutiny was suppressed, many soldiers and native officers who had revolted sought refuge in their valley. Here, through a mix of force and persuasion, they established themselves, married local women, and settled down. In 1863, the Bunerwals clashed with the British Government, leading to intense fighting known as the Ambeyla Campaign. The refugees from India eagerly resumed their conflict with the British troops and earned the nickname "Hindustani Fanatics" due to their remarkable bravery and violence. Buner was subdued at the cost of thirty-six officers and eight hundred soldiers. The "Crag Picket" was seized one last time by the 101st Fusiliers and held until the operations concluded. Elephants, brought at great cost from India, trampled the crops. Most of the "Hindustani Fanatics" were killed in the fighting. The Bunerwals accepted the Government's terms, and the troops withdrew. Since then, in 1868, 1877, and again in 1884, they have raided border villages, but in response to the threat of military action, they paid fines and made reparations for the damage. Their strong resistance in 1863 has allowed them to take a prominent role among the frontier tribes, which they have used to incite and intensify various uprisings against the British. Their black and dark-blue clothing set them apart from other attackers at Malakand and Chakdara. They have now retreated back to their valley and have since defied the Government, rejecting all terms.
As Sir Bindon Blood and his escort approached the top of the pass, a few shots were fired by the watchers there, but there was no opposition. All the Bunerwals had hurried over to defend the southern entrances to their country, which they conceived were in danger of attack from Brigadier-General Wodehouse's force at Rustum. The general reached the Kotal, and saw the whole valley beneath him. Great villages dotted the plains and the aspect was fertile and prosperous.
As Sir Bindon Blood and his group got near the top of the pass, a few shots were fired by the guards up there, but there was no real opposition. All the Bunerwals had rushed over to protect the southern entrances to their territory, which they believed were at risk of attack from Brigadier-General Wodehouse's forces at Rustum. The general reached the Kotal and looked out over the entire valley below him. Large villages were scattered across the plains, and the area looked fertile and thriving.
The unguarded Karakar Pass was practicable for troops, and if the Government would give their consent, Buner might be reduced in a fortnight without difficulty, almost without fighting.
The unprotected Karakar Pass was accessible for troops, and if the Government would approve, Buner could be captured in two weeks without much trouble, almost without any fighting.
Telegrams were despatched to India on the subject, and after much delay and hesitation the Viceroy decided against the recommendation of his victorious general. Though the desirability of settling with the Bunerwals was fully admitted, the Government shrank from the risk. The Malakand Field Force thus remained idle for nearly a fortnight. The news, that the Sirkar had feared to attack Buner, spread like wildfire along the frontier, and revived the spirits of the tribes. They fancied they detected a sign of weakness. Nor were they altogether wrong. But the weakness was moral rather than physical.
Telegrams were sent to India about this, and after a lot of delays and doubts, the Viceroy chose not to follow his victorious general's advice. While everyone agreed that settling with the Bunerwals was a good idea, the Government was wary of the risks involved. As a result, the Malakand Field Force stayed inactive for almost two weeks. News that the Sirkar was too scared to attack Buner spread quickly along the frontier and boosted the tribes' morale. They thought they saw a sign of weakness. They weren't entirely wrong, but the weakness was more moral than physical.
It is now asserted, that the punishment of Buner is only postponed, and that a few months may see its consummation. [Written in 1897.] The opportunity of entering the country without having to force the passes may not, however, recur.
It is now claimed that Buner’s punishment is just delayed and that in a few months it might be finalized. [Written in 1897.] However, the chance to enter the country without having to battle through the passes might not happen again.
On the 26th of August the force returned to Thana, and the expedition into Upper Swat terminated.
On August 26th, the force returned to Thana, marking the end of the expedition into Upper Swat.
[The following is the most trustworthy estimate obtainable of loss of life among the tribesmen in the fighting in the Swat Valley from 26th July to 17th August. The figures include wounded, who have since died, and are more than double those killed outright in the actions:—
[The following is the most reliable estimate available of the death toll among the tribesmen in the conflict in the Swat Valley from July 26 to August 17. The figures include the wounded who have since died and are more than double those killed outright in the battles:—
1. Lower Swat Pathans... 700 Buried in the graveyards. 2. Upper " " ... 600 " " " " 3. Buner proper . ... 500 " " " " 4. Utman Khel . ... 80 5. Yusafzai. . ... 50 6. Other tribes . ... 150 Total—2080. 1, 2 and 3 are the result of recent inquiry on the spot. 4, 5 and 6 are estimates based on native information.
1. Lower Swat Pathans... 700 buried in the graveyards. 2. Upper " " ... 600 " " " " 3. Buner proper . ... 500 " " " " 4. Utman Khel . ... 80 5. Yusafzai. . ... 50 6. Other tribes . ... 150 Total—2080. 1, 2 and 3 are the result of recent inquiry on the spot. 4, 5 and 6 are estimates based on native information.
The proportion of killed and died of wounds to wounded would be very high, as the tribes have little surgical or medical knowledge and refused all offers of aid. Assuming that only an equal number were wounded and recovered, the total loss would be approximately 4000. A check is obtained by comparing these figures with the separate estimates for each action:—
The ratio of those killed and those who died from their injuries to the number of wounded would be very high, as the tribes have minimal surgical or medical knowledge and decline all offers of help. If we assume that only an equal number were wounded and recovered, the total loss would be around 4,000. A verification is made by comparing these numbers with the individual estimates for each engagement:—
Malakand.... 700 Siege of Chakdara.. 2000 Relief " " .. 500 Action of Landakai.. 500 Total—3700.
Malakand.... 700 Siege of Chakdara.. 2000 Relief " " .. 500 Action of Landakai.. 500 Total—3700.
CHAPTER VIII: THE ADVANCE AGAINST THE MOHMANDS
The beginning of this chapter must mark a change in the standpoint from which the story is told. Hitherto the course of events has been recorded in the impersonal style of history. But henceforward I am able to rely on my own memory as well as on other people's evidence. [I do not desire to bore the reader or depreciate the story by the introduction of personal matters. It will be sufficient if, in the interests of coherency, I explain my connection with the Malakand Field Force. Having realised, that if a British cavalry officer waits till he is ordered on active service, he is likely to wait a considerable time, I obtained six weeks' leave of absence from my regiment, and on the 2nd of September arrived at Malakand as press correspondent of the PIONEER and DAILY TELEGRAPH, and in the hope of being sooner or later attached to the force in a military capacity.] It may be doubtful whether an historical record gains or loses value when described by an eye-witness. From the personal point of view, all things appear in a gradual perspective, according to the degree in which they affect the individual; and we are so prone to exaggerate the relative importance of incidents, which we see, over those we hear about, that what the narrative gains in accuracy of detail, it may lose in justness of proportion. In so nice a question I shall not pronounce. I remember that the original object with which this book was undertaken, was to present a picture of the war on the North-West Frontier to the Englishmen at home; a picture which should not only exist, but be looked at; and I am inclined to think, that this end will be more easily attained by the adoption of a style of personal narrative. Many facts, too local, too specialised, too insignificant, for an historical record, and yet which may help the reader to form a true impression of the scene and situation, are thus brought within the compass of these pages. The account becomes more graphic if less imposing, more vivid if less judicial. As long as each step down from the "dignity of history" is accompanied by a corresponding increase in interest, we may pursue without compunction that pleasant, if descending, path.
The start of this chapter marks a shift in how the story is told. Until now, events have been narrated in an impersonal, historical style. From this point on, I can draw from my own memory as well as other people's accounts. [I don’t want to bore you or lessen the story by bringing in personal details. It’s enough to clarify my connection with the Malakand Field Force for the sake of clarity. Realizing that if a British cavalry officer waits to be ordered on active duty, he might be waiting a long time, I took six weeks' leave from my regiment and arrived at Malakand on September 2nd as a press correspondent for the PIONEER and DAILY TELEGRAPH, hoping to eventually be attached to the military force.] It's unclear whether an eyewitness account adds or detracts from historical records. From a personal perspective, everything is seen in a gradual way based on how it affects me; and we often tend to exaggerate the importance of events we witness compared to those we hear about. So, while the narrative might gain accuracy in detail, it may lose proportionality. I won’t make a judgment on that. I remember that the original purpose of this book was to provide a vivid picture of the war on the North-West Frontier for English readers at home—one that not only exists but can be truly appreciated. I believe this goal can be achieved more effectively through personal storytelling. Many facts, which are too localized, specialized, or minor for a historical account, can still help readers form a genuine impression of the scene and situation, making the account more engaging—even if it’s less formal. As long as each step away from the "dignity of history" comes with more interest, we can comfortably pursue this enjoyable, if less lofty, path.
The ninth chapter also introduces a new phase of the operations of the force. The Mohmands now become the enemy and the scene is changed from Swat to Bajaur. Before marching into their country, it will be desirable to consider briefly those causes and events which induced the Government of India to despatch an expedition against this powerful and warlike tribe.
The ninth chapter also introduces a new stage in the operations of the force. The Mohmands now become the enemy, shifting the scene from Swat to Bajaur. Before moving into their territory, it’s important to briefly consider the causes and events that led the Government of India to send an expedition against this strong and aggressive tribe.
The tidal wave of fanaticism, which had swept the frontier, had influenced the Mohmands, as all other border peoples. Their situation was, however, in several important respects, different from that of the natives of the Swat Valley. These Mohmands had neither been irritated nor interfered with in any way. No military road ran through their territory. No fortified posts stirred their animosity or threatened their independence. Had they respected in others the isolation which they themselves have so long enjoyed, they might have remained for an indefinite period in that state of degraded barbarism which seems to appeal so strongly to certain people in England. They became, however, the aggressors.
The wave of fanaticism that swept through the frontier also affected the Mohmands, just like all the other border communities. However, their situation was different in some significant ways from that of the people in the Swat Valley. The Mohmands hadn’t been provoked or interfered with at all. There was no military road cutting through their land. No fortified posts stirred their anger or threatened their freedom. If they had respected the isolation that they had enjoyed for so long in others, they might have stayed in a state of degraded barbarism that seems to appeal to certain people in England for an indefinite period. Instead, they became the aggressors.
In the heart of the wild and dismal mountain region, in which these fierce tribesmen dwell, are the temple and village of Jarobi: the one a consecrated hovel, the other a fortified slum. This obscure and undisturbed retreat was the residence of a priest of great age and of peculiar holiness, known to fame as the Hadda Mullah. His name is Najb-ud-din, but as respect has prevented it being mentioned by the tribesmen for nearly fifty years, it is only preserved in infidel memories and records. The Government of India have, however, had this man's personality brought vividly before them on several occasions. About thirteen years ago he quarrelled with the Amir and raised the Mohmands against him. The Amir replied by summoning his rebellious subject—for Hadda, the Mullah's home and birthplace, is a village of Afghanistan—to answer for his conduct at Cabul. But the crafty priest, who was well acquainted with Afghan legal procedure, declined the invitation, and retired to the independent Mohmand territory, where he has lived ever since.
In the heart of the rugged and gloomy mountain region where these fierce tribesmen live, you'll find the temple and village of Jarobi: one is a sacred hut, and the other is a fortified slum. This hidden and tranquil spot was home to a very old priest known for his unique holiness, famous as the Hadda Mullah. His real name is Najb-ud-din, but out of respect, the tribesmen haven't mentioned it for nearly fifty years, so it's only remembered by outsiders and recorded in documents. The Government of India has, however, encountered this man's personality vividly on several occasions. About thirteen years ago, he had a falling out with the Amir and incited the Mohmands against him. The Amir responded by summoning his rebellious subject—Hadda, the Mullah's hometown, is a village in Afghanistan—to answer for his actions in Cabul. But the clever priest, who was well-versed in Afghan legal procedures, turned down the invitation and retreated to the independent Mohmand territory, where he has lived ever since.
Content with thus inflicting the punishment of exile, the Amir was disposed to forget the offence. In a letter to his Commander-in-Chief, the "Sipah Salar," a great friend of the Mullah, he described him as a "light of Islam." So powerful a light, indeed, he did not desire to have in his own dominions; but across the border it was fitting that respect should be shown to so holy a man. He therefore directed his officials to cherish and honour him. Thus he retained a powerful weapon—to be used when desirable. Whether by instigation or from personal motives, the Hadda Mullah has long been a bitter foe to the British power. In 1895 he sent the fighting men of the Mohmands to resist the Chitral Relief Force. Since then he has been actively engaged, by preaching and by correspondence with other Mullahs, in raising a great combination against the advancing civilisation.
Satisfied with just exiling him, the Amir was ready to move on from the offense. In a letter to his Commander-in-Chief, the "Sipah Salar," who was a close friend of the Mullah, he referred to him as a "light of Islam." This light was so powerful that the Amir didn’t want it in his own territory; however, it was important to show respect for such a holy person across the border. He instructed his officials to support and honor him. Thus, he maintained a strong influence to use when needed. Whether out of provocation or personal reasons, the Hadda Mullah has been a longtime opponent of British power. In 1895, he sent the Mohmands to fight against the Chitral Relief Force. Since then, he has been actively involved in rallying a significant resistance against advancing civilization through preaching and communicating with other Mullahs.
In 1896 he terminated a long religious controversy with the Manki Mullah of Nowshera and Spinkhara—a comparatively tame Mullah, who now supports the Indian Government—by publishing a book setting forth his views, and demolishing those of his antagonist. This work was printed in Delhi and had an extensive sale among Mahommedans all over India. Complimentary copies were sent to the "Sipah Salar" and other Afghan notabilities, and the fame of the Hadda Mullah was known throughout the land. Besides increasing his influence, his literary success stimulated his efforts.
In 1896, he ended a long religious debate with the Manki Mullah of Nowshera and Spinkhara—a relatively moderate Mullah who now supports the Indian Government—by publishing a book that presented his views and refuted those of his opponent. This book was printed in Delhi and sold widely among Muslims across India. Complimentary copies were sent to the "Sipah Salar" and other prominent Afghan figures, and the Hadda Mullah's fame spread throughout the country. In addition to boosting his influence, his literary success motivated him to work even harder.
While the Mad Fakir was rousing Swat and Buner, this powerful priest incited the Mohmands. Though he was known to be a physical coward, his sanctity and the fact that he was their own particular holy man, not less than his eloquence, powerfully moved this savage tribe. A Jehad was proclaimed. How long should Islam be insulted? How long should its followers lurk in the barren lands of the North? He urged them to rise and join in the destruction of the white invaders. Those who fell should become saints; those who lived would be rich, for these Kafirs had money and many other things besides, for which a true believer might find a use.
While the Mad Fakir was rallying Swat and Buner, this powerful priest stirred up the Mohmands. Even though he was known to be physically cowardly, his holiness and the fact that he was their own revered leader, along with his persuasive speech, profoundly impacted this fierce tribe. A Jihad was declared. How long should Islam be disrespected? How long should its followers hide in the barren lands of the North? He urged them to rise up and join in driving out the white invaders. Those who died would become saints; those who survived would be wealthy, as these Kafirs had money and many other things that a true believer could find useful.
The combined allurements of plunder and paradise proved irresistible. On the 8th of August a great gathering, nearly 6000 strong, crossed the frontier line, invaded British territory, burned the village of Shankargarh, and attacked the fort of Shabkadr. This place is an advanced post in the defensive system of the frontier, and is situated some nineteen miles to the north-west of Peshawar. Its ordinary garrison consists of about fifty Border Police. It is strongly built, and is intended to attract the attention and delay the advance of a raiding-party, until the Peshawar garrison has had time to take the field. Both of these objects it admirably fulfilled in this case.
The combined attractions of loot and paradise were too tempting to resist. On August 8th, a large group, nearly 6,000 strong, crossed the border, invaded British territory, burned down the village of Shankargarh, and attacked the fort of Shabkadr. This location is a forward base in the defense system of the frontier and is located about nineteen miles northwest of Peshawar. Its regular garrison typically consists of around fifty Border Police. It is well-constructed and designed to draw attention and slow down a raiding party's advance until the Peshawar garrison can mobilize. In this case, it served both purposes perfectly.
As soon as the news of the incursion of the Mohmands was received in Peshawar, a flying column was mobilised and proceeded under the command of Lieut.-Colonel J.B. Woon, 20th Punjaub Infantry, in the direction of the fort. At dawn on the 9th of August they found the tribesmen in force in a strong position near Shabdakr. The force at Colonel Woon's disposal was small. It consisted of:—
As soon as news of the Mohmands' invasion reached Peshawar, a rapid response unit was mobilized and headed towards the fort under the leadership of Lieut.-Colonel J.B. Woon of the 20th Punjab Infantry. At dawn on August 9th, they discovered the tribesmen in significant numbers, well-positioned near Shabdakr. Colonel Woon had a small force available, which included:—
4 Guns 51st Field Battery. 2 squadrons 13th Bengal Lancers..... 151 lances. 2 Companies Somersetshire Light Infantry.. 186 rifles. 20th Punjaub Infantry ...... 400 "
4 Guns 51st Field Battery. 2 squadrons 13th Bengal Lancers..... 151 lances. 2 Companies Somersetshire Light Infantry.. 186 rifles. 20th Punjaub Infantry ...... 400 "
A total of about 750 men. The enemy numbered 6000. Nevertheless it was decided to attack at once.
A total of about 750 men. The enemy had 6000. Still, it was decided to attack immediately.
As the action which followed is but remotely connected with the fortunes of the Malakand Field Force, I do not intend to describe it in detail. The infantry in advancing could only attack on a front of 600 yards. The enemy's line, being much longer, quickly turned both flanks. The fire became severe. Numerous casualties occurred. A retirement was ordered. As is usual in Asiatic warfare, it was considerably pressed. The situation at about nine o'clock appeared critical. At this point Brigadier-General Ellis, commanding the Peshawar District, arrived on the field. He immediately ordered the two squadrons of the 13th Bengal Lancers to move well to the right flank, to charge across the front and check the enemy's advance. The "cease fire" sounded as on a field day. Then there was a pause. The movements of the cavalry were concealed from most of the troops, but suddenly all noticed the slackening of the enemy's fire. Then the tribesmen were seen to be in retreat and disorder. The power of cavalry had been strikingly displayed. The two squadrons, ably led, had executed a fine charge over what theorists would call impossible ground for a distance of one and a half miles along the bed of a great nullah, and among rocks and stones that reduced the pace to a trot. The enemy were driven from the field. Sixty were actually speared by the Lancers, and the rest retreated in gloom and disorder to their hills across the frontier.
As the action that followed is only loosely connected to the fate of the Malakand Field Force, I won’t go into detail about it. The infantry, while advancing, could only engage on a front of 600 yards. The enemy's line, which was much longer, quickly outflanked both sides. The fighting intensified, leading to many casualties. A retreat was ordered. As is common in Asian warfare, it was heavily pressured. By around nine o’clock, the situation looked critical. At that moment, Brigadier-General Ellis, who was in charge of the Peshawar District, arrived on the scene. He immediately ordered the two squadrons of the 13th Bengal Lancers to move far to the right flank, charge across the front, and stop the enemy's advance. The “cease fire” sound echoed like it would on a training day. Then there was a pause. Most of the troops couldn’t see the cavalry's movements, but suddenly everyone noticed that the enemy's fire was easing up. Then, the tribesmen were seen retreating in disarray. The effectiveness of the cavalry was impressively displayed. The two squadrons, expertly led, executed a strong charge over what analysts would consider impossible terrain for a distance of one and a half miles along the dry riverbed of a large nullah, and through rocks and stones that slowed their speed to a trot. The enemy was driven off the field. Sixty were actually speared by the Lancers, and the rest retreated in despair and confusion back to their hills across the border.
The casualties were as follows:—
The casualties were as follows:—
British Officers. Wounded severely—Major A. Lumb, Somersetshire Light Infantry. " " Captain S.W. Blacker, R.A. " " 2nd Lieut. E Drummond, Somersetshire Light Infantry. Wounded slightly—Lieut. A.V. Cheyne, 13th Bengal Lancers. British N.C.O.'s and Soldiers. Killed. Wounded. 51st Field Battery, R.A..... 0 2 Somersetshire Light Infantry... 3 9 Native Ranks. 13th Bengal Lancers ..... 1 12 20th Punjaub Infantry..... 5 35 Followers ....... 0 1 Total Casualties, all ranks—72.
British Officers. Seriously Wounded—Major A. Lumb, Somersetshire Light Infantry. " " Captain S.W. Blacker, R.A. " " 2nd Lieutenant E. Drummond, Somersetshire Light Infantry. Slightly Wounded—Lieutenant A.V. Cheyne, 13th Bengal Lancers. British N.C.O.s and Soldiers. Killed. Wounded. 51st Field Battery, R.A..... 0 2 Somersetshire Light Infantry... 3 9 Native Ranks. 13th Bengal Lancers ..... 1 12 20th Punjab Infantry..... 5 35 Followers ....... 0 1 Total Casualties, all ranks—72.
That such an outrage, as the deliberate violation of British territory by these savages, should remain unpunished, "Forward Policy" or no "Forward Policy," was of course impossible. Yet the vacillation and hesitancy which the Government of India had displayed in the matter of the Bunerwals, and the shocking and disgraceful desertion of the forts in the Khyber Pass, were so fresh in all men's minds, that the order to advance against the Mohmands was received with feelings of the greatest relief throughout the forces. The general plan of the operations as arranged by the Commander-in-Chief was as follows:—
That such an outrage, as the intentional violation of British territory by these savages, should go unpunished, "Forward Policy" or not, was obviously unacceptable. However, the indecision and hesitation displayed by the Government of India regarding the Bunerwals, along with the shocking and disgraceful abandonment of the forts in the Khyber Pass, were still fresh in everyone's minds, so the order to advance against the Mohmands was met with immense relief throughout the forces. The overall plan for the operations, as laid out by the Commander-in-Chief, was as follows:—
1. Sir Bindon Blood with two brigades of the Malakand Field Force and due proportions of cavalry and guns was to move through South Bajaur to Nawagai, and on the 15th of September invade the Mohmand country from that place.
1. Sir Bindon Blood with two brigades of the Malakand Field Force and the appropriate amounts of cavalry and artillery was set to move through South Bajaur to Nawagai, and on September 15th, invade the Mohmand area from there.
2. On the same date Major-General Elles with an equal force would leave Shabkadr, and entering the mountains march northeast to effect a junction.
2. On the same date, Major-General Elles, with an equal force, would leave Shabkadr and head northeast into the mountains to join up.
3. This having been done, the combined forces under the supreme command of Sir Bindon Blood would be brought back through the Mohmands' territories to Shabkadr. Incidentally they would deal with the Hadda Mullah's village of Jarobi, and inflict such punishment on the tribesmen as might be necessary to ensure their submission. The troops would then be available for the Tirah Expedition, which it had by this time been decided to organise.
3. With this completed, the united forces under the overall command of Sir Bindon Blood would be led back through the Mohmand territories to Shabkadr. Along the way, they would address the Hadda Mullah's village of Jarobi and impose any necessary punishment on the tribesmen to ensure their compliance. Afterward, the troops would be ready for the Tirah Expedition, which had by then been decided to organize.
The fact that after leaving Nawagai, nothing was known of the configuration of the country, of which no maps existed; nor of the supplies of food, forage and water available by the way, made the preparations for, and the execution of, these operations somewhat difficult. Wide margins had to be allowed in the matter of rations, and in order to be prepared for all contingencies and obstructions of ground, Sir Bindon Blood equipped his 2nd Brigade entirely with mule transport. The 3rd Brigade with camels would follow if the road was passable.
The fact that after leaving Nawagai, there was no information about the layout of the land, as there were no maps available, nor details about the food, forage, and water supplies along the route, made preparing for and carrying out these operations quite challenging. Considerable leeway had to be factored into the rations, and to prepare for any potential obstacles and terrain issues, Sir Bindon Blood outfitted his 2nd Brigade entirely with mule transport. The 3rd Brigade with camels would follow if the route was navigable.
The following was the composition of the forces employed:—
The following was the makeup of the forces used:—
I. MALAKAND FIELD FORCE. Commanding—Major-General Sir Bindon Blood. 2nd Brigade. Brigadier-General Jeffries, C.B. The Buffs. 35th Sikhs. 38th Dogras. Guides Infantry. No.4 Company (Bengal) Sappers and Miners. No.7 Mountain Battery. 3rd Brigade. Brigadier-General Wodehouse. The Queen's Regiment.[This regiment had replaced the Gordon Highlanders in the 3rd Brigade.] 22nd Punjaub Infantry. 39th Punjaub Infantry. No.3 Company (Bombay) Sappers and Miners. No.1 Mountain Battery, R.A. Cavalry—11th Bengal Lancers. Line of Communications. 1st Brigade. Brigadier-General Meiklejohn. Royal West Kent. Highland Light Infantry. 31st Punjaub Infantry. 24th Punjaub Infantry. 45th Sikhs. No.7 British Mountain Battery. And the following additional troops:— 1 Squadron 10th Bengal Lancers. 2 Squadrons Guides Cavalry.
I. MALAKAND FIELD FORCE. Commanding—Major-General Sir Bindon Blood. 2nd Brigade. Brigadier-General Jeffries, C.B. The Buffs. 35th Sikhs. 38th Dogras. Guides Infantry. No.4 Company (Bengal) Sappers and Miners. No.7 Mountain Battery. 3rd Brigade. Brigadier-General Wodehouse. The Queen's Regiment. [This regiment had replaced the Gordon Highlanders in the 3rd Brigade.] 22nd Punjaub Infantry. 39th Punjaub Infantry. No.3 Company (Bombay) Sappers and Miners. No.1 Mountain Battery, R.A. Cavalry—11th Bengal Lancers. Line of Communications. 1st Brigade. Brigadier-General Meiklejohn. Royal West Kent. Highland Light Infantry. 31st Punjaub Infantry. 24th Punjaub Infantry. 45th Sikhs. No.7 British Mountain Battery. And the following additional troops:— 1 Squadron 10th Bengal Lancers. 2 Squadrons Guides Cavalry.
II.THE MOHMAND FIELD FORCE. 1st Brigade. 1st Battalion Somersetshire Light Infantry. Maxim Gun Detachment, 1st Battalion Devonshire Regiment. 20th Punjaub Infantry. 2nd Battalion 1st Gurkhas. Sections A and B No.5 British Field Hospital. Three Sections No.31 Native " " Section A No.45 " " " 2nd Brigade. 2nd Battalion Oxfordshire Light Infantry. 9th Gurkha Rifles. 37th Dogras. Sections C and D No.5 British Field Hospital. No.44 Native Field Hospital. Divisional Troops. 13th Bengal Lancers. No.3 Mountain Battery, Royal Artillery. No.5 (Bombay) Mountain Battery. No.5 Company (Bengal) Sappers and Miners. 28th Bombay Pioneers. 1st Patiala Infantry. Sections C and D No.63 Native Field Hospital.
II.THE MOHMAND FIELD FORCE. 1st Brigade. 1st Battalion Somersetshire Light Infantry. Maxim Gun Detachment, 1st Battalion Devonshire Regiment. 20th Punjaub Infantry. 2nd Battalion 1st Gurkhas. Sections A and B No.5 British Field Hospital. Three Sections No.31 Native " " Section A No.45 " " " 2nd Brigade. 2nd Battalion Oxfordshire Light Infantry. 9th Gurkha Rifles. 37th Dogras. Sections C and D No.5 British Field Hospital. No.44 Native Field Hospital. Divisional Troops. 13th Bengal Lancers. No.3 Mountain Battery, Royal Artillery. No.5 (Bombay) Mountain Battery. No.5 Company (Bengal) Sappers and Miners. 28th Bombay Pioneers. 1st Patiala Infantry. Sections C and D No.63 Native Field Hospital.
To record the actual movements of troops in a campaign, is among the most important duties of one who undertakes to tell its tale. For the sake of clearness, of brevity, and that the reader who is not interested may find convenience in skipping, I shall at once describe the whole of the marches and manoeuvres, by which Sir Bindon Blood moved his brigades across the Panjkora River, and after the Malakand Field Force is safely camped at Ghosam, the reader will be invited to return to examine the scenery, and remark the incidents of the way.
Recording the actual movements of troops during a campaign is one of the most important responsibilities for anyone telling the story. To keep things clear and concise, and to make it easy for readers who aren’t interested to skip ahead, I’ll quickly describe all the marches and maneuvers that Sir Bindon Blood used to move his brigades across the Panjkora River. Once the Malakand Field Force is safely set up at Ghosam, I’ll invite the reader to come back and explore the scenery and note the events along the way.
During the end of August, the 2nd Brigade, equipped with mule transport, was at Khar in the Swat Valley. The 3rd Brigade was at Uch. On the 2nd of September, definite orders to advance were received from Simla. In pursuance of these instructions, Sir Bindon Blood ordered Brigadier-General Wodehouse with the 3rd Brigade, which in anticipation had been moved from Uch a few days previously, to take over the bridge across the Panjkora from the Khan of Dir's Levies, and secure the passage. On the 6th, the 3rd Brigade marched from Sarai to Panjkora, and obtained possession of the bridge just in time to prevent it falling into the hands of the enemy, who had already gathered to seize it. The 12-pounder guns of the 10th Field Battery were placed in a strong position commanding the passage, and the brigade camped on the left bank. On the same day, Brigadier-General Jeffries with headquarters marched from Khar to Chakdara. On the 7th he proceeded to Sarai, and on the 8th effected the passage of the Panjkora, and camped on the further bank at Kotkai. On the 10th, both brigades marched to Ghosam, where they concentrated. On the line of communications to the Malakand, stages were established at Chakdara and Sarai, with accommodation for sick and wounded. An advanced depot was formed behind the Panjkora, to guard which and to hold the passage, an additional force was moved from the Swat Valley.
At the end of August, the 2nd Brigade, with mule transport, was in Khar in the Swat Valley. The 3rd Brigade was in Uch. On September 2nd, clear orders to advance came from Simla. Following these instructions, Sir Bindon Blood directed Brigadier-General Wodehouse and the 3rd Brigade, which had been moved from Uch a few days earlier in preparation, to take over the bridge across the Panjkora from the Khan of Dir's Levies and secure the crossing. On the 6th, the 3rd Brigade marched from Sarai to Panjkora and seized the bridge just in time to stop it from falling into enemy hands, as they had already gathered to take it. The 12-pounder guns of the 10th Field Battery were positioned strategically to cover the passage, and the brigade set up camp on the left bank. On the same day, Brigadier-General Jeffries with headquarters marched from Khar to Chakdara. On the 7th, he moved to Sarai, and on the 8th crossed the Panjkora, camping on the other side at Kotkai. On the 10th, both brigades marched to Ghosam, where they concentrated. Along the communication lines to Malakand, stages were set up at Chakdara and Sarai, providing accommodations for the sick and wounded. An advanced depot was established behind the Panjkora, and to protect it and hold the crossing, an additional force was sent from the Swat Valley.
This concentration at Ghosam, of which the details had worked out so mechanically, had been necessitated by the attitude of the tribesmen of Bajaur and the adjoining valleys. Great gatherings had collected, and up to the 7th of September there had been every sign of determined opposition. So formidable did the combination appear, that Sir Bindon Blood arranged to have at his disposal a force of six squadrons, nine battalions and three batteries, in the expectation of an action at or near Ghosam, which would perhaps have been on a larger scale than any British engagement since Tel-el-Kebir. [As so many misconceptions exist as to the British casualties in this victory, it is necessary to state that in the twenty minutes' fighting 11 officers and 43 men were killed and 22 officers and 320 men were wounded.]
This concentration at Ghosam, which had been organized in a very methodical way, was required due to the stance of the tribesmen from Bajaur and the nearby valleys. Large gatherings had formed, and until September 7th, there were clear signs of strong opposition. The coalition seemed so powerful that Sir Bindon Blood planned to have a force of six squadrons, nine battalions, and three batteries ready, anticipating a conflict at or near Ghosam, which might have been larger than any British engagement since Tel-el-Kebir. [As there are many misunderstandings regarding British casualties in this victory, it’s important to clarify that during twenty minutes of fighting, 11 officers and 43 men were killed, and 22 officers and 320 men were wounded.]
These anticipations were however doomed to disappointment. The methodical, remorseless advance of powerful forces filled the tribesmen with alarm. They made a half-hearted attempt to capture the Panjkora bridge, and finding themselves forestalled, fell again to discussing terms. In this scene of indecision the political officers employed all their arts. And then suddenly the whole huge combination, which had been raised in our path, collapsed as an iceberg, when southern waters have melted its base.
These expectations were destined to fall short. The steady, relentless approach of strong forces left the tribesmen anxious. They made a half-hearted attempt to take the Panjkora bridge, and realizing they were too late, went back to discussing terms. In this atmosphere of uncertainty, the political officers used all their skills. Then, just like that, the entire massive obstacle that had been in our way fell apart like an iceberg when the warm waters from the south melted its bottom.
Whatever the philanthropist may say, it would appear to have been better policy to have encouraged the tribesmen to oppose the advance in the open, on some well-defined position. Had they done so, there can be no doubt that the two fine brigades, backed by a powerful artillery, and under a victorious commander, who knew and had fought over every inch of the ground, would have defeated them with severe loss. Bajaur would have been settled at a single blow and probably at a far less cost in lives than was afterwards incurred. Instead of this, it was the aim of our diplomacy to dissipate the opposition. The inflammation, which should have been brought to a head and then operated on, was now dispersed throughout the whole system, with what results future chapters will show.
Whatever the philanthropist might say, it seems it would have been better to encourage the tribesmen to confront the advance directly, from a clear and strategic position. If they had done that, there’s no doubt that the two strong brigades, supported by powerful artillery and guided by a successful commander who knew the terrain well, would have defeated them with heavy losses. Bajaur could have been handled in one decisive strike, likely at a much lower cost in lives than what was ultimately incurred. Instead, our diplomatic strategy aimed to weaken the opposition. The tension that should have been focused and then addressed was now spread throughout the entire situation, and the outcomes of this will be revealed in future chapters.
Having thus brought the brigades peacefully to Gosham, I ask the reader to return to the Malakand and ride thence with the Headquarters Staff along the line of march. On the 5th of September, Sir Bindon Blood and his staff, which I had the pleasure to accompany, started from the Kotal Camp and proceeded across the plain of Khar to Chakdara. Here we halted for the night, and as the scenery and situation of this picturesque fort have already been described, the march may be continued without delay next morning. From Chakdara to Sarai is a stage of twelve miles. The road runs steadily up the valley until the summit of the Catgalla Pass is reached. "Catgalla" means "Cut-throat," and, indeed, it is not hard to believe that this gloomy defile has been the scene of dark and horrid deeds. Thence a descent of two miles leads to Sarai. On the way, we fell in with the 2nd Brigade, and had to leave the road to avoid the long lines of mules and marching men who toiled along it.
Having successfully brought the brigades peacefully to Gosham, I invite the reader to return to the Malakand and ride along with the Headquarters Staff on our journey. On September 5th, Sir Bindon Blood and his staff, whom I had the pleasure of accompanying, left the Kotal Camp and made our way across the plain of Khar to Chakdara. We stopped here for the night, and since the scenery and location of this charming fort have already been described, we can continue our march without delay the next morning. The stretch from Chakdara to Sarai is twelve miles. The road gradually ascends the valley until we reach the top of the Catgalla Pass. "Catgalla" means "Cut-throat," and it’s not hard to believe that this somber pass has witnessed dark and terrible events. From there, a two-mile descent leads us to Sarai. On the way, we encountered the 2nd Brigade and had to leave the path to avoid the long lines of mules and soldiers trudging along it.
The valley at Sarai is about two miles wide, and the mountains rise steeply from it. On every ridge it is possible to distinguish the red brick ruins which were the dwellings of the ancient Buddhists. These relics of an early civilisation, long since overthrown and forgotten, cannot fail to excite interest and awaken reflection. They carry the mind back to the times "when the smoke of sacrifice rose from the Pantheon, and when camelopards and tigers bounded in the Flavian amphitheatre." And they also lead us to speculations of the future, till we wonder whether the traveller shall some day inspect, with unconcerned composure, the few scraps of stone and iron which may indicate the British occupation of India. Few, indeed, the remains would be—for we build for immediate use, not future ostentation in these days, and if we should ever cease to be a force in the world, all traces of us would soon be obliterated by time. Yet, perhaps, if that unborn critic of remote posterity would remember that "in the days of the old British," the rice crop had been more abundant, the number of acres under cultivation greater, the population larger and the death rate lower, than at any period in the history of India—we should not be without a monument more glorious than the pyramids.
The valley at Sarai is about two miles wide, and the mountains rise steeply from it. On every ridge, you can see the red brick ruins that were once homes to ancient Buddhists. These remnants of a long-gone civilization, which has been overthrown and forgotten, are sure to spark interest and reflection. They take us back to the times "when the smoke of sacrifice rose from the Pantheon, and when giraffes and tigers bounded in the Flavian amphitheater." They also make us think about the future, leading us to wonder if someday a traveler will casually examine the few scraps of stone and iron that might indicate the British occupation of India. There would indeed be few remnants—since we build for immediate use, not for future show, and if we were to ever lose our significance in the world, all traces of us would quickly disappear over time. Yet, perhaps if that future critic from a distant age remembers that "in the days of the old British," the rice crop was more abundant, the number of cultivated acres was greater, the population was larger, and the death rate was lower than at any other time in India's history—we might still have a monument more glorious than the pyramids.
We camped with the 2nd Brigade on the night of the 6th, and next morning, while the stars were still shining, resumed the march. Five miles from Sarai the road dwindles to a mule track, and henceforward is not fit for wheeled traffic. In spite of this, the 10th Field Battery had succeeded in getting their guns along it, and had brought them safely to Panjkora. But soldiers will accomplish a good deal to get nearer the enemy. The scenery before the gorge of the river is reached is gloomy, but grand. Great cliffs tower up precipitously on the further bank and the path is cut in the face of the rock. The river, which flows swiftly by, plunges into a narrow cleft about a mile below the bridge, and disappears among the mountains. It abounds in fish, but is rapid and dangerous, and while the troops were encamped near it, two gunners lost their lives by falling in, and being carried down. Indeed, watching the dead bodies of several camels being swept along, swirled around, and buffeted against the rocks, it was not hard to understand these accidents.
We camped with the 2nd Brigade on the night of the 6th, and the next morning, while the stars were still shining, we resumed our march. Five miles from Sarai, the road shrinks to a mule track, and from there on it's not suitable for vehicles. Still, the 10th Field Battery managed to get their guns along it and brought them safely to Panjkora. Soldiers will do a lot to get closer to the enemy. The scenery before reaching the river gorge is dark but impressive. Huge cliffs rise steeply on the opposite bank, and the path is carved into the rock face. The river flows quickly by, plunging into a narrow gap about a mile downstream from the bridge, disappearing among the mountains. It’s full of fish but is swift and dangerous. While the troops camped nearby, two gunners lost their lives after falling in and being swept away. In fact, watching several dead camels being carried along, tossed around, and slammed against the rocks made it clear how these accidents could happen.
At length, the bridge is reached. It is a frail structure, supported on wire ropes. At each end are gates, flanked by little mud towers. The battery was established on a knoll to the right, and the long muzzles of the guns peered through stone embrasures at the opposite hills. It was round the bases of these hills that much hard fighting took place in the Chitral campaign. About half a mile beyond the bridge, I was shown the place where the Guides had been so hard pressed, and for a whole night had had to stand at bay, their colonel killed, the bridge broken, and the river in flood, against the tribesmen in overwhelming numbers.
Finally, we reached the bridge. It’s a fragile structure, held up by wire ropes. On each end are gates, next to small mud towers. The battery was set up on a hill to the right, and the long barrels of the guns peeked through stone openings at the hills across from us. It was around the bases of these hills that a lot of intense fighting occurred during the Chitral campaign. About half a mile beyond the bridge, I was shown the spot where the Guides were under severe pressure and had to hold their ground all night, with their colonel killed, the bridge destroyed, and the river swollen, facing off against the tribesmen in overwhelming numbers.
The field telegraph stopped at the bridge-head, and a small tent with a half-dozen military operators marked the breaking of the slender thread that connected us, across thousands of miles of sea and land, with London. Henceforward a line of signal stations with their flickering helios would be the only links. We were at the end of the wire. I have often stood at the other and watched the tape machine click off the news as it arrives; the movements of the troops; the prospects of action; the fighting; the casualties. How different are the scenes. The club on an autumn evening—its members grouped anxiously around, discussing, wondering, asserting; the noise of the traffic outside; the cigarette smoke and electric lights within. And, only an hour away along the wire, the field, with the bright sunlight shining on the swirling muddy waters; the black forbidding rocks; the white tents of the brigade a mile up the valley; the long streak of vivid green rice crop by the river; and in the foreground the brown-clad armed men. I can never doubt which is the right end to be at. It is better to be making the news than taking it; to be an actor rather than a critic.
The field telegraph stopped at the bridge-head, and a small tent with a few military operators signaled the end of the slender thread that connected us, across thousands of miles of sea and land, with London. From now on, a line of signal stations with their flickering heliographs would be our only links. We were at the end of the wire. I've often stood at the other end and watched the tape machine click off updates as they come in: the movements of the troops, the chances of action, the fighting, the casualties. How different the scenes are. The club on an autumn evening—its members gathered anxiously, discussing, wondering, asserting; the noise of traffic outside; the cigarette smoke and electric lights inside. And just an hour away along the wire, the field, with bright sunlight shining on the swirling muddy waters; the dark, forbidding rocks; the white tents of the brigade a mile up the valley; the long patch of vivid green rice crop by the river; and in the foreground, the brown-clad armed men. I can never doubt which is the right side to be on. It's better to be making the news than receiving it; to be an actor rather than a critic.
To cross the bridge, it was necessary to dismount and lead the horses over in single file. Even then the swinging of the whole structure made it difficult to walk. The passage of the transport under such conditions occupied all the day, and the unfortunate officers in charge of the mule trains were working incessantly. The staff passed quickly, however, and riding on about a mile forded the tributary stream of the Jandol, and reached the camp at Kotkai about noon. Thence we proceeded on the following day to Ghosam, but as the road is uninteresting, and I am beginning to think the reader will readily excuse further description, we need not toil along it in the dust and the heat. The narration of the daily movements of troops, unmarked by variety of incident, is dull and wearying. Yet he who would obtain a true idea of the soldier's life on service, must mentally share the fatigues of the march and the monotony of the camp. The fine deeds, the thrilling moments of war, are but the high lights in a picture, of which the background is routine, hard work, and discomfort.
To cross the bridge, we had to get off our horses and lead them over one by one. Even then, the whole structure swayed, making it hard to walk. Getting the transport across took all day, and the poor officers overseeing the mule trains were working nonstop. However, the staff moved quickly, and after riding about a mile, we crossed the tributary stream of the Jandol and reached the camp at Kotkai around noon. We then continued to Ghosam the next day, but since the road was boring and I think the reader would appreciate skipping more details, we don’t need to drag through the dust and heat. Describing the daily movements of troops, lacking any interesting incidents, is dull and tiring. Yet anyone wanting a real sense of a soldier's life in service must mentally endure the exhaustion of the march and the repetitive nature of camp life. The brave acts and thrilling moments of war are just highlights in a picture, with the background made up of routine, hard work, and discomfort.
At Ghosam the 2nd Brigade remained until joined by the 3rd and pending negotiations between the political officers and the tribal Jirgahs.
At Ghosam, the 2nd Brigade stayed put until they were joined by the 3rd Brigade while waiting for negotiations between the political officers and the tribal Jirgahs.
The use of purely local terms in all writing is to be deprecated. Perhaps the reason that no popular history of India exists, is to be found in the outlandish names of the characters, and the other expressions with which the pages are sprinkled. In this account I have zealously tried to avoid the ugly jargon of a degraded language, and to minimise the use of native names. The term just employed has, however, been so freely used in the newspapers recently, that it is perhaps as well to explain its meaning. A Jirgah is a deputation of tribesmen. It does not necessarily represent the tribe. It may present—and very often does—a minority report. Occasionally it expresses the opinion only of its own members. What has been settled one day is therefore very often overruled the next. The Jirgah may accept terms of peace in the morning, and the camp may be rushed that night. These were, however, genuine, and spoke in the name and with the authority of the tribes. All day they kept arriving and squatting in rows before Major Deane's tent, to hear the Government terms. The chief condition imposed, was the surrender of rifles. A fixed number, based on calculation of wealth and population, was demanded from each clan. This method of punishment is peculiarly galling to people whose life is so full of war. No other course was, however, open but submission, and, promising that the terms should be complied with, the deputations departed. To stimulate their efforts and zeal in collecting their arms, the combined movements were delayed for three days, and the forces remained encamped at Ghosam, near Manda.
Using purely local terms in writing is not advisable. One possible reason there isn't a popular history of India is the strange names of the characters and the other unusual expressions found throughout the text. In this account, I've made a strong effort to avoid the awkward jargon of a degraded language and to limit the use of native names. However, the term I just used has been so frequently mentioned in the news lately that it’s probably a good idea to explain its meaning. A Jirgah is a group of tribesmen. It doesn't always represent the entire tribe. It can present—and often does—a minority opinion. Sometimes it only reflects the views of its own members. What is agreed on one day might easily be overturned the next. The Jirgah might accept peace terms in the morning, and then the camp could be attacked that night. However, these were genuine representatives, speaking on behalf of the tribes. All day, they arrived and sat in rows in front of Major Deane's tent to hear the government’s terms. The chief condition was the surrender of rifles. A specific number, determined by calculations of wealth and population, was required from each clan. This method of punishment is especially frustrating for people whose lives are filled with conflict. However, there was no option but to submit, and after promising that the terms would be met, the delegations left. To encourage their efforts in collecting their weapons, the combined movements were postponed for three days, and the forces stayed camped at Ghosam, near Manda.
I avail myself of this halt to touch, albeit with no little trepidation, the tangled and obscure subject of tribal politics in Dir and Bajaur. All the people, incited by their priests, are bitterly hostile to the British Government, except those benefited by the subsidies paid. They were now anxious to fight, and were only restrained by a fear which fury or fanaticism might at any moment overcome. Four principal khans exercise an authority which varies locally, from absolute dominion to a shadowy suzerainty, over the whole region. The Khan of Dir, the most important, is a Government nominee. He is supported by the British influence, and is, as I have already noticed, entrusted with the raising of Levies to protect and keep in repair the Chitral road. For these services he receives pay, and a certain allowance of arms and ammunition. His own subjects are strongly opposed to his rule from dislike of his British sympathies, and he only maintains himself by the assistance which the Government gives him in arms and money. In other words he is a puppet.
I take this pause to address, though with some anxiety, the complicated and unclear topic of tribal politics in Dir and Bajaur. The people, stirred up by their religious leaders, are strongly against the British Government, except for those who benefit from the government subsidies. They are eager to fight, held back only by a fear that could be easily overcome by rage or fanaticism. Four main khans have varying degrees of authority in the region, ranging from total control to mere symbolic power. The Khan of Dir, the most significant figure, is appointed by the Government. He is backed by British influence and, as I mentioned earlier, is responsible for organizing Levies to protect and maintain the Chitral road. For these duties, he receives a salary and a certain supply of weapons and ammunition. His own people strongly oppose his leadership due to his pro-British sentiments, and he only stays in power with the help of the arms and financial support provided by the Government. In other words, he is a puppet.
The Khan of Nawagai is constrained by fear to display a friendly attitude towards the Sirkar. His subjects resent this and his position is insecure. He receives some moral support from the British agents, and as his people are uncertain how far the Government would go to uphold him, and also as they partly realise his difficult position, they have hitherto submitted sullenly to his rule.
The Khan of Nawagai is held back by fear from showing a friendly attitude toward the Sirkar. His subjects are unhappy about this, and his position is unstable. He gets some moral support from British agents, and since his people aren't sure how far the Government will go to support him, and they also somewhat understand his tough situation, they've mostly accepted his rule with resentment.
The position and attitude of the Khan of Jar are similar, but he is a less influential chief. The fourth potentate, the Khan of Khar, is perhaps the most honest and trustworthy. He will appear in a later chapter, and the reader will have the opportunity of judging of his character from his conduct. Thus in these valleys, while the people are all hostile, their rulers find it expedient to preserve a friendly demeanour to the British, and for this they are hated by their subjects.
The position and attitude of the Khan of Jar are similar, but he is a less influential leader. The fourth ruler, the Khan of Khar, is possibly the most honest and trustworthy. He will appear in a later chapter, and the reader will have the chance to judge his character based on his actions. So in these valleys, even though people are all hostile, their leaders find it necessary to maintain a friendly attitude toward the British, which makes them hated by their subjects.
At this stage, the leader of the popular party claims attention. As is usual, he is out of office. After the Chitral expedition of 1895, Umra Khan was expelled from his territories, and escaped to Cabul. There he has remained. The Amir is under an obligation to the British Government to prevent his raising trouble in Bajaur. If the Amir desired war he would send Umra Khan back. This would create a strong faction throughout the whole country—but particularly in the Jandol, Salarzai and Mamund Valleys—hostile to the British and the friendly khans. The Amir hinted at this in a recent letter to the Government of India; and such a step would probably precede his declaration of war, or follow ours. The Afghan sovereign is, however, well aware that he has at present nothing to gain, and many things to lose, by provoking a war with the great power which gave him his throne and has since increased his revenue by subsidies. In the meanwhile, anxious to preserve his influence with the border tribes, and to impress the Indian Government with the fact that he could be a powerful foe, he keeps Umra Khan as a trump card, to be played when the occasion arises. That he may maintain his authority in Bajaur, the exiled khan is well supplied with funds, with which to arm and pay his retainers.
At this point, the leader of the popular party is grabbing attention. As usual, he is out of office. After the Chitral expedition of 1895, Umra Khan was kicked out of his territories and escaped to Kabul, where he has stayed. The Amir has a responsibility to the British Government to stop him from causing trouble in Bajaur. If the Amir wanted war, he would send Umra Khan back, which would create a strong faction across the country—especially in the Jandol, Salarzai, and Mamund Valleys—hostile to the British and the friendly khans. The Amir hinted at this in a recent letter to the Government of India; such a move would likely come before his declaration of war or after ours. However, the Afghan ruler knows he currently has nothing to gain and a lot to lose by starting a war with the great power that gave him his throne and has increased his revenue through subsidies. Meanwhile, eager to maintain his influence with the border tribes and to show the Indian Government that he could be a serious opponent, he keeps Umra Khan as a trump card to play when the time is right. To maintain his authority in Bajaur, the exiled khan is well-funded to arm and pay his followers.
The situation I have thus briefly described has been little altered by the operations with which future chapters are concerned. The friendly khans have been fortified in their allegiance and position by the military demonstration and by the severe punishment inflicted on those tribes who resisted. On the other hand, the hostility of the people has been not unnaturally increased by war, and one tribe in particular has gained a reputation for courage, which will give them the power to cause trouble in the future. I shall not, however, anticipate the tale.
The situation I've briefly described hasn't changed much with the events covered in the upcoming chapters. The supportive khans have strengthened their loyalty and status thanks to the military show of force and the harsh penalties imposed on the tribes that resisted. On the flip side, the people's animosity has understandably grown due to the war, and one tribe, in particular, has gained a reputation for bravery, which could lead to future conflicts. However, I won't spoil the story.
CHAPTER IX: RECONNAISSANCE
While the infantry of both brigades remained halted at Ghosam, near Manda, the cavalry made daily reconnaissances in all directions. Sometimes the object in view was topographical, sometimes military, and at others diplomatic, or to use the Indian application of the term, "political."
While the foot soldiers of both brigades stayed put at Ghosam, close to Manda, the cavalry conducted daily reconnaissance in all directions. Sometimes their goal was to gather information about the terrain, other times it was military-related, and at other times it was about diplomacy, or as it’s referred to in India, "political."
On the 10th, Major Deane visited the various chiefs in the Jandul Valley. I asked and obtained permission to accompany him. A change from the hot and dusty camp was agreeable to all who could be spared, and quite a party was formed, among whom were some whose names have occurred previously in these pages—Major Beatson, Major Hobday, and Lord Fincastle. A squadron of the 11th Bengal Lancers acted as escort.
On the 10th, Major Deane visited the different leaders in the Jandul Valley. I asked for and got permission to join him. Everyone who could get away was happy to escape the hot and dusty camp, and a bit of a group formed, including some familiar faces from earlier in this text—Major Beatson, Major Hobday, and Lord Fincastle. A squadron of the 11th Bengal Lancers provided an escort.
The valley of the Jandul is about eight miles long and perhaps half as broad. It opens out of the main valley, which extends from the Panjkora to Nawagai, and is on all other sides surrounded by high and precipitous mountains. The bed of the river, although at the time of our visit occupied only by a small stream, is nearly half a mile broad and bordered by rice fields, to which the water is conducted by many artfully contrived dykes and conduits. The plain itself is arid and sandy, but at the winter season yields a moderate crop. The presence of water below the surface is attested by numerous groves of chenar trees.
The Jandul valley is about eight miles long and roughly half that wide. It branches off from the main valley, which stretches from the Panjkora to Nawagai, and is surrounded on all sides by steep, high mountains. The riverbed, though only home to a small stream during our visit, is nearly half a mile wide and lined with rice fields that get their water from a network of cleverly designed dykes and channels. The plain itself is dry and sandy, but it produces a decent harvest in the winter season. The presence of water beneath the surface is indicated by numerous groves of chenar trees.
This valley may, in natural and political features, be taken as typical of the Afghan valleys. Seven separate castles formed the strongholds of seven separate khans. Some of these potentates had been implicated in the attack on the Malakand, and our visit to their fastnesses was not wholly of an amicable nature. They had all four days before been bound by the most sacred oaths to fight to the death. The great tribal combination had, however, broken up, and at the last moment they had decided upon peace. But the Pathan does nothing by halves. No black looks, no sullen reserve, marred the geniality of their welcome. As we approached the first fortified village the sovereign and his army rode out to meet us, and with many protestations of fidelity, expressed his joy at our safe arrival. He was a fine-looking man and sat well on a stamping roan stallion. His dress was imposing. A waistcoat of gorgeous crimson, thickly covered with gold lace, displayed flowing sleeves of white linen, buttoned at the wrist. Long, loose, baggy, linen trousers, also fastened above the ankle, and curiously pointed shoes clothed his nether limbs. This striking costume was completed by a small skull-cap, richly embroidered, and an ornamental sabre.
This valley represents the typical characteristics of Afghan valleys, both in nature and politics. Seven separate castles served as the strongholds of seven different khans. Some of these leaders had been involved in the attack on the Malakand, so our visit to their territories wasn’t entirely friendly. Four days earlier, they had all sworn sacred oaths to fight to the death. However, the large tribal alliance had fallen apart, and at the last moment, they chose to pursue peace instead. But the Pathan never does anything halfway. There were no scowls or sullen attitudes to dampen the warmth of their welcome. As we approached the first fortified village, the leader and his army came out to greet us, and with numerous declarations of loyalty, he expressed his happiness at our safe arrival. He was an impressive-looking man, sitting confidently on a stamping roan stallion. His outfit was striking. He wore a beautiful crimson waistcoat, heavily adorned with gold lace, showcasing flowing white linen sleeves that were buttoned at the wrist. His long, loose, baggy linen trousers were also secured above the ankle, along with notably pointed shoes. This eye-catching attire was finished off with a small, richly embroidered skull-cap and an ornamental sabre.
He sprang from his horse with grace and agility, to offer his sword to Major Deane, who bade him mount and ride with him. The army, four or five rascally-looking men on shaggy ponies, and armed with rifles of widely different patterns, followed at a distance. The fort was an enclosure about a hundred yards square. Its walls were perhaps twenty feet high and built of rough stones plastered together with mud and interspersed with courses of timber. All along the top was a row of loopholes. At each corner a tall flanking tower enfiladed the approaches. At the gate of this warlike residence some twenty or thirty tribesmen were gathered, headed by the khan's own cousin, an elderly man dressed in long white robes. All saluted us gravely. The escort closed up. A troop trotted off to the right out of the line fire of the fort. The advance scouts, passing round the walls, formed on the farther side. These matters of detail complied with, conversation began. It was conducted in Pushtu, and was naturally unintelligible to every one of our party except the two political officers. Apparently Major Deane reproached the two chiefs for their conduct. He accused them of having seized the bridge across the Panjkora and delivered the passage to the fanatic crowds that had gathered to attack the Malakand. This they admitted readily enough. "Well, why not?" said they; "there was a good fair fight." Now they would make peace. They bore no malice, why should the Sirkar?
He jumped off his horse with ease and style to hand his sword to Major Deane, who told him to get back on and ride with him. The army, consisting of four or five scruffy-looking men on shaggy ponies armed with various types of rifles, followed at a distance. The fort was an area about a hundred yards square. Its walls were around twenty feet high, made of rough stones held together with mud and mixed with wooden beams. Along the top, there was a row of slits. At each corner, a tall tower overlooked the approaches. At the entrance of this military stronghold, about twenty or thirty tribesmen were gathered, led by the khan's cousin, an older man in long white robes. They all greeted us seriously. The escort regrouped. A troop moved off to the right to avoid the fort's line of fire. The advance scouts went around the walls and gathered on the other side. With those details settled, conversation started. It was in Pushtu, so it was obviously incomprehensible to everyone in our group except the two political officers. Apparently, Major Deane reprimanded the two chiefs for their actions. He accused them of taking control of the bridge over the Panjkora and allowing the fanatical crowds to cross and attack the Malakand. They readily admitted to this. "Well, why not?" they said; "there was a good fair fight." Now they wanted to make peace. They held no grudges, so why should the Sirkar?
It was not, however, possible to accept this sportsmanlike view of the situation. They were asked where were the rifles they had been ordered to surrender. At this they looked blank. There were no rifles. There never had been any rifles. Let the soldiers search the fort and see for themselves. The order was given; three or four sowars drew their carbines, dismounted and entered the great and heavy gate, which had been suspiciously opened a little way.
It wasn't really possible to agree with that sportsmanlike perspective on things. They were asked where the rifles they were told to give up were. At this, they looked confused. There were no rifles. There had never been any rifles. Let the soldiers search the fort and find out for themselves. The order was given; three or four soldiers took out their carbines, got off their horses, and went through the large, heavy gate, which had been suspiciously opened a bit.
The gate gave access to a small courtyard, commanded on every side by an interior defence. In front was a large low room of uncertain dimensions: a kind of guard-house. It simply hummed with men. The outer walls were nearly five feet thick and would have resisted the fire of mountain guns. It was a strong place.
The gate led to a small courtyard, surrounded on all sides by an internal defense. In front was a large, low room of indeterminate size: a kind of guardhouse. It was buzzing with men. The outer walls were almost five feet thick and could have withstood fire from mountain guns. It was a solid stronghold.
The Lancers, accustomed to the operation of hunting for arms, hurriedly searched the likely and usual places, but without success. One thing, however, they noticed, which they immediately reported. There were no women and children in the fort. This had a sinister aspect. Our visit was unexpected and had taken them by surprise, but they were prepared for all emergencies. They had hidden their rifles and cleared for action.
The Lancers, used to hunting for weapons, quickly searched the usual spots but found nothing. However, they did notice one important thing, which they reported right away: there were no women or children in the fort. This was concerning. Our visit had caught them off guard, but they were ready for anything. They had stashed their rifles and were prepared for action.
The two chiefs smiled in superior virtue. Of course there were no rifles. But matters took, for them, an unexpected turn. They had no rifles—said Major Deane—very well, they should come themselves. He turned to an officer of the Lancers; a section rode forward and surrounded both men. Resistance was useless. Flight was impossible. They were prisoners. Yet they behaved with Oriental composure and calmly accepted the inevitable. They ordered their ponies and, mounting, rode behind us under escort.
The two chiefs smiled with a sense of superiority. Of course, there were no rifles. But things took an unexpected turn for them. They had no rifles—Major Deane said—so they would come themselves. He turned to an officer of the Lancers; a group rode forward and surrounded both men. Resistance was pointless. Escape was impossible. They were prisoners. Still, they maintained their calm and accepted the situation with dignity. They called for their ponies and, once mounted, rode behind us under guard.
We pursued our way up the valley. As we approached each fort, a khan and his retainers advanced and greeted us. Against these there was no definite charge, and the relations throughout were amicable. At the head of the valley is Barwa, the home of the most powerful of these princelets. This fort had belonged to Umra Khan, and attested, by superiority of construction, the intellectual development of that remarkable man. After the Chitral expedition it had been given by the Government to its present owner, who, bitterly hated by the other chieftains of the valley, his near relatives mostly, had no choice but loyalty to the British. He received us with courtesy and invited us to enter and see the fort. This, after taking all precautions and posting sentries, we did. It was the best specimen of Afghan architecture I have seen. In this very fort Lieutenants Fowler and Edwards were confined in 1895, when the prisoners of Umra Khan. The new chief showed their room which opened on a balcony, whence a fine view of the whole valley could be obtained. There are many worse places of durance. The fort is carefully defended and completely commands the various approaches. Judicious arrangements of loopholes and towers cover all dead ground. Inside the walls galleries of brushwood enabled the defenders to fire without exposing themselves. In the middle is the keep, which, if Fortune were adverse, would be the last stronghold of the garrison.
We made our way up the valley. As we got closer to each fort, a khan and his attendants came forward to greet us. There was no formal conflict here, and the relationships between everyone were friendly. At the end of the valley is Barwa, the home of the most powerful of these local rulers. This fort used to belong to Umra Khan, and its superior construction showcases the remarkable intellect of that man. After the Chitral expedition, the Government handed it over to its current owner, who, despised by the other chieftains of the valley, mostly his own relatives, had no choice but to remain loyal to the British. He welcomed us with courtesy and invited us to enter and explore the fort. After taking all necessary precautions and posting sentries, we did just that. It was the best example of Afghan architecture I had ever seen. In this very fort, Lieutenants Fowler and Edwards were held captive in 1895, when they were prisoners of Umra Khan. The new chief showed us their room, which opened onto a balcony with a stunning view of the entire valley. There are far worse places for confinement. The fort is well-defended and completely controls the various approaches. Smartly placed loopholes and towers cover all blind spots. Inside the walls, galleries made of brushwood allowed the defenders to shoot without exposing themselves. In the center is the keep, which, if things went badly, would be the last refuge of the garrison.
What a strange system of society is disclosed by all this! Here was this man, his back against the mountains, maintaining himself against the rest of the valley, against all his kin, with the fear of death and the chances of war ever in his mind, and holding his own, partly by force of arms, partly by the support of the British agents, and partly through the incessant feuds of his adversaries.
What a strange social system is revealed by all this! Here was this man, his back against the mountains, standing his ground against the rest of the valley, against all his relatives, with the fear of death and the risks of war constantly on his mind, and holding his own, partly by the use of force, partly through the backing of the British agents, and partly through the endless feuds of his enemies.
It is "all against all," in these valleys. The two khans who had been arrested would have fled to the hills. They knew they were to be punished. Still they dared not leave their stronghold. A neighbour, a relation, a brother perhaps, would step into the unguarded keep and hold it for his own. Every stone of these forts is blood-stained with treachery; each acre of ground the scene of a murder. In Barwa itself, Umra Khan slew his brother, not in hot anger or open war, but coldly and deliberately from behind. Thus he obtained power, and the moralist might observe with a shudder, that but for the "Forward Policy" he would probably be in full enjoyment to-day. This Umra Khan was a man of much talent, a man intellectually a head and shoulders above his countrymen. He was a great man, which on the frontier means that he was a great murderer, and might have accomplished much with the quick-firing guns he was negotiating for, and the troops he was drilling "on the European model." The career of this Afghan Napoleon was cut short, however, by the intervention of Providence in the guise or disguise of the Indian Government. He might have been made use of. People who know the frontier well, say that a strong man who has felt the grip of the British power is the best tool to work with, and that if Umra Khan, humbled and overawed, had been reinstated, he might have done much to maintain law and order. As long as they fight, these Afghans do not mind much on which side they fight. There are worse men and worse allies helping us to-day. The unpractical may wonder why we, a people who fill some considerable place in the world, should mix in the petty intrigues of these border chieftains, or soil our hands by using such tools at all. Is it fitting that Great Britain should play off one brutal khan against his neighbours, or balance one barbarous tribe against another? It is as much below our Imperial dignity, as it would be for a millionaire to count the lumps in the sugar-basin. If it be necessary for the safety of our possessions that these territories should be occupied, it would be more agreeable to our self-respect that we should take them with a strong hand. It would be more dignified, but nothing costs more to keep up than dignity, and it is perhaps because we have always been guided by sound commercial principles in this respect that we have attained our present proud position.
It's "every person for themselves" in these valleys. The two khans who were arrested would have escaped to the hills. They knew punishment awaited them. Yet, they didn’t dare leave their stronghold. A neighbor, a relative, or perhaps even a brother could easily take over the unguarded fort for themselves. Every stone of these forts is stained with betrayal; every acre of land has witnessed murder. In Barwa itself, Umra Khan killed his brother, not out of rage or in open conflict, but coldly and deliberately from behind. This is how he gained power, and a moralist might shudder at the thought that without the "Forward Policy," he would likely be in full control today. Umra Khan was a man of considerable talent, intellectually far superior to his fellow countrymen. He was a significant figure, which on the frontier means he was a great murderer, and he could have achieved much with the rapid-fire guns he was trying to acquire and the troops he was training "in the European style." However, his ambitions were cut short by the intervention of Providence, disguised as the Indian Government. He could have been useful. Those familiar with the frontier say that a strong leader who understands British authority is the best tool to have, and if Umra Khan had been humbled and reinstated, he could have done much to maintain law and order. As long as they’re fighting, these Afghans don’t care much which side they’re on. There are worse individuals and worse allies supporting us today. The unworldly might wonder why we, a nation with a significant place in the world, should involve ourselves in the petty schemes of these border leaders, or sully our hands by using such means at all. Is it appropriate for Great Britain to play one ruthless khan against another, or to balance one savage tribe against another? It’s as beneath our Imperial dignity as it would be for a millionaire to count the lumps in his sugar bowl. If it’s necessary for the safety of our territories to occupy these lands, it would be more in line with our self-respect to take them firmly. It would be more dignified, but nothing is more costly to maintain than dignity, and perhaps because we have always been guided by sound commercial principles in this regard, we have achieved our current esteemed position.
After looking round the fortress and admiring the skill and knowledge with which it was built, we were conducted by the khan to the shade of some beautiful chenar trees, which grew near a little spring not far from the walls of the fort. Here were a number of charpoys, or native bedsteads, very comfortable, but usually full of bugs, and on these we sat.
After exploring the fortress and appreciating the skill and knowledge that went into its construction, the khan led us to the shade of some beautiful chenar trees near a small spring not far from the fort walls. There were several charpoys, or traditional beds, which were quite comfortable but usually infested with bugs, and we sat down on these.
Remembering Maizar, and many other incidents of frontier hospitality, sentries were posted on all the approaches and a sufficient guard kept under arms. Then we had breakfast—a most excellent breakfast.
Remembering Maizar and many other instances of hospitality on the frontier, we stationed sentries at all entrances and kept a solid guard on duty. Then we had breakfast—a really great breakfast.
The arrangements for the comfort and convenience of the troops of the Frontier Force are unequalled. They live more pleasantly and with less discomfort on active service than does a British regiment at the Aldershot manoeuvres. Whether the march be long or short, peaceful or opposed, whether the action be successful or the reverse, their commissariat never fails. In fact it is only just to say that they have always lances and bullets for an enemy, and sandwiches and "pegs" for a friend.
The arrangements for the comfort and convenience of the Frontier Force troops are unmatched. They live more comfortably and with less hassle on active duty than a British regiment at the Aldershot exercises. Whether the march is long or short, peaceful or challenging, whether the mission is successful or not, their supplies always come through. In fact, it's fair to say that they always have lances and bullets for an enemy, and sandwiches and drinks for a friend.
On this occasion, our provisions were supplemented by the hospitality of the khan. A long row of men appeared, each laden with food. Some carried fruit,—pears or apples; others piles of chupatties, or dishes of pillau.
On this occasion, our supplies were boosted by the generosity of the khan. A long line of men showed up, each carrying food. Some brought fruit—pears or apples; others carried stacks of flatbreads or platters of pilaf.
Nor were our troopers forgotten. The Mahommedans among them eagerly accepted the proffered food. But the Sikhs maintained a remorseful silence and declined it. They could not eat what had been prepared by Mussulman hands, and so they sat gazing wistfully at the appetising dishes, and contented themselves with a little fruit.
Nor were our soldiers forgotten. The Muslims among them eagerly accepted the offered food. But the Sikhs kept a regretful silence and turned it down. They couldn’t eat what had been prepared by Muslim hands, so they sat looking longingly at the tempting dishes and made do with a bit of fruit.
Very austere and admirable they looked, almost painfully conscious of their superior virtue. But I could not help thinking that had we not been spectators the chenar trees might have witnessed the triumph of reason over religious prejudice.
They looked very serious and impressive, almost painfully aware of their own superior virtue. But I couldn’t help thinking that if we hadn’t been watching, the chenar trees might have seen reason win out over religious bias.
During the heat of the day we rested in this pleasant grove, and with sleep and conversation passed the hours away, while the sentries pacing to and fro alone disturbed the illusion that this was some picnic party in a more propitious land. Then, as the shadows lengthened, we started upon our return to camp.
During the heat of the day, we took a break in this nice grove, and with sleep and chatting, we spent the hours, while the sentries walking back and forth were the only ones to break the illusion that this was some picnic in a nicer place. Then, as the shadows got longer, we began our trip back to camp.
On arriving, the political officers were pleased, and the soldiers disappointed, to find that the tribesmen were determined to accept the Government terms. A hundred rifles from the Utman Khels had already been surrendered, and now lay outside Major Deane's tent, surrounded by a crowd of officers, who were busily engaged in examining them.
Upon arrival, the political officers were satisfied, while the soldiers were let down to see that the tribesmen were set on accepting the Government's terms. A hundred rifles from the Utman Khels had already been handed over and now rested outside Major Deane's tent, surrounded by a group of officers who were eagerly inspecting them.
Opinion is divided, and practice has followed opinion as to whether, in a tale of travel or of war, it is preferable to intersperse the narrative with conclusions and discussions, or to collect them all in a final chapter. I shall unhesitatingly embrace the former method. The story shall be told as it happened, and the reader's attention will be directed to such considerations and reflections as arise by the way. It will therefore be convenient to make a digression into the question of the supply of arms to the frontier tribes, while a hundred rifles, probably a representative hundred, are piled in the main street of the camp at Ghosam.
Opinions are mixed, and practice has followed suit regarding whether, in a story about travel or war, it's better to mix the narrative with conclusions and discussions or to save them all for a final chapter. I will confidently choose the first approach. The story will be told as it unfolded, and the reader's attention will be drawn to the thoughts and reflections that come up along the way. Therefore, it will be useful to take a moment to discuss the issue of supplying arms to the frontier tribes while a hundred rifles, likely a representative number, are stacked in the main street of the camp at Ghosam.
The perpetual state of intestine war, in which the border peoples live, naturally creates a keen demand for deadly weapons. A good Martini-Henry rifle will always command a price in these parts of Rs.400 or about 25 British pounds. As the actual value of such a rifle does not exceed Rs.50, it is evident that a very large margin of profit accrues to the enterprising trader. All along the frontier, and from far down into India, rifles are stolen by expert and cunning thieves. One tribe, the Ut Khels, who live in the Laghman Valley, have made the traffic in arms their especial business. Their thieves are the most daring and their agents the most cunning. Some of their methods are highly ingenious. One story is worth repeating. A coffin was presented for railway transport. The relatives of the deceased accompanied it. The dead man, they said, had desired to be buried across the frontier. The smell proclaimed the corpse to be in an advanced state of decomposition. The railway officials afforded every facility for the passage of so unpleasant an object. No one checked its progress. It was unapproachable. It was only when coffin and mourners were safe across the frontier that the police were informed that a dozen rifles had been concealed in the coffin, and that the corpse was represented by a quarter of "well hung" beef!
The ongoing civil conflict, where the border communities reside, creates a constant demand for lethal weapons. A decent Martini-Henry rifle can always sell for around Rs.400 or about 25 British pounds in this region. Since the actual value of such a rifle is only around Rs.50, it's clear that a huge profit goes to the enterprising dealer. All along the border and deep into India, rifles are stolen by skilled and crafty thieves. One tribe, the Ut Khels, who live in the Laghman Valley, have made arms trafficking their main business. Their thieves are the boldest, and their agents are the smartest. Some of their techniques are quite clever. One story is worth sharing. A coffin was sent for railway transport. The relatives of the deceased went along with it, claiming the deceased wished to be buried across the border. The smell revealed that the corpse was in an advanced state of decay. The railway officials provided every assistance for the journey of such an unpleasant item. No one questioned its passage; it was off-limits. It was only once the coffin and mourners were safely over the border that the police were alerted that a dozen rifles had been hidden in the coffin, and that the corpse was actually a quarter of "well-hung" beef!
I regret to have to state, that theft is not the only means by which the frontier tribes obtain weapons. Of a hundred rifles, which the Utman Khels had surrendered, nearly a third were condemned Government Martinis, and displayed the Government stamp. Now no such rifles are supposed to exist. As soon as they are condemned, the arsenal authorities are responsible that they are destroyed, and this is in every case carried out under European supervision. The fact, that such rifles are not destroyed and are found in the possession of trans-frontier tribesmen, points to a very grave instance of dishonest and illegal traffic being carried on by some person connected with the arsenal. It need hardly be said that a searching inquiry was instituted.
I regret to say that theft isn’t the only way the frontier tribes get weapons. Out of a hundred rifles that the Utman Khels turned in, nearly a third were government-condemned Martinis and had the government stamp on them. Officially, no such rifles should exist anymore. Once they’re condemned, the arsenal authorities are supposed to destroy them, and this process is always done under European supervision. The fact that these rifles aren’t destroyed and are found in the hands of tribal members across the border indicates a serious instance of dishonest and illegal trafficking by someone connected to the arsenal. It goes without saying that a thorough investigation was launched.
Another point connected with these rifles is that even when they have been officially destroyed, by cutting them in three pieces, the fractions have a marketable value. Several were shown me which had been rejoined by the tribesmen. These were, of course, very dangerous weapons indeed. The rest of the hundred had strange tales to tell. Two or three were Russian military rifles, stolen probably from the distant posts in Central Asia. One was a Snider, taken at Maiwand, and bearing the number of the ill-fated regiment to which it had belonged. Some had come from Europe, perhaps overland through Arabia and Persia; others from the arms factory at Cabul. It was a strange instance of the tireless efforts of Supply to meet Demand.
Another point related to these rifles is that even when they have been officially destroyed by cutting them into three pieces, the parts still have a marketable value. I was shown several that had been reassembled by the tribesmen. These were, of course, very dangerous weapons. The rest of the hundred had strange stories to tell. Two or three were Russian military rifles, likely stolen from distant posts in Central Asia. One was a Snider, taken at Maiwand, and showing the number of the doomed regiment it once belonged to. Some had come from Europe, possibly traveling overland through Arabia and Persia; others were from the arms factory in Kabul. It was a strange example of the relentless efforts of Supply to meet Demand.
The importance of the arms question cannot be exaggerated. The long-range rifle fire, which has characterised the great frontier war, is a new feature. Hitherto our troops have had to face bold sword charges but comparatively little firing. Against the former, modern weapons are effective. But no discipline and no efficiency can stop bullets hitting men. This is a small part of the question. In the matter of fighting, what is good enough for the tribesmen should be good enough for the soldier. A more serious consideration is raised than that of casualties, which are after all only the inseparable concomitant of glory. Transport in mountainous countries depends entirely on mules and camels. A great number are needed even to supply one brigade. At night these animals have to be packed closely in an entrenched camp. It is not possible to find camping grounds in the valleys which are not commanded by some hill or assailable from some nullah. It is dangerous to put out pickets, as they may be "rushed" or, in the event of a severe attack, shot down, by the fire of their main body. [This applies to Swat and Bajaur, where the sword charge is still to be apprehended.] The result is that the transport animals must be exposed to long-range fire at night. The reader will observe, as the account proceeds, that on two occasions a large number of transport mules were killed in this way. When a certain number are killed, a brigade is as helpless as a locomotive without coal. It cannot move. Unless it be assisted it must starve. Every year the tribesmen will become better marksmen, more completely armed with better rifles. If they recognise the policy of continually firing at our animals, they may bring all operations to a standstill. And so by this road I reach the conclusion that whatever is to be done on the frontier, should be done as quickly as possible. But to return to the story.
The significance of the arms issue can't be overstated. The long-range rifle fire that has defined the major frontier war is a new element. Until now, our troops have primarily faced daring sword charges but not a lot of gunfire. Modern weapons work well against the former, but no amount of training or skill can prevent bullets from hitting soldiers. This is just one aspect of the issue. When it comes to fighting, what works for the tribesmen should work for the soldiers too. However, there's a more serious concern than casualties, which are an unavoidable part of glory. Transport in mountainous regions relies entirely on mules and camels. A large number are needed just to support one brigade. At night, these animals have to be tightly packed into a fortified camp. It's impossible to find camping spots in the valleys that aren't overlooked by some hillside or vulnerable from some ravine. It's risky to set up pickets because they could be "rushed" or, during a heavy attack, shot down by fire from the main group. [This is true for Swat and Bajaur, where sword charges are still a threat.] As a result, the transport animals are left exposed to long-range fire at night. As the story unfolds, the reader will notice that on two occasions, many transport mules were killed this way. When a certain number are lost, a brigade is as helpless as a train without coal. It can't move. If it doesn't get help, it will starve. Each year, the tribesmen will become better marksmen and more fully armed with superior rifles. If they recognize the strategy of continuously shooting at our animals, they could halt all operations. Thus, I conclude that whatever needs to be done on the frontier should be executed as quickly as possible. But let's return to the narrative.
The next day, the 11th of September, the troops remained halted at Ghosam, and another squadron was ordered to escort the Intelligence Officer, Captain H.E. Stanton, D.S.O., while making a topographical reconnaissance of the passes into the Utman Khel country. The opportunity of making fresh maps and of adding to and correcting the detail of existing maps only occurs when troops are passing through the country, and must not be neglected. The route lay up the main valley which leads to Nawagei. We started early, but the way was long and the sun high before we reached the entrance of the pass. The landscape was one of the strangest I shall ever see. On the opposite bank of the river were the dwellings of the Utman Khels, and in an area seven miles by three, I counted forty-six separate castles, complete with moats, towers and turrets. The impression produced was extraordinary. It suggested Grimm's fairy tales. It almost seemed as if we had left the natural earth and strayed into some strange domain of fancy, the resort of giants or ogres.
The next day, September 11th, the troops stayed put at Ghosam, and another squad was assigned to accompany the Intelligence Officer, Captain H.E. Stanton, D.S.O., while he conducted a topographical survey of the passes into the Utman Khel territory. The chance to create new maps and update existing ones only arises when troops are moving through an area, and it shouldn’t be missed. The route led up the main valley toward Nawagei. We set off early, but the journey was long and the sun was high by the time we reached the entrance of the pass. The scenery was some of the strangest I’ve ever seen. On the opposite bank of the river were the homes of the Utman Khels, and in a stretch of land measuring seven miles by three, I counted forty-six separate castles, complete with moats, towers, and turrets. The impact was remarkable. It felt like something out of Grimm's fairy tales. It almost seemed like we had left the real world and wandered into some bizarre realm of imagination, somewhere inhabited by giants or ogres.
To reach the pass, we were compelled to traverse a large village, and as the situation in the narrow, winding streets was about as awkward for cavalry as could be imagined, every possible precaution was taken to guard against attack. At length the squadron passed safely through and formed up on the farther side. The steep ascent to the passes became visible. As there were two routes to be reconnoitered, the party was divided, and after a hasty breakfast we commenced the climb. For a considerable distance it was possible to ride. At every difficult turn of the track sowars were posted to secure the retreat, if it should be necessary to come back in a hurry. The head man of the village furnished a guide, a cheery and amusing fellow, who professed much solicitude for our safety. But no reliance could be placed on these people, and on the opposite side of the valley numerous figures could be seen moving along and keeping pace with our advancing party. At length the horses and the greater part of the escort had to be abandoned. I accompanied Captain Stanton, and Captain Cole, who commanded the squadron and was also Reuter's correspondent, with a couple of troopers to the top of the pass. The day was intensely hot, and the arduous climb excited a thirst which there was nothing to allay. At length we gained the summit, and stood on the Kotal.
To reach the pass, we had to go through a large village, and since the narrow, winding streets were pretty tough for cavalry, we took every possible precaution to avoid an attack. Eventually, the squadron made it through safely and lined up on the other side. The steep climb to the passes came into view. Since there were two routes to check out, we split up the group, and after a quick breakfast, we started the ascent. For quite a distance, we could ride. At each tricky turn in the path, sowars were stationed to ensure a quick retreat if needed. The village head provided a guide, a cheerful and funny guy who seemed really concerned about our safety. But we couldn’t really trust these locals, and on the other side of the valley, we could see a lot of figures moving along, matching our pace. Eventually, we had to leave the horses and most of the escort behind. I went with Captain Stanton and Captain Cole, who led the squadron and also worked as Reuter's correspondent, along with a couple of troopers to the top of the pass. The day was scorching, and the tough climb made us extremely thirsty with nothing to quench it. Finally, we reached the summit and stood at the Kotal.
Far below us was a valley, into which perhaps no white man had looked since Alexander crossed the mountains on his march to India. Numerous villages lay dotted about in its depths, while others nestled against the hills. Isolated forts were distinguishable, while large trees showed there was no lack of water. It was a view that repaid the exertions of the climb, even if it did not quench the thirst they had excited.
Far below us was a valley that probably no white man had seen since Alexander crossed the mountains on his way to India. Numerous villages were scattered throughout its depths, while others were tucked against the hills. Isolated forts were visible, and the large trees indicated that there was plenty of water. It was a view that made the effort of the climb worthwhile, even if it didn’t satisfy the thirst it had created.
While Captain Stanton was making his sketch,—one of those useful view-sketches, now taking the place of all others, in rapid cavalry reconnaissance, we amused our fancy by naming the drinks we should order, were a nice, clean European waiter at hand to get them. I forget what my selection was, but it was something very long and very cold. Alas! how far imagination lags behind reality. The vivid impressions which we conjured up—the deep glasses, and the clinking ice—did little to dissipate the feelings of discomfort.
While Captain Stanton was sketching—one of those practical view-sketches now replacing all others in quick cavalry reconnaissance—we entertained ourselves by naming the drinks we would order if we had a nice, clean European waiter to bring them. I can't remember what I chose, but it was something very long and very cold. Unfortunately, imagination falls short of reality. The vivid images we created—the tall glasses and the clinking ice—did little to ease our discomfort.
Our guide meanwhile squatted on the ground and pronounced the names of all the villages, as each one was pointed at. To make sure there was no mistake, the series of questions was repeated. This time he gave to each an entirely different name with an appearance of great confidence and pride. However, one unpronounceable name is as good as another, and the villages of the valley will go down to official history, christened at the caprice of a peasant. But perhaps many records, now accepted as beyond dispute, are derived from such a slender authority.
Our guide squatted on the ground and stated the names of all the villages as he pointed to each one. To ensure there were no mistakes, he repeated the series of questions. This time, he assigned each village a completely different name with a show of great confidence and pride. However, one unpronounceable name is just as good as another, and the villages in the valley will be recorded in official history, named at the whim of a peasant. But maybe many records, now considered undisputed, come from such a fragile source.
The sketch finished, we commenced the descent and reached our horses without incident. The squadron concentrated near the village, and we heard that the other sketching party had met with more adventures than had fallen to our lot.
The sketch completed, we began our descent and arrived at our horses without any trouble. The squadron gathered near the village, and we learned that the other sketching group had experienced more adventures than we had.
It was commanded by Lieutenant Hesketh, a young officer, who was severely wounded at the storming of the Malakand Pass in 1895, and who, having again volunteered for active service, was attached to the 11th Bengal Lancers. At the foot of the pass he dismounted his troop and, taking a few men with him, began the climb. The pass was occupied by tribesmen, who threatened to fire on the party if they advanced farther. The subaltern replied, that he only wished to see the country on the other side and did not intend to harm any one. At the same time he pursued his way and the tribesmen, not wishing to bring matters to a crisis, fell back slowly, repeatedly taking aim, but never daring to fire. He reached the top of the pass and Captain Walters, the Assistant Intelligence Officer, was able to make a most valuable sketch of the country beyond. It was a bold act and succeeded more through its boldness than from any other cause; for, had the tribesmen once opened fire, very few of the party could have got down alive. Making a detour to avoid the village, which it was undesirable to traverse a second time, the squadron returned and arrived at the camp at Ghosam as the sun was setting.
It was led by Lieutenant Hesketh, a young officer who had been seriously injured during the attack on the Malakand Pass in 1895. After volunteering for active duty again, he was assigned to the 11th Bengal Lancers. At the base of the pass, he got off his horse and, taking a few men with him, began the ascent. The pass was held by tribesmen, who threatened to shoot if they moved closer. The young officer replied that he only wanted to see the land on the other side and had no intention of harming anyone. As he continued on, the tribesmen, not wanting to escalate the situation, slowly retreated, repeatedly aiming their weapons but never firing. He made it to the top of the pass, and Captain Walters, the Assistant Intelligence Officer, was able to create a highly valuable sketch of the area beyond. It was a daring move that worked more because of its audacity than anything else; had the tribesmen opened fire, very few from the group would have made it back alive. To avoid passing through the village again, which was not advisable, the squadron took a different route and returned to the camp at Ghosam just as the sun was setting.
The service camp of an Anglo-Indian brigade is arranged on regular principles. The infantry and guns are extended in the form of a square. The animals and cavalry are placed inside. In the middle is the camp of the Headquarters staff, with the tent of the brigadier facing that of the general commanding the division. All around the perimeter a parapet is built, varying in height according to the proximity and activity of the enemy. This parapet not only affords cover from random shots, but also makes a line for the men to form on in case of a sudden attack. Behind it the infantry lie down to sleep, a section of each company, as an inlying picket, dressed and accoutred. Their rifles are often laid along the low wall with the bayonets ready fixed. If cavalry have to be used in holding part of the defences, their lances can be arranged in the same way. Sentries every twenty-five yards surround the camp with a line of watchers.
The service camp of an Anglo-Indian brigade is set up according to specific principles. The infantry and artillery are arranged in a square formation. The animals and cavalry are positioned inside. In the center is the camp for the Headquarters staff, with the brigadier's tent facing that of the division's commanding general. Around the perimeter, a parapet is constructed, varying in height depending on the distance and activity of the enemy. This parapet offers protection from stray bullets and also serves as a guide for the men to form a line in case of an sudden attack. Behind it, the infantry lie down to sleep, with a section from each company serving as an inlying picket, fully dressed and equipped. Their rifles are often placed along the low wall with bayonets fixed. If cavalry need to defend part of the perimeter, their lances can be arranged similarly. Sentries are positioned every twenty-five yards around the camp, forming a line of watchers.
To view the scene by moonlight is alone an experience which would repay much travelling. The fires have sunk to red, glowing specks. The bayonets glisten in a regular line of blue-white points. The silence of weariness is broken by the incessant and uneasy shuffling of the animals and the occasional neighing of the horses. All the valley is plunged in gloom and the mountains rise high and black around. Far up their sides, the twinkling watch-fires of the tribesmen can be seen. Overhead is the starry sky, bathed in the pale radiance of the moon. It is a spectacle that may inspire the philosopher no less than the artist. The camp is full of subdued noises. Here is no place for reflection, for quiet or solemn thought. The day may have been an exciting one. The morrow may bring an action. Some may be killed, but in war-time life is only lived in the present. It is sufficient to be tired and to have time to rest, and the camp, if all the various items that compose it can be said to have a personality, shrugs its shoulders and, regarding the past without regret, contemplates the future without alarm.
Seeing the scene by moonlight is truly an experience worth traveling for. The fires have dimmed to glowing red spots. The bayonets shine in a regular line of blue-white points. The silence of exhaustion is interrupted by the constant, restless movement of the animals and the occasional whinnying of the horses. The whole valley is shrouded in darkness, with the mountains looming high and black around us. Far up their slopes, the twinkling campfires of the tribesmen can be spotted. Above, the sky is filled with stars, illuminated by the soft glow of the moon. It’s a sight that can inspire both philosophers and artists. The camp is filled with quiet sounds. This isn’t a place for reflection, quiet, or serious thought. The day may have been thrilling. Tomorrow might bring a battle. Some may fall, but in wartime, life is only lived in the moment. It’s enough to be tired and to take a break, and the camp, if all its various elements can be thought of as having a personality, shrugs off the past without regret and looks toward the future without fear.
CHAPTER X: THE MARCH TO NAWAGAI
After considering such maps and information as to the nature of the country as were available, Sir Bindon Blood decided to enter the territories of the Mohmands by two routes. (1) The 3rd Brigade through the pass of Nawagai. (2) The 2nd Brigade over the Rambat Pass. This would sweep the country more thoroughly, and afford increased facilities for drawing supplies. As the 3rd Brigade had a greater distance to cover, it passed in front of the 2nd, and on the 12th of September, by a march of twelve miles, reached Shumshuk. The 2nd Brigade, which had hitherto been leading, moved by an easy stage of seven miles to Jar, and there camped within supporting distance.
After reviewing the maps and information about the area's characteristics that were available, Sir Bindon Blood decided to enter the Mohmand territories via two routes. (1) The 3rd Brigade would go through the Nawagai pass. (2) The 2nd Brigade would take the Rambat Pass. This approach would cover the area more thoroughly and make it easier to gather supplies. Since the 3rd Brigade had to cover a longer distance, it moved ahead of the 2nd Brigade and reached Shumshuk after a twelve-mile march on September 12th. The 2nd Brigade, which had been leading until then, made an easy seven-mile journey to Jar, where they camped within supporting distance.
The Headquarters staff was now transferred to the 3rd Brigade and marched with them. The road lay for the first five or six miles over the ground, which the cavalry had reconnoitered the day before. Again all were struck by the great array of castles on the Utman Khel side of the valley. Many eager spirits would have liked to stop and blow up some of these fine places. But the Government terms had been complied with and the columns moved slowly by, eyeing the forts, which were covered with the white and blue clad figures of their defenders, with a sour disdain.
The Headquarters staff was now assigned to the 3rd Brigade and marched alongside them. The road for the first five or six miles was over the ground that the cavalry had surveyed the day before. Once again, everyone was struck by the impressive line of castles on the Utman Khel side of the valley. Many eager soldiers wished they could stop and blow up some of these impressive structures. However, the government’s terms had been met, and the columns moved slowly past, looking at the forts, which were manned by defenders dressed in white and blue, with a sense of contempt.
After riding for a couple of hours, the staff halted for breakfast under a shady tree by the banks of a clear and rapid stream.
After riding for a couple of hours, the team stopped for breakfast under a shady tree by the banks of a clear and fast-flowing stream.
Two hundred yards away we observed a large flight of teal sitting tamely on the water. Every one became interested. Rifles there were in plenty; but where could a gun be found? Rigorous and hasty search was made. The political officer of the force, Mr. Davis, being consulted, eventually produced a friendly khan, who was the owner of a shot gun. After further delay this weapon was brought. The teal still floated unconcernedly on the water. A gun awakened no sense of danger. Shots in plenty they had heard in the valley, but they were not usually fired at birds. The exciting moment now arrived. Who should shoot? The responsibility was great. Many refused. At length Veterinary-Captain Mann, who was wounded a few days later at Nawagai, volunteered. He took the gun and began a painful stalk. He crawled along cautiously. We watched with suppressed emotion. Suddenly two shots rang out. They were to be the first of many. The men in the marching column 200 yards away became wide awake. The teal rose hurriedly and flew away, but four remained behind, killed or wounded. These birds we picked up with a satisfaction which was fully justified by their excellence that night at dinner.
Two hundred yards away, we spotted a large group of teal resting peacefully on the water. Everyone became interested. We had plenty of rifles, but no one could find a shotgun. A swift and thorough search was conducted. The political officer of the group, Mr. Davis, was consulted and eventually located a friendly khan who owned a shotgun. After a bit more waiting, the weapon was brought to us. The teal continued to float calmly on the water, showing no fear. They had heard gunshots in the valley, but those were rarely aimed at birds. The thrilling moment finally arrived. Who would take the shot? The pressure was high, and many hesitated. Finally, Veterinary-Captain Mann, who would be wounded a few days later at Nawagai, stepped up. He took the gun and began a careful approach. He crawled along slowly. We watched with held breath. Suddenly, two shots rang out. They would be the first of many. The men in the marching column 200 yards away snapped to attention. The teal took off in a panic, but four stayed behind, either dead or injured. We collected these birds with a satisfaction that was entirely justified by how well they tasted at dinner that night.
Another mile or so brought us to the Watelai River, a stream about thirty yards broad, which flows into the Jandul, and thence into the Panjkora. Crossing this and climbing the opposite bank, the troops debouched on to the wide level plateau of Khar, perhaps ten miles across and sixteen in length. Standing on the high ground, the great dimensions of the valley were displayed. Looking westward it was possible to see the hills behind the Panjkora, the sites of the former camps, and the entrance of the subsidiary valley of the Jandul. In front, at the further end, an opening in the mountain range showed the pass of Nawagai. Towering on the left was the great mass of the Koh-i-mohr, or "Mountain of Peacocks"—a splendid peak, some 8000 feet high, the top of which is visible from both Peshawar and Malakand. Its name is possibly a corruption. Arrian calls it Mount Meros. At its base the city of Nysa stood in former times, and among many others fell before the arms of Alexander. Its inhabitants, in begging for peace, boasted that they conducted their government "with constitutional order," and that "ivy, which did not grow in the rest of India, grew among them." City, ivy, and constitutional order have alike disappeared. The mountain alone remains. A little to the northward the Ramlat Pass was distinguishable. On the right the smooth plain appeared to flow into the hill country, and a wide bay in the mountains, roughly circular in shape and nearly twelve miles across, opened out of the valley. The prominent spurs which ran from the hills formed many dark ravines and deep hollows, as it were gulfs and inlets of the sea. The entrance was perhaps a mile broad. I remember that, when I first looked into the valley, the black clouds of a passing storm hung gloomily over all, and filled it with a hazy half-light that contrasted with the brilliant sunshine outside. It was the Watelai, or as we got to call it later—the Mamund Valley.
Another mile or so took us to the Watelai River, a stream about thirty yards wide, which flows into the Jandul and then into the Panjkora. After crossing it and climbing the opposite bank, the troops emerged onto the wide, flat plateau of Khar, about ten miles across and sixteen miles long. From the high ground, the vastness of the valley unfolded. Looking west, you could see the hills behind the Panjkora, the sites of the former camps, and the entrance to the Jandul valley. At the far end, an opening in the mountain range revealed the Nawagai pass. Towering to the left was the impressive Koh-i-mohr, or "Mountain of Peacocks"—a stunning peak about 8000 feet high, which can be seen from both Peshawar and Malakand. Its name may have been slightly altered over time; Arrian referred to it as Mount Meros. At its base once stood the city of Nysa, which, like many others, fell to Alexander's armies. The residents, seeking peace, claimed they governed "with constitutional order" and that "ivy, which didn’t grow elsewhere in India, thrived among them." The city, the ivy, and the constitutional order have all vanished. Only the mountain remains. A little to the north, you could spot the Ramlat Pass. To the right, the smooth plain seemed to blend into the hills, and a wide bay in the mountains, roughly circular and nearly twelve miles across, extended from the valley. The prominent spurs from the hills created many dark ravines and deep hollows, resembling gulfs and inlets of the sea. The entrance was about a mile wide. I remember when I first looked into the valley, dark storm clouds loomed overhead, casting a gloomy haze that contrasted with the bright sunshine outside. It was the Watelai, or as we later called it—the Mamund Valley.
The Khan of Khar met the general on the farther bank of the river. He was a tall, fine-looking man with bright eyes, bushy black whiskers and white teeth, which his frequent smiles displayed. He was richly dressed, attended by a dozen horsemen and mounted on a handsome, though vicious dun horse. He saluted Sir Bindon Blood with great respect and ceremony. Some conversation took place, conducted, as the khan only spoke Pushtu, through the political officer. The khan asserted his loyalty and that of his neighbour the Khan of Jar. He would, he said, do his utmost to secure the peaceful passage of the troops. Such supplies as they might need, he would provide, as far as his resources would go. He looked with some alarm at the long lines of marching men and animals. The general reassured him. If the forces were not interfered with or opposed, if the camps were not fired into at night, if stragglers were not cut off and cut up by his people, payment in cash would be made for all the grain and wood it was necessary to requisition.
The Khan of Khar met the general on the far side of the river. He was a tall, handsome man with bright eyes, bushy black beard, and white teeth that showed when he smiled. He was dressed in rich clothing, accompanied by a dozen horsemen, and riding a striking but aggressive dun horse. He greeted Sir Bindon Blood with great respect and formality. Some conversation occurred, as the khan only spoke Pushtu, facilitated by the political officer. The khan expressed his loyalty and that of his neighbor, the Khan of Jar. He stated that he would do his best to ensure the peaceful passage of the troops. He offered to provide any supplies they might need as much as his resources allowed. He looked somewhat apprehensive at the long lines of marching men and animals. The general reassured him. If the forces were not interfered with or opposed, if the camps were not attacked at night, and if stragglers were not harmed by his people, cash payment would be made for all the grain and wood that needed to be requisitioned.
The khan accepted this promise with gratitude and relief, and henceforth during the operations which took place at Nawagai and in the Mamund Valley, he preserved a loyal and honourable behaviour. To the best of his power he restrained his young bloods. As much as he was able, he used his influence to discourage the other tribes from joining the revolt. Every night his pickets watched our camps, and much good sleep was obtained by weary men in consequence. At the end of the fighting he was the intermediary between the Government and the Mamund tribesmen. And on one occasion he rendered a signal service, though one which should hardly have been entrusted to him, by escorting with his own retainers an ammunition convoy to the 2nd Brigade, when troops and cartridges were alike few and sorely needed. Had he proved treacherous in this instance the consequences might have been most grave. Throughout, however, he kept his word with the general, and that in the face of opposition from his own people, and threats of vengeance from his neighbours.
The khan accepted this promise with gratitude and relief, and from that point on during the events at Nawagai and in the Mamund Valley, he maintained a loyal and honorable demeanor. He did his best to keep his hotheaded young followers in check. As much as he could, he used his influence to discourage the other tribes from joining the uprising. Every night, his sentries watched our camps, allowing exhausted soldiers to get a good night's sleep. When the fighting ended, he acted as the go-between for the Government and the Mamund tribesmen. On one occasion, he provided a significant service, although it was risky for him to do so, by escorting an ammunition convoy to the 2nd Brigade with his own men when both troops and supplies were scarce and desperately needed. If he had betrayed us in that situation, the outcomes could have been very serious. Throughout, however, he kept his promise to the general, even while facing opposition from his own people and threats of retaliation from his neighbors.
He on his part will not complain of British good faith. Although the fighting was continued in the district for nearly a month, not one of his villages was burnt, while all damage done to his crops was liberally compensated. He was guaranteed against reprisals, and at the end of the operations the gift of a considerable sum of money proved to him that the Sirkar could reward its friends, as well as punish its enemies.
He won't complain about the British keeping their promises. Even though the fighting went on in the area for almost a month, none of his villages were burned, and he was generously compensated for any damage to his crops. He was protected from reprisals, and at the end of the operations, receiving a significant amount of money showed him that the government could reward its allies as well as punish its foes.
The camel transport of the 3rd Brigade lagged on the road, and the troops, tired after their long march, had to wait in the blazing sun for a couple of hours without shelter until the baggage came up. At length it arrived, and we proceeded to camp as far as is possible without tents. Shelters were improvised from blankets, from waterproof sheets supported on sticks, or from the green boughs of some adjacent trees. Beneath these scanty coverings the soldiers lay, and waited for the evening.
The camel convoy for the 3rd Brigade was slow on the road, and the troops, exhausted from their long march, had to wait in the scorching sun for a couple of hours without any shade until the supplies arrived. Finally, they got there, and we set up camp as best as we could without tents. We made makeshift shelters from blankets, waterproof sheets held up by sticks, or from the leafy branches of nearby trees. Under these minimal coverings, the soldiers lay down and waited for the evening.
Every one has read of the sufferings of the British troops in having to campaign in the hot weather during the Indian Mutiny. September in these valleys is as hot as it is easy to imagine or elegant to describe, and the exposure to the sun tells severely on the British battalions, as the hospital returns show. Of course, since Mutiny days, many salutary changes have been made in the dress and equipment of the soldier. The small cap with its insufficient puggaree is replaced by the pith helmet, the shade of which is increased by a long quilted covering. The high stock and thick, tight uniforms are gone, and a cool and comfortable khaki kit has been substituted. A spine protector covers the back, and in other ways rational improvements have been effected. But the sun remains unchanged, and all precautions only minimise, without preventing the evils.
Everyone has read about the hardships faced by British troops during the hot weather of the Indian Mutiny. September in these valleys is as oppressive as one can imagine, and the sun exposure takes a heavy toll on British battalions, as shown by the hospital reports. Of course, since the days of the Mutiny, many beneficial changes have been made in soldiers' uniforms and gear. The small cap with its inadequate puggaree has been replaced by the pith helmet, which is now covered with a long quilted cover for extra shade. The high stock and heavy, tight uniforms are gone, and a cool, comfortable khaki outfit has taken their place. A spine protector shields the back, and various other sensible improvements have been implemented. But the sun remains the same, and all precautions only reduce, not eliminate, the negative effects.
Slowly the hours pass away. The heat is intense. The air glitters over the scorched plain, as over the funnel of an engine. The wind blows with a fierce warmth, and instead of bringing relief, raises only whirling dust devils, which scatter the shelters and half-choke their occupants. The water is tepid, and fails to quench the thirst. At last the shadows begin to lengthen, as the sun sinks towards the western mountains. Every one revives. Even the animals seem to share the general feeling of relief. The camp turns out to see the sunset and enjoy the twilight. The feelings of savage hatred against the orb of day fade from our minds, and we strive to forget that he will be ready at five o'clock next morning to begin the torment over again.
Slowly, the hours drag on. The heat is unbearable. The air shimmers over the parched land, like the exhaust of an engine. The wind blows hot and, instead of offering relief, stirs up swirling dust storms that scatter the makeshift shelters and nearly suffocate their occupants. The water is lukewarm and doesn’t quench our thirst. Finally, the shadows start to stretch as the sun sets behind the western mountains. Everyone perks up. Even the animals seem to feel the collective sense of relief. The camp gathers to watch the sunset and enjoy the twilight. The intense hatred we felt toward the sun fades from our minds, and we try to forget that it will rise at five o'clock tomorrow morning to start the torment all over again.
As there were still several days to spare before the Malakand Field Force was due to enter the Mohmand country, Sir Bindon Blood ordered both brigades to remain halted on the 13th: the 3rd Brigade at Shumshuk; the 2nd at Jar. Meanwhile two reconnaissances were to be sent, one to the summit of the Rambat Pass, and the other up the Watelai Valley.
As there were still several days left before the Malakand Field Force was set to enter the Mohmand region, Sir Bindon Blood ordered both brigades to stay put on the 13th: the 3rd Brigade at Shumshuk and the 2nd at Jar. In the meantime, two reconnaissance missions were to be carried out, one to the top of the Rambat Pass and the other up the Watelai Valley.
The night of the 12th was the first occasion of "sniping," since the advance against the Mohmands had begun. About half a dozen shots were fired into camp, without other result than to disturb light sleepers. Still it marked a beginning.
The night of the 12th was the first instance of "sniping" since the advance against the Mohmands started. About six shots were fired into the camp, doing nothing more than waking up light sleepers. Still, it marked a beginning.
The reconnaissances started next morning. The general accompanied the one to the Rambat pass, to satisfy himself as to the nature of the unexplored country on the other side. Two companies of infantry were ordered to clear the way, and two others remained in support half-way up the pass. Sir Bindon Blood started at six o'clock accompanied by his escort, whose gay pennons combined, with the Union Jack of the Headquarters staff, to add a dash of colour to the scene. After riding for a couple of miles we caught up the infantry and had to halt, to let them get on ahead and work through the broken ground and scrub. A mile further it was necessary to dismount and proceed on foot. No opposition was encountered, though the attitude and demeanour of the natives was most unfriendly. The younger ones retired to the hills. The elder stayed to scowl at, and even curse us. The village cemetery was full of property of all kinds, beds, pitchers, and bags of grain, which the inhabitants had deposited there under the double delusion, that we wanted to plunder, and that in so sacred a spot it would be safe—were such our intention. In spite of their black looks, they were eventually all made to stand up and salute respectfully.
The scouting began the next morning. The general joined the one to the Rambat pass to see for himself what the unexplored land was like on the other side. Two companies of infantry were sent to clear the path, while two others were stationed halfway up the pass for support. Sir Bindon Blood set off at six o'clock with his escort, whose colorful banners, along with the Union Jack from the Headquarters staff, brightened up the scene. After riding for a couple of miles, we caught up with the infantry and had to pause to let them move ahead and navigate through the difficult terrain and scrub. A mile later, we needed to get off our horses and continue on foot. We faced no resistance, though the natives had a very unfriendly attitude. The younger ones moved to the hills, while the older ones stayed behind to scowl at us and even shout curses. The village cemetery was filled with various belongings—beds, pitchers, and bags of grain—that the locals had hidden there, mistakenly believing we wanted to loot them and that it was a safe spot since it was sacred. Despite their hostile glares, they all eventually stood up and saluted us respectfully.
The climb was a stiff one and took at least an hour. But the track was everywhere passable, or capable of easily being made passable for mules. The general, trained and hardened by years of shooting of all kinds in the jungles, arrived at the top first, followed by Brigadier-General Wodehouse, and a panting staff. A fine view of the Ambasar Valley was displayed. It was of arid aspect. Villages in plenty could be seen, but no sign of water. This was serious, as information as to wells was unreliable, and it was desirable to see some tanks and streams, before allowing a column to plunge into the unknown dangers of the valley. After some consideration Sir Bindon Blood decided to modify the original plan and send only two battalions of the 2nd Brigade with one squadron over the pass, while the rest were to march to join him at Nawagai. We then returned, reaching camp in time for luncheon.
The climb was challenging and took at least an hour. But the path was manageable and could easily be made suitable for mules. The general, experienced and toughened by years of various shooting in the jungles, reached the top first, followed by Brigadier-General Wodehouse and a breathless staff. A stunning view of the Ambasar Valley opened up. It looked dry and barren. Many villages were visible, but there was no sign of water. This was concerning, as information about wells was unreliable, and it was important to see some tanks and streams before allowing a group to head into the unknown dangers of the valley. After some thought, Sir Bindon Blood decided to change the original plan and send only two battalions of the 2nd Brigade with one squadron over the pass, while the rest would march to join him at Nawagai. We then headed back and reached camp in time for lunch.
Meanwhile the reconnaissance up the Watelai or Mamund Valley had been of a more interesting nature. Two squadrons of the 11th Bengal Lancers, under Major Beatson, and with Mr. Davis, the political officer, were sent to put some pressure on the Mamunds, to make them carry out the terms agreed upon. They had promised to surrender fifty rifles. This they now showed no intention of doing. They had realised, that the brigades were only marching through the country, and that they had no time to stop, and they were determined to keep their arms as long as possible.
Meanwhile, the scouting in the Watelai or Mamund Valley was more engaging. Two squadrons of the 11th Bengal Lancers, led by Major Beatson and accompanied by Mr. Davis, the political officer, were sent to pressure the Mamunds into fulfilling the agreed terms. They had promised to surrender fifty rifles, but now it was clear they had no intention of doing so. They understood that the brigades were just passing through the area, with no time to linger, and they were determined to hold onto their weapons for as long as they could.
As the cavalry approached the first village, about 300 men gathered and, displaying standards, called on the Lancers to stop. An altercation ensued. They were given half an hour to remove their women and children. Then the squadrons advanced. The tribesmen, still menacing, retired slowly towards the hills. Then a small party came up and informed Major Beatson, that in the next village was a troop-horse, which had been captured in the fighting in the Swat Valley. This admission, that the Mamunds had been implicated in the attack on the Malakand, was sufficiently naive. The cavalry rode on to the village. The horse was not to be found, but the officious informers from the first village eagerly pointed out where it had been stabled. In consequence of this information, and to stimulate the tribesmen to carry out the original terms, Mr. Davis decided to make an example and authorised Major Beatson to destroy the house of the owner of the stolen property. This was accordingly done. As soon as the smoke began to rise, the tribesmen, who had waited, half a mile away, opened a dropping fire from Martini-Henry rifles on the cavalry. These, not wishing to engage, retired at a trot. They were followed up, but though the fire was well directed, the range was too great for accurate shooting and the bullets whizzed harmlessly overhead.
As the cavalry neared the first village, about 300 men gathered, showing their flags and calling for the Lancers to stop. A dispute broke out. They were given half an hour to take their women and children away. Then the squadrons moved forward. The tribesmen, still threatening, slowly retreated towards the hills. Shortly after, a small group approached Major Beatson and informed him that there was a troop horse in the next village that had been captured during the fighting in the Swat Valley. This admission, that the Mamunds were involved in the attack on the Malakand, was quite naive. The cavalry continued to the village, but the horse wasn't found. However, the eager informants from the first village pointed out where it had been kept. Based on this information, and to encourage the tribesmen to follow through with the original agreement, Mr. Davis decided to set an example and authorized Major Beatson to destroy the house of the owner of the stolen horse. This was promptly carried out. As soon as the smoke started to rise, the tribesmen, who had been waiting half a mile away, opened fire with their Martini-Henry rifles on the cavalry. Not wanting to engage, the cavalry retreated at a trot. They were pursued, but although the fire was well aimed, the range was too long for accurate shooting, and the bullets flew harmlessly overhead.
As the Lancers left the valley, an incident occurred which illustrates what has been said in an earlier chapter, and is characteristic of the daily life of the natives. The people of the first village had directed the attention of the cavalry to the second. Part of the second had been in consequence burnt. The inhabitants of both turned out to discuss the matter with rifles and, when last seen that night, were engaged in a lively skirmish. Apparently, however, they soon forgot their differences.
As the Lancers left the valley, something happened that shows what was mentioned in an earlier chapter and represents the everyday life of the locals. The people from the first village had pointed the cavalry's attention to the second village. As a result, part of the second village was burned. The residents of both villages came out to discuss the situation with rifles, and when they were last seen that night, they were involved in a heated skirmish. However, it seemed they quickly forgot their conflicts.
The rumour that the cavalry had been fired on preceded them to camp, and the prospects of some opposition were everywhere hailed with satisfaction. Many had begun to think that the Mohmand expedition was going to be a mere parade, and that the tribesmen were overawed by the powerful forces employed. They were soon to be undeceived. I watched the squadrons return. Behind them the Mamund Valley was already dark with the shadows of the evening and the heavy clouds that had hung over it all day. They were vastly pleased with themselves. Nothing in life is so exhilarating as to be shot at without result. The sowars sat their horses with conscious pride. Some of the younger officers still showed the flush of excitement on their cheeks. But they pretended excellently well to have forgotten all about the matter. They believed a few fellows had "sniped" at them; that was all.
The rumor that the cavalry had been fired upon reached the camp ahead of them, and the possibility of some resistance was met with excitement. Many had started to think that the Mohmand expedition would just be a show and that the tribesmen were intimidated by the powerful forces involved. They were about to be proven wrong. I watched the squadrons come back. Behind them, the Mamund Valley was already shrouded in the evening's shadows and the heavy clouds that had lingered all day. They were very pleased with themselves. Nothing is as thrilling as being shot at with no consequences. The soldiers sat tall on their horses with a sense of pride. Some of the younger officers still had a glow of excitement on their faces. But they did a great job pretending to have forgotten all about it. They thought a few guys had taken some shots at them; that was it.
But it was by no means all. Whatever is the Afhgan equivalent of the "Fiery Cross" was circulated among the tribes. There was no time for them to gather to attack that night, and the situation of the camp in the open was unsuited to night firing. The other brigade was coming. They would wait. They therefore contented themselves with firing occasional shots, beginning while we were at dinner, and continuing at intervals until daylight. No one was hurt, but we may imagine that the tribesmen, who spent the night prowling about the nullahs, and firing from time to time, returned to their countrymen next morning boasting of what they had done. "Alone, while ye all slumbered and slept, in the night, in the darkness, I, even I, have attacked the camp of the accursed ones and have slain a Sahib. Is it not so, my brothers?" Whereupon the brothers, hoping he would some day corroborate a lie for them, replied, that it was undoubtedly so, and that he had deserved well of the tribe. Such is the reward of the "sniper."
But that wasn't the whole story. Whatever the Afghan equivalent of the "Fiery Cross" was, it was spread among the tribes. There wasn't enough time for them to gather and launch an attack that night, and the camp's location in the open wasn't ideal for night firing. The other brigade was on its way. They decided to wait. So, they settled for firing off occasional shots, starting while we were having dinner and going at intervals until morning. No one got hurt, but we can imagine that the tribesmen, who spent the night wandering around the ravines and firing sporadically, returned to their fellow tribesmen the next morning bragging about their exploits. "While you all slept soundly in the night and darkness, I, just I, attacked the camp of the cursed ones and killed a Sahib. Isn't that right, my brothers?" To which the brothers, hoping he would one day back up a story for them, agreed that it was definitely true and that he had done well by the tribe. Such is the reward of the "sniper."
Early next morning the 3rd Brigade and three squadrons of the 11th Bengal Lancers moved on to Nawagai and crossed the pass without opposition. The general and Headquarters staff accompanied them, and we found ourselves in a wide and extensive valley, on the far side of which the Bedmanai Pass could be plainly seen. Here, at last, we got definite information of the Mohmands' intentions. The Hadda Mullah with 1000 tribesmen had gathered to oppose the further advance. After all there would be a fight. In the evening Sir Bindon Blood, taking a squadron of cavalry, rode out to reconnoitre the approaches to the pass and the general configuration of the ground. On his return he sent a despatch to the Government of India, that he would force it on the 18th. The soldiers, especially the British troops, who had not yet been engaged, eagerly looked forward to the approaching action. But events were destined to a different course.
Early the next morning, the 3rd Brigade and three squadrons of the 11th Bengal Lancers moved on to Nawagai and crossed the pass without any opposition. The general and Headquarters staff were with them, and we found ourselves in a wide and vast valley, on the other side of which the Bedmanai Pass was clearly visible. Here, finally, we got solid information about the Mohmands' plans. The Hadda Mullah, along with 1,000 tribesmen, had gathered to block further progress. After all, there would be a battle. In the evening, Sir Bindon Blood took a squadron of cavalry to scout the route to the pass and check out the lay of the land. Upon his return, he sent a message to the Government of India, stating that he would attack on the 18th. The soldiers, especially the British troops who hadn’t been in action yet, were eagerly anticipating the upcoming engagement. But things were about to take a different turn.
It was already dusk when we returned from the reconnaissance. The evening was pleasant and we dined in the open air. Still the valley was very dark. The mountains showed a velvet black. Presently the moon rose. I repress the inclination to try to describe the beauty of the scene, as the valley was swiftly flooded with that mysterious light. All the suitable words have probably been employed many times by numerous writers and skipped by countless readers. Indeed I am inclined to think, that these elaborate descriptions convey little to those who have not seen, and are unnecessary to those who have. Nature will not be admired by proxy. In times of war, however, especially of frontier war, the importance of the moon is brought home to everybody. "What time does it rise to-night?" is the question that recurs; for other things—attacks, "sniping," rushes,—besides the tides are influenced by its movements.
It was already getting dark when we came back from the scouting. The evening was nice, and we ate outside. Still, the valley was quite dark. The mountains appeared deep black. Soon, the moon rose. I hold back the urge to describe how beautiful the scene was as the valley quickly filled with that mysterious light. All the right words have probably been used many times by countless writers and overlooked by just as many readers. In fact, I think these detailed descriptions mean little to those who haven’t seen it and are unnecessary for those who have. Nature won't be appreciated through someone else’s experience. However, during wartime, especially in border conflicts, everyone feels the significance of the moon. "What time does it rise tonight?" is a recurring question, since things like attacks, "sniping," rushes, and even the tides are affected by its phases.
Meanwhile, as at Nawagai, at a peaceful camp and a quiet dinner we watched the "silvery maiden" swiftly appear over the eastern mountains. She was gazing on a different scene eleven miles away, in the valley we had left.
Meanwhile, just like at Nawagai, at a peaceful camp while enjoying a quiet dinner, we saw the "silvery maiden" quickly rise over the eastern mountains. She was looking at a different view eleven miles away, in the valley we had just left.
The 2nd Brigade had marched that morning from Jar to the foot of the Rambat Pass, which it was intended to cross the next day. Brigadier-General Jefferys, in anticipation of this movement, sent the Buffs up to hold the Kotal, and camped at the foot with the rest of his force. The situation of the camp, which had been adopted with a view to the advance at daybreak, favored the approach of an enemy. The ground was broken and intersected by numerous small and tortuous nullahs, and strewn with rocks. Any other site would, however, have necessitated a long march the next day, and no attack was thought likely.
The 2nd Brigade had marched that morning from Jar to the base of the Rambat Pass, which they planned to cross the next day. Brigadier-General Jefferys, expecting this move, sent the Buffs up to secure the Kotal and camped at the bottom with the rest of his troops. The camp's location, chosen to facilitate an advance at dawn, made it vulnerable to enemy attacks. The terrain was uneven and crossed by many small, winding streams, scattered with rocks. However, any other location would have required a longer march the next day, and an attack was not deemed likely.
At 8.15, as the officers were finishing dinner, three shots rang out in the silence. They were a signal. Instantly brisk firing broke out from the nullahs on the face of the square occupied by the Guides Infantry. Bullets whistled all about the camp, ripping through the tents and killing and wounding the animals.
At 8:15, as the officers were wrapping up dinner, three shots pierced the quiet. They were a signal. Immediately, rapid firing erupted from the ditches on the side of the square where the Guides Infantry were stationed. Bullets zipped around the camp, tearing through tents and injuring and killing the animals.
The Guides returned the fire with steadiness, and, as the shelter trench they had dug in front of their section of the line was higher than at other parts, no officers or men were hit. At ten o'clock a bugler among the enemy sounded the "Retire," and the fire dwindled to a few dropping shots. All were congratulating themselves on a termination of the event, when at 10.30 the attack was renewed with vigour on the opposite side of the camp, occupied by the 38th Dogras. The enemy, who were largely armed with Martini-Henry rifles, crept up to within 100 yards of the trenches. These were only about eighteen inches high, but afforded sufficient cover to the soldiers. The officers, with a splendid disregard of the danger, exposed themselves freely. Walking coolly up and down in the brilliant moonlight they were excellent targets. The brigadier proceeded himself to the threatened side of the camp, to control the firing and prevent the waste of ammunition. A good many thousand rounds were, however, fired away without much result. Several star shells were also fired by the battery. The ground was so broken that they revealed very little, but the tribesmen were alarmed by the smell they made, thinking it a poisonous gas. The officers were directed to take cover, but the necessity of sending messages and regulating the fire involved a great deal of exposure. And to all who showed above the trench the danger was great. Captain Tomkins of the 38th Dogras was shot through the heart, and a few minutes later the adjutant of the regiment, Lieutenant Bailey, was also killed. In assisting to take these officers to the hospital, where a rough shelter of boxes had been improvised, Lieutenant Harington, an officer attached to the Dogras, received a bullet in the back of the head, which penetrated his brain and inflicted injuries from which he died subsequently. All tents were struck and as much cover as could be made from grain-bags and biscuit-boxes was arranged. At 2.15 the firing ceased and the enemy drew off, taking their killed and wounded with them. They had no mind to be surprised by daylight, away from their hills. But they had already remained a little too long.
The Guides returned fire steadily, and since the trench they dug in front of their section was higher than in other areas, no officers or soldiers were hit. At ten o'clock, a bugler among the enemy sounded the "Retire," and the gunfire dwindled to a few sporadic shots. Everyone was congratulating themselves on the end of the skirmish when, at 10:30, the attack resumed vigorously on the opposite side of the camp, where the 38th Dogras were stationed. The enemy, mostly armed with Martini-Henry rifles, crept within 100 yards of the trenches. Though these were only about eighteen inches high, they provided enough cover for the soldiers. The officers, showing remarkable disregard for their safety, freely exposed themselves. Walking casually up and down in the bright moonlight, they became excellent targets. The brigadier went to the threatened side of the camp to manage the firing and prevent wasting ammunition. However, many thousands of rounds were fired without much effect. A few star shells were also fired by the battery. The uneven ground offered little visibility, but the tribesmen were scared by the smell, thinking it was poisonous gas. The officers were instructed to take cover, but the need to send messages and manage the fire exposed them significantly. Anyone who showed above the trench was at great risk. Captain Tomkins of the 38th Dogras was shot through the heart, and a few minutes later, the regiment's adjutant, Lieutenant Bailey, was also killed. While helping to take these officers to a makeshift hospital made of boxes, Lieutenant Harington, an officer attached to the Dogras, was shot in the back of the head, which penetrated his brain and led to his death later. All the tents were taken down, and as much cover as possible was made from grain bags and biscuit boxes. At 2:15, the firing stopped, and the enemy retreated, taking their dead and wounded with them. They did not want to be caught off guard by daylight away from their hills, though they had already stayed longer than they should have.
As soon as the light allowed, the cavalry squadron under Captain Cole started in pursuit. After a long gallop down the valley, he caught one party making for the mountains. Charging immediately, he succeeded in spearing twenty-one of these before they could reach the rocks. The squadron then dismounted and opened fire with their carbines. But the tribesmen turned at once and made a dash in the direction of the led horses. A sowar was wounded and a couple of horses killed. The cavalrymen, threatened in a vital point, ran hurriedly back, and just got into their saddles in time. In the haste of mounting four horses got loose and galloped away, leaving six dismounted men. Captain Cole placed one of them before him on the saddle, and the troopers followed his example. The squadron thus encumbered, retired, and after getting out of range, succeeded in catching their loose horses again. The enemy, seeing the cavalry mounted once more, took refuge on the hills. But it was evident, they were eager for fighting.
As soon as there was enough light, Captain Cole's cavalry squadron set off in pursuit. After a long run down the valley, he spotted a group heading for the mountains. Without hesitation, he charged and managed to take down twenty-one of them before they could reach the rocks. The squadron then dismounted and began firing their carbines. However, the tribesmen quickly turned and rushed towards the led horses. One soldier was injured, and a couple of horses were killed. Facing a serious threat, the cavalrymen hurriedly retreated and barely managed to get into their saddles in time. In the rush to mount, four horses got loose and ran away, leaving six men dismounted. Captain Cole placed one of the dismounted men on his saddle, and the other troopers did the same. With their numbers reduced, the squadron fell back, and once they were out of range, they were able to catch their loose horses again. Seeing the cavalry mounted once more, the enemy took shelter in the hills. But it was clear they were still eager for a fight.
The casualties in the night attack of Markhanai were as follows:—
The casualties in the night attack of Markhanai were as follows:—
BRITISH OFFICERS. Killed—Capt. W.E. Tomkins, 38th Dogras. " Lieut. A.W. Bailey, 38th Dogras. Died of wounds—Lieut. H.A. Harington, attd. 38th Dogras. NATIVE OFFICER. Wounded......... 1 NATIVE SOLDIERS. Killed. Wounded. No.8 Mountain Battery.... 1 1 35th Sikhs....... 1 3 38th Dogras....... 1 0 Guides Infantry...... 0 1 Followers....... 2 2 Total Casualties, 16; and 98 horses and mules.
BRITISH OFFICERS. Killed—Capt. W.E. Tomkins, 38th Dogras. " Lieut. A.W. Bailey, 38th Dogras. Died of wounds—Lieut. H.A. Harington, attached 38th Dogras. NATIVE OFFICER. Wounded......... 1 NATIVE SOLDIERS. Killed. Wounded. No.8 Mountain Battery.... 1 1 35th Sikhs....... 1 3 38th Dogras....... 1 0 Guides Infantry...... 0 1 Followers....... 2 2 Total Casualties, 16; and 98 horses and mules.
Meanwhile, the 3rd Brigade had passed a tranquil night at Nawagai. Next morning, however, at about six o'clock, a message was heliographed from the Buffs on the Rambat Pass, to the effect that an attack had been made on General Jeffreys' camp; that heavy firing had continued all night, and that several officers were among the casualties. This news set every one agog. While we were breakfasting, a native officer and ten sowars of the 11th Bengal Lancers arrived at speed with full details: six hours' fighting with the Mamunds: three officers killed or mortally wounded; and nearly a hundred animals hit. In consequence of this information, Sir Bindon Blood cancelled the orders for the passage of the Rambat Pass and instructed General Jeffreys to enter the Mamund Valley and thoroughly chastise the tribesmen.
Meanwhile, the 3rd Brigade had a peaceful night at Nawagai. The next morning, around six o'clock, a message was sent by helicopter from the Buffs at Rambat Pass, stating that an attack had taken place on General Jeffreys' camp; heavy gunfire had continued all night, and several officers were among the casualties. This news got everyone excited. While we were having breakfast, a native officer and ten soldiers from the 11th Bengal Lancers rushed in with more details: six hours of fighting with the Mamunds, three officers killed or seriously injured, and nearly a hundred animals wounded. As a result of this information, Sir Bindon Blood canceled the orders for crossing Rambat Pass and instructed General Jeffreys to enter the Mamund Valley and deal firmly with the tribesmen.
I was allowed to go back with the native officer's escort to the 2nd Brigade, in order to witness the operations which had been ordered. Judiciously selecting a few things, which could be carried on the saddle, of which the most important were a cloak, some chocolate and a tooth-brush, I hurried after the escort, who had already started, and overtook them just as they had got through the pass of Nawagai.
I was permitted to return with the local officer's escort to the 2nd Brigade to observe the operations that had been planned. Carefully picking a few items I could carry on the saddle, the most essential being a cloak, some chocolate, and a toothbrush, I rushed after the escort, who had already set off, and caught up with them just as they emerged from the Nawagai pass.
For the first six miles the road lay through a network of deep ravines, through which the troopers picked their way very carefully. It would have been a bad place for a small party to have been attacked in, but fortunately, though several armed tribesmen were seen, they did not fire at us. At one point the route lay through a deep nullah, along which some of the assailants of the night before had retired. These were probably from the Charmanga Valley. They had evidently suffered losses. Several native beds on which wounded men had been carried lay scattered about. At this place they had probably found some oxen, to which they had transferred their bodies. At length we got clear of the difficult ground, and entering the smooth plain of Nawagai looked out eagerly for the brigade. Seven miles away across the valley was a long brown streak. It was the troops marching from Markhanai to the entrance of the Mamund Valley. The smoke of five burning villages rose in a tall column into the air—blue against the mountains, brown against the sky. An hour's riding brought us to the brigade. Every one was full of the events of the night, and all looked worn from having had no sleep. "You were very lucky to be out of it," they said. "There's plenty more coming."
For the first six miles, the road went through a network of deep ravines, and the troopers navigated carefully. It would have been a dangerous spot for a small group to be attacked, but fortunately, although we saw several armed tribesmen, they didn't shoot at us. At one point, the path went through a deep gully, along which some of the attackers from the night before had retreated. They were probably from the Charmanga Valley and had clearly suffered losses. Several native beds, which had been used to carry wounded men, were scattered around. Here, they likely found some oxen to transport their injured. Eventually, we got past the difficult terrain and entered the smooth plain of Nawagai, eagerly looking for the brigade. Seven miles away across the valley was a long brown line. It was the troops marching from Markhanai to the entrance of the Mamund Valley. The smoke from five burning villages rose in a tall column into the air—blue against the mountains, brown against the sky. An hour of riding brought us to the brigade. Everyone was talking about the events of the night, looking worn out from lack of sleep. "You were really lucky to be out of it," they said. "There's plenty more coming."
The cavalry soon returned from their pursuit. The points of their lances were covered with dark smears. A sowar displayed his weapon proudly to some Sikhs, who grinned in appreciation. "How many?" was the question asked on all sides. "Twenty-one," replied the officer. "But they're full of fight."
The cavalry quickly came back from chasing after them. The tips of their lances were stained dark. A soldier showed off his weapon to a group of Sikhs, who smiled in appreciation. "How many?" was the question everyone was asking. "Twenty-one," the officer replied. "But they’re still full of fight."
Orders were now issued for the brigade to camp on the open ground near Inayat Kila, which, translated, means Fort Grant, and is the name of a considerable stone stronghold belonging to the Khan of Khar. Although the troops were very tired from their march, and the fighting of the preceding night, they began entrenching with alacrity. Besides making an outer wall to the camp, about three and a half feet high, everybody scratched a little hole for himself. In these occupations the afternoon passed.
Orders were now given for the brigade to set up camp on the open ground near Inayat Kila, which means Fort Grant and is the name of a significant stone fortress belonging to the Khan of Khar. Even though the troops were exhausted from their march and the fighting the night before, they started digging in with enthusiasm. In addition to building an outer wall around the camp, about three and a half feet high, everyone made a little space for themselves. The afternoon went by in these activities.
The Buffs came in at sunset, having marched from the top of the Rambat Pass. They had heard the firing of the night and were disappointed at having been absent. It was "just their luck," they said. During the Chitral campaign of 1895, they had had the ill-fortune to miss every engagement. It would be the same now. All tried to reassure them. As soon as it was dark an attack was probable.
The Buffs arrived at sunset after marching down from the top of the Rambat Pass. They had heard the gunfire from earlier that night and felt let down for missing it. They said it was "just their luck." During the Chitral campaign of 1895, they had been unfortunate enough to miss every fight. It was bound to happen again. Everyone tried to comfort them. As soon as it got dark, an attack was likely.
A dropping fire began after dinner from the great nullah to the north of the camp, and all lights were put out and the tents struck. Every one retired to the soup-plate he had scooped in the earth. But no attack was made. The enemy had informed the political officer through the friendlies, that they were weary and would rest that night. They sent a few "snipers" to fire into the camp, and these kept up a desultory fusillade until about two o'clock, when they drew off.
A fire broke out after dinner from the large ravine to the north of the camp, and all the lights were extinguished while the tents were taken down. Everyone went back to the shallow hole they had dug in the ground. But no attack came. The enemy had let the political officer know through the friendly locals that they were tired and would take the night off. They sent a few "snipers" to shoot into the camp, and they maintained a sporadic gunfire until around two o'clock, when they retreated.
Those who had been deprived of their rest the night before soon dropped off to sleep, in spite of the firing. Others, not overpowered by weariness, found no occupation but to lie in their holes and contemplate the stars—those impartial stars which shine as calmly on Piccadilly Circus as on Inayat Kila.
Those who hadn’t gotten much sleep the night before quickly fell asleep, despite the gunfire. Others, not utterly exhausted, had nothing to do but lie in their spots and gaze at the stars—those indifferent stars that shine just as serenely on Piccadilly Circus as they do on Inayat Kila.
CHAPTER XI: THE ACTION OF THE MAMUND VALLEY, 16TH SEPTEMBER
Sound as of bugle in camp, how it rings through the chill air of morning, Bidding the soldier arise, he must wake and be armed ere the light. Firm be your faith and your feet, when the sun's burning rays shall be o'er you. When the rifles are ranging in line, and the clear note of battle is blown. "A Sermon in Lower Bengal," SIR A. LYALL.
The sound of a bugle in camp rings through the chilly morning air, urging the soldier to get up; he has to wake and be ready before dawn. Stand firm in your faith and be steady on your feet, when the sun's hot rays shine down on you. When the rifles are lined up, and the clear call to battle is sounded. "A Sermon in Lower Bengal," SIR A. LYALL.
The story has now reached a point which I cannot help regarding as its climax. The action of the Mamund Valley is recalled to me by so many vivid incidents and enduring memories, that it assumes an importance which is perhaps beyond its true historic proportions. Throughout the reader must make allowances for what I have called the personal perspective. Throughout he must remember, how small is the scale of operations. The panorama is not filled with masses of troops. He will not hear the thunder of a hundred guns. No cavalry brigades whirl by with flashing swords. No infantry divisions are applied at critical points. The looker-on will see only the hillside, and may, if he watches with care, distinguish a few brown clad men moving slowly about it, dwarfed almost to invisibility by the size of the landscape. I hope to take him close enough, to see what these men are doing and suffering; what their conduct is and what their fortunes are. But I would ask him to observe that, in what is written, I rigidly adhere to my role of a spectator. If by any phrase or sentence I am found to depart from this, I shall submit to whatever evil things the ingenuity of malice may suggest.
The story has now reached a point that I can’t help but consider the climax. The events in the Mamund Valley come back to me through so many vivid experiences and lasting memories that they take on an importance that might be greater than their actual historical significance. Throughout, the reader needs to keep in mind what I’ve referred to as the personal perspective. They must remember how small the scale of operations is. The scene isn’t filled with large groups of soldiers. There won't be the roar of a hundred guns. No cavalry units will charge by with shining swords. No infantry divisions will be deployed at crucial moments. The observer will see only the hillside and, if they pay close attention, might notice a few brown-clad men moving slowly about, almost fading into the landscape. I hope to bring them close enough to see what these men are doing and enduring; to understand their actions and their fates. But I must ask them to note that, in what is written, I strictly stick to my role as a spectator. If any phrase or sentence suggests otherwise, I’ll accept whatever harsh criticism anyone can come up with.
On the morning of the 16th, in pursuance of Sir Bindon Blood's orders, Brigadier-General Jeffreys moved out of his entrenched camp at Inayat Kila, and entered the Mamund Valley. His intentions were, to chastise the tribesmen by burning and blowing up all defensible villages within reach of the troops. It was hoped, that this might be accomplished in a single day, and that the brigade, having asserted its strength, would be able to march on the 17th to Nawagai and take part in the attack on the Bedmanai Pass, which had been fixed for the 18th. Events proved this hope to be vain, but it must be remembered, that up to this time no serious opposition had been offered by the tribesmen to the columns, and that no news of any gathering had been reported to the general. The valley appeared deserted. The villages looked insignificant and defenceless. It was everywhere asserted that the enemy would not stand.
On the morning of the 16th, following Sir Bindon Blood's orders, Brigadier-General Jeffreys left his fortified camp at Inayat Kila and entered the Mamund Valley. His plan was to punish the tribesmen by destroying all defensible villages within reach of his troops. The hope was that this could be done in a single day, allowing the brigade to march on the 17th to Nawagai and participate in the attack on the Bedmanai Pass scheduled for the 18th. Events showed that this hope was unrealistic, but it should be noted that until then, the tribesmen had not put up any serious resistance to the military columns, and there had been no reports of any large gatherings to warn the general. The valley seemed deserted, and the villages appeared small and defenseless. It was widely believed that the enemy would not fight back.
Reveille sounded at half-past five, and at six o'clock the brigade marched out. In order to deal with the whole valley at once, the force was divided into three columns, to which were assigned the following tasks:—
Reveille sounded at 5:30, and at 6:00 the brigade marched out. To cover the entire valley simultaneously, the force was split into three columns, each assigned the following tasks:—
I. The right column, under Lieut.-Col. Vivian, consisting of the 38th Dogras and some sappers, was ordered to attack the village of Domodoloh. II. The centre column, under Colonel Goldney, consisting of six companies Buffs, six companies 35th Sikhs, a half-company sappers, four guns of No.8 Mountain Battery and the squadron of the 11th Bengal Lancers, was ordered to proceed to the head of the valley, and destroy the villages of Badelai and Shahi-Tangi (pronounced Shytungy). III. The left column, under Major Campbell, consisting of five companies of the Guides Infantry, and some sappers, was directed against several villages at the western end of the valley.
I. The right column, led by Lieutenant Colonel Vivian, made up of the 38th Dogras and some sappers, was instructed to attack the village of Domodoloh. II. The center column, led by Colonel Goldney, which included six companies of Buffs, six companies of the 35th Sikhs, half a company of sappers, four guns from the No. 8 Mountain Battery, and a squadron of the 11th Bengal Lancers, was ordered to move to the head of the valley and destroy the villages of Badelai and Shahi-Tangi (pronounced Shytungy). III. The left column, led by Major Campbell, composed of five companies of the Guides Infantry and some sappers, was directed toward several villages at the western end of the valley.
Two guns and two companies from each battalion were left to protect the camp, and a third company of the Guides was detached to protect the survey party. This reduced the strength of the infantry in the field to twenty-three companies, or slightly over 1200 men. Deducting the 300 men of the 38th Dogras who were not engaged, the total force employed in the action was about 1000 men of all arms.
Two guns and two companies from each battalion were assigned to secure the camp, and a third company of the Guides was sent to safeguard the survey team. This brought the total number of infantry in the field down to twenty-three companies, or just over 1,200 men. Subtracting the 300 men of the 38th Dogras who were not involved, the total force engaged in the action was about 1,000 men from all units.
It will be convenient to deal with the fortunes of the right column first. Lieut.-Colonel Vivian, after a march of six miles, arrived before the village of Domodoloh at about 9 A.M. He found it strongly held by the enemy, whose aspect was so formidable, that he did not consider himself strong enough to attack without artillery and supports, and with prudence returned to camp, which he reached about 4 P.M. Two men were wounded by long-range fire.
It will be convenient to deal with the situation of the right column first. Lieutenant Colonel Vivian, after a six-mile march, arrived at the village of Domodoloh around 9 A.M. He found it heavily fortified by the enemy, whose presence was so intimidating that he didn't feel he had enough strength to attack without artillery and backup. Acting wisely, he returned to camp, reaching it around 4 P.M. Two men were wounded by long-range fire.
The centre column advanced covered by Captain Cole's squadron of Lancers, to which I attached myself. At about seven o'clock we observed the enemy on a conical hill on the northern slopes of the valley. Through the telescope, an instrument often far more useful to cavalry than field-glasses, it was possible to distinguish their figures. Long lines of men clad in blue or white, each with his weapon upright beside him, were squatting on the terraces. Information was immediately sent back to Colonel Goldney. The infantry, eager for action, hurried their march. The cavalry advanced to within 1000 yards of the hills. For some time the tribesmen sat and watched the gradual deployment of the troops, which was developing in the plain below them. Then, as the guns and infantry approached, they turned and began slowly to climb the face of the mountain.
The center column moved forward, led by Captain Cole's squadron of Lancers, which I joined. Around seven o'clock, we spotted the enemy on a conical hill on the northern slopes of the valley. Through the telescope, which is often more helpful to cavalry than field glasses, we could clearly see their figures. Long lines of men dressed in blue or white, each with their weapon standing beside them, were crouched on the terraces. Information was immediately relayed to Colonel Goldney. The infantry, eager for action, quickened their march. The cavalry advanced to within 1,000 yards of the hills. For a while, the tribesmen sat and observed the troops' gradual deployment in the plain below. Then, as the artillery and infantry drew closer, they turned and began to slowly climb the slope of the mountain.
In hopes of delaying them or inducing them to fight, the cavalry now trotted to within closer range, and dismounting, opened fire at 7.30 precisely. It was immediately returned. From high up the hillside, from the cornfields at the base, and from the towers of the villages, little puffs of smoke darted. The skirmish continued for an hour without much damage to either side, as the enemy were well covered by the broken ground and the soldiers by the gravestones and trees of a cemetery. Then the infantry began to arrive. The Buffs had been detached from Colonel Goldney's column and were moving against the village of Badelai. The 35th Sikhs proceeded towards the long ridge, round the corner of which Shahi-Tangi stands. As they crossed our front slowly—and rather wearily, for they were fatigued by the rapid marching—the cavalry mounted and rode off in quest of more congenial work with the cavalryman's weapon—the lance. I followed the fortunes of the Sikhs. Very little opposition was encountered. A few daring sharpshooters fired at the leading companies from the high corn. Others fired long-range shots from the mountains. Neither caused any loss. Colonel Goldney now ordered one and a half companies, under Captain Ryder, to clear the conical hill, and protect the right of the regiment from the fire—from the mountains. These men, about seventy-five in number, began climbing the steep slope; nor did I see them again till much later in the day. The remaining four and a half companies continued to advance. The line lay through high crops on terraces, rising one above the other. The troops toiled up these, clearing the enemy out of a few towers they tried to hold. Half a company was left with the dressing station near the cemetery, and two more were posted as supports at the bottom of the hills. The other two commenced the ascent of the long spur which leads to Shahi-Tangi.
Hoping to delay or provoke them into a fight, the cavalry moved closer and dismounted, opening fire right at 7:30. The enemy immediately returned fire. From high on the hillside, from the cornfields at the bottom, and from the village towers, little puffs of smoke appeared. The skirmish lasted for an hour with minimal damage to either side, as the enemy was well-protected by the rough terrain and the soldiers by the gravestones and trees in a cemetery. Then the infantry started to arrive. The Buffs had been detached from Colonel Goldney's column and were heading toward the village of Badelai. The 35th Sikhs advanced toward the long ridge around the corner where Shahi-Tangi stands. As they crossed our front slowly—and rather wearily, since they were tired from quick marching—the cavalry mounted up and left to find more suitable work with the cavalryman's weapon—the lance. I followed the progress of the Sikhs. They faced very little opposition. A few bold sharpshooters took shots at the leading companies from the tall cornfields. Others fired long-range shots from the mountains. Neither posed significant losses. Colonel Goldney then ordered one and a half companies, led by Captain Ryder, to clear the conical hill and protect the regiment's right from the fire coming from the mountains. About seventy-five men began climbing the steep slope; I didn't see them again until much later in the day. The remaining four and a half companies continued to advance. The line stretched through high crops on terraces, rising one above the other. The troops struggled up these, clearing the enemy out of a few towers they attempted to hold. Half a company stayed with the dressing station near the cemetery, and two more were stationed as support at the bottom of the hills. The other two started the ascent of the long spur leading to Shahi-Tangi.
It is impossible to realise without seeing, how very slowly troops move on hillsides. It was eleven o'clock before the village was reached. The enemy fell back "sniping," and doing hardly any damage. Everybody condemned their pusillanimity in making off without a fight. Part of the village and some stacks of bhoosa, a kind of chopped straw, were set on fire, and the two companies prepared to return to camp.
It’s hard to understand just how slowly troops move on hillsides without seeing it for yourself. It was eleven o'clock by the time they reached the village. The enemy retreated, firing shots but causing hardly any harm. Everyone criticized their cowardice for running away without putting up a fight. Part of the village and some stacks of bhoosa, which is a type of chopped straw, were set on fire, and the two companies got ready to head back to camp.
But at about eight the cavalry patrols had reported the enemy in great strength at the northwest end of the valley. In consequence of this Brigadier-General Jeffreys ordered the Guides Infantry to join the main column. [Copy of message showing the time:—"To Officer, Commanding Guides Infantry.—Despatched 8.15 A.M. Received 8.57 A.M. Enemy collecting at Kanra; come up at once on Colonel Goldney's left. C. Powell, Major, D.A.Q.M.G."] Major Campbell at once collected his men, who were engaged in foraging, and hurried towards Colonel Goldney's force. After a march of five miles, he came in contact with the enemy in strength on his left front, and firing at once became heavy. At the sound of the musketry the Buffs were recalled from the village of Badelai and also marched to support the 35th Sikhs.
But around eight o'clock, the cavalry patrols reported that the enemy was in strong numbers at the northwest end of the valley. As a result, Brigadier-General Jeffreys ordered the Guides Infantry to join the main column. [Copy of message showing the time:—"To Officer, Commanding Guides Infantry.—Despatched 8:15 A.M. Received 8:57 A.M. Enemy gathering at Kanra; come up immediately on Colonel Goldney's left. C. Powell, Major, D.A.Q.M.G."] Major Campbell quickly gathered his men, who were out foraging, and rushed toward Colonel Goldney's force. After a five-mile march, he encountered the enemy in significant numbers on his left front, and the firing quickly intensified. Hearing the gunfire, the Buffs were recalled from the village of Badelai and also marched to support the 35th Sikhs.
While both these regiments were hurrying to the scene, the sound of loud firing first made us realise that our position at the head of the spur near Shahi-Tangi was one of increasing danger. The pressure on the left threatened the line of retreat, and no supports were available within a mile. A retirement was at once ordered. Up to this moment hardly any of the tribesmen had been seen. It appeared as if the retirement of the two companies was the signal for their attack. I am inclined to think, however, that this was part of the general advance of the enemy, and that even had no retirement been ordered the advanced companies would have been assailed. In any case the aspect of affairs immediately changed. From far up the hillsides men came running swiftly down, dropping from ledge to ledge, and dodging from rock to rock. The firing increased on every hand. Half a company was left to cover the withdrawal. The Sikhs made excellent practice on the advancing enemy, who approached by twos and threes, making little rushes from one patch of cover to another. At length a considerable number had accumulated behind some rocks about a hundred yards away. The firing now became heavy and the half-company, finding its flank threatened, fell back to the next position.
While both regiments were rushing to the scene, the sound of heavy gunfire made us realize that our position at the head of the spur near Shahi-Tangi was becoming increasingly dangerous. The pressure on the left side threatened our escape route, and there were no reinforcements available within a mile. A retreat was immediately ordered. Until this point, we had hardly seen any of the tribesmen. It seemed as if the retreat of the two companies triggered their attack. However, I believe this was part of the overall advance of the enemy, and even if we hadn't ordered a retreat, the forward companies would have been attacked. In any case, the situation quickly changed. From far up the hillsides, men came rushing down, jumping from ledge to ledge and dodging from rock to rock. The firing intensified all around us. Half a company stayed behind to cover the withdrawal. The Sikhs were accurate in targeting the advancing enemy, who approached in groups of two or three, making quick dashes from one piece of cover to another. Eventually, a significant number gathered behind some rocks about a hundred yards away. The firing became heavy, and the half-company, feeling its flank being threatened, fell back to the next position.
A digression is necessary to explain the peculiar configuration of the ground.
A quick side note is needed to explain the unusual layout of the ground.
The spur, at the top of which the village stands, consists of three rocky knolls, each one higher than the other, as the main hill is approached. These are connected by open necks of ground, which are commanded by fire from both flanks. In section the ground resembles a switchback railway.
The ridge where the village sits has three rocky hills, each one taller than the last as you get closer to the main hill. These hills are linked by open patches of land that can be targeted from both sides. The layout of the ground looks like a switchback railway.
The first of these knolls was evacuated without loss, and the open space to the next quickly traversed. I think a couple of men fell here, and were safely carried away. The second knoll was commanded by the first, on to which the enemy climbed, and from which they began firing. Again the companies retired. Lieutenant Cassells remained behind with about eight men, to hold the knoll until the rest had crossed the open space. As soon as they were clear they shouted to him to retire. He gave the order.
The first of these hills was cleared without any losses, and the open area to the next was crossed quickly. I think a couple of guys got hit here and were safely taken away. The second hill was overlooked by the first one, which the enemy climbed and started shooting from. The companies fell back again. Lieutenant Cassells stayed back with about eight men to hold the hill until the others had crossed the open area. Once they were clear, they called out to him to fall back. He gave the order.
Till this time the skirmishing of the morning might have afforded pleasure to the neuropath, experience to the soldier, "copy" to the journalist. Now suddenly black tragedy burst upon the scene, and all excitement died out amid a multitude of vivid trifles. As Lieutenant Cassells rose to leave the knoll, he turned sharply and fell on the ground. Two Sepoys immediately caught hold of him. One fell shot through the leg. A soldier who had continued firing sprang into the air, and, falling, began to bleed with strange and terrible rapidity from his mouth and chest. Another turned on his back kicking and twisting. A fourth lay quite still. Thus in the time it takes to write half the little party were killed or wounded. The enemy had worked round both flanks and had also the command. Their fire was accurate.
Up until now, the morning skirmishes might have given enjoyment to the anxious observer, valuable experience to the soldier, and material for the journalist. Suddenly, however, tragedy struck, and all excitement faded into a blur of vivid details. As Lieutenant Cassells stood to leave the hill, he turned sharply and collapsed onto the ground. Two Sepoys quickly rushed to assist him. One was shot in the leg. A soldier who continued firing leaped into the air and began bleeding profusely from his mouth and chest. Another soldier flipped onto his back, kicking and twisting in pain. A fourth lay completely still. In the time it takes to write this, half of the small group had either died or sustained injuries. The enemy had maneuvered around both sides and had the advantage. Their fire was precise.
Two officers, the subadar major, by name Mangol Singh, and three or four Sepoys ran forward from the second knoll, to help in carrying the wounded off. Before they reached the spot, two more men were hit. The subadar major seized Lieutenant Cassells, who was covered with blood and unable to stand, but anxious to remain in the firing line. The others caught hold of the injured and began dragging them roughly over the sharp rocks in spite of their screams and groans. Before we had gone thirty yards from the knoll, the enemy rushed on to it, and began firing. Lieutenant Hughes, the adjutant of the regiment, and one of the most popular officers on the frontier, was killed. The bullets passed in the air with a curious sucking noise, like that produced by drawing the air between the lips. Several men also fell. Lieut.-Colonel Bradshaw ordered two Sepoys to carry the officer's body away. This they began to do. Suddenly a scattered crowd of tribesmen rushed over the crest of the hill and charged sword in hand, hurling great stones. It became impossible to remain an impassive spectator. Several of the wounded were dropped. The subadar major stuck to Lieutenant Cassells, and it is to him the lieutenant owes his life. The men carrying the other officer, dropped him and fled. The body sprawled upon the ground. A tall man in dirty white linen pounced down upon it with a curved sword. It was a horrible sight.
Two officers, the subadar major, named Mangol Singh, and three or four Sepoys rushed forward from the second hill to help carry the wounded away. Before they got to the spot, two more men were hit. The subadar major grabbed Lieutenant Cassells, who was covered in blood and barely able to stand but still wanted to stay in the fight. The others grabbed hold of the injured and started dragging them roughly over the sharp rocks despite their screams and groans. Before we had gone thirty yards from the knoll, the enemy charged onto it and began firing. Lieutenant Hughes, the adjutant of the regiment and one of the most liked officers on the frontier, was killed. The bullets zipped through the air with a strange sucking noise, like the sound made when drawing air through pursed lips. Several men also fell. Lieut.-Colonel Bradshaw ordered two Sepoys to take the officer's body away. They started to do so. Suddenly, a scattered group of tribesmen burst over the hilltop and charged at us with swords drawn, throwing large stones. It became impossible to just stand by and watch. Several of the wounded were dropped. The subadar major stayed by Lieutenant Cassells, and it’s thanks to him that the lieutenant is alive. The men carrying the other officer dropped him and ran away. The body fell limply onto the ground. A tall man in dirty white linen lunged at it with a curved sword. It was a horrifying sight.
Had the swordsmen charged home, they would have cut everybody down. But they did not. These wild men of the mountains were afraid of closing. The retirement continued. Five or six times the two companies, now concentrated, endeavoured to stand. Each time the tribesmen pressed round both flanks. They had the whole advantage of ground, and commanded, as well as out-flanked the Sikhs. At length the bottom of the spur was reached, and the remainder of the two companies turned to bay in the nullah with fixed bayonets. The tribesmen came on impetuously, but stopped thirty yards away, howling, firing and waving their swords.
Had the swordsmen charged in, they would have taken everyone down. But they didn’t. These wild men from the mountains were afraid to close in. The retreat continued. Five or six times the two companies, now gathered together, tried to hold their ground. Each time, the tribesmen surrounded both sides. They had the advantage of the terrain and managed to outflank the Sikhs. Eventually, they reached the bottom of the ridge, and the remaining soldiers from both companies turned to face their attackers in the dry riverbed with their bayonets ready. The tribesmen charged forward fiercely but stopped thirty yards away, shouting, firing, and waving their swords.
No other troops were in sight, except our cavalry, who could be seen retiring in loose squadron column—probably after their charge. They could give no assistance. The Buffs were nearly a mile away. Things looked grave. Colonel Goldney himself tried to re-form the men. The Sikhs, who now numbered perhaps sixty, were hard pressed, and fired without effect. Then some one—who it was is uncertain—ordered the bugler to sound the "charge." The shrill notes rang out not once but a dozen times. Every one began to shout. The officers waved their swords frantically. Then the Sikhs commenced to move slowly forward towards the enemy, cheering. It was a supreme moment. The tribesmen turned, and began to retreat. Instantly the soldiers opened a steady fire, shooting down their late persecutors with savage energy.
No other troops were visible, just our cavalry, who could be seen pulling back in loose formation—probably after their charge. They couldn't provide any help. The Buffs were nearly a mile away. The situation looked serious. Colonel Goldney himself tried to regroup the men. The Sikhs, now numbering around sixty, were under heavy pressure and firing with no effect. Then someone—it's unclear who—ordered the bugler to sound the "charge." The sharp notes rang out not just once but a dozen times. Everyone started shouting. The officers waved their swords wildly. Then the Sikhs began to move slowly forward toward the enemy, cheering. It was a critical moment. The tribesmen turned and started to retreat. Instantly, the soldiers opened fire, shooting down their former attackers with fierce intensity.
Then for the first time, I perceived that the repulse was general along the whole front. What I have described was only an incident. But the reader may learn from the account the explanation of many of our losses in the frontier war. The troops, brave and well-armed, but encumbered with wounded, exhausted by climbing and overpowered by superior force, had been ordered to retire. This is an operation too difficult for a weak force to accomplish. Unless supports are at hand, they must be punished severely, and the small covering parties, who remain to check the enemy, will very often be cut to pieces, or shot down. Afterwards in the Mamund Valley whole battalions were employed to do what these two Sikh companies had attempted. But Sikhs need no one to bear witness to their courage.
Then for the first time, I realized that the retreat was happening all along the front. What I described was just one incident. But from this account, you can understand a lot of our losses in the frontier war. The troops were brave and well-armed, but they were weighed down with wounded soldiers, exhausted from climbing, and outnumbered by a stronger force, so they had to be ordered to fall back. This is a task that's too tough for a small force to manage. Unless reinforcements are available, they can suffer heavy casualties, and the small cover teams left to hold off the enemy often get overwhelmed or shot down. Later in the Mamund Valley, entire battalions were sent to do what these two Sikh companies had tried to accomplish. But Sikhs don’t need anyone to validate their bravery.
During the retirement down the spur, I was unable to observe the general aspect of the action, and now in describing it, I have dealt only with the misadventures of one insignificant unit. It is due to the personal perspective. While the two advanced companies were being driven down the hill, a general attack was made along the whole left front of the brigade, by at least 2000 tribesmen, most of whom were armed with rifles. To resist this attack there were the cavalry, the two supporting companies of the 35th Sikhs and five of the Guides Infantry, who were arriving. All became engaged. Displaying their standards, the enemy advanced with great courage in the face of a heavy fire. Many were killed and wounded, but they continued to advance, in a long skirmish line, on the troops. One company of the 35th became seriously involved. Seeing this, Captain Cole moved his squadron forward, and though the ground was broken, charged. The enemy took refuge in the nullah, tumbling into it standards and all, and opened a sharp fire on the cavalry at close range, hitting several horses and men. The squadron fell back. But the moral effect of their advance had been tremendous. The whole attack came to a standstill. The infantry fire continued. Then the tribesmen began to retire, and they were finally repulsed at about twelve o'clock.
During the retreat down the slope, I couldn’t see the full picture of the situation, so in describing it, I’ve only focused on the mishaps of one small unit. This is because of my personal viewpoint. While the two forward companies were pushed down the hill, a large assault was launched along the entire left flank of the brigade by at least 2,000 tribesmen, most of whom were armed with rifles. To counter this attack, there were the cavalry, the two supporting companies of the 35th Sikhs, and five companies of the Guides Infantry, who were arriving. Everyone got involved. The enemy, displaying their flags, charged forward bravely despite heavy gunfire. Many were killed and wounded, but they kept advancing in a long skirmish line toward our troops. One company of the 35th got into serious trouble. Seeing this, Captain Cole pushed his squadron forward, and even though the ground was uneven, they charged. The enemy took cover in the ravine, tumbling in with their flags and opened up a fierce fire on the cavalry at close range, hitting several horses and men. The squadron fell back. But the psychological impact of their charge was huge. The entire attack came to a halt. The infantry fire continued. Then the tribesmen started to pull back, and by around noon, they were finally driven off.
An opportunity was now presented of breaking off the action. The brigade had started from camp divided, and in expectation that no serious resistance would be offered. It had advanced incautiously. The leading troops had been roughly handled. The enemy had delivered a vigorous counter attack. That attack had been repulsed with slaughter, and the brigade was concentrated. Considering the fatigues to which the infantry had been exposed, it would perhaps have been more prudent to return to camp and begin again next morning. But Brigadier-General Jeffries was determined to complete the destruction of Shahi-Tangi, and to recover the body of Lieutenant Hughes, which remained in the hands of the enemy. It was a bold course. But it was approved by every officer in the force.
An opportunity had now presented itself to break off the action. The brigade had set out from camp divided, expecting little serious resistance. They had moved forward carelessly. The leading troops had faced heavy losses. The enemy had launched a fierce counterattack. That attack had been pushed back with significant casualties, and the brigade had regrouped. Given the exhaustion the infantry had endured, it might have been wiser to return to camp and try again in the morning. But Brigadier-General Jeffries was determined to finish the job of destroying Shahi-Tangi and recover the body of Lieutenant Hughes, which was still in enemy hands. It was a bold move, but it was supported by every officer in the force.
A second attack was ordered. The Guides were to hold the enemy in check on the left. The Buffs, supported by the 35th Sikhs, were to take the village. Orders were signalled back to camp for all the available troops to reinforce the column in the field, and six fresh companies consequently started. At one o'clock the advance recommenced, the guns came into action on a ridge on the right of the brigade, and shelled the village continuously.
A second attack was called for. The Guides were to keep the enemy in check on the left. The Buffs, backed by the 35th Sikhs, were to take the village. Orders were sent back to camp for all available troops to reinforce the column in the field, and six new companies set out. At one o'clock, the advance started again, the guns opened fire from a ridge on the right of the brigade, and constantly shelled the village.
Again the enemy fell back "sniping," and very few of them were to be seen. But to climb the hill alone took two hours. The village was occupied at three o'clock, and completely destroyed by the Buffs. At 3.30 orders reached them to return to camp, and the second withdrawal began. Again the enemy pressed with vigour, but this time there were ten companies on the spur instead of two, and the Buffs, who became rear-guard, held everything at a distance with their Lee-Metford rifles. At a quarter to five the troops were clear of the hills and we looked about us.
Again, the enemy fell back while taking shots from a distance, and very few of them could be seen. Climbing the hill alone took two hours. The village was taken at three o'clock and was completely destroyed by the Buffs. At 3:30, they received orders to return to camp, and the second withdrawal began. Once more, the enemy pushed forward with intensity, but this time there were ten companies on the spur instead of two, and the Buffs, who acted as the rear guard, kept everything at bay with their Lee-Metford rifles. At a quarter to five, the troops were clear of the hills, and we looked around us.
While this second attack was being carried out, the afternoon had slipped away. At about two o'clock Major Campbell and Captain Cole, both officers of great experience on the frontier, had realised the fact, that the debate with the tribesmen could not be carried to a conclusion that day. At their suggestion a message was heliographed up to the General's staff officer on the spur near the guns, as follows: "It is now 2.30. Remember we shall have to fight our way home." But the brigadier had already foreseen this possibility, and had, as described, issued orders for the return march. These orders did not reach Captain Ryder's company on the extreme right until they had become hard pressed by the increasing attack of the enemy. Their wounded delayed their retirement. They had pushed far up the mountain side, apparently with the idea they were to crown the heights, and we now saw them two miles away on the sky line hotly engaged.
While the second attack was happening, the afternoon passed quickly. Around two o'clock, Major Campbell and Captain Cole, both experienced officers on the frontier, realized that the discussion with the tribesmen wouldn't come to a resolution that day. At their suggestion, a message was sent via heliograph to the General's staff officer on the spur near the guns: "It is now 2:30. Remember, we’ll have to fight our way back." However, the brigadier had already anticipated this and had issued orders for the retreat, as previously mentioned. These orders didn’t reach Captain Ryder's company on the far right until they were already under heavy pressure from the enemy's increasing attack. Their wounded slowed their withdrawal. They had moved far up the mountainside, seemingly with the intention of taking the heights, and we now saw them two miles away on the skyline, heavily engaged.
While I was taking advantage of a temporary halt, to feed and water my pony, Lieutenant MacNaghten of the 16th Lancers pointed them out to me, and we watched them through our glasses. It was a strange sight. Little figures running about confusedly, tiny puffs of smoke, a miniature officer silhouetted against the sky waving his sword. It seemed impossible to believe that they were fighting for their lives, or indeed in any danger. It all looked so small and unreal. They were, however, hard pressed, and had signalled that they were running out of cartridges. It was then five o'clock, and the approach of darkness was accelerated by the heavy thunderclouds which were gathering over the northern mountains.
While I took a break to feed and water my pony, Lieutenant MacNaghten of the 16th Lancers pointed them out to me, and we watched through our binoculars. It was a strange sight. Small figures scurrying around in confusion, little puffs of smoke, a tiny officer silhouetted against the sky waving his sword. It seemed hard to believe that they were fighting for their lives or in any real danger. Everything looked so small and unreal. However, they were under a lot of pressure and had signaled that they were running out of cartridges. It was five o'clock, and the coming darkness was hastened by the heavy thunderclouds gathering over the northern mountains.
At about 3.30 the brigadier had ordered the Guides to proceed to Ryder's assistance and endeavour to extricate his company. He directed Major Campbell to use his own discretion. It was a difficult problem, but the Guides and their leader were equal to it. They had begun the day on the extreme left. They had hurried to the centre. Now they were ordered to the extreme right. They had already marched sixteen miles, but they were still fresh. We watched them defiling across the front, with admiration. Meanwhile, the retirement of the brigade was delayed. It was necessary that all units should support each other, and the troops had to wait till the Guides had succeeded in extricating Ryder. The enemy now came on in great strength from the north-western end of the valley, which had been swarming with them all day, so that for the first time the action presented a fine spectacle.
At around 3:30, the brigadier ordered the Guides to go help Ryder and try to pull his company out. He told Major Campbell to use his own judgment. It was a tough challenge, but the Guides and their leader were up to it. They started the day on the far left, rushed to the center, and now were sent to the far right. They had already marched sixteen miles, but they were still going strong. We watched them moving across the front with admiration. Meanwhile, the brigade's withdrawal was postponed. It was important that all units supported each other, so the troops had to wait until the Guides managed to rescue Ryder. The enemy was now advancing in large numbers from the northwestern end of the valley, where they had been swarming all day, making the action a spectacular sight for the first time.
Across the broad plain the whole of the brigade was in echelon. On the extreme right Ryder's company and the Guides Infantry were both severely engaged. Half a mile away to the left rear the battery, the sappers and two companies of the 35th Sikhs were slowly retiring. Still farther to the left were the remainder of the 35th, and, at an interval of half a mile, the Buffs. The cavalry protected the extreme left flank. This long line of troops, who were visible to each other but divided by the deep broad nullahs which intersected the whole plain, fell back slowly, halting frequently to keep touch. Seven hundred yards away were the enemy, coming on in a great half-moon nearly three miles long and firing continually. Their fire was effective, and among other casualties at this time Lieutenant Crawford, R.A., was killed. Their figures showed in rows of little white dots. The darkness fell swiftly. The smoke puffs became fire flashes. Great black clouds overspread the valley and thunder began to roll. The daylight died away. The picture became obscured, and presently it was pitch dark. All communication, all mutual support, all general control now ceased. Each body of troops closed up and made the best of their way to the camp, which was about seven miles off. A severe thunderstorm broke overhead. The vivid lightning displayed the marching columns and enabled the enemy to aim. Individual tribesmen ran up, shouting insults, to within fifty yards of the Buffs and discharged their rifles. They were answered with such taunts as the limited Pushtu of the British soldier allows and careful volleys. The troops displayed the greatest steadiness. The men were determined, the officers cheery, the shooting accurate. At half-past eight the enemy ceased to worry us. We thought we had driven them off, but they had found a better quarry.
Across the wide plain, the entire brigade was lined up in formation. On the far right, Ryder's company and the Guides Infantry were heavily engaged. Half a mile to the left and behind them, the battery, sappers, and two companies of the 35th Sikhs were slowly pulling back. Further to the left were the rest of the 35th, with the Buffs half a mile beyond them. The cavalry protected the far left flank. This long line of troops could see each other, but they were separated by deep, wide ditches that crossed the entire plain, as they fell back slowly, frequently stopping to stay in touch. Seven hundred yards away, the enemy advanced in a large half-moon formation nearly three miles long, firing continuously. Their fire was effective, and among other casualties at this time, Lieutenant Crawford, R.A., was killed. Their figures appeared as rows of little white dots. Darkness quickly descended. The puffs of smoke transformed into flashes of fire. Huge black clouds filled the valley, and thunder started to rumble. Daylight faded away, the scene became obscured, and soon it was pitch dark. All communication, mutual support, and overall control ceased. Each group of troops gathered together and made their way towards the camp, about seven miles away. A heavy thunderstorm struck overhead. The bright lightning revealed the marching columns and helped the enemy aim. Individual tribesmen ran up, shouting insults, to within fifty yards of the Buffs and fired their rifles. They were met with the limited Pushtu-based insults of the British soldiers and careful volleys. The troops remained extremely steady. The men were resolute, the officers upbeat, and the shooting precise. At half-past eight, the enemy stopped bothering us. We thought we had driven them off, but they had found more rewarding targets.
The last two miles to camp were painful. After the cessation of the firing the fatigue of the soldiers asserted itself. The Buffs had been marching and fighting continuously for thirteen hours. They had had no food, except their early morning biscuit, since the preceding night. The older and more seasoned amongst them laughed at their troubles, declaring they would have breakfast, dinner and tea together when they got home. The younger ones collapsed in all directions.
The last two miles to camp were tough. After the gunfire stopped, the soldiers' exhaustion kicked in. The Buffs had been marching and fighting for thirteen straight hours. They hadn’t eaten anything since their early morning biscuit the night before. The older, more experienced soldiers laughed off their struggles, saying they’d have breakfast, lunch, and dinner all at once when they got home. The younger ones were collapsing everywhere.
The officers carried their rifles. Such ponies and mules as were available were laden with exhausted soldiers. Nor was this all. Other troops had passed before us, and more than a dozen Sepoys of different regiments were lying senseless by the roadside. All these were eventually carried in by the rear-guard, and the Buffs reached camp at nine o'clock.
The officers had their rifles with them. The available ponies and mules were loaded with worn-out soldiers. But that wasn’t everything. Other troops had moved ahead of us, and more than a dozen Sepoys from different regiments were lying unconscious by the side of the road. Eventually, the rear-guard carried them all in, and the Buffs got to camp by nine o'clock.
Meanwhile, the Guides had performed a brilliant feat of arms, and had rescued the remnants of the isolated company from the clutches of the enemy. After a hurried march they arrived at the foot of the hill down which Ryder's men were retiring. The Sikhs, utterly exhausted by the exertions of the day, were in disorder, and in many cases unable from extreme fatigue even to use their weapons. The tribesmen hung in a crowd on the flanks and rear of the struggling company, firing incessantly and even dashing in and cutting down individual soldiers. Both officers were wounded. Lieutenant Gunning staggered down the hill unaided, struck in three places by bullets and with two deep sword cuts besides. Weary, outnumbered, surrounded on three sides, without unwounded officers or cartridges, the end was only a matter of moments. All must have been cut to pieces. But help was now at hand.
Meanwhile, the Guides pulled off an incredible military operation and rescued the remaining members of the isolated company from the enemy's grip. After a quick march, they reached the base of the hill where Ryder's men were retreating. The Sikhs, completely worn out from the day's efforts, were disorganized and, in many cases, too exhausted to even handle their weapons. The tribesmen crowded the flanks and rear of the struggling company, firing nonstop and even rushing in to strike down individual soldiers. Both officers were injured. Lieutenant Gunning staggered down the hill on his own, hit by bullets in three places and suffering two deep sword wounds as well. Tired, outnumbered, surrounded on three sides, without uninjured officers or ammo, the end was only moments away. All should have been slaughtered. But help was now on the way.
The Guides formed line, fixed bayonets and advanced at the double towards the hill. At a short distance from its foot they halted and opened a terrible and crushing fire upon the exulting enemy. The loud detonations of their company volleys were heard and the smoke seen all over the field, and on the left we wondered what was happening. The tribesmen, sharply checked, wavered. The company continued its retreat. Many brave deeds were done as the night closed in. Havildar Ali Gul, of the Afridi Company of the Guides, seized a canvas cartridge carrier, a sort of loose jacket with large pockets, filled it with ammunition from his men's pouches, and rushing across the fire-swept space, which separated the regiment from the Sikhs, distributed the precious packets to the struggling men. Returning he carried a wounded native officer on his back. Seeing this several Afridis in the Guides ran forward, shouting and cheering, to the rescue, and other wounded Sikhs were saved by their gallantry from a fearful fate. At last Ryder's company reached the bottom of the hill and the survivors re-formed under cover of the Guides.
The Guides formed a line, fixed their bayonets, and charged up the hill. They stopped just before reaching the base and unleashed a brutal and devastating fire on the triumphant enemy. The loud blasts of their gunfire echoed across the field, and we on the left were left wondering what was going on. The tribesmen were taken aback and hesitated. The company continued their retreat. Many acts of bravery occurred as night fell. Havildar Ali Gul from the Afridi Company of the Guides grabbed a canvas cartridge carrier, a kind of loose jacket with big pockets, filled it with ammunition from his men’s pouches, and dashed across the fire-scarred ground that separated the regiment from the Sikhs, handing out the vital supplies to the struggling soldiers. On his way back, he carried an injured native officer on his back. Seeing this, several Afridis in the Guides rushed forward, shouting and cheering, to help, and their bravery saved other wounded Sikhs from a terrible fate. Finally, Ryder's company reached the foot of the hill, and the survivors regrouped under the protection of the Guides.
These, thrown on their own resources, separated from the rest of the brigade by darkness and distance and assailed on three sides by the enemy, calmly proceeded to fight their way back to camp. Though encumbered with many wounded and amid broken ground, they repulsed every attack, and bore down all the efforts which the tribesmen made to intercept their line of retreat. They reached camp at 9.30 in safety, and not without honour. The skill and experience of their officers, the endurance and spirit of the men, had enabled them to accomplish a task which many had believed impossible, and their conduct in the action of the Mamund Valley fills a brilliant page in the history of the finest and most famous frontier regiment. [The gallantry of the two officers, Captain Hodson and Lieut. Codrington, who commanded the two most exposed companies, was the subject of a special mention in despatches, and the whole regiment were afterwards complimented by Brigadier-General Jeffreys on their fine performance.]
They were left to fend for themselves, cut off from the rest of the brigade by darkness and distance, and attacked from three sides by the enemy. They calmly fought their way back to camp. Despite dealing with many wounded and navigating rough terrain, they repelled every attack and overcame all the efforts made by the tribesmen to block their escape route. They safely reached the camp at 9:30, and they did so with honor. The skill and experience of their officers, along with the endurance and spirit of the soldiers, enabled them to achieve something many thought was impossible, and their actions in the Mamund Valley are a notable part of the history of the finest and most celebrated frontier regiment. [The bravery of the two officers, Captain Hodson and Lieut. Codrington, who led the two most at-risk companies, was specifically mentioned in dispatches, and the entire regiment was later praised by Brigadier-General Jeffreys for their outstanding performance.]
As the Buffs reached the camp the rain which had hitherto held off came down. It poured. The darkness was intense. The camp became a sea of mud. In expectation that the enemy would attack it, General Jeffreys had signalled in an order to reduce the perimeter. The camp was therefore closed up to half its original size.
As the Buffs arrived at the camp, the rain that had been holding off suddenly started pouring down. It was a deluge. The darkness was overwhelming. The camp turned into a muddy mess. Anticipating an enemy attack, General Jeffreys issued an order to shrink the perimeter. As a result, the camp was reduced to half its original size.
Most of the tents had been struck and lay with the baggage piled in confused heaps on the ground. Many of the transport animals were loose and wandering about the crowded space. Dinner or shelter there was none. The soldiers, thoroughly exhausted, lay down supperless in the slush. The condition of the wounded was particularly painful. Among the tents which had been struck were several of the field hospitals. In the darkness and rain it was impossible to do more for the poor fellows than to improve the preliminary dressings and give morphia injections, nor was it till four o'clock on the next afternoon that the last were taken out of the doolies.
Most of the tents had been taken down and were left with the baggage piled in messy heaps on the ground. Many transport animals were loose and wandering around the crowded area. There was no dinner or shelter available. The soldiers, completely exhausted, lay down without supper in the mud. The situation of the wounded was especially heartbreaking. Among the tents that had been taken down were several field hospitals. In the darkness and rain, it was impossible to do more for the poor men than to adjust their initial dressings and give them morphine injections. It wasn't until four o'clock the next afternoon that the last of them were taken out of the doolies.
After about an hour the rain stopped, and while the officers were bustling about making their men get some food before they went to sleep, it was realised that all the troops were not in camp. The general, the battery, the sappers and four companies of infantry were still in the valley. Presently we heard the firing of guns. They were being attacked,—overwhelmed perhaps. To send them assistance was to risk more troops being cut off. The Buffs who were dead beat, the Sikhs who had suffered most severe losses, and the Guides who had been marching and fighting all day, were not to be thought of. The 38th Dogras were, however, tolerably fresh, and Colonel Goldney, who commanded in the absence of the General, at once ordered four companies to parade and march to the relief. Captain Cole volunteered to accompany them with a dozen sowars. The horses were saddled. But the order was countermanded, and no troops left the camp that night.
After about an hour, the rain stopped, and while the officers rushed around getting their men some food before they went to sleep, it became clear that not all the troops were in camp. The general, the battery, the sappers, and four companies of infantry were still in the valley. Soon, we heard gunfire. They were being attacked—possibly overwhelmed. Sending help would risk more troops getting cut off. The Buffs were exhausted, the Sikhs had sustained severe losses, and the Guides had been marching and fighting all day, so they weren’t an option. However, the 38th Dogras were reasonably fresh, and Colonel Goldney, the acting commander in the General's absence, immediately ordered four companies to assemble and march for relief. Captain Cole volunteered to go with them, bringing a dozen sowars. The horses were saddled. But the order was canceled, and no troops left the camp that night.
Whether this decision was justified or not the reader shall decide. In the darkness and the broken ground it was probable the relief would never have found the general. It was possible that getting involved among the nullahs they would have been destroyed. The defenders of the camp itself were none too many. The numbers of the enemy were unknown. These were weighty reasons. On the other hand it seemed unsoldierly to lie down to sleep while at intervals the booming of the guns reminded us, that comrades were fighting for their lives a few miles away in the valley.
Whether this decision was justified or not is up to the reader to decide. In the darkness and the rough ground, it's likely the relief wouldn’t have found the general. It’s possible that if they got caught up among the nullahs, they could have been destroyed. The defenders of the camp weren’t many. The number of enemies was unknown. These were significant reasons. On the flip side, it felt unprofessional to lie down and sleep while the distant sound of gunfire reminded us that comrades were fighting for their lives just a few miles away in the valley.
CHAPTER XII: AT INAYAT KILA
"Two thousand pounds of education Drops to a ten-rupee jezail. . . . . . . Strike hard who cares. Shoot straight who can. The odds are on the cheaper man." RUDYARD KIPLING.
"Two thousand pounds worth of education Drops to a ten-rupee gun. . . . . . . Strike hard, who cares? Shoot straight, who can? The odds favor the cheaper man." RUDYARD KIPLING.
Half an hour before dawn on the 17th, the cavalry were mounted, and as soon as the light was strong enough to find a way through the broken ground, the squadron started in search of the missing troops. We had heard no more of their guns since about two o'clock. We therefore concluded they had beaten off the enemy. There might, of course, be another reason for their silence. As we drew near Bilot, it was possible to distinguish the figures of men moving about the walls and houses. The advanced files rode cautiously forward. Suddenly they cantered up to the wall and we knew some at least were alive. Captain Cole, turning to his squadron, lifted his hand. The sowars, actuated by a common impulse, rose in their stirrups and began to cheer. But there was no response. Nor was this strange. The village was a shambles. In an angle of the outside wall, protected on the third side by a shallow trench, were the survivors of the fight. All around lay the corpses of men and mules. The bodies of five or six native soldiers were being buried in a hurriedly dug grave. It was thought that, as they were Mahommedans, their resting-place would be respected by the tribesmen. [These bodies were afterwards dug up and mutilated by the natives: a foul act which excited the fury and indignation of soldiers of every creed in the force. I draw the reader's attention to this unpleasant subject, only to justify what I have said in an earlier chapter of the degradation of mind in which the savages of the mountains are sunk.] Eighteen wounded men lay side by side in a roofless hut. Their faces, drawn by pain and anxiety, looked ghastly in the pale light of the early morning. Two officers, one with his left hand smashed, the other shot through both legs, were patiently waiting for the moment when the improvised tourniquets could be removed and some relief afforded to their sufferings. The brigadier, his khaki coat stained with the blood from a wound on his head, was talking to his only staff-officer, whose helmet displayed a bullet-hole. The most ardent lover of realism would have been satisfied. Food, doolies, and doctors soon arrived. The wounded were brought to the field hospitals to be attended to. The unwounded hurried back to camp to get breakfast and a bath. In half an hour, the ill-omened spot was occupied only by the few sowars engaged in shooting the wounded mules, and by the vultures who watched the proceedings with an expectant interest.
Half an hour before dawn on the 17th, the cavalry mounted their horses, and as soon as there was enough light to navigate the rough terrain, the squadron set off to find the missing troops. We hadn’t heard their guns since around two o'clock, so we assumed they had successfully pushed back the enemy. However, there could have been other reasons for their silence. As we approached Bilot, we could see figures moving around the walls and houses. The scouts moved forward cautiously. Suddenly, they rode up to the wall, and we realized that some of them were still alive. Captain Cole turned to his squadron and raised his hand. The soldiers, driven by a shared impulse, stood in their stirrups and began to cheer. But there was no response. This wasn’t surprising. The village was a devastation. In the corner of the outer wall, sheltered on one side by a shallow trench, were the survivors of the fight. All around lay the bodies of men and mules. Five or six native soldiers were being buried in a hastily dug grave. It was believed that since they were Muslims, their graves would be respected by the local tribesmen. [These bodies were later exhumed and mutilated by the locals: a vile act that sparked anger and outrage among soldiers of all faiths in the unit. I mention this unpleasant incident solely to support my earlier statement about the degraded mindset of the tribes in the mountains.] Eighteen wounded men lay next to each other in a roofless hut. Their faces, strained by pain and worry, looked ghostly in the dim light of early morning. Two officers, one with a shattered left hand and the other shot through both legs, were patiently waiting for the moment when the makeshift tourniquets could be removed and their suffering could be alleviated. The brigadier, his khaki coat stained with blood from a head injury, was speaking with his only staff officer, whose helmet had a bullet hole in it. Even the most fervent admirer of realism would have found this scene striking. Food, stretchers, and doctors soon arrived. The wounded were taken to field hospitals for treatment. Those without injuries hurried back to camp for breakfast and a shower. Within half an hour, the cursed spot was left occupied only by a few soldiers shooting the wounded mules and by the vultures observing the scene with eager interest.
Gradually we learnt the story of the night. The battery, about thirty sappers and half the 35th Sikhs, were returning to camp. At about seven o'clock an order was sent for them to halt and remain out all night, to assist the Guides Infantry, whose firing could be heard and for whose safety the brigadier was above all things anxious. This order reached the battery, and with the sappers as an escort they turned back, recrossed a nullah and met the general with two companies of Sikhs outside the village of Bilot. The half-battalion of the 35th did not apparently receive the order, for they continued their march. Lieutenant Wynter, R.A., was sent back to look for them. He did not find them, but fell in with four fresh companies, two of the Guides and two of the 35th, who, under Major Worlledge, had been sent from camp in response to the general's demand for reinforcements. Lieutenant Wynter brought these back, as an escort to the guns. On arrival at the village, the brigadier at once sent them to the assistance of the Guides. He counted on his own two companies of Sikhs. But when Worlledge had moved off and had already vanished in the night, it was found that these two companies had disappeared. They had lost touch in the darkness, and, not perceiving that the general had halted, had gone on towards camp. Thus the battery was left with no other escort than thirty sappers.
Gradually, we learned what happened that night. The battery, made up of about thirty sappers and half of the 35th Sikhs, was on their way back to camp. Around seven o'clock, an order was sent for them to stop and stay out all night to help the Guides Infantry, who were firing shots, and for whose safety the brigadier was particularly concerned. This order reached the battery, and with the sappers as their escort, they turned back, crossed a watercourse, and met the general with two companies of Sikhs outside the village of Bilot. It seemed that the half-battalion of the 35th did not get the order, as they kept marching. Lieutenant Wynter, R.A., was sent back to look for them. He didn't find them, but instead encountered four fresh companies—two from the Guides and two from the 35th—under Major Worlledge, who had been sent from camp in response to the general's request for reinforcements. Lieutenant Wynter brought them back as an escort for the guns. Upon arriving at the village, the brigadier immediately sent them to assist the Guides. He counted on his own two companies of Sikhs. However, after Worlledge had moved off and had already disappeared into the night, it became clear that these two companies were missing. They had lost contact in the dark and, not realizing that the general had stopped, had continued toward camp. As a result, the battery was left with no other escort than thirty sappers.
A party of twelve men of the Buffs now arrived, and the circumstances which led them to the guns are worth recording. When the Buffs were retiring through the villages, they held a Mahommedan cemetery for a little while, in order to check the enemy's advance. Whilst there, Lieutenant Byron, Orderly Officer to General Jeffreys, rode up and told Major Moody, who commanded the rear companies, that a wounded officer was lying in a dooly a hundred yards up the road, without any escort. He asked for a few men. Moody issued an order, and a dozen soldiers under a corporal started to look for the dooly. They missed it, but while searching, found the general and the battery outside the village. The presence of these twelve brave men—for they fully maintained the honour of their regiment—with their magazine rifles, just turned the scale. Had not the luck of the British army led them to the village, it can hardly be doubted, and certainly was not doubted by any who were there, that the guns would have been captured and the general killed. Fortune, especially in war, uses tiny fulcra for her powerful lever.
A group of twelve men from the Buffs arrived, and the reasons that brought them to the guns are worth noting. As the Buffs were retreating through the villages, they held a Muslim cemetery for a short time to slow the enemy's advance. While there, Lieutenant Byron, the Orderly Officer to General Jeffreys, rode up and informed Major Moody, who was in charge of the rear companies, that a wounded officer was lying in a dooly a hundred yards down the road without any escort. He requested a few men. Moody gave the order, and a dozen soldiers under a corporal set out to find the dooly. They didn’t locate it, but while searching, they came across the general and the battery outside the village. The presence of these twelve brave men—who upheld the honor of their regiment with their magazine rifles—made all the difference. If luck hadn’t brought them to the village, it’s hard to doubt, and certainly no one present doubted, that the guns would have been captured and the general killed. Fortune, especially in war, uses small fulcrums for her powerful lever.
The general now ordered the battery and sappers to go into the village, but it was so full of burning bhoosa, that this was found to be impossible, and they set to work to entrench themselves outside. The village was soon full of the enemy. From the walls and houses, which on two sides commanded the space occupied by the battery, they began to fire at about thirty yards' range. The troops were as much exposed as if they had been in a racket court, of which the enemy held the walls. They could not move, because they would have had to desert either the guns or the wounded. Fortunately, not many of the tribesmen at this point were armed with rifles. The others threw stones and burning bhoosa into the midst of the little garrison. By its light they took good aim. Everybody got under such cover as was available. There was not much. Gunner Nihala, a gallant native soldier, repeatedly extinguished the burning bhoosa with his cloak at the imminent peril of his life. Lieutenants Watson and Colvin, with their sappers and the twelve men of the Buffs, forced their way into the village, and tried to expel the enemy with the bayonet. The village was too large for so small a party to clear. The tribesmen moved from one part to another, repeatedly firing. They killed and wounded several of the soldiers, and a bullet smashed Lieutenant Watson's hand. He however continued his efforts and did not cease until again shot, this time so severely as to be unable to stand. His men carried him from the village, and it was felt that it would be useless to try again.
The general ordered the battery and sappers to go into the village, but it was so full of burning fodder that they found it impossible, so they began to entrench themselves outside. The village quickly filled with enemy forces. From the walls and houses, which overlooked the area where the battery was positioned on two sides, they started firing from about thirty yards away. The troops were as exposed as if they were in a squash court, with the enemy holding the walls. They couldn't move because they would have had to abandon either the guns or the wounded. Luckily, not many of the tribesmen were armed with rifles at this point. The others threw stones and burning fodder into the midst of the small garrison. Using the light from the flames, they aimed well. Everyone took cover wherever they could find it, though there wasn't much. Gunner Nihala, a brave native soldier, repeatedly put out the burning fodder with his cloak, putting his life at great risk. Lieutenants Watson and Colvin, along with their sappers and the twelve men from the Buffs, forced their way into the village and tried to drive out the enemy with bayonets. The village was too big for such a small group to clear. The tribesmen moved around frequently, firing repeatedly. They killed and wounded several soldiers, and a bullet broke Lieutenant Watson’s hand. However, he kept pushing and didn't stop until he was shot again, this time so seriously that he could no longer stand. His men carried him out of the village, and it seemed that trying again would be pointless.
The attention of the reader is directed to the bravery of this officer. After a long day of marching, and fighting, in the dark, without food and with small numbers, the man who will go on, unshaken and unflinching, after he has received a severe and painful wound, has in respect of personal courage few equals and no superior in the world. It is perhaps as high a form of valour to endure as to dare. The combination of both is sublime. [Both officers have received the Victoria Cross for their conduct on this occasion.]
The reader's attention is drawn to the bravery of this officer. After a long day of marching and fighting, in the dark, without food and with few men, the person who continues on, steady and resolute, even after suffering a serious and painful wound, shows a level of personal courage that few can match and no one can surpass. Enduring is perhaps just as noble as daring. The blend of both is extraordinary. [Both officers have received the Victoria Cross for their conduct on this occasion.]
At nine o'clock the rain stopped the firing, as the tribesmen were afraid of wetting their powder, but at about ten they opened again. They now made a great hole in the wall of the village, through which about a dozen men fired with terrible effect. Others began loopholing the walls. The guns fired case shot at twenty yards' range at these fierce pioneers, smashing the walls to pieces and killing many. The enemy replied with bullets, burning bhoosa and showers of stones.
At nine o'clock, the rain halted the shooting because the tribesmen were worried about getting their gunpowder wet, but around ten, they started up again. They created a large hole in the village wall, through which about a dozen men fired with deadly accuracy. Others began making openings in the walls. The guns fired explosive rounds at a distance of twenty yards at these fierce attackers, demolishing the walls and killing many. The enemy responded with bullets, burning debris, and showers of stones.
So the hours dragged away. The general and Captain Birch were both wounded, early in the night. Lieutenant Wynter, while behaving with distinguished gallantry, was shot through both legs at about 11.30. He was thus twice severely wounded within forty-five days. He now continued to command his guns, until he fainted from loss of blood. A native gunner then shielded him with his body, until he also was hit. The whole scene, the close, desperate fighting, the carcasses of the mules, the officers and men crouching behind them, the flaming stacks of bhoosa, the flashes of the rifles, and over all and around all, the darkness of the night—is worthy of the pencil of De Neuville.
So the hours passed slowly. The general and Captain Birch were both injured early in the night. Lieutenant Wynter, showing remarkable bravery, was shot through both legs around 11:30. He had now been seriously wounded twice within forty-five days. He continued to command his guns until he fainted from blood loss. A native gunner then protected him with his body until he was also hit. The whole scene—the close, desperate fighting, the dead mules, the officers and men hiding behind them, the blazing stacks of bhoosa, the flashes of the rifles, and above all, the darkness of the night—is something worthy of De Neuville's brush.
At length, at about midnight, help arrived. Worlledge's two companies had gone in search of the Guides, but had not found them. They now returned and, hearing the firing at Bilot, sent an orderly of the 11th Bengal Lancers to ask if the general wanted assistance. This plucky boy—he was only a young recruit—rode coolly up to the village although the enemy were all around, and he stood an almost equal chance of being shot by our own men. He soon brought the two companies to the rescue, and the enemy, balked of their prey, presently drew off in the gloom. How much longer the battery and its defenders could have held out is uncertain. They were losing men steadily, and their numbers were so small that they might have been rushed at any moment. Such was the tale.
At last, around midnight, help arrived. Worlledge's two companies had gone to look for the Guides but hadn’t found them. They returned and, hearing the gunfire at Bilot, sent an orderly from the 11th Bengal Lancers to see if the general needed assistance. This brave young recruit rode calmly into the village despite the enemy surrounding them, knowing he could be shot by our own men. He quickly brought the two companies to the rescue, and the enemy, denied their target, soon retreated into the darkness. It’s unclear how much longer the battery and its defenders could have held out. They were steadily losing men, and their numbers were so few that they could have been overwhelmed at any moment. That was the story.
No operations took place on the 17th. The soldiers rested, casualties were counted, wounds were dressed, confidence was restored. The funerals of the British officers and men, killed the day before, took place at noon. Every one who could, attended; but all the pomp of military obsequies was omitted, and there were no Union Jacks to cover the bodies, nor were volleys fired over the graves, lest the wounded should be disturbed. Somewhere in the camp—exactly where, is now purposely forgotten—the remains of those who had lost, in fighting for their country, all that men can be sure of, were silently interred. No monument marked the spot. The only assurance that it should be undisturbed is, that it remains unknown. Nevertheless, the funerals were impressive. To some the game of war brings prizes, honour, advancement, or experience; to some the consciousness of duty well discharged; and to others—spectators, perhaps—the pleasure of the play and the knowledge of men and things. But here were those who had drawn the evil numbers—who had lost their all, to gain only a soldier's grave. Looking at these shapeless forms, coffined in a regulation blanket, the pride of race, the pomp of empire, the glory of war appeared but the faint and unsubstantial fabric of a dream; and I could not help realising with Burke: "What shadows we are and what shadows we pursue."
No operations happened on the 17th. The soldiers rested, counted their casualties, treated wounds, and regained their confidence. The funerals for the British officers and men who were killed the day before took place at noon. Everyone who could attend did, but all the formal military rites were skipped; there were no Union Jacks to cover the bodies, and no salutes fired over the graves so as not to disturb the wounded. Somewhere in the camp—exactly where, is now purposely forgotten—the remains of those who had sacrificed everything for their country were quietly buried. No monument marked the spot. The only assurance that it would remain undisturbed is that it stays unknown. Still, the funerals were moving. For some, war brings rewards, honor, advancement, or experience; for others, the satisfaction of duty well done; and for others—perhaps spectators—the enjoyment of the action and the understanding of people and things. But here were those who had drawn the bad luck—who lost everything for just a soldier's grave. Looking at these unmarked bodies, wrapped in a standard blanket, the pride of race, the grandeur of empire, the glory of war seemed like a faint and insubstantial illusion; and I couldn’t help but realize with Burke: "What shadows we are and what shadows we pursue."
The actual casualties were, in proportion to the numbers engaged, greater than in any action of the British army in India for many years. Out of a force which at no time exceeded 1000 men, nine British officers, four native officers, and 136 soldiers were either killed or wounded. The following is the full return:—
The actual casualties were, in proportion to the numbers involved, greater than in any action of the British army in India for many years. Out of a force that never exceeded 1,000 men, nine British officers, four native officers, and 136 soldiers were either killed or wounded. The following is the full report:—
BRITISH OFFICERS. Killed—Lieutenant and Adjutant V. Hughes, 35th Sikhs. " " A.T. Crawford, R.A. Wounded severely—Captain W.I. Ryder, attd. 35th Sikhs. " " Lieutenant O.G. Gunning, 35th Sikhs. " " " O.R. Cassells, 35th Sikhs. " " " T.C. Watson, R.E. " " " F.A. Wynter, R.A. Wounded slightly—Brigadier-General Jeffreys, Commanding 2nd Bde. M.F.F. " " Captain Birch, R.A. BRITISH SOLDIERS. Killed. Wounded. The Buffs . . . . 2 9 NATIVE RANKS. Killed. Wounded. 11th Bengal Lancers . . 0 2 No.8 Mountain Battery. . 6 21 Guides Infantry. . . 2 10 35th Sikhs. . . . 22 45 38th Dogras. . . . 0 2 Sappers.. . . . 4 15 Total Casualties, 149; with 48 horses and mules.
BRITISH OFFICERS. Killed—Lieutenant and Adjutant V. Hughes, 35th Sikhs. " " A.T. Crawford, R.A. Severely Wounded—Captain W.I. Ryder, attached to 35th Sikhs. " " Lieutenant O.G. Gunning, 35th Sikhs. " " " O.R. Cassells, 35th Sikhs. " " " T.C. Watson, R.E. " " " F.A. Wynter, R.A. Slightly Wounded—Brigadier-General Jeffreys, Commanding 2nd Bde. M.F.F. " " Captain Birch, R.A. BRITISH SOLDIERS. Killed. Wounded. The Buffs . . . . 2 9 NATIVE RANKS. Killed. Wounded. 11th Bengal Lancers . . 0 2 No.8 Mountain Battery. . 6 21 Guides Infantry. . . 2 10 35th Sikhs. . . . 22 45 38th Dogras. . . . 0 2 Sappers.. . . . 4 15 Total Casualties, 149; with 48 horses and mules.
The action of the 16th September is considered by some to have been a reverse. I do not think this view is justified by the facts. The troops accomplished every task they were set. They burned the village of Shahi-Tangi most completely, in spite of all opposition, and they inflicted on the tribesmen a loss of over 200 men. The enemy, though elated by the capture of twenty-two rifles from the bodies of the killed, were impressed by the bravery of the troops. "If," they are reported to have said, "they fight like this when they are divided, we can do nothing." Our losses were undoubtedly heavy and out of all proportion to the advantages gained. They were due to an ignorance, shared by all in the force, of the numbers and fighting power of the Mamunds. No one knew, though there were many who were wise after the event, that these tribesmen were as well armed as the troops, or that they were the brave and formidable adversaries they proved themselves. "Never despise your enemy" is an old lesson, but it has to be learnt afresh, year after year, by every nation that is warlike and brave. Our losses were also due to the isolation of Captain Ryder's company, to extricate which the whole force had to wait till overtaken by darkness. It has been said that war cannot be made without running risks, nor can operations be carried out in the face of an enemy armed with breech-loaders without loss. No tactics can altogether shield men from bullets. Those serene critics who note the errors, and forget the difficulties, who judge in safety of what was done in danger, and from the security of peace, pronounce upon the conduct of war, should remember that the spectacle of a General, wounded, his horse shot, remaining on the field with the last unit, anxious only for the safety of his soldiers, is a spectacle not unworthy of the pages of our military history.
The events of September 16th are seen by some as a setback. I don't believe this perspective is supported by the facts. The troops accomplished every task given to them. They completely burned the village of Shahi-Tangi, despite facing resistance, and inflicted more than 200 casualties on the tribesmen. Although the enemy was buoyed by capturing twenty-two rifles from the deceased, they were struck by the courage of our troops. "If," they reportedly said, "they fight like this even when divided, we can do nothing." Our losses were certainly significant and far outweighed the advantages gained. This was due to a lack of knowledge shared by everyone in the force regarding the numbers and fighting power of the Mamunds. Despite many claiming to have insight after the fact, no one realized that these tribesmen were as well-armed as our troops, or that they would turn out to be brave and formidable opponents. "Never underestimate your enemy" is an old lesson, but it's one that every warlike and courageous nation has to relearn year after year. Our losses were also a result of Captain Ryder's company being isolated, which forced the entire force to wait until darkness fell to rescue them. It has been said that you can’t engage in war without taking risks, nor can operations be conducted against an enemy armed with breech-loaders without some losses. No tactics can completely protect soldiers from bullets. Those calm critics who point out mistakes while ignoring the challenges, who safely judge what was done in danger from the comfort of peace, should remember that the sight of a wounded General, with his horse shot, staying on the field with the last unit, only concerned for the safety of his soldiers, is an image worthy of our military history.
The depression, caused by the loss of amiable and gallant comrades, was dispelled by the prospects of immediate action. Sir Bindon Blood, whose position at Nawagai was now one of danger, sent the brigadier, instead of reinforcements, orders to vigorously prosecute the operations against the tribesmen, and on the morning of the 18th the force moved to attack the village of Domodoloh, which the 38th Dogras had found so strongly occupied on the 16th. Again the enemy were numerous. Again they adopted their effective tactics; but this time no chances were given them. The whole brigade marched concentrated to the attack, and formed up on the level ground just out of shot. The general and his staff rode forward and reconnoitered.
The sadness from losing friendly and brave comrades faded away at the thought of upcoming action. Sir Bindon Blood, who was now in a risky position at Nawagai, sent word to the brigadier, directing him to aggressively continue operations against the tribesmen instead of sending reinforcements. On the morning of the 18th, the force set out to attack the village of Domodoloh, which the 38th Dogras had discovered to be heavily defended on the 16th. Once again, the enemy was numerous and used their usual effective tactics; but this time, no chances were taken. The entire brigade marched together to the attack and lined up on the flat ground just out of range. The general and his staff moved forward to survey the situation.
The village lay in a re-entrant of the hills, from which two long spurs projected like the piers of a harbour. Behind, the mountains rose abruptly to a height of 5000 feet. The ground, embraced by the spurs, was filled with crops of maize and barley. A fort and watch-tower guarded the entrance. At 8.30 the advance was ordered. The enemy did not attempt to hold the fort, and it was promptly seized and blown up. The explosion was a strange, though, during the fighting in the Mamund Valley, not an uncommon sight. A great cloud of thick brown-red dust sprang suddenly into the air, bulging out in all directions. The tower broke in half and toppled over. A series of muffled bangs followed. The dust-cloud cleared away, and nothing but a few ruins remained.
The village was nestled in a dip of the hills, with two long spurs sticking out like the piers of a harbor. Behind it, the mountains shot up abruptly to a height of 5,000 feet. The area between the spurs was filled with fields of corn and barley. A fort and watchtower protected the entrance. At 8:30, the attack was ordered. The enemy didn’t try to defend the fort, and it was quickly captured and blown up. The explosion was unusual, but during the fighting in the Mamund Valley, it wasn’t a rare sight. A huge cloud of thick brown-red dust suddenly erupted into the air, spreading out in all directions. The tower split in half and fell over. A series of muffled bangs followed. As the dust cleared, only a few ruins remained.
The enemy now opened fire from the spurs, both of which became crowned with little circles of white smoke. The 35th Sikhs advancing cleared the right ridge: the 38th Dogras the left. The Guides moved on the village, and up the main re-entrant itself. The Buffs were in reserve. The battery came into action on the left, and began shelling the crests of the opposite hills. Taking the range with their instruments, they fired two shots in rapid succession, each time at slightly different ranges. The little guns exploded with a loud report. Then, far up the mountain side, two balls of smoke appeared, one above the other, and after a few seconds the noise of the bursting shells came faintly back. Usually one would be a little short of—and the other a little over—the point aimed at. The next shot, by dividing the error, would go home, and the dust of the splinters and bullets would show on the peak, from which the tribesmen were firing, and it would become silent and deserted—the scene of an unregarded tragedy. Gradually the spurs were cleared of the enemy and the Guides, passing through the village, climbed up the face of the mountain and established themselves among the great rocks of the steep water-course. Isolated sharpshooters maintained a dropping fire. The company whose operations I watched,—Lieutenant Lockhart's,—killed one of these with a volley, and we found him sitting by a little pool, propped against a stone. He had been an ugly man originally, but now that the bones of his jaw and face were broken in pieces by the bullet, he was hideous to look upon. His only garment was a ragged blue linen cloak fastened at the waist. There he sat—a typical tribesman, ignorant, degraded, and squalid, yet brave and warlike; his only property, his weapon, and that his countrymen had carried off. I could not help contrasting his intrinsic value as a social organism, with that of the officers who had been killed during the week, and those lines of Kipling which appear at the beginning of this chapter were recalled to mind with a strange significance. Indeed I often heard them quoted in the Watelai Valley.
The enemy began firing from the spurs, which soon filled the air with little puffs of white smoke. The 35th Sikhs advanced and took the right ridge, while the 38th Dogras moved up the left. The Guides headed toward the village and made their way up the main re-entrant. The Buffs were held in reserve. The battery positioned itself on the left and started shelling the crests of the opposite hills. They adjusted their aim using their instruments, firing two shots in quick succession, each time at slightly different distances. The small guns fired with a loud bang. Then, up the mountainside, two clouds of smoke appeared, one above the other, and after a few seconds, the sound of the exploding shells faintly returned. Usually, one shot would fall a bit short and the other would go a little long of the target. The next shot, correcting the errors, would hit the mark, and the dust from the shattered rocks and bullets would rise on the peak where the tribesmen were firing, turning it into a silent, abandoned site—a scene of unnoticed tragedy. Gradually, the spurs were cleared of the enemy, and the Guides, moving through the village, climbed the mountainside and established themselves among the large boulders of the steep watercourse. Isolated sharpshooters continued to fire intermittently. The company I was observing—Lieutenant Lockhart's—took one out with a volley, and we found him sitting by a small pool, propped against a rock. He had been an unattractive man at first, but now with his jaw and face shattered by the bullet, he looked grotesque. His only clothing was a tattered blue linen cloak tied at the waist. There he sat—a typical tribesman, uneducated, degraded, and miserable, yet brave and combative; his only possession was his weapon, and that had been taken by his fellow countrymen. I couldn’t help but compare his intrinsic worth as a person to that of the officers who had been killed that week, and those lines from Kipling that open this chapter came to mind with a strange relevance. I often heard them quoted in the Watelai Valley.
The sappers had now entered the village, and were engaged in preparing the hovels of which it consisted for destruction. Their flat roofs are covered with earth, and will not burn properly, unless a hole is made first in each. This took time. Meanwhile the troops held on to the positions they had seized, and maintained a desultory fire with the enemy. At about noon the place was lighted up, and a dense cloud of smoke rose in a high column into the still air. Then the withdrawal of the troops was ordered. Immediately the enemy began their counter attack. But the Guides were handled with much skill. The retirement of each company was covered by the fire of others, judiciously posted farther down the hill. No opportunity was offered to the enemy. By one o'clock all the troops were clear of the broken ground. The Buffs assumed the duty of rear-guard, and were delighted to have a brisk little skirmish—fortunately unattended with loss of life—with the tribesmen, who soon reoccupied the burning village. This continued for, perhaps, half an hour, and meanwhile the rest of the brigade returned to camp.
The sappers had now entered the village and were busy getting the huts ready for destruction. Their flat roofs were covered with earth and wouldn't burn properly unless a hole was made in each one first. This took time. In the meantime, the troops held onto the positions they had taken and maintained sporadic fire with the enemy. Around noon, the place was set ablaze, and a thick cloud of smoke rose into the still air. Then the troops were ordered to withdraw. Immediately, the enemy launched a counterattack. But the Guides were handled with great skill. The retreat of each company was covered by the fire of others, wisely positioned further down the hill. The enemy was given no chance. By one o'clock, all the troops were clear of the rough terrain. The Buffs took on the role of rear guard and were happy to have a quick skirmish—thankfully without any casualties—with the tribesmen, who soon took back the burning village. This went on for about half an hour, while the rest of the brigade returned to camp.
The casualties in this highly successful affair were small. It was the first of six such enterprises, by which Brigadier-General Jeffreys, with stubborn perseverance, broke the spirit of the Mamund tribesmen.
The casualties in this very successful operation were minimal. It was the first of six such missions, through which Brigadier-General Jeffreys, with relentless determination, shattered the spirit of the Mamund tribesmen.
Killed. Wounded. 35th Sikhs....... 2 3 Guides Infantry...... 0 1 38th Dogras....... 0 2 Total casualties, 8.
Killed. Wounded. 35th Sikhs....... 2 3 Guides Infantry...... 0 1 38th Dogras....... 0 2 Total casualties, 8.
The enemy's losses were considerable, but no reliable details could be obtained.
The enemy's losses were significant, but no trustworthy information could be gathered.
On the 19th the troops rested, and only foraging parties left the camp. On the 20th, fighting was renewed. From the position at the entrance to the valley it was possible to see all the villages that lay in the hollows of the hills, and to distinguish not only the scenes of past but also of future actions. The particular village which was selected for chastisement was never mentioned by name, and it was not until the brigade had marched some miles from the camp, that the objective became evident. The tribesmen therefore continued in a state of "glorious uncertainty," and were unable to gather in really large numbers. At 5.30 A.M. the brigade started, and, preceded by the cavalry, marched up the valley—a long brown stream of men. Arrived nearly at the centre, the troops closed up into a more compact formation. Then suddenly the head wheeled to the left, and began marching on the village of Zagai. Immediately from high up on the face of the mountain a long column of smoke shot into the air. It was a signal fire. Other hills answered it. The affair now became a question of time. If the village could be captured and destroyed before the clans had time to gather, then there would be little fighting. But if the force were delayed or became involved, it was impossible to say on what scale the action would be.
On the 19th, the troops took a break, and only foraging parties left the camp. On the 20th, fighting resumed. From the position at the entrance to the valley, it was possible to see all the villages nestled in the hills and to recognize not just the scenes from the past but also those of future encounters. The specific village chosen for punishment was never named, and it wasn't until the brigade had marched several miles from the camp that the target became clear. The tribesmen, therefore, remained in a state of "glorious uncertainty," unable to gather in large numbers. At 5:30 A.M., the brigade set out, led by the cavalry, marching up the valley—like a long brown stream of soldiers. Once almost at the center, the troops tightened their formation. Then suddenly, the front veered left and began marching toward the village of Zagai. Immediately, a long column of smoke shot up from high on the mountain's face. It was a signal fire. Other hills responded. The situation now became a race against time. If the village could be captured and destroyed before the clans had a chance to assemble, there would be little fighting. But if the force got delayed or caught up in skirmishes, it was impossible to predict how large the conflict would become.
The village of Zagai stands in a similar situation to that of Domodoloh. On either side long spurs advance into the valley, and the houses are built in terraces on the sides of the hollow so formed. Great chenar trees, growing in all their luxuriant beauty out of the rocky ground by the water-course, mark the hillside with a patch of green in contrast to the background of sombre brown. As the troops approached in fine array, the sound of incessant drumming was faintly heard, varied from time to time by the notes of a bugle. The cavalry reconnoitered and trotted off to watch the flank, after reporting the place strongly occupied. The enemy displayed standards on the crests of the spurs. The advance continued: the Guides on the left, the 38th Dogras in the centre, the Buffs on the right, and the 35th Sikhs in reserve. Firing began on the left at about nine o'clock, and a quarter of an hour later the guns came into action near the centre. The Guides and Buffs now climbed the ridges to the right and left. The enemy fell back according to their custom, "sniping." Then the 38th pushed forward and occupied the village, which was handed over to the sappers to destroy. This they did most thoroughly, and at eleven o'clock a dense white smoke was rising from the houses and the stacks of bhoosa. Then the troops were ordered to withdraw. "Facilis ascensus Averni sed...;" without allowing the quotation to lead me into difficulties, I will explain that while it is usually easy to advance against an Asiatic, all retirements are matters of danger. While the village was being destroyed the enemy had been collecting. Their figures could be distinguished on the top of the mountain—a numerous line of dark dots against the sky; others had tried to come, from the adjoining valleys on the left and right. Those on the right succeeded, and the Buffs were soon sharply engaged. On the left the cavalry again demonstrated the power of their arm. A large force of tribesmen, numbering at least 600 men, endeavoured to reach the scene of action. To get there, however, they had to cross the open ground, and this, in face of the Lancers, they would not do. Many of these same tribesmen had joined in the attack on the Malakand, and had been chased all across the plain of Khar by the fierce Indian horsemen. They were not ambitious to repeat the experience. Every time they tried to cross the space, which separated them from their friends, Captain Cole trotted forward with his squadron, which was only about fifty strong, and the tribesmen immediately scurried back to the hills. For a long time they were delayed, and contented themselves by howling out to the sowars, that they would soon "make mincemeat of them," to which the latter replied that they were welcome to try. At length, realising that they could not escape the cavalry, if they left the hills, they made a long circuit and arrived about half an hour after the village was destroyed and the troops had departed.
The village of Zagai is in a situation similar to that of Domodoloh. On both sides, long ridges extend into the valley, and the houses are built in terraces along the sides of the depression formed. Majestic chenar trees, thriving in their lush beauty from the rocky ground by the stream, create a splash of green against the backdrop of dark brown. As the troops approached in neat formation, the sound of constant drumming could be heard faintly, occasionally interrupted by the notes of a bugle. The cavalry scouted ahead and moved off to monitor the flank after confirming that the area was heavily defended. The enemy raised flags on the ridges. The advance continued: the Guides on the left, the 38th Dogras in the center, the Buffs on the right, and the 35th Sikhs in reserve. Firing started on the left around nine o'clock, and a quarter-hour later, the artillery came into play near the center. The Guides and Buffs climbed the ridges to their respective sides. The enemy fell back, as they typically did, engaging in "sniping." Then the 38th moved up and took the village, which was then handed over to the sappers for destruction. They did this thoroughly, and by eleven o'clock, thick white smoke was rising from the houses and stacks of bhoosa. After that, the troops were ordered to pull back. "Facilis ascensus Averni sed..."; without letting the quote lead me into complications, I'll say that while it’s usually easy to advance against an enemy in Asia, retreating is always fraught with danger. While the village was being destroyed, the enemy had been gathering. Their figures were visible on top of the mountain—a long line of dark shapes against the sky; others attempted to come from the valleys on the left and right. Those on the right managed to succeed, and the Buffs soon found themselves heavily engaged. On the left, the cavalry once again showcased their prowess. A large group of tribesmen, at least 600 strong, tried to reach the fight. To do so, they had to cross open ground, which they were unwilling to do in the face of the Lancers. Many of these tribesmen had participated in the attack on Malakand and had been chased across the plains of Khar by fierce Indian horsemen. They were not eager to go through that again. Each time they attempted to cross the gap between them and their allies, Captain Cole rode forward with his squadron, which numbered only about fifty, and the tribesmen quickly retreated back to the hills. They were delayed for a long time, opting instead to yell at the sowars that they would soon "make mincemeat out of them," to which the sowars replied that they were welcome to try. Eventually, realizing they couldn't evade the cavalry if they left the hills, they made a long detour and arrived about half an hour after the village had been destroyed and the troops had left.
Nevertheless, as soon as the retirement was seen to be in progress, a general attack was made all along the line. On the left, the Guides were threatened by a force of about 500 men, who advanced displaying standards, and waving swords. They dispersed these and drove them away by a steady long-range fire, killing and wounding a large number. On the right, the Buffs were harassed by being commanded by another spur. Lieutenant Hasler's company, which I accompanied, was protected from this flanking fire by the ground. A great many bullets, however, hummed overhead, and being anxious to see whence these were coming, the lieutenant walked across the crest to the far side. The half-company here was briskly engaged. From a point high up the mountain an accurate fire was directed upon them. We tried to get the range of this point with the Lee-Metford rifles. It was, as nearly as could be determined, 1400 yards. The tribesmen were only armed with Martini-Henrys. They nevertheless made excellent practice. Lieutenant R.E. Power was shot through the arm and, almost immediately afterwards, Lieutenant Keene was severely wounded in the body. Luckily, the bullet struck his sword-hilt first or he would have been killed. Two or three men were also wounded here. Those who know the range and power of the Martini-Henry rifle will appreciate the skill and marksmanship which can inflict loss even at so great a range.
Nevertheless, as soon as the retreat began, a general attack was launched all along the line. On the left, the Guides faced a force of about 500 men, who advanced waving standards and swords. They scattered these attackers and pushed them back with steady fire from a distance, killing and wounding many. On the right, the Buffs were harassed by another flanking assault. Lieutenant Hasler's company, which I was with, was shielded from this flanking fire by the terrain. However, many bullets whizzed overhead, and wanting to see where they were coming from, the lieutenant walked across the ridge to the other side. The half-company there was heavily engaged. From a high point on the mountain, precise fire was directed at them. We tried to determine the range of this position with the Lee-Metford rifles. It was estimated to be about 1400 yards. The tribesmen were only armed with Martini-Henrys, yet they still showed remarkable accuracy. Lieutenant R.E. Power was shot through the arm, and shortly after, Lieutenant Keene was severely wounded in the torso. Fortunately, the bullet hit his sword-hilt first, or he would have been killed. Two or three other men were also wounded here. Those who understand the range and power of the Martini-Henry rifle will appreciate the skill and marksmanship that can cause casualties even at such a long distance.
As the retirement proceeded, the tribesmen came to closer quarters. The Buffs, however, used their formidable weapon with great effect. I witnessed one striking demonstration of its power. Lieutenant F.S. Reeves remained behind with a dozen men to cover the withdrawal of his company, and in hopes of bringing effective fire to bear on the enemy, who at this time were pressing forward boldly. Three hundred yards away was a nullah, and along this they began running, in hopes of cutting off the small party. At one point, however, the line of their advance was commanded by our fire. Presently a man ran into the open. The section fired immediately. The great advantage of the rifle was that there was no difficulty about guessing the exact range, as the fixed sight could be used. The man dropped—a spot of white. Four others rushed forward. Again there was a volley. All four fell and remained motionless. After this we made good our retreat almost unmolested.
As the retirement continued, the tribesmen moved in closer. The Buffs, however, used their powerful weapon effectively. I witnessed a striking demonstration of its power. Lieutenant F.S. Reeves stayed back with a dozen men to cover his company's withdrawal, hoping to bring effective fire on the enemy, who were boldly advancing at that time. Three hundred yards away was a dry streambed, and they started running along it, trying to cut off the small group. At one point, however, our fire commanded their line of advance. Soon a man ran into the open. The section fired immediately. The great advantage of the rifle was that there was no guessing the exact range since the fixed sight could be used. The man fell—a spot of white. Four others rushed forward. Again there was a volley. All four fell and lay still. After that, we made our retreat with little trouble.
As soon as the troops were clear of the hills, the enemy occupied the rocks and ridges, and fired at the retreating soldiers. The Buffs' line of retirement lay over smooth, open ground. For ten minutes the fire was hot. Another officer and seven or eight men dropped. The ground was wet and deep, and the bullets cutting into the soft mud, made strange and curious noises. As soon as the troops got out of range, the firing ceased, as the tribesmen did not dare follow into the open.
As soon as the troops moved away from the hills, the enemy took over the rocks and ridges and shot at the retreating soldiers. The Buffs' path to retreat was through smooth, open ground. For ten minutes, the gunfire was intense. Another officer and seven or eight men went down. The ground was wet and muddy, and the bullets striking the soft mud made strange and curious noises. As soon as the troops were out of range, the shooting stopped, since the tribesmen didn't dare follow them into the open.
On the extreme left, considerable bodies of the enemy appeared, and for a moment it seemed that they would leave the hills and come into the plain. The cavalry, however, trotted forward, and they ran back in confusion, bunching together as they did so. The battery immediately exploded two shrapnel shells in their midst with great effect. This ended the affair, and the troops returned to camp. The casualties were as follows:—
On the far left, a significant number of enemy troops showed up, and for a moment, it looked like they would come down from the hills into the plain. However, the cavalry moved forward, causing them to retreat in disarray, crowding together as they did. The artillery then fired off two shrapnel shells right in their midst with serious impact. That wrapped up the situation, and the troops went back to camp. The casualties were as follows:—
BRITISH OFFICERS. Wounded severely—2nd Lieutenant G.N.S. Keene. " slightly—Captain L.I.B. Hulke. " " —Lieutenant R.E. Power. BRITISH SOLDIERS. Killed. Wounded. Buffs. . . . . 1 10 (Died of wounds). Native Ranks. Wounded. 38th Dogras . . .. 2 Total casualties, 16.
BRITISH OFFICERS. Severely wounded—2nd Lieutenant G.N.S. Keene. " slightly—Captain L.I.B. Hulke. " " —Lieutenant R.E. Power. BRITISH SOLDIERS. Killed. Wounded. Buffs. . . . . 1 10 (Died of wounds). Native Ranks. Wounded. 38th Dogras . . .. 2 Total casualties, 16.
I shall make the reader no apology for having described at such length, what was after all only a skirmish. The picture of the war on the frontier is essentially one of detail, and it is by the study of the details alone that a true impression can be obtained.
I won’t apologize to the reader for going into such detail about what was, after all, just a skirmish. The portrayal of the war on the frontier is fundamentally about the details, and it’s only by examining those details that a true impression can be gained.
On the 22nd and 23rd the villages of Dag and Tangi were respectively captured and destroyed, but as the resistance was slight and the operations were unmarked by any new features, I shall not weary the reader by further description. The casualties were:—
On the 22nd and 23rd, the villages of Dag and Tangi were captured and destroyed, but since the resistance was minimal and the operations didn't have any noteworthy details, I won't bore the reader with more descriptions. The casualties were:—
BRITISH OFFICER. Wounded—Major S. Moody, the Buffs. NATIVE RANKS. Killed. Wounded. Guides Infantry. . . 1 2 38th Dogras. . . . 0 2
BRITISH OFFICER. Injured—Major S. Moody, the Buffs. NATIVE RANKS. Killed. Injured. Guides Infantry. . . 1 2 38th Dogras. . . . 0 2
By these operations the tribesmen of the Mamund Valley had been severely punished. Any exultation which they might have felt over the action of the 16th was completely effaced. The brigade had demonstrated its power to take and burn any village that might be selected, and had inflicted severe loss on all who attempted to impede its action. The tribesmen were now thoroughly disheartened, and on the 21st began to sue for peace.
By these actions, the tribesmen of the Mamund Valley were harshly punished. Any celebration they might have felt over the events of the 16th was entirely wiped out. The brigade showed its ability to capture and destroy any village it chose, causing significant losses to anyone who tried to stop its advance. The tribesmen were now completely demoralized, and on the 21st they began to seek peace.
The situation was, however, complicated by the proximity of the Afghan frontier. The western side of the Mamund Valley is bounded by the mountains of the Hindu Raj range, along the summits of which is the Durand line of demarcation with the Amir. On the farther side of this range Gholam Hyder, the Afghan commander-in-chief, lay with a powerful force, which, at the time of the actions I have described, amounted to nine battalions, six squadrons and fourteen mountain guns. During the attack upon Zagai, numerous figures in khaki uniform had been observed on the higher slopes of the hills, and it was alleged that one particular group appeared to be directing the movements of the tribesmen. At any rate, I cannot doubt, nor did any one who was present during the fighting in the Mamund Valley, that the natives were aided by regular soldiers from the Afghan army, and to a greater extent by Afghan tribesmen, not only by the supply of arms and ammunition but by actual intervention.
The situation was complicated by the nearby Afghan border. The western side of the Mamund Valley is bordered by the Hindu Raj mountain range, along the peaks of which runs the Durand Line marking the boundary with the Amir. On the other side of this range, Gholam Hyder, the Afghan commander-in-chief, had a strong force, which, during the events I described, included nine battalions, six squadrons, and fourteen mountain guns. During the attack on Zagai, many soldiers in khaki uniforms were spotted on the higher slopes of the hills, and it was claimed that one specific group seemed to be coordinating the movements of the tribesmen. In any case, I have no doubt, nor did anyone who witnessed the fighting in the Mamund Valley, that the locals received help from regular soldiers of the Afghan army, and even more so from Afghan tribesmen, not just in terms of arms and ammunition but also through direct involvement.
I am not in possession of sufficient evidence to pronounce on the question of the Amir's complicity in the frontier risings. It is certain, that for many years the Afghan policy has consistently been to collect and preserve agents, who might be used in raising a revolt among the Pathan tribes. But the advantages which the Amir would derive from a quarrel with the British are not apparent. It would seem more probable, that he has only tried throughout to make his friendship a matter of more importance to the Indian Government, with a view to the continuance or perhaps the increase of his subsidy. It is possible, that he has this year tested and displayed his power; and that he has desired to show us what a dangerous foe he might be, were he not so useful an ally. The question is a delicate and difficult one. Most of the evidence is contained in Secret State Papers. The inquiry would be profitless; the result possibly unwelcome. Patriotic discretion is a virtue which should at all times be zealously cultivated.
I don’t have enough evidence to comment on whether the Amir was involved in the unrest at the border. It’s clear that for many years, Afghanistan’s strategy has been to gather and keep agents who could support a revolt among the Pathan tribes. However, it’s not obvious what the Amir would gain from a conflict with the British. It seems more likely that he has been trying to make his friendship with the Indian Government feel more valuable to ensure the continuation or perhaps an increase of his financial support. It’s possible that this year he has tested and shown his strength, wanting to demonstrate how dangerous he could be if he weren't such a useful partner. This is a sensitive and complicated issue. Most of the information is found in Secret State Papers. An investigation wouldn’t be useful; the outcome could even be unpleasant. Being patriotically discreet is a quality that should always be actively encouraged.
I do not see that the facts I have stated diminish or increase the probability of the Amir's complicity. As the American filibusters sympathise with the Cuban insurgents; as the Jameson raiders supported the outlanders of the Transvaal, so also the soldiers and tribesmen of Afghanistan sympathised with and aided their countrymen and coreligionists across the border. Probably the Afghan Colonial Office would have been vindicated by any inquiry.
I don't think the facts I've mentioned change the likelihood of the Amir being involved. Just as the American filibusters supported the Cuban rebels and the Jameson Raiders backed the outsiders in the Transvaal, the soldiers and tribesmen of Afghanistan also sympathized with and helped their fellow countrymen and co-religionists across the border. It's likely that the Afghan Colonial Office would have been cleared if there had been any investigation.
It is no disparagement but rather to the honour of men, that they should be prepared to back with their lives causes which claim their sympathy. It is indeed to such men that human advancement has been due. I do not allude to this matter, to raise hostile feelings against the Afghan tribesmen or their ruler, but only to explain the difficulties encountered in the Mamund Valley by the 2nd Brigade of the Malakand Field Force: to explain how it was that defenders of obscure villages were numbered by thousands, and why the weapons of poverty-stricken agriculturists were excellent Martini-Henry rifles.
It’s not a criticism but rather a point of pride for men to be willing to risk their lives for causes they believe in. Truly, it’s these men who have driven human progress. I mention this not to stir up negative feelings against the Afghan tribesmen or their leader, but simply to clarify the challenges faced by the 2nd Brigade of the Malakand Field Force in the Mamund Valley: to explain how defenders from small, little-known villages numbered in the thousands and why the weapons of struggling farmers were top-quality Martini-Henry rifles.
The Mamunds themselves were now genuinely anxious for peace. Their valley was in our hands; their villages and crops were at our mercy; but their allies, who suffered none of these things, were eager to continue the struggle. They had captured most of the rifles of the dead soldiers on the 16th, and they had no intention of giving them up. On the other hand, it was obvious that the British Raj could not afford to be defied in this matter. We had insisted on the rifles being surrendered, and that expensive factor, Imperial prestige, demanded that we should prosecute operations till we got them, no matter what the cost might be. The rifles were worth little. The men and officers we lost were worth a great deal. It was unsound economics, but Imperialism and economics clash as often as honesty and self-interest. We were therefore committed to the policy of throwing good money after bad in order to keep up our credit; as a man who cannot pay his tradesmen, sends them fresh orders in lieu of settlement. Under these unsatisfactory conditions, the negotiations opened. They did not, however, interfere with the military situation, and the troops continued to forage daily in the valley, and the tribesmen to fire nightly into the camp.
The Mamunds were genuinely anxious for peace now. Their valley was under our control; their villages and crops were at our mercy, but their allies, who weren’t facing these issues, were eager to keep fighting. They had taken most of the rifles from the dead soldiers on the 16th and had no plans to return them. On the flip side, it was clear that the British Raj couldn’t afford to be defied in this situation. We insisted on the rifles being handed over, and that costly element, Imperial prestige, required us to continue operations until we got them, no matter the price. The rifles weren’t worth much, but the men and officers we lost were extremely valuable. It was poor economics, but Imperialism and economics often conflict, just as honesty clashes with self-interest. So we were stuck with the policy of throwing good money after bad to maintain our credibility, like someone who can’t pay their bills but keeps placing new orders instead. Under these frustrating circumstances, the negotiations began. However, they didn’t affect the military situation, and the troops kept foraging daily in the valley while the tribesmen continued to shoot into the camp each night.
At the end of the week a message from the Queen, expressing sympathy with the sufferings of the wounded, and satisfaction at the conduct of the troops, was published in Brigade orders. It caused the most lively pleasure to all, but particularly to the native soldiers, who heard with pride and exultation that their deeds and dangers were not unnoticed by that august Sovereign before whom they know all their princes bow, and to whom the Sirkar itself is but a servant. The cynic and the socialist may sneer after their kind; yet the patriot, who examines with anxious care those forces which tend to the cohesion or disruption of great communities, will observe how much the influence of a loyal sentiment promotes the solidarity of the Empire.
At the end of the week, a message from the Queen expressing sympathy for the wounded and appreciation for the troops' conduct was published in Brigade orders. This brought great joy to everyone, especially to the native soldiers, who felt pride and excitement knowing that their efforts and sacrifices were recognized by that revered Sovereign, whom all their princes respect, and to whom the government itself is merely a servant. The cynics and socialists might scoff at this, but the patriot, who carefully looks at the forces that either unite or divide large communities, will see how much a sense of loyalty helps strengthen the Empire.
The reader must now accompany me to the camp of the 3rd Brigade, twelve miles away, at Nawagai. We shall return to the Mamund Valley and have a further opportunity of studying its people and natural features.
The reader must now join me at the 3rd Brigade camp, twelve miles away, at Nawagai. We will return to the Mamund Valley and have another chance to explore its people and natural features.
CHAPTER XIII: NAWAGAI
"When the wild Bajaur mountain men lay choking with their blood, And the Kafirs held their footing..." "A Sermon in Lower Bengal," SIR A. LYALL.
"When the fierce Bajaur mountain men lie dying in their own blood, And the infidels maintain their position..." "A Sermon in Lower Bengal," SIR A. LYALL.
Few spectacles in nature are so mournful and so sinister as the implacable cruelty with which a wounded animal is pursued by its fellows. Perhaps it is due to a cold and bracing climate, perhaps to a Christian civilisation, that the Western peoples of the world have to a great extent risen above this low original instinct. Among Europeans power provokes antagonism, and weakness excites pity. All is different in the East. Beyond Suez the bent of men's minds is such, that safety lies only in success, and peace in prosperity. All desert the falling. All turn upon the fallen.
Few sights in nature are as heartbreaking and cruel as the relentless way a wounded animal is chased by its peers. Maybe it's because of a harsh climate, or perhaps it's a result of a Christian society, that Western people have mostly moved past this primitive instinct. In Europe, strength leads to rivalry, while weakness inspires compassion. It's a different story in the East. Beyond Suez, people's mindset is such that safety comes only from success, and peace from prosperity. Everyone abandons the weak. Everyone turns against the fallen.
The reader may have been struck, in the account of the fighting in the Mamund Valley, with the vigour with which the tribesmen follow up a retreating enemy and press an isolated party. In war this is sound, practical policy. But the hillmen adopt it rather from a natural propensity, than from military knowledge. Their tactics are the outcome of their natures. All their actions, moral, political, strategic, are guided by the same principle. The powerful tribes, who had watched the passage of the troops in sullen fear, only waited for a sign of weakness to rise behind them. As long as the brigades dominated the country, and appeared confident and successful, their communications would be respected, and the risings localised; but a check, a reverse, a retreat would raise tremendous combinations on every side.
The reader might have noticed, in the description of the fighting in the Mamund Valley, how fiercely the tribesmen pursue a retreating enemy and attack an isolated group. In war, this is a smart and practical strategy. However, the hillmen follow this approach more out of their natural instincts than from military strategy. Their tactics reflect their character. All their actions—moral, political, and strategic—are guided by the same principle. The powerful tribes, who watched the troops pass by in grim apprehension, only waited for a sign of weakness to strike from behind. As long as the brigades controlled the area and seemed confident and successful, their communications would be respected, and local uprisings would remain contained; but a setback, a defeat, or a retreat would trigger massive opposition on all sides.
If the reader will bear this in mind, it will enable him to appreciate the position with which this chapter deals, and may explain many other matters which are beyond the scope of these pages. For it might be well also to remember, that the great drama of frontier war is played before a vast, silent but attentive audience, who fill a theatre, that reaches from Peshawar to Colombo, and from Kurrachee to Rangoon.
If the reader keeps this in mind, it will help them understand the topic this chapter discusses and may clarify many other things that aren’t covered in these pages. It’s worth noting that the major drama of frontier warfare unfolds before a huge, silent yet attentive audience that spans a theater from Peshawar to Colombo and from Karachi to Rangoon.
The strategic and political situation, with which Sir Bindon Blood was confronted at Nawagai on the 17th of September, was one of difficulty and danger. He had advanced into a hostile country. In his front the Mohmands had gathered at the Hadda Mullah's call to oppose his further progress. The single brigade he had with him was not strong enough to force the Bedmanai Pass, which the enemy held. The 2nd Brigade, on which he had counted, was fully employed twelve miles away in the Mamund Valley. The 1st Brigade, nearly four marches distant on the Panjkora River, had not sufficient transport to move. Meanwhile General Elles's division was toiling painfully through the difficult country north-east of Shabkadr, and could not arrive for several days. He was therefore isolated, and behind him was the "network of ravines," through which a retirement would be a matter of the greatest danger and difficulty.
The strategic and political situation that Sir Bindon Blood faced at Nawagai on September 17 was full of challenges and dangers. He had moved into enemy territory. In front of him, the Mohmands had gathered at the Hadda Mullah's call to block his advance. The single brigade he had with him was not strong enough to push through the Bedmanai Pass, which the enemy controlled. The 2nd Brigade, which he had relied on, was busy twelve miles away in the Mamund Valley. The 1st Brigade, almost four marches away on the Panjkora River, lacked the transportation to move. Meanwhile, General Elles's division was struggling through the tough terrain northeast of Shabkadr and wouldn't arrive for several days. Therefore, he was isolated, and behind him was a "network of ravines," making any retreat extremely dangerous and challenging.
Besides this, his line of communications, stretching away through sixty miles of hostile country, or country that at any moment might become hostile, was seriously threatened by the unexpected outbreak in the Mamund Valley. He was between two fires. Nor was this all. The Khan of Nawagai, a chief of great power and influence, was only kept loyal by the presence of Sir Bindon Blood's brigade. Had that brigade marched, as was advocated by the Government of India, back to join Brigadier-General Jeffreys in the Mamund Valley, this powerful chief would have thrown his whole weight against the British. The flame in the Mamund Valley, joining the flame in the Bedmanai Pass, would have produced a mighty conflagration, and have spread far and wide among the inflammable tribesmen. Bajaur would have risen to a man. Swat, in spite of its recent punishment, would have stirred ominously. Dir would have repudiated its ruler and joined the combination. The whole mountain region would have been ablaze. Every valley would have poured forth armed men. General Elles, arriving at Lakarai, would have found, instead of a supporting brigade, a hostile gathering, and might even have had to return to Shabkadr without accomplishing anything.
Besides this, his communication lines, extending through sixty miles of potentially hostile territory, were seriously threatened by the unexpected conflict in the Mamund Valley. He was caught in a tough situation. That wasn’t all. The Khan of Nawagai, a powerful and influential leader, remained loyal only because Sir Bindon Blood's brigade was present. If that brigade had marched back to join Brigadier-General Jeffreys in the Mamund Valley, as the Government of India had suggested, this influential chief would have fully turned against the British. The unrest in the Mamund Valley, combined with the unrest in the Bedmanai Pass, would have created a massive firestorm and spread widely among the quick-to-ignite tribesmen. Bajaur would have risen up completely. Swat, despite its recent punishment, would have reacted dangerously. Dir would have rejected its ruler and joined the uprising. The entire mountainous region would have erupted in chaos. Every valley would have sent out armed men. General Elles, arriving at Lakarai, would have found not a supporting brigade, but a hostile gathering, and might have even had to retreat to Shabkadr without achieving anything.
Sir Bindon Blood decided to remain at Nawagai; to cut the Hadda Mullah's gathering from the tribesmen in the Mamund Valley; to hold out a hand to General Elles; to keep the pass open and the khan loyal. Nawagai was the key of the situation. But that key could not be held without much danger. It was a bold course to take, but it succeeded, as bold courses, soundly conceived, usually do. He therefore sent orders to Jeffreys to press operations against the Mamund tribesmen; assured the Khan of Nawagai of the confidence of the Government, and of their determination to "protect" him from all enemies; heliographed to General Elles that he would meet him at Nawagai; entrenched his camp and waited.
Sir Bindon Blood decided to stay at Nawagai to cut off the Hadda Mullah's gathering of tribesmen in the Mamund Valley, to offer support to General Elles, and to ensure the pass remained open and the khan stayed loyal. Nawagai was the key to the situation. However, that key couldn't be held without a lot of risk. It was a risky decision to make, but it worked out, as well-planned bold actions often do. He then sent orders to Jeffreys to intensify operations against the Mamund tribesmen; assured the Khan of Nawagai that the Government had faith in him and was determined to "protect" him from all adversaries; signaled to General Elles that he would meet him at Nawagai; fortified his camp, and waited.
He did not wait long in peace. The tribesmen, whose tactical instincts have been evolved by centuries of ceaseless war, were not slow to realise that the presence of the 3rd Brigade at Nawagai was fatal to their hopes. They accordingly resolved to attack it. The Suffi and Hadda Mullahs exerted the whole of their influence upon their credulous followers. The former appealed to the hopes of future happiness. Every Ghazi who fell fighting should sit above the Caaba at the very footstool of the throne, and in that exalted situation and august presence should be solaced for his sufferings by the charms of a double allowance of celestial beauty. Mullah Hadda used even more concrete inducements. The muzzles of the guns should be stopped for those who charged home. No bullet should harm them. They should be invulnerable. They should not go to Paradise yet. They should continue to live honoured and respected upon earth. This promise appears to have carried more weight, as the Hadda Mullah's followers had three times as many killed and wounded as the candidates for the pleasures of the world to come. It would almost seem, that in the undeveloped minds of these wild and superstitious sons of the mountains, there lie the embryonic germs of economics and practical philosophy, pledges of latent possibilities of progress.
He didn’t wait long in peace. The tribesmen, whose tactical skills had been shaped by centuries of ongoing war, quickly realized that the presence of the 3rd Brigade at Nawagai was a serious threat to their plans. They decided to launch an attack. The Suffi and Hadda Mullahs used all their influence over their gullible followers. The former appealed to their hopes for future happiness. Every Ghazi who died fighting would sit above the Caaba right at the foot of the throne, and in that elevated position and sacred presence, would find comfort from his suffering with a special share of celestial beauty. Mullah Hadda offered even more tangible incentives. The gunfire would stop for those who charged bravely. No bullet would harm them. They would be invincible. They wouldn’t go to Paradise just yet; they would continue to live with honor and respect on earth. This promise seemed to carry more weight, as Hadda Mullah’s followers suffered three times as many killed and wounded compared to those seeking pleasures in the afterlife. It almost seemed that in the unrefined minds of these wild and superstitious mountain dwellers, there were the early signs of economic thought and practical philosophy, hints of untapped potential for progress.
Some for the pleasures of this world, and some Sigh for the prophet's paradise to come. Ah! take the cash and let the credit go, Nor heed the rumble of a distant drum. OMAR KHAYYAM
Some enjoy the pleasures of this world, while others Long for the paradise promised by the prophet. Ah! Take the cash and let the credit fade, And don't worry about the sound of a distant drum. OMAR KHAYYAM
It is the practice of wise commanders in all warfare, to push their cavalry out every evening along the lines of possible attack, to make sure that no enemy has concentrated near the camp in the hopes of attacking at nightfall. On the 18th, Captain Delamain's squadron of the 11th Bengal Lancers came in contact with scattered parties of the enemy coming from the direction of the Bedmanai Pass. Desultory skirmishing ensued, and the cavalry retired to camp. Some firing took place that night, and a soldier of the Queen's Regiment who strayed about fifty yards from his picket, was pulled down and murdered by the savage enemies, who were lurking all around. The next evening the cavalry reconnoitered as usual. The squadron pushed forward protected by its line of advanced scouts across the plain towards the Bedmanai Pass. Suddenly from a nullah a long line of tribesmen rose and fired a volley. A horse was shot. The squadron wheeled about and cantered off, having succeeded in what is technically called "establishing contact."
It's common practice for wise commanders in all warfare to send their cavalry out every evening along potential attack routes to ensure that no enemy has gathered near the camp with plans to strike at night. On the 18th, Captain Delamain's squadron from the 11th Bengal Lancers encountered scattered enemy forces coming from the direction of the Bedmanai Pass. A few skirmishes broke out, and the cavalry retreated to camp. Some gunfire occurred that night, and a soldier from the Queen's Regiment who wandered about fifty yards from his picket was pulled down and killed by savage enemies lurking nearby. The following evening, the cavalry conducted their usual reconnaissance. The squadron advanced, shielded by a line of scouts, across the plain toward the Bedmanai Pass. Suddenly, from a gully, a long line of tribesmen appeared and fired a volley. One horse was shot. The squadron quickly turned and galloped away, having successfully achieved what is known as "establishing contact."
A great gathering of the enemy, some 3000 strong, now appeared in the plain. For about half an hour before sunset they danced, shouted and discharged their rifles. The mountain battery fired a few shells, but the distance was too great to do much good, or shall I say harm? Then it became dark. The whole brigade remained that night in the expectation of an attack, but only a very half-hearted attempt was made. This was easily repulsed, one man in the Queen's Regiment being killed among the troops.
A huge group of enemies, around 3,000 strong, showed up in the plain. For about half an hour before sunset, they danced, shouted, and fired their rifles. The mountain battery shot off a few shells, but the distance was too far to be effective, or should I say, to cause any real damage? Then it got dark. The entire brigade stayed alert that night, expecting an attack, but only a pretty half-hearted attempt was made. This was easily pushed back, with one man from the Queen's Regiment being killed among the troops.
On the 20th, however, definite information was received from the Khan of Nawagai, that a determined assault would be made on the camp that night. The cavalry reconnaissance again came in touch with the enemy at nightfall. The officers had dinner an hour earlier, and had just finished, when, at about 8.30, firing began. The position of the camp was commanded, though at long ranges, by the surrounding heights. From these a searching rifle fire was now opened. All the tents were struck. The officers and men not employed in the trenches were directed to lie down. The majority of the bullets, clearing the parapets of the entrenchment on one side, whizzed across without doing any harm to the prostrate figures; but all walking about was perilous, and besides this the plunging fire from the heights was galling to every one.
On the 20th, however, we received solid information from the Khan of Nawagai that there would be a serious attack on the camp that night. The cavalry scouts made contact with the enemy again at sunset. The officers had dinner an hour earlier and had just finished when, at around 8:30, the shooting started. The camp's position was overlooked, although from a distance, by the surrounding hills. From these heights, a relentless rifle fire was unleashed. All the tents were taken down. The officers and soldiers not involved in the trenches were told to lie down. Most of the bullets, flying over the parapets of the trench on one side, zipped past without hitting anyone on the ground; but moving around was dangerous, and the incoming fire from the heights was a source of frustration for everyone.
Determined and vigorous sword charges were now delivered on all sides of the camp. The enemy, who numbered about 4000, displayed the greatest valour. They rushed right up to the trenches and fell dead and dying, under the very bayonets of the troops. The brunt of the attack fell upon the British Infantry Regiment, the Queen's. This was fortunate, as many who were in camp that night say, that such was the determination of the enemy in their charges, that had they not been confronted with magazine rifles, they might have got into the entrenchments.
Determined and powerful sword charges were now launched from all sides of the camp. The enemy, numbering about 4,000, showed incredible bravery. They charged straight up to the trenches, falling dead and wounded under the very bayonets of the troops. The main force of the attack hit the British Infantry Regiment, the Queen's. Fortunately, as many who were in camp that night say, the enemy was so determined in their assaults that if they hadn't faced magazine rifles, they might have breached the entrenchments.
The fire of the British was, however, crushing. Their discipline was admirable, and the terrible weapon with which they were armed, with its more terrible bullet, stopped every rush. The soldiers, confident in their power, were under perfect control. When the enemy charged, the order to employ magazine fire was passed along the ranks. The guns fired star shell. These great rockets, bursting into stars in the air, slowly fell to the ground shedding a pale and ghastly light on the swarming figures of the tribesmen as they ran swiftly forward. Then the popping of the musketry became one intense roar as the ten cartridges, which the magazine of the rifle holds, were discharged almost instantaneously. Nothing could live in front of such a fire. Valour, ferocity, fanaticism, availed nothing. All were swept away. The whistles sounded. The independent firing stopped, with machine-like precision, and the steady section volleys were resumed. This happened not once, but a dozen times during the six hours that the attack was maintained. The 20th Punjaub Infantry, and the cavalry also, sustained and repulsed the attacks delivered against their fronts with steadiness. At length the tribesmen sickened of the slaughter, and retired to their hills in gloom and disorder.
The British firepower was overwhelming. Their discipline was impressive, and the deadly weapon they used, along with its even more lethal bullet, halted every advance. The soldiers were confident in their strength and maintained perfect control. When the enemy charged, the order to use magazine fire was communicated along the ranks. The guns fired star shells. These large rockets exploded into stars in the sky and slowly descended, casting a pale and eerie light on the rushing tribesmen as they charged forward. Then the sound of gunfire erupted into a deafening roar as the ten cartridges in the rifle’s magazine were fired almost at once. Nothing could survive that kind of firepower. Bravery, aggression, and fanaticism meant nothing. All were swept away. The whistles blew. The independent firing halted with machine-like precision, and the steady volleys resumed. This happened not just once but a dozen times during the six hours of the assault. The 20th Punjaub Infantry and the cavalry held their ground and pushed back the attackers with poise. Eventually, the tribesmen grew weary of the bloodshed and retreated to their hills in despair and disarray.
The experience of all in the camp that night was most unpleasant. Those who were in the trenches were the best off. The others, with nothing to do and nothing to look at, remained for six hours lying down wondering whether the next bullet would hit them or not. Some idea of the severity of the fire may be obtained from the fact that a single tent showed sixteen bullet holes.
The experience of everyone in the camp that night was really uncomfortable. Those in the trenches had it the easiest. The others had nothing to do and nothing to see, so they spent six hours lying down, worrying about whether the next bullet would hit them. You can get an idea of how intense the fire was by the fact that one tent had sixteen bullet holes in it.
Brigadier-General Wodehouse was wounded at about eleven o'clock. He had walked round the trenches and conferred with his commanding officers as to the progress of the attack and the expenditure of ammunition, and had just left Sir Bindon Blood's side, after reporting, when a bullet struck him in the leg, inflicting a severe and painful, though fortunately not a dangerous, wound.
Brigadier-General Wodehouse was injured around eleven o'clock. He had been walking around the trenches and discussing the progress of the attack and the use of ammunition with his commanding officers. He had just stepped away from Sir Bindon Blood after giving his report when a bullet hit him in the leg, causing a severe and painful injury, although fortunately not a life-threatening one.
Considering the great number of bullets that had fallen in the camp, the British loss was surprisingly small. The full return is as follows:—
Considering the large number of bullets that had landed in the camp, the British loss was unexpectedly small. The complete report is as follows:—
BRITISH OFFICERS. Wounded severely—Brigadier-General Wodehouse. " slightly—Veterinary-Captain Mann. BRITISH SOLDIERS. Killed. Wounded. Queen's Regiment... 1 3 NATIVE RANKS—Wounded, 20. FOLLOWERS— " 6. Total, 32 of all ranks.
BRITISH OFFICERS. Severely injured—Brigadier-General Wodehouse. " slightly injured—Veterinary-Captain Mann. BRITISH SOLDIERS. Killed. Wounded. Queen's Regiment... 1 3 NATIVE RANKS—Wounded, 20. FOLLOWERS— " 6. Total, 32 of all ranks.
The casualties among the cavalry horses and transport animals were most severe. Over 120 were killed and wounded.
The losses among the cavalry horses and transport animals were extremely high. More than 120 were killed or injured.
The enemy drew off, carrying their dead with them, for the most part, but numerous bodies lying outside the shelter trench attested the valour and vigour of their attack. One man was found the next morning, whose head had been half blown off, by a discharge of case shot from one of the mountain guns. He lay within a yard of the muzzle, the muzzle he had believed would be stopped, a victim to that blind credulity and fanaticism, now happily passing away from the earth, under the combined influences of Rationalism and machine guns.
The enemy withdrew, taking most of their dead with them, but numerous bodies outside the shelter trench showed the bravery and energy of their attack. The next morning, they found a man whose head had been mostly blown off by a shell from one of the mountain guns. He lay just a yard from the muzzle, having believed it would be stopped, a victim of that blind belief and fanaticism that is thankfully fading away from the world, thanks to Rationalism and machine guns.
It was of course very difficult to obtain any accurate estimate of the enemy's losses. It was proved, however, that 200 corpses were buried on the following day in the neighbourhood, and large numbers of wounded men were reported to have been carried through the various villages. A rough estimate should place their loss at about 700.
It was definitely very hard to get an accurate estimate of the enemy's losses. However, it was confirmed that 200 bodies were buried the next day nearby, and many wounded men were reported to have been taken through the different villages. A rough estimate would put their loss at around 700.
The situation was now cleared. The back of the Hadda Mullah's gathering was broken, and it dispersed rapidly. The Khan of Nawagai feverishly protested his unswerving loyalty to the Government. The Mamunds were disheartened. The next day General Elles's leading brigade appeared in the valley. Sir Bindon Blood rode out with his cavalry. The two generals met at Lakarai. It was decided that General Elles should be reinforced by the 3rd Brigade of the Malakand Field Force, and should clear the Bedmanai Pass and complete the discomfiture of the Hadda Mullah. Sir Bindon Blood with the cavalry would join Jeffreys' force in the Mamund Valley, and deal with the situation there. The original plan of taking two brigades from the Malakand to Peshawar was thus discarded; and such troops of Sir Bindon Blood's force as were required for the Tirah expedition would, with the exception of the 3rd Brigade, reach their points of concentration via Nowshera. As will be seen, this plan was still further modified to meet the progress of events.
The situation was now resolved. The Hadda Mullah's gathering had fallen apart, and it quickly scattered. The Khan of Nawagai urgently declared his unwavering loyalty to the Government. The Mamunds were discouraged. The next day, General Elles's main brigade arrived in the valley. Sir Bindon Blood rode out with his cavalry. The two generals met at Lakarai. They agreed that General Elles should be supported by the 3rd Brigade of the Malakand Field Force to clear the Bedmanai Pass and fully defeat the Hadda Mullah. Sir Bindon Blood and the cavalry would join Jeffreys' force in the Mamund Valley to tackle the situation there. The original plan to send two brigades from Malakand to Peshawar was scrapped; and the troops from Sir Bindon Blood's force needed for the Tirah expedition, except for the 3rd Brigade, would reach their assembly points through Nowshera. As will be seen, this plan would be further adjusted based on the developments.
I had rejoined the 3rd Brigade on the morning of the 21st, and in the evening availed myself of an escort, which was proceeding across the valley, to ride over and see General Elles's brigade. The mobilisation of the Mohmand Field Force was marked by the employment, for the first time, of the Imperial Service Troops. The Maharaja of Patiala, and Sir Pertab Singh, were both with the force. The latter was sitting outside his tent, ill with fever, but cheery and brave as ever. The spectacle of this splendid Indian prince, whose magnificent uniform in the Jubilee procession had attracted the attention of all beholders, now clothed in business-like khaki, and on service at the head of his regiment, aroused the most pleasing reflections. With all its cost in men and money, and all its military and political mistakes, the great Frontier War of 1897 has at least shown on what foundations the British rule in India rests, and made clear who are our friends and who our enemies.
I rejoined the 3rd Brigade on the morning of the 21st, and in the evening, I took advantage of an escort that was crossing the valley to visit General Elles's brigade. The mobilization of the Mohmand Field Force was notable for being the first time the Imperial Service Troops were used. The Maharaja of Patiala and Sir Pertab Singh were both part of the force. Sir Pertab was sitting outside his tent, sick with fever but as cheerful and brave as ever. The sight of this remarkable Indian prince, whose stunning uniform had drawn everyone's attention during the Jubilee procession, now dressed in practical khaki and leading his regiment, sparked very positive thoughts. Despite all the costs in lives and money, along with the military and political missteps, the significant Frontier War of 1897 has at least highlighted the foundations of British rule in India and made it clear who our friends are and who our enemies are.
I could not help thinking, that polo has had a good deal to do with strengthening the good relations of the Indian princes and the British officers. It may seem strange to speak of polo as an Imperial factor, but it would not be the first time in history that national games have played a part in high politics. Polo has been the common ground on which English and Indian gentlemen have met on equal terms, and it is to that meeting that much mutual esteem and respect is due. Besides this, polo has been the salvation of the subaltern in India, and the young officer no longer, as heretofore, has a "centre piece" of brandy on his table night and day. The pony and polo stick have drawn him from his bungalow and mess-room, to play a game which must improve his nerve, his judgment and his temper. The author of the Indian Polity asserts that the day will come when British and native officers will serve together in ordinary seniority, and on the same footing. From what I know of the British officer, I do not myself believe that this is possible; but if it should ever came to pass, the way will have been prepared on the polo ground.
I couldn't help but think that polo has played a significant role in strengthening the relationship between Indian princes and British officers. It might seem odd to consider polo an Imperial factor, but it's not the first time in history that national games have influenced high politics. Polo has provided a common ground for English and Indian gentlemen to meet as equals, and it is from these meetings that a lot of mutual respect and admiration has developed. Moreover, polo has been a lifesaver for junior officers in India; unlike before, the young officer no longer keeps a bottle of brandy on his table all day and night. The pony and polo stick have encouraged him to leave his bungalow and mess to engage in a game that enhances his nerve, judgment, and temperament. The author of the Indian Polity claims that a day will come when British and native officers will work together with equal seniority and on the same level. From my experience with British officers, I personally doubt this is possible; however, if it ever happens, the groundwork will have been laid on the polo field.
The camp of the 3rd Brigade was not attacked again. The tribesmen had learnt a bitter lesson from their experiences of the night before. The trenches were, however, lined at dark, and as small parties of the enemy were said to be moving about across the front, occupied by the Queen's, there was some very excellent volley firing at intervals throughout the night. A few dropping shots came back out of the darkness, but no one was the worse, and the majority of the force made up for the sleep they had lost the night before.
The camp of the 3rd Brigade wasn’t attacked again. The tribesmen had learned a harsh lesson from what happened the night before. The trenches were lined after dark, and since small groups of the enemy were reportedly moving around in front where the Queen's were stationed, there was some really good volley firing at regular intervals throughout the night. A few stray shots came back from the darkness, but no one was hurt, and most of the soldiers caught up on the sleep they had missed the night before.
The next morning Sir Bindon Blood, his staff and three squadrons of the 11th Bengal Lancers, rode back through the pass of Nawagai, and joined General Jeffreys at Inayat Kila. The 3rd Brigade now left the Malakand Field Force, and passed under the command of General Elles and beyond the proper limits of this chronicle; but for the sake of completeness, and as the reader may be anxious to hear more of the fine regiment, whose astonishing fire relieved the strategic situation at Nawagai, and inflicted such terrible losses on the Hadda Mullah's adherents, I shall briefly trace their further fortunes.
The next morning, Sir Bindon Blood, along with his staff and three squadrons of the 11th Bengal Lancers, rode back through the Nawagai pass and met up with General Jeffreys at Inayat Kila. The 3rd Brigade then left the Malakand Field Force and came under the command of General Elles, going beyond the limits of this account. However, for the sake of completeness, and since the reader might be eager to know more about the impressive regiment whose exceptional firepower improved the tactical situation at Nawagai and caused significant losses to the Hadda Mullah's followers, I will briefly outline their subsequent fate.
After General Wodehouse was wounded the command of the 3rd Brigade devolved upon Colonel Graves. They were present at the forcing of the Bedmanai Pass on the 29th of September, and on the two following days they were employed in destroying the fortified villages in the Mitai and Suran valleys; but as these operations were unattended by much loss of life, the whole brigade reached Shabkadr with only three casualties. Thence the Queen's were despatched to Peshawar to take part in the Tirah expedition, in which they have added to the high reputation they had acquired in the Malakand and Mohmand Field Forces.
After General Wodehouse was injured, command of the 3rd Brigade passed to Colonel Graves. They were involved in breaching the Bedmanai Pass on September 29, and in the following two days, they worked on destroying the fortified villages in the Mitai and Suran valleys. Since these operations didn't result in many casualties, the entire brigade arrived in Shabkadr with only three losses. From there, the Queen's were sent to Peshawar to participate in the Tirah expedition, where they further enhanced their strong reputation gained in the Malakand and Mohmand Field Forces.
CHAPTER XIV: BACK TO THE MAMUND VALLEY
"Again I revisit the hills where we sported, The streams where we swam, and the fields where we fought." "On a Distant View of Harrow," BYRON.
"Once more I return to the hills where we played, The streams where we swam, and the fields where we battled." "On a Distant View of Harrow," BYRON.
It is with a vague and undefined feeling of satisfaction that I conduct the reader back to the entrenched camp of Inayat Kila at the entrance of the Mamund Valley, where so much happened, and with which so many memories and experiences are associated. Now that the troops are gone, the scene of life and activity has become solitary and silent. The graves of the officers and men who fell there are lost in the level of the plain. Yet the name is still remembered in not a few English homes, nor will the tribesmen, looking at the deserted entrenchment, easily forget the visit of the 2nd Brigade.
It’s with a vague and undefined sense of satisfaction that I take the reader back to the entrenched camp of Inayat Kila at the entrance of the Mamund Valley, a place where so much happened and where many memories and experiences are tied. Now that the troops are gone, the once-busy scene has become quiet and still. The graves of the officers and soldiers who fell there are lost in the flat landscape. Still, the name is remembered in a number of English homes, and the tribesmen, looking at the abandoned entrenchment, will not easily forget the visit of the 2nd Brigade.
When, on the afternoon of the 15th, the camp had first been pitched, only a small and hasty shelter-trench surrounded it. But as the weeks passed, the parapets grew higher, the ditches deeper, and the pits more numerous, until the whole place became a redoubt. Traverses were built along the perimeter to protect the defenders from flanking fire. Great walls of earth and stone sheltered the horses and mules. Fifty yards out, round the whole camp, a wire trip was carefully laid, to break a rush, and the paths and tracks leading to the entrances had become beaten, level roads. The aspect of permanency was comforting.
When, on the afternoon of the 15th, the camp was first set up, there was only a small, makeshift shelter trench around it. But as the weeks went by, the walls got higher, the ditches got deeper, and the pits multiplied, turning the entire area into a defensive stronghold. Barriers were constructed around the perimeter to shield the defenders from side attacks. Tall walls of earth and stone provided cover for the horses and mules. Fifty yards out, around the entire camp, a wire trip was carefully laid to impede any sudden rush, and the paths leading to the entrances became well-worn, flat roads. The overall feeling of permanence was reassuring.
Since the action of the 16th September, the 2nd Brigade had been unable to move. Transport—the life and soul of an army—is an even more vital factor here than in less undeveloped countries. The mobility of a brigade depends entirely on its pack animals. On the 14th many mules were killed. On the 16th the field hospitals were filled with wounded. It now became impossible for the camp to move, because the wounded could not be carried. It was impossible to leave them behind, because, deducting an adequate guard, the rest of the brigade would have been too few for fighting. The 2nd Brigade was therefore a fixture. Its striking power was limited to out and home marches. The first step taken by Sir Bindon Blood was to restore its mobility by getting the wounded sent down to the base. Some changes in the constitution of the force were also made. The 11th Bengal Lancers, who now joined the Mohmand Field Force, were succeeded by the Guides Cavalry. The 35th Sikhs, who had suffered such severe losses, were replaced by the 31st Punjaub Infantry from Panjkora. The Buffs, who were full of fever, were exchanged for the Royal West Kent from the Malakand. No.7 British Mountain Battery took the place of No.8, which was now reduced to four guns, having lost in the week's fighting half its officers, a third of its mules, and a quarter of its men.
Since the events of September 16th, the 2nd Brigade has been unable to move. Transport—essential for an army—was even more critical here than in less developed countries. The brigade's mobility relied completely on its pack animals. On the 14th, many mules were lost. By the 16th, the field hospitals were filled with wounded soldiers. It became impossible for the camp to advance because the injured could not be carried. Leaving them behind wasn’t an option, as even with a proper guard, the remaining brigade members would be too few to fight. The 2nd Brigade was therefore stuck. Its capability for action was limited to march in and march out. Sir Bindon Blood's first step was to restore mobility by sending the wounded back to the base. Some adjustments were also made to the force's structure. The 11th Bengal Lancers, who joined the Mohmand Field Force, were replaced by the Guides Cavalry. The 35th Sikhs, who had experienced severe losses, were substituted with the 31st Punjaub Infantry from Panjkora. The Buffs, who were suffering from fever, were replaced by the Royal West Kent from Malakand. No.7 British Mountain Battery took the place of No.8, which was reduced to four guns after losing half its officers, a third of its mules, and a quarter of its men during the week’s fighting.
Camels to carry the wounded were sent up from Panjkora. The Buffs escorted the long convoy down the line of communications. Every one in camp was sorry to see the last of them. In the fighting of the week they had made it clear that the British Infantry battalion is the backbone of every mixed brigade, and they shared with the Guides Infantry one of those enviable reputations for steadiness which are so hard to gain and so easy to lose on active service.
Camels to transport the injured were sent up from Panjkora. The Buffs escorted the long convoy along the supply route. Everyone in camp was sad to see them go. In the fighting during the week, they demonstrated that the British Infantry battalion is the backbone of every mixed brigade, and they shared with the Guides Infantry one of those respected reputations for reliability that are so hard to earn and so easy to lose in active service.
On the 24th of September Sir Bindon Blood received despatches appointing him to the command of the First Division of the Tirah Expeditionary Force, and as the negotiations with the Mamund Jirgahs were then in progress, and it seemed that a settlement might be reached, he proceeded with his staff to Panjkora. Here he was on the telegraph wire, and could communicate easily and quickly with India, and at the same time watch the progress of events at Inayat Kila. Mr. Davis conducted the diplomatic relations with the Mamunds. On the 26th a Jirgah from the tribe came into camp. They deposited 4000 rupees as a token of submission, and brought in fifty firearms. These, however, were of the oldest and most antiquated types, and were obviously not the weapons with which so many soldiers had been killed and wounded. This was pointed out to the tribal representatives. They protested that they had no others. They were poor men, they said, and their property was at the mercy of the Government. But they had no other arms.
On September 24th, Sir Bindon Blood received messages appointing him to lead the First Division of the Tirah Expeditionary Force. Since negotiations with the Mamund Jirgahs were ongoing and a settlement seemed possible, he and his staff moved to Panjkora. Here, he had access to the telegraph, allowing him to communicate quickly with India and keep an eye on developments at Inayat Kila. Mr. Davis managed the diplomatic talks with the Mamunds. On the 26th, a Jirgah from the tribe came to camp. They offered 4000 rupees as a sign of submission and handed over fifty firearms. However, these were the oldest, most outdated types and clearly not the weapons that had caused so many soldier casualties. This was pointed out to the tribal representatives. They insisted they had no other arms, claiming they were poor and that their property was at the mercy of the Government. But they maintained that they had no other weapons.
The political officer was firm, and his terms were explicit. Either they must give up the twenty-two rifles captured from the 35th Sikhs, on the 16th, or their villages would be destroyed. No other terms would he accept. To this they replied, that they had not got the rifles. They had all been taken, they said, and I think with truth, by the Afghan tribesmen from the Kunar Valley. These would not give them up. Besides—this also with truth—they had been taken in "fair war."
The political officer was resolute, and his demands were clear. They had to either surrender the twenty-two rifles taken from the 35th Sikhs on the 16th, or their villages would be destroyed. He wouldn’t accept any other conditions. In response, they insisted they didn’t have the rifles. They claimed that all of them had been taken—truthfully, I believe—by the Afghan tribesmen from the Kunar Valley. Those tribesmen wouldn’t return them. Furthermore—this was also true—they had been seized in "fair war."
One man, who had lived some years in Calcutta, was especially eloquent on the subject, and argued the case with much skill. He was however, crushed by Mr. Davies asking whether there were "no greybeards in the tribe," and why they were "led by a babu" [a native clerk—the Oriental embodiment of Red Tape]. The discussion was extended to the whole question of their quarrel with the British power. They admitted having sent their young men to attack the Malakand and Chakdara. "All the world was going ghaza," they said. They could not stay behind. They also owned to having gone five miles from their valley to attack the camp at Markhanai. Why had the Sirkar burnt their village? they asked. They had only tried to get even—for the sake of their honour. All this showed a most unsatisfactory spirit from the Government point of view, and it was evident that the brigade could not leave the valley until the tribesmen adopted a more submissive attitude. The matter reverted to the crucial point. Would they give up their rifles or not? To this they replied evasively, that they would consult their fellow-tribesmen and return an answer on the next day. This practically amounted to a refusal, and as no reply was received on the 27th, the negotiations ceased.
One man, who had spent several years in Calcutta, was particularly articulate on the topic and made his case very skillfully. However, he was silenced when Mr. Davies asked if there were "no old men in the tribe," and why they were "led by a babu" [a native clerk—the embodiment of bureaucracy in the East]. The discussion expanded to their overall conflict with the British authorities. They acknowledged sending their young men to attack the Malakand and Chakdara. "Everyone was going to war," they said. They couldn’t stay behind. They also admitted to going five miles from their valley to attack the camp at Markhanai. Why had the government burned their village? they questioned. They had only tried to avenge themselves—for the sake of their honor. All of this demonstrated a highly unsatisfactory attitude from the Government’s perspective, and it was clear that the brigade couldn’t leave the valley until the tribesmen showed a more compliant stance. The issue came back to the critical question: Would they surrender their rifles or not? To this, they responded evasively, saying they would consult their fellow tribesmen and provide an answer the following day. This practically amounted to a refusal, and since no reply was received on the 27th, the negotiations came to a halt.
In consequence of this and of the threatening attitude of the tribesmen throughout Dir and Bajaur, Sir Bindon Blood telegraphed to the Government of India and recommended the retention of a large force in these territories. By so doing he virtually resigned the command which awaited him in the Tirah expedition. This disinterested decision caused the liveliest satisfaction throughout the force. The Government accepted the advice of their general. The Tirah force was reconstituted, and Major-General W.P. Symons received the command of its first division. A force of eleven battalions, seven squadrons and three batteries was placed at Sir Bindon Blood's disposal, and he was directed to deal with the local situation as he should see fit. He immediately ordered General Jeffreys to resume the punitive operations against the Mamunds.
As a result of this and the aggressive stance of the tribesmen throughout Dir and Bajaur, Sir Bindon Blood sent a telegram to the Government of India recommending that a large force remain in these territories. By doing this, he effectively stepped down from the command that was waiting for him in the Tirah expedition. This selfless decision was met with great approval among the troops. The Government agreed with their general's advice. The Tirah force was reorganized, and Major-General W.P. Symons was put in charge of its first division. A force consisting of eleven battalions, seven squadrons, and three batteries was placed at Sir Bindon Blood's disposal, and he was instructed to handle the local situation as he saw fit. He promptly ordered General Jeffreys to continue the punitive operations against the Mamunds.
In pursuance of these orders, the 2nd Brigade, on the 29th, destroyed all the villages in the centre of the valley, some twelve or fourteen in number, and blew up with dynamite upwards of thirty towers and forts. The whole valley was filled with the smoke, which curled upwards in dense and numerous columns, and hung like a cloud over the scene of destruction. The continued explosions of the demolitions resembled a bombardment. The tribesmen, unable to contend with the troops in the open, remained sullenly on the hillsides, and contented themselves with firing from long range at the cavalry patrols.
Following these orders, the 2nd Brigade, on the 29th, destroyed all the villages in the center of the valley, around twelve or fourteen in total, and blew up more than thirty towers and forts with dynamite. The entire valley was filled with smoke that curled up in thick, numerous columns, hanging like a cloud over the area of destruction. The ongoing explosions from the demolitions sounded like a bombardment. The tribesmen, unable to fight the troops out in the open, remained sullenly on the hillsides and settled for firing from a distance at the cavalry patrols.
I feel that this is a fitting moment to discuss the questions which village-burning raises. I have described with independent impartiality the progress of the quarrel between the British and the tribesmen. In a similar spirit I approach the examination of the methods of offence employed. Many misconceptions, some of which are caused by an extraordinary ignorance, exist on this subject in England. One member of the House of Commons asked the Secretary of State whether, in the punishment of villages, care was taken that only the houses of the guilty parties should be destroyed. He was gravely told that great care was taken. The spectacle of troops, who have perhaps carried a village with the bayonet and are holding it against a vigorous counter-attack, when every moment means loss of life and increase of danger, going round and carefully discriminating which houses are occupied by "guilty parties," and which by unoffending people, is sufficiently ridiculous. Another member asked, "Whether the villages were destroyed or only the fortifications." "Only the fortifications," replied the minister guilelessly. What is the actual fact? All along the Afghan border every man's house is his castle. The villages are the fortifications, the fortifications are the villages. Every house is loopholed, and whether it has a tower or not depends only on its owner's wealth. A third legislator, in the columns of his amusing weekly journal, discussed the question at some length, and commented on the barbarity of such tactics. They were not only barbarous, he affirmed, but senseless. Where did the inhabitants of the villages go? To the enemy of course! This reveals, perhaps, the most remarkable misconception of the actual facts. The writer seemed to imagine that the tribesmen consisted of a regular army, who fought, and a peaceful, law-abiding population, who remained at their business, and perhaps protested against the excessive military expenditure from time to time. Whereas in reality, throughout these regions, every inhabitant is a soldier from the first day he is old enough to hurl a stone, till the last day he has strength to pull a trigger, after which he is probably murdered as an encumbrance to the community.
I think this is a good time to discuss the issues raised by village-burning. I’ve described the conflict between the British and the tribesmen with objective fairness. In the same spirit, I’ll look at the offensive tactics used. There are many misconceptions about this in England, some stemming from a shocking lack of understanding. One member of the House of Commons asked the Secretary of State if, when punishing villages, care was taken to ensure only the houses of the guilty were destroyed. He was seriously told that they took great care. The image of troops who have taken a village by force and are now holding it against a strong counter-attack, where every moment costs lives and heightens danger, carefully deciding which houses belong to "guilty parties" and which to innocent people is quite absurd. Another member asked, "Were the villages destroyed or just the fortifications?" "Only the fortifications," the minister replied innocently. What’s the reality? Along the Afghan border, every man's home is his fortress. The villages are the fortifications; the fortifications are the villages. Every house has openings for defense, and whether it has a tower depends only on the owner's wealth. A third lawmaker, in his entertaining weekly magazine, discussed this for a while and condemned the barbarity of such tactics. He claimed they were not only cruel but also pointless. Where do the village inhabitants go? To the enemy, of course! This points out one of the most significant misunderstandings of the truth. The writer seemed to think that the tribesmen were a regular army fighting against a peaceful, law-abiding population that just went about their business and occasionally protested against excessive military spending. However, in reality, every resident in these areas is a soldier from the age they can throw a stone until the last day they can pull a trigger, after which they’re likely murdered for being a burden on the community.
Equipped with these corrected facts, I invite the reader to examine the question of the legitimacy of village-burning for himself. A camp of a British brigade, moving at the order of the Indian Government and under the acquiescence of the people of the United Kingdom, is attacked at night. Several valuable and expensive officers, soldiers and transport animals are killed and wounded. The assailants retire to the hills. Thither it is impossible to follow them. They cannot be caught. They cannot be punished. Only one remedy remains—their property must be destroyed. [It may be of interest, to consider for a moment the contrast between the effects of village-burning on the Indian Frontier and in Cuba. In Cuba a small section of the population are in revolt; the remainder are sympathisers. To screw these lukewarm partisans up to the fighting-point, the insurgents destroy their villages and burn the sugar-came. This, by placing the alternative of "fight or starve" before the inhabitants, has the effect of driving them to take up arms against the Spaniards, whom they all hate, and join the rebels in the field. Thus in Cuba it is the endeavour of the Government to protect property, and of the rebels to destroy it. It was with the aim of keeping the wavering population loyal, that General Weyler collected them all into the towns, with such painful results. His policy was cruel but sound, and, had it been accompanied by vigorous military operations, might have been successful.] Their villages are made hostages for their good behavior. They are fully aware of this, and when they make an attack on a camp or convoy, they do it because they have considered the cost and think it worth while. Of course, it is cruel and barbarous, as is everything else in war, but it is only an unphilosophic mind that will hold it legitimate to take a man's life, and illegitimate to destroy his property. The burning of mud hovels cannot at any rate be condemned by nations whose customs of war justify the bombardment of the dwelling-houses of a city like Paris, to induce the garrison to surrender by the sufferings of the non-combatants.
Equipped with these updated facts, I invite the reader to think about the legitimacy of burning villages for themselves. A British brigade camp, operating on orders from the Indian Government and with the approval of the people in the United Kingdom, is attacked at night. Several valuable and high-ranking officers, soldiers, and transport animals are killed or injured. The attackers retreat to the hills. There, it’s impossible to pursue them. They can’t be caught. They can’t be punished. Only one solution remains—their property must be destroyed. [It may be interesting to compare the effects of burning villages on the Indian Frontier and in Cuba. In Cuba, a small part of the population is in revolt; the rest are sympathizers. To push these indifferent supporters to fight, the insurgents destroy their villages and burn the sugar cane. This forces the residents to choose between “fight or starve,” driving them to take up arms against the Spaniards, whom they all dislike, and join the rebels. So, in Cuba, it’s the government’s goal to protect property, while the rebels aim to destroy it. To keep the undecided population loyal, General Weyler gathered them all into towns, with painful consequences. His strategy was harsh but logical, and if it had been paired with strong military actions, it might have worked.] Their villages become hostages for their good behavior. They know this fully, and when they attack a camp or convoy, they do it because they’ve weighed the costs and think it’s worth it. Of course, it’s cruel and barbaric, like everything else in war, but it’s only an unthinking mind that believes it’s legitimate to take a man's life while considering it illegitimate to destroy his property. Burning mud huts can hardly be condemned by nations whose wartime customs allow the bombardment of cities like Paris, to force the garrison to surrender through the suffering of non-combatants.
In official parlance the burning of villages is usually expressed euphemistically as "So many villages were visited and punished," or, again, "The fortifications were demolished." I do not believe in all this circumlocution. The lack of confidence in the good sense of the British democracy, which the Indian Government displays, is one of its least admirable characteristics. Exeter Hall is not all England; and the people of our islands only require to have the matter put fairly before them to arrive at sound, practical conclusions. If this were not so, we should not occupy our present position in the world.
In official language, the burning of villages is often referred to as "So many villages were visited and punished," or, "The fortifications were demolished." I don’t buy into all this vague wording. The Indian Government’s lack of faith in the common sense of British democracy is one of its less admirable traits. Exeter Hall doesn’t represent all of England; the people of our islands just need the facts presented to them clearly to make sound, practical decisions. If it were otherwise, we wouldn’t hold our current standing in the world.
To return to the Mamund Valley. The difference between villages in the plains and those in the hills was forcibly demonstrated. On the 29th over a dozen villages in the plains were destroyed without the loss of a single life. On the 30th the tale ran somewhat differently. The village of Agrah adjoins the village of Zagai, the capture of which has already been recorded. It stood in a broad re-entrant of the mountains, and amid ground so tangled and broken, that to move over it is difficult, and to describe it impossible. On the steep face of the mountain great rocks, sometimes thirty feet high, lay tossed about: interspersed with these were huts or narrow terraces, covered with crops, and rising one above the other by great steps of ten or twelve feet each. The attack on such a place was further complicated by the fact that the same re-entrant contained another village called Gat, which had to be occupied at the same time. This compelled the brigade to attack on a broader front than their numbers allowed. It was evident, as the Guides Cavalry approached the hills, that resistance was contemplated. Several red standards were visible to the naked eye, and the field-glasses disclosed numerous figures lining the ridges and spurs. The squadrons, advancing as far as the scrub would allow them, soon drew the fire of isolated skirmishers. Several troops dismounted, and returned the salute with their carbines, and at 8.45 a dropping fire began. The brigade now came into action in the following formation. The cavalry, on the extreme left, covered the head of a considerable valley, from which the flank was threatened; the Guides Infantry and the Royal West Kent Regiment prolonged the line to the centre of the attack; the 31st Punjaub Infantry moved against the spurs to the right of the village, and the 38th Dogras were in reserve. The action was begun by the Guides Infantry storming the ridges to the left of the enemy's position. These were strongly held and fortified by sungars, behind which the defenders were sheltered. The Guides advanced at a brisk pace, and without much firing, across the open ground to the foot of the hills. The tribesmen, shooting from excellent cover, maintained a hot fire. The bullets kicked up the dust in all directions, or whistled viciously through the air; but the distance was short, and it was soon apparent that the enemy did not mean to abide the assault. When the troops got within 100 yards and fixed bayonets, a dozen determined men were still firing from the sungars. The Afridi and Pathan companies of the Guides, uttering shrill cries of exultation, culminating in an extraordinary yell, dashed forward, climbed the hill as only hillmen can climb, and cleared the crest. On the side of the next hill the figures of the retreating tribesmen were visible, and many were shot down before they could find shelter.
To go back to the Mamund Valley. The contrast between the villages in the plains and those in the hills was starkly highlighted. On the 29th, over a dozen villages in the plains were destroyed without anyone getting hurt. However, on the 30th, the situation changed. The village of Agrah is next to the village of Zagai, which has already been mentioned. Agrah is situated in a wide area of the mountains, surrounded by such tangled and broken ground that it's hard to navigate and nearly impossible to describe. On the steep side of the mountain, large rocks, some as high as thirty feet, were scattered about, interspersed with huts or narrow terraces, filled with crops, and built one above the other with large steps of ten or twelve feet each. Attacking such a location was further complicated by the fact that the same area also contained another village called Gat, which needed to be taken at the same time. This forced the brigade to launch an attack across a wider front than their numbers could comfortably cover. As the Guides Cavalry neared the hills, it was clear that they faced resistance. Several red flags were visible, and binoculars revealed numerous figures positioned along the ridges and spurs. The squadrons advanced as far as the brush allowed them and soon attracted fire from isolated skirmishers. Several troops dismounted and returned fire with their carbines, and at 8:45, a steady stream of gunfire began. The brigade then went into action in the following formation: the cavalry on the far left covered the entrance of a large valley, where their flank was at risk; the Guides Infantry and the Royal West Kent Regiment extended the line to the center of the attack; the 31st Punjaub Infantry moved against the spurs to the right of the village, and the 38th Dogras remained in reserve. The Guides Infantry initiated the action by charging the ridges to the left of the enemy’s position. These were strongly defended and fortified with sungars, behind which the defenders took cover. The Guides advanced quickly and, without much firing, crossed the open ground to the base of the hills. The tribesmen, firing from great cover, unleashed a heavy barrage. Bullets kicked up dust in every direction or whistled sharply through the air; but the distance was short, and it soon became clear that the enemy did not plan to hold their ground. When the troops were within 100 yards and fixed their bayonets, a dozen determined men were still firing from the sungars. The Afridi and Pathan companies of the Guides, letting out shrill cries of victory, peaked with a remarkable shout, charged forward, scaled the hill like only mountain people can, and cleared the summit. On the next hill, the figures of the fleeing tribesmen were visible, and many were shot down before they could find cover.
It was a strange thing, to watch these conspicuous forms toiling up the hillside, dodging this way and that way, as the bullets cut into the earth around them; but with the experience of the previous ten minutes fresh in the memory, pity was not one of the emotions it aroused. A good many fell, subsiding peacefully, and lying quite still. Their fall was greeted by strange little yells of pleasure from the native soldiers. These Afridi and Pathan companies of the Guides Infantry suggest nothing so much as a well-trained pack of hounds. Their cries, their movements, and their natures are similar.
It was odd to watch these visible figures struggling up the hillside, dodging this way and that as bullets slammed into the ground around them; but with the last ten minutes still fresh in mind, pity wasn’t one of the feelings it triggered. Many fell, collapsing quietly and lying completely still. Their fall was met with strange little shouts of joy from the local soldiers. These Afridi and Pathan companies of the Guides Infantry resemble nothing more than a well-trained pack of hounds. Their shouts, their movements, and their nature are alike.
The West Kents had now come into line on the Guides' right, and while the latter held the long ridge they had taken, the British regiment moved upon the village. Here the resistance became very severe. The tangled and broken ground, rising in terraces, sometimes ten feet high, and covered with high crops, led to fighting at close quarters with loss on both sides. Loud and continuous grew the musketry fire. The 31st Punjaub Infantry, who had ascended the spur on the right, soon joined hands with the West Kents, and both regiments became hotly engaged. Meantime the Mountain Battery, which had come into action near the centre, began to throw its shells over the heads of the infantry on to the higher slopes, from which the enemy were firing. It soon became evident that the troops were too few for the work. On the left the Guides Infantry were unable to leave the ridge they had captured, lest it should be reoccupied by the enemy, who were showing in great strength. A gap opened in consequence, between the Guides and Royal West Kents, and this enabled the tribesmen to get round the left flank of the British regiment, while the 31st Punjaub Infantry, on the right, were also turned by the enveloping enemy. It is to these circumstances that most of the losses were due.
The West Kents had now aligned with the Guides on their right side, and while the Guides held the long ridge they had secured, the British regiment advanced toward the village. Here, the resistance intensified. The uneven and rugged terrain, rising in steps of sometimes ten feet and covered with tall crops, led to close-quarters combat with casualties on both sides. The musket fire grew loud and relentless. The 31st Punjaub Infantry, who had climbed the spur on the right, quickly linked up with the West Kents, and both regiments engaged fiercely. Meanwhile, the Mountain Battery, which had deployed near the center, began firing shells over the heads of the infantry onto the higher slopes, where the enemy was shooting from. It became clear that the troops were too few for the task at hand. On the left, the Guides Infantry couldn't leave the ridge they had taken, for fear it would be reclaimed by the enemy, who were showing significant strength. This created a gap between the Guides and the Royal West Kents, allowing the tribesmen to encircle the left flank of the British regiment, while the 31st Punjaub Infantry on the right also faced being outflanked by the surrounding enemy. These situations accounted for most of the losses.
The British regiment forced its way through the village, and encountered the enemy strongly posted in sungars among the rocks above it. Here they were sharply checked. The leading company had stormed one of these fortifications, and the enemy at once retired higher up the hill. About fifteen men were inside the work, and perhaps thirty more just below it. The whole place was commanded by the higher ground. The enemy's fire was accurate and intense.
The British regiment pushed through the village and ran into the enemy, who were well-positioned in shelters among the rocks above. Here they were quickly held up. The front company managed to take one of these defenses, and the enemy immediately withdrew further up the hill. About fifteen men were inside the position, with maybe thirty more just below. The entire area was under the control of the higher ground. The enemy's fire was precise and heavy.
Of those inside, four or five were instantly killed or wounded. The sungar was a regular trap, and the company were ordered to retire. Lieutenant Browne-Clayton remained till the last, to watch the withdrawal, and in so doing was shot dead, the bullet severing the blood-vessels near the heart. The two or three men who remained were handing down his body over the rock wall, when they were charged by about thirty Ghazis and driven down the hill. A hundred and fifty yards away, Major Western had three companies of the West Kents in support. He immediately ordered Captain Styles to retake the sungar, and recover the body. The company charged. Captain Styles was the first to reach the stone wall, and with Lieutenant Jackson cleared it of such of the enemy as remained. Five or six men were wounded in the charge, and others fell in the sungar. The advanced position of this company was soon seen to be untenable, and they were ordered to fall back to the edge of the village, where the whole regiment was hotly engaged.
Of those inside, four or five were immediately killed or injured. The sungar was a typical trap, and the unit was ordered to retreat. Lieutenant Browne-Clayton stayed until the end to oversee the withdrawal and was shot dead, with the bullet hitting the blood vessels near his heart. The two or three men who stayed behind were passing down his body over the rock wall when they were charged by about thirty Ghazis and forced down the hill. One hundred and fifty yards away, Major Western had three companies of the West Kents ready for support. He quickly ordered Captain Styles to reclaim the sungar and retrieve the body. The company charged forward. Captain Styles was the first to reach the stone wall, and along with Lieutenant Jackson, cleared it of the remaining enemy fighters. Five or six men were injured during the charge, and others fell inside the sungar. It soon became clear that this company's advanced position was no longer sustainable, and they were ordered to fall back to the edge of the village, where the entire regiment was heavily engaged.
Meanwhile the 31st Punjaub Infantry, who had advanced under Colonel O'Bryen on the right, were exposed to a severe fire from a rocky ridge on their flank. Their attack was directed against a great mass of boulders, some of them of enormous size, which were tenaciously held by the enemy. The fighting soon became close. The two advanced companies were engaged at a distance of under 100 yards. Besides this the cross fire from their right flank added to their difficulties. In such a position the presence of Colonel O'Bryen was invaluable. Moving swiftly from point to point, he directed the fire and animated the spirit of the men, who were devoted to him. It was not long before the enemy's marksmen began to take aim at this prominent figure. But for a considerable period, although bullets struck the ground everywhere around him, he remained unhurt. At last, however, he was shot through the body, and carried mortally wounded from the action.
Meanwhile, the 31st Punjaub Infantry, led by Colonel O'Bryen on the right, came under heavy fire from a rocky ridge on their flank. Their attack was aimed at a large mass of boulders, some of which were huge, that the enemy held firmly. The fighting quickly became intense. The two forward companies found themselves engaged at a distance of less than 100 yards. In addition, they faced crossfire from their right flank, which made things even more challenging. In this situation, Colonel O'Bryen's presence was crucial. Moving quickly from one spot to another, he directed the fire and boosted the morale of the men, who were deeply loyal to him. It wasn't long before the enemy's snipers started aiming at this noticeable figure. For quite a while, even though bullets struck the ground all around him, he remained unharmed. Finally, though, he was shot in the body and was carried away from the fighting, mortally wounded.
I pause to consider for a moment the conditions, and circumstances, by which the pursuit of a military career differs from all others. In political life, in art, in engineering, the man with talents who behaves with wisdom may steadily improve his position in the world. If he makes no mistakes he will probably achieve success. But the soldier is more dependent upon external influences. The only way he can hope to rise above the others, is by risking his life in frequent campaigns. All his fortunes, whatever they may be, all his position and weight in the world, all his accumulated capital, as it were, must be staked afresh each time he goes into action. He may have seen twenty engagements, and be covered with decorations and medals. He may be marked as a rising soldier. And yet each time he comes under fire his chances of being killed are as great as, and perhaps greater than, those of the youngest subaltern, whose luck is fresh. The statesman, who has put his power to the test, and made a great miscalculation, may yet retrieve his fortunes. But the indiscriminating bullet settles everything. As the poet somewhat grimly has it:—
I take a moment to think about the conditions and circumstances that make pursuing a military career different from all other paths. In politics, art, or engineering, a talented person who acts wisely can steadily improve their standing in the world. If they avoid mistakes, they'll likely find success. But a soldier relies more on external factors. The only way for them to rise above others is by risking their life in frequent battles. Every time they go into action, they must stake everything they've achieved—whatever their fortunes, status, and experience may be—once again. They could have fought in twenty battles, adorned with medals and honors, and recognized as a promising soldier. Yet, each time they're under fire, their chances of being killed are just as high, if not higher, than those of the youngest officer, whose luck is still untested. A politician who miscalculates can often recover their position. But a random bullet changes everything. As the poet harshly puts it:—
Stone-dead hath no better.
Stone dead has no better.
Colonel O'Bryen had been specially selected, while still a young man, for the command of a battalion. He had made several campaigns. Already he had passed through the drudgery of the lower ranks of the service, and all the bigger prizes of the military profession appeared in view: and though the death in action of a colonel at the head of his regiment is as fine an end as a soldier can desire, it is mournful to record the abrupt termination of an honourable career at a point when it might have been of much value to the State.
Colonel O'Bryen had been specially chosen, while still young, to lead a battalion. He had participated in several campaigns. He had already experienced the tedious work of the lower ranks in the military, and all the major achievements in his career were within reach: although dying in action as a colonel at the forefront of his regiment is the noblest end a soldier could hope for, it is sad to note the sudden end of a commendable career at a time when it could have greatly benefited the country.
The pressure now became so strong along the whole line that the brigadier, fearing that the troops might get seriously involved, ordered the withdrawal to commence. The village was however burning, and the enemy, who had also suffered severely from the close fighting, did not follow up with their usual vigour. The battery advanced to within 600 yards of the enemy's line, and opened a rapid fire of shrapnel to clear those spurs that commanded the line of retirement. The shells screamed over the heads of the West Kent Regiment, who were now clear of the hills and in front of the guns, and burst in little white puffs of smoke along the crest of the ridge, tearing up the ground into a thick cloud of dust by the hundreds of bullets they contained.
The pressure became so intense along the entire front that the brigadier, worried that the troops might get into serious trouble, ordered the withdrawal to start. The village, however, was on fire, and the enemy, who had also taken heavy losses in the close fighting, didn’t pursue with their usual intensity. The battery moved up to within 600 yards of the enemy’s line and opened a rapid fire of shrapnel to clear the hills that overlooked the retreat route. The shells screamed over the heads of the West Kent Regiment, who were now out of the hills and in front of the guns, bursting in little white puffs of smoke along the top of the ridge, sending up thick clouds of dust from the hundreds of bullets they carried.
A continuous stream of doolies and stretchers commenced to flow from the fighting line. Soon all available conveyances were exhausted, and the bodies of the wounded had to be carried over the rough ground in the arms of their comrades—a very painful process, which extorted many a groan from the suffering men. At length the withdrawal was completed, and the brigade returned to camp. The presence of the cavalry, who covered the rear, deterred the enemy from leaving the hills.
A steady flow of stretchers and carrying devices began to move from the front lines. Before long, all available transport was used up, and the wounded had to be carried over the rough terrain by their fellow soldiers—a very painful process that elicited many groans from the suffering men. Eventually, the withdrawal was finished, and the brigade returned to camp. The presence of the cavalry, who held the rear, prevented the enemy from leaving the hills.
Riding back, I observed a gruesome sight. At the head of the column of doolies and stretchers were the bodies of the killed, each tied with cords upon a mule. Their heads dangled on one side and their legs on the other. The long black hair of the Sikhs, which streamed down to the ground, and was draggled with dust and blood, imparted a hideous aspect to these figures. There was no other way, however, and it was better than leaving their remains to be insulted and defiled by the savages with whom we were fighting. At the entrance to the camp a large group of surgeons—their sleeves rolled up—awaited the wounded. Two operating tables, made of medical boxes, and covered with water-proof sheets, were also prepared. There is a side to warfare browner than khaki.
Riding back, I saw a horrific scene. At the front of the line of doolies and stretchers were the bodies of the dead, each tied to a mule. Their heads hung to one side and their legs dangled to the other. The long black hair of the Sikhs, dragging on the ground and matted with dust and blood, gave these figures a ghastly look. There was no other option, though, and it was better than leaving their remains to be degraded and desecrated by the savages we were fighting. At the entrance to the camp, a large group of surgeons—sleeves rolled up—waited for the wounded. Two operating tables, made from medical boxes and covered with waterproof sheets, were also set up. There’s a side to warfare that’s darker than khaki.
The casualties in the attack upon Agrah were as follows:—
The casualties in the attack on Agrah were as follows:—
BRITISH OFFICERS. Killed—Lieut.-Col. J.L. O'Bryen, 31st Punjaub Infantry. " 2nd Lieut. W.C. Brown-Clayton, Royal West Kent. Wounded severely—Lieutenant H. Isacke, Royal West Kent. " " " E.B. Peacock, 31st Punjaub Infantry. Wounded slightly—Major W.G.B. Western, Royal West Kent. " " Captain R.C. Styles, Royal West Kent. " " " N.H.S. Lowe, Royal West Kent. " " 2nd Lieut. F.A. Jackson, Royal West Kent. BRITISH SOLDIERS. Killed. Wounded. Royal West Kent... 3 20 NATIVE RANKS. Killed. Wounded. Guides Cavalry... 0 4 31st Punjaub Infantry . 7 15 38th Dogras ... 0 4 Total casualties, 61.
BRITISH OFFICERS. Killed—Lieut.-Col. J.L. O'Bryen, 31st Punjaub Infantry. " 2nd Lieut. W.C. Brown-Clayton, Royal West Kent. Severely wounded—Lieutenant H. Isacke, Royal West Kent. " " " E.B. Peacock, 31st Punjaub Infantry. Slightly wounded—Major W.G.B. Western, Royal West Kent. " " Captain R.C. Styles, Royal West Kent. " " " N.H.S. Lowe, Royal West Kent. " " 2nd Lieut. F.A. Jackson, Royal West Kent. BRITISH SOLDIERS. Killed. Wounded. Royal West Kent... 3 20 NATIVE RANKS. Killed. Wounded. Guides Cavalry... 0 4 31st Punjaub Infantry . 7 15 38th Dogras ... 0 4 Total casualties, 61.
As soon as Sir Bindon Blood, at his camp on the Panjkora, received the news of the sharp fighting of the 30th, [After the action of the 30th of September, Lieut.-Colonel McRae, of the 45th Sikhs, was sent up to command the 31st Punjaub Infantry in the place of Lieut.-Colonel O'Bryen, and I was myself attached as a temporary measure to fill another of the vacancies. This is, I believe, the first time a British Cavalry officer has been attached to a native infantry regiment. After the kindness and courtesy with which I was treated, I can only hope it will not be the last.] he decided to proceed himself to Inayat Kila with reinforcements. He arrived on the 2nd October, bringing No.8 Mountain Battery; a wing of the 24th Punjaub Infantry; and two troops of the Guides Cavalry; and having also sent orders for the Highland Light Infantry and four guns of the 10th Field Battery to follow him at once. He was determined to make a fresh attack on Agrah, and burn the village of Gat, which had only been partially destroyed. And this attack was fixed for the 5th. By that date the big 12-pounder guns of the Field Battery were to have arrived, and the fire of fourteen pieces would have been concentrated on the enemy's position. Every one was anxious to carry matters to a conclusion with the tribesmen at all costs.
As soon as Sir Bindon Blood, at his camp on the Panjkora, got the news about the intense fighting on the 30th, [After the action of the 30th of September, Lieut.-Colonel McRae, of the 45th Sikhs, was sent up to command the 31st Punjaub Infantry in place of Lieut.-Colonel O'Bryen, and I was myself attached as a temporary measure to fill another of the vacancies. This is, I believe, the first time a British Cavalry officer has been attached to a native infantry regiment. After the kindness and courtesy with which I was treated, I can only hope it won’t be the last.] he decided to head to Inayat Kila with reinforcements. He arrived on October 2nd, bringing No.8 Mountain Battery; a wing of the 24th Punjaub Infantry; and two troops of the Guides Cavalry; and he also sent orders for the Highland Light Infantry and four guns from the 10th Field Battery to follow him immediately. He was set on launching a new attack on Agrah and burning the village of Gat, which had only been partially destroyed. This attack was scheduled for the 5th. By that date, the large 12-pounder guns from the Field Battery were expected to arrive, and the fire from fourteen pieces would be focused on the enemy's position. Everyone was eager to wrap things up with the tribesmen at all costs.
On the 3rd, the force was ordered to take and burn the village of Badelai, against which, it may be remembered, the Buffs had advanced on the 16th, and from which they had been recalled in a hurry to support the 35th Sikhs. The attack and destruction of the village presented no new features; the tribesmen offered little resistance, and retired before the troops. But as soon as the brigade began its homeward march, they appeared in much larger numbers than had hitherto been seen. As the cavalry could not work among the nullahs and the broken ground, the enemy advanced boldly into the plain. In a great crescent, nearly four miles long, they followed the retiring troops. A brisk skirmish began at about 800 yards. Both batteries came into action, each firing about 90 shells. The Royal West Kent Regiment made good shooting with their Lee-Metford rifles. All the battalions of the brigade were engaged. The enemy, whose strength was estimated to be over 3000, lost heavily, and drew off at 2.30, when the force returned to camp. Sir Bindon Blood and his staff watched the operations and reconnoitered the valley. The casualties were as follows:—
On the 3rd, the force was ordered to take and burn the village of Badelai, which, as you may recall, the Buffs had advanced on the 16th and were quickly pulled back from to support the 35th Sikhs. The attack and destruction of the village didn’t have any new elements; the tribesmen offered little resistance and withdrew before the troops. However, once the brigade started its march back, they showed up in much larger numbers than had previously been seen. Since the cavalry couldn’t operate effectively among the nullahs and uneven terrain, the enemy boldly advanced into the plain. In a large crescent formation, nearly four miles long, they trailed the retreating troops. A lively skirmish began at about 800 yards. Both batteries opened fire, each launching around 90 shells. The Royal West Kent Regiment had good accuracy with their Lee-Metford rifles. All the battalions in the brigade fought. The enemy, estimated to be over 3,000 strong, suffered heavy losses and withdrew at 2:30 when the force returned to camp. Sir Bindon Blood and his staff observed the operations and surveyed the valley. The casualties were as follows:—
Royal West Kent—dangerously wounded, 1. Guides Cavalry—wounded, 2. 31st Punjaub Infantry—killed, 1; wounded, 5. Guides Infantry—wounded, 3. 38th Dogras—killed, 1; wounded, 3. Total casualties, 16.
Royal West Kent—dangerously wounded, 1. Guides Cavalry—wounded, 2. 31st Punjaub Infantry—killed, 1; wounded, 5. Guides Infantry—wounded, 3. 38th Dogras—killed, 1; wounded, 3. Total casualties, 16.
The next day the Highland Light Infantry and the field guns arrived. The former marched in over 700 strong, and made a fine appearance. They were nearly equal in numbers to any two battalions in the brigade. Sickness and war soon reduce the fighting strength. The guns had accomplished a great feat in getting over the difficult and roadless country. They had had to make their own track, and in many places the guns had been drawn by hand. The 10th Field Battery had thus gone sixty miles further into the hill country than any other wheeled traffic. They had quite a reception when they arrived. The whole camp turned out to look with satisfaction on the long polished tubes, which could throw twelve pounds a thousand yards further than the mountain guns could throw seven. They were, however, not destined to display their power. The Mamunds had again sued for peace. They were weary of the struggle. Their valley was desolate. The season of sowing the autumn crops approached. The arrival of reinforcements convinced them that the Government were determined to get their terms. Major Deane came up himself to conduct the negotiations. Meanwhile all important operations were suspended, though the foraging and "sniping" continued as usual.
The next day, the Highland Light Infantry and the field guns arrived. The former marched in with over 700 troops and made a great impression. They were nearly as many as two battalions in the brigade combined. Sickness and war quickly reduce the fighting strength. The guns achieved a significant feat by navigating the tough, roadless terrain. They had to create their own path, and in many places, the guns were pulled by hand. The 10th Field Battery had thus traveled sixty miles deeper into the hill country than any other wheeled vehicles. They received a warm welcome when they arrived. The entire camp gathered to admire the long, polished barrels, which could fire a twelve-pound shell a thousand yards further than the mountain guns could with their seven-pound shells. However, they weren't meant to show off their power. The Mamunds had once again requested peace. They were tired of the conflict. Their valley was devastated. The time for planting autumn crops was approaching. The arrival of reinforcements convinced them that the Government was determined to impose their conditions. Major Deane came up himself to handle the negotiations. In the meantime, all major operations were put on hold, although foraging and "sniping" continued as usual.
The force was now large enough for two brigades to be formed, and on the arrival of Brigadier-General Meiklejohn it was reconstituted as follows:—
The force was now big enough to form two brigades, and when Brigadier-General Meiklejohn arrived, it was reorganized as follows:—
1st Brigade. Commanding—Brigadier-General Meiklejohn, C.B., C.M.G. Highland Light Infantry. 31st Punjaub Infantry. 4 Cos. 24th Punjaub Infantry. 10th Field Battery. No.7 British Mountain Battery. 2nd Brigade. Commanding—Brigadier-General Jeffries, C.B. The Royal West Kent. 38th Dogras. Guides Infantry. No.8 Mountain Battery. The Guides Cavalry.
1st Brigade. Commanding—Brigadier-General Meiklejohn, C.B., C.M.G. Highland Light Infantry. 31st Punjab Infantry. 4 Companies 24th Punjab Infantry. 10th Field Battery. No. 7 British Mountain Battery. 2nd Brigade. Commanding—Brigadier-General Jeffries, C.B. The Royal West Kent. 38th Dogras. Guides Infantry. No. 8 Mountain Battery. The Guides Cavalry.
The camp was greatly extended and covered a large area of ground. In the evenings, the main street presented an animated appearance. Before the sun went down, the officers of the different regiments, distinguished by their brightly-coloured field caps, would assemble to listen to the pipes of the Scottish Infantry, or stroll up and down discussing the events of the day and speculating on the chances of the morrow. As the clear atmosphere of the valley became darkened by the shadows of the night, and the colours of the hills faded into an uniform black, the groups would gather round the various mess tents, and with vermuth, cigarettes and conversation pass away the pleasant half-hour before dinner and "sniping" began.
The camp was significantly expanded and covered a large area. In the evenings, the main street was lively. Before sunset, the officers from different regiments, easily recognized by their brightly-colored field caps, would gather to listen to the pipes of the Scottish Infantry or walk around chatting about the day's events and speculating on what tomorrow might bring. As the clear atmosphere of the valley darkened with night, and the colors of the hills faded to a uniform black, groups would congregate around the various mess tents, enjoying vermouth, cigarettes, and conversation as they passed the pleasant half-hour before dinner and "sniping" began.
I would that it were in my power to convey to the reader, who has not had the fortune to live with troops on service, some just appreciation of the compensations of war. The healthy, open-air life, the vivid incidents, the excitement, not only of realisation, but of anticipation, the generous and cheery friendships, the chances of distinction which are open to all, invest life with keener interests and rarer pleasures. The uncertainty and importance of the present, reduce the past and future to comparative insignificance, and clear the mind of minor worries. And when all is over, memories remain, which few men do not hold precious. As to the hardships, these though severe may be endured. Ascetics and recluses have in their endeavours to look beyond the grave suffered worse things. Nor will the soldier in the pursuit of fame and the enjoyment of the pleasures of war, be exposed to greater discomforts than Diogenes in his tub, or the Trappists in their monastery. Besides all this, his chances of learning about the next world are infinitely greater. And yet, when all has been said, we are confronted with a mournful but stubborn fact. In this contrary life, so prosaic is the mind of man, so material his soul, so poor his spirit, that there is no one who has been six months on active duty who is not delighted to get safe home again, to the comfortable monotonies of peace.
I wish I could share with the reader, who hasn’t had the chance to live with troops on duty, some true understanding of the benefits of war. The healthy, outdoor lifestyle, the lively experiences, the thrill not just of realization but also of anticipation, the warm and cheerful friendships, the opportunities for distinction available to everyone, fill life with sharper interests and rarer joys. The uncertainty and significance of the present make the past and future seem relatively unimportant and clear the mind of minor worries. And when it’s all over, the memories remain, which most men cherish. As for the hardships, while they may be tough, they can be endured. Ascetics and recluses, in their quest for deeper understanding, have faced worse. Moreover, the soldier seeking fame and enjoying the excitement of war won't experience greater discomfort than Diogenes in his tub, or the Trappists in their monastery. On top of all that, his chances of learning about the next world are far greater. Yet, after everything is said and done, we face a sad but undeniable truth. In this contrary life, the human mind is so practical, the soul so material, the spirit so lacking, that anyone who has spent six months on active duty is always glad to return home safely to the comfortable routines of peace.
CHAPTER XV: THE WORK OF THE CAVALRY
The negotiations of the Mamunds had this time opened under more propitious circumstances. The tribesmen were convinced by the arrival of the large reinforcements that the Government were in earnest. The return of "the big general," as they called Sir Bindon Blood, to distinguish him from the brigadiers, impressed them with the fact that the operations would be at once renewed, if they continued recalcitrant. They had still a few villages unburned, and these they were anxious to save. Besides, they disliked the look of the long topes, or field guns, of whose powers they were uncertain. They therefore displayed a much more humble spirit.
The negotiations with the Mamunds this time began under better circumstances. The tribesmen were convinced by the arrival of the large reinforcements that the Government was serious. The return of "the big general,” as they called Sir Bindon Blood to distinguish him from the brigadiers, made them realize that the operations would restart immediately if they kept resisting. They still had a few villages left unburned, and they were eager to protect those. Also, they didn't like the look of the long topes, or field guns, which they weren't sure how powerful were. So, they showed a much more humble attitude.
On the other hand, every one in the force had realised that there were "more kicks than ha'pence" to be got out of the Mamund Valley. All the villages in the plain had been destroyed. Only a few of those in the hollows of the hills remained. To these the enemy had retired. In Arrian's History of Alexander's Conquests we read the following passage: "The men in Bazira [Bazira is the same as Bajaur], despairing of their own affairs, abandoned the city... and fled to the rock, as the other barbarians were doing. For all the inhabitants deserted the cities, and began to fly to the rock which is in their land." Then it was that Alexander's difficulties began. Nor need we wonder, when the historian gravely asserts that "so stupendous is the rock in this land... that it was found impregnable even by Heracles, the son of Zeus." Thus history repeats itself, and the people of Bajaur their tactics. There was, however, no doubt as to the ability of the brigades to take and burn any village they might select. At the same time it was certain that they would encounter relays of Afghan tribesmen, and regular soldiers from the Amir's army, and that they would lose officers and men in the operation. The matter had to be carried to a conclusion at whatever cost, but the sooner the end was reached, the better.
On the other hand, everyone in the force had realized that there were "more kicks than halfpennies" to be gained from the Mamund Valley. All the villages in the plain had been destroyed. Only a few of those in the hills remained. The enemy had retreated to these. In Arrian's History of Alexander's Conquests, we read: "The men in Bazira [Bazira is the same as Bajaur], despairing of their own situation, abandoned the city... and fled to the rock, like the other barbarians were doing. For all the inhabitants deserted the cities and began to flee to the rock that is in their land." It was then that Alexander's difficulties began. Nor should we be surprised when the historian gravely states that "so stupendous is the rock in this land... that it was found impregnable even by Heracles, the son of Zeus." Thus, history repeats itself, along with the tactics of the people of Bajaur. However, there was no doubt about the brigades' ability to take and burn any village they chose. At the same time, it was certain that they would face waves of Afghan tribesmen and regular soldiers from the Amir's army, and that they would lose officers and men in the process. The matter had to be resolved at whatever cost, but the sooner it was concluded, the better.
But in spite of the auguries of peace, the foraging parties were usually fired upon, and this furnished several opportunities for the display of the value of the cavalry. I shall avail myself of the occasion to review the performances of the mounted arm during the operations. As soon as the brigades entered Bajaur, the 11th Bengal Lancers were employed more and more in that legitimate duty of cavalry—reconnaissance. Major Beatson made daily expeditions towards the various valleys and passes about which information was needed. This use of cavalry is an entirely new one on the frontier—it having been thought that it was dangerous to employ them in this way. Though horsemen need good ground to fight on to advantage, they can easily move over any country, however broken, and where they are boldly used, can collect as much information as is necessary.
But despite the signs of peace, the foraging parties were often fired upon, which created several chances to showcase the importance of the cavalry. I'll take this opportunity to look back at the performance of the mounted troops during the operations. Once the brigades entered Bajaur, the 11th Bengal Lancers were increasingly engaged in their primary duty as cavalry—reconnaissance. Major Beatson conducted daily expeditions to the various valleys and passes where information was needed. This use of cavalry is completely new on the frontier—it had previously been thought too risky to employ them this way. While horsemen require good terrain to fight effectively, they can travel easily across any landscape, no matter how rough, and when used confidently, they can gather all the necessary information.
Reconnaissance is by no means the only opportunity for cavalry employment on the frontier. They are as formidable in offensive tactics as they are useful in collecting intelligence.
Reconnaissance isn't the only way to use cavalry on the frontier. They're just as powerful in offensive tactics as they are helpful in gathering intelligence.
The task which is usually confided to them in these mountain actions is to protect one of the flanks. The ground hardly ever admits of charging in any formation, and it is necessary for the men to use their carbines. On 30th September the cavalry were so employed. On the left of the hostile position was a wide valley full of scrubby trees, and stone walls, and occupied by large numbers of the enemy. Had these tribesmen been able to debouch from this valley, they would have fallen on the flank of the brigade, and the situation would have become one of danger. For five hours two weak squadrons of the Guides Cavalry were sufficient to hold them in check.
The job they usually get during these mountain missions is to protect one of the sides. The terrain rarely allows for charging in any formation, so the men have to use their carbines. On September 30th, the cavalry was utilized for this purpose. On the left of the enemy's position was a wide valley filled with shrubby trees and stone walls, occupied by a large number of the enemy. If these tribesmen had managed to come out of this valley, they would have attacked the flank of the brigade, and the situation would have become dangerous. For five hours, two small squadrons of the Guides Cavalry were enough to keep them in check.
The methods they employed are worth noticing. Little groups of six or seven men were dismounted, and these with their carbines replied to the enemy's fire. Other little groups of mounted men remained concealed in nullahs or hollows, or behind obstacles. Whenever the enemy tried to rush one of the dismounted parties, and to do so advanced from the bad ground, the mounted patrols galloped forward and chased them back to cover. The terror that these tribesmen have of cavalry contrasts with their general character. It was a beautiful display of cavalry tactics in this kind of warfare, and, considering the enormous numbers of the enemy, who were thus kept from participating in the main action, it demonstrated the power and value of the mounted arm with convincing force.
The tactics they used are noteworthy. Small groups of six or seven men dismounted and responded to the enemy's fire with their rifles. Other small groups of mounted soldiers stayed hidden in streams or dips, or behind cover. Whenever the enemy attempted to charge one of the dismounted groups, advancing from rough terrain, the mounted patrols rode out and pushed them back into hiding. The fear these tribesmen have of cavalry stands out against their usual behavior. It was an impressive showcase of cavalry tactics in this type of warfare, and given the large numbers of the enemy who were thus kept from engaging in the main battle, it clearly demonstrated the strength and importance of mounted forces.
On the 6th of October, I witnessed some very similar work, though on a smaller scale. A squadron was engaged in covering the operations of a foraging party. A line of patrols, moving rapidly about, presented difficult targets to the enemy's sharpshooters. I found the remainder of the squadron dismounted in rear of a large bank of stones. Twenty sowars with their carbines were engaged in firing at the enemy, who had occupied a morcha—a small stone fort—some 300 yards away. Desultory skirmishing continued for some time, shots being fired from the hills, half a mile away, as well as from the morcha. Bullets kept falling near the bank, but the cover it afforded was good and no one was hurt. At length word was brought that the foraging was finished and that the squadron was to retire under cover of the infantry. Now came a moment of some excitement. The officer in command knew well that the instant his men were mounted they would be fired at from every point which the enemy held. He ordered the first troop to mount, and the second to cover the retirement. The men scrambled into their saddles, and spreading out into an extended line cantered away towards a hollow about 300 yards distant. Immediately there was an outburst of firing. The dust rose in spurts near the horsemen, and the bullets whistled about their ears. No one was however hit. Meanwhile, the remaining troop had been keeping up a rapid fire on the enemy to cover their retirement. It now became their turn to go. Firing a parting volley the men ran to their horses, mounted, and followed the first troop at a hand-gallop, extending into a long line as they did so. Again the enemy opened fire, and again the dusty ground showed that the bullets were well directed. Again, however, nobody was hurt, and the sowars reached the hollow, laughing and talking in high glee. The morning's skirmish had, nevertheless, cost the squadron a man and a horse, both severely wounded.
On October 6th, I saw some very similar actions, but on a smaller scale. A squadron was covering the operations of a foraging party. A line of patrols was moving quickly, making it hard for the enemy's sharpshooters to get a clear shot. I found the rest of the squadron off their horses behind a large pile of stones. Twenty soldiers with their carbines were firing at the enemy, who had taken cover in a small stone fort about 300 yards away. There was some scattered skirmishing for a while, with shots coming from the hills half a mile away, as well as from the fort. Bullets kept landing near the stone pile, but it provided good cover, and no one was hurt. Eventually, we got word that the foraging was done, and the squadron was to retreat under the cover of the infantry. This prompted a moment of excitement. The officer in charge knew that as soon as his men mounted up, they would be targeted from every position the enemy held. He ordered the first troop to get on their horses while the second troop covered the retreat. The men jumped into their saddles and spread out in a line, cantering towards a hollow about 300 yards away. Suddenly, there was a flurry of gunfire. Dust rose all around the horsemen, and bullets whistled by their ears. Fortunately, no one was hit. Meanwhile, the remaining troop had maintained a rapid fire on the enemy to cover their withdrawal. Now it was their turn to leave. After firing a farewell volley, the men ran to their horses, mounted up, and followed the first troop at a fast gallop, stretching into a long line as they did. The enemy opened fire once more, and again the ground showed signs that the bullets were accurately aimed. Yet again, no one was harmed, and the soldiers reached the hollow, laughing and chatting excitedly. However, the morning's skirmish had cost the squadron one man and one horse, both severely wounded.
Such affairs as these were of almost daily occurrence during the time that the 2nd Brigade occupied the camp at Inayat Kila. They were of the greatest value in training the soldiers. The Guides Cavalry know all there is to know of frontier war, but there are many other regiments who would be made infinitely more powerful fighting organisations if they were afforded the opportunity for such experience.
Such events happened almost every day while the 2nd Brigade was stationed at Inayat Kila. They were extremely valuable for training the soldiers. The Guides Cavalry knows everything there is to know about frontier warfare, but many other regiments would become much more effective fighting forces if they were given the chance to gain that kind of experience.
The great feature which the war of 1897 on the Indian Frontier has displayed is the extraordinary value of cavalry. At Shabkadr a charge of the 13th Bengal Lancers was more than successful. In the Swat Valley, during the relief of Chakdara, the Guides Cavalry and 11th Bengal Lancers inflicted the most terrible loss on the enemy. To quote the words of Sir Bindon Blood's official report to the Adjutant-General, these regiments, "eager for vengeance, pursued, cut up and speared them in every direction, leaving their bodies thickly strewn over the fields." Again, after the action of Landakai, the cavalry made a most vigorous pursuit and killed large numbers of the enemy. While I was with the Malakand Field Force, I was a witness of the constant employment of the cavalry, and was several times informed by general officers that they would gladly have a larger number at their disposal. The reader may recall some of the numerous instances which these pages have recorded of cavalry work. On the morning of the 15th September, it was the cavalry who were able to catch up the enemy before they could reach the hills, and take some revenge for the losses of the night. In the action of the 16th, the charge of Captain Cole's squadron brought the whole attack of the enemy to a standstill, and enabled the infantry by their fire to convert the hesitation of the tribesmen into a retreat. Indeed, in every fight in the Mamund Valley, the cavalry were the first in, and the last out. In the official despatches Sir Bindon Blood thus alludes to the work of the cavalry:—"I would now wish to invite attention to the invaluable nature of the services rendered by the cavalry. At Nawagai, three squadrons of the 11th Bengal Lancers swept the country everywhere that cavalry could go, carrying out reconnaissances, protecting signalling parties and watching every movement of the enemy. In the Mamund Valley a squadron of the same regiment, under Captain E.H. Cole, took part in every engagement that occurred while they were there, establishing such a reputation that the enemy, even when in greatly superior numbers, never dared to face them in the open. Afterwards, when Captain Cole and his men left the Mamund Valley, the Guides Cavalry, under Lieut.-Col. Adams, being in greater strength, acted still more effectually in the same manner, showing tactical skill of a high order, combined with conspicuous gallantry."—Official Despatches. From Gazette of India, 3rd December, 1897.
The key takeaway from the 1897 war on the Indian Frontier is the incredible importance of cavalry. At Shabkadr, a charge by the 13th Bengal Lancers was more than successful. In the Swat Valley, during the mission to relieve Chakdara, the Guides Cavalry and the 11th Bengal Lancers caused massive losses to the enemy. To quote Sir Bindon Blood's official report to the Adjutant-General, these regiments, "eager for revenge, pursued, cut down, and speared them in every direction, leaving their bodies thick on the fields." After the action at Landakai, the cavalry aggressively pursued and killed many of the enemy. While I was with the Malakand Field Force, I constantly saw the cavalry at work, and several general officers told me they would have loved to have more cavalry available. The reader may remember some of the many examples of cavalry action recorded in these pages. On the morning of September 15th, it was the cavalry who caught up to the enemy before they could reach the hills and took some revenge for losses from the night. During the action on the 16th, Captain Cole's squadron charged and halted the entire enemy attack, allowing the infantry to turn the tribesmen's hesitation into a retreat with their fire. Indeed, in every fight in the Mamund Valley, the cavalry were first in and last out. In his official dispatches, Sir Bindon Blood mentions the valuable services provided by the cavalry: "I would now like to highlight the invaluable services rendered by the cavalry. At Nawagai, three squadrons of the 11th Bengal Lancers swept through every area cavalry could reach, conducting reconnaissance, protecting signaling parties, and monitoring every movement of the enemy. In the Mamund Valley, a squadron of the same regiment, led by Captain E.H. Cole, participated in every engagement during their time there, earning such a reputation that the enemy, despite being far more numerous, never dared to face them in the open. Later, when Captain Cole and his men left the Mamund Valley, the Guides Cavalry, under Lieut.-Col. Adams, who were stronger in number, acted even more effectively in the same manner, demonstrating high tactical skill combined with remarkable bravery."—Official Dispatches. From Gazette of India, December 3rd, 1897.
There has been a boom in cavalry. But one section, and that the most important, has been deprived of its share in the good fortune. The authorities have steadily refused to allow any British cavalry to cross the frontier. Of course this is defended on the ground of expense. "British cavalry costs so much," it is said, "and natives do the work just as well." "Better," say some. But it is a poor kind of economy thus to discourage a most expensive and important branch of the service. The ambition that a young officer entering the army ought to set before him, is to lead his own men in action. This ought to inspire his life, and animate his effort. "Stables" will no longer be dull, when he realises that on the fitness of his horses, his life and honour may one day depend. If he thinks that his men may soon be asked to stand beside him at a pinch, he will no longer be bored by their interests and affairs. But when he realises that all is empty display, and that his regiment is a sword too costly to be drawn, he naturally loses keenness and betakes himself to polo as a consolation. It is a good one.
There has been a surge in cavalry. However, one part, the most important one, has been left out of this good fortune. The authorities have consistently refused to let any British cavalry cross the border. This is justified by claiming it's too expensive. "British cavalry costs a lot," they say, "and local troops can do the job just as well." "Even better," some argue. But it's a poor way to save money by discouraging such a costly and crucial part of the service. The goal that a young officer joining the army should aim for is to lead his own troops into battle. This should drive his passion and motivate his work. "Stable duties" won’t feel tedious once he understands that his life and reputation may rely on the readiness of his horses. If he knows that his men might soon be asked to stand by him in tough times, he won't find their interests and issues boring. But when he realizes that everything is just for show, and that his regiment is too expensive to engage, he naturally loses enthusiasm and turns to polo for comfort. It’s a good distraction.
It was my fortune to meet many young men in frontier regiments, both cavalry and infantry, who had already served in three, and even four, campaigns. Daring, intelligent and capable, they are proofs of the value of their training, and are fit to lead their men under any conditions, and in any country. Subalterns in British cavalry regiments do occasionally manage to see a little active service as transport officers, signalling officers, war correspondents, or on the staff; but to lead in the field the men they have trained in peace, is a possibility which is never worth contemplating. To the young man who wants to enjoy himself, to spend a few years agreeably in a military companionship, to have an occupation—the British cavalry will be suited. But to the youth who means to make himself a professional soldier, an expert in war, a specialist in practical tactics, who desires a hard life of adventure and a true comradeship in arms, I would recommend the choice of some regiment on the frontier, like those fine ones I have seen, the Guides and the 11th Bengal Lancers.
I was fortunate to meet many young men in frontier regiments, both cavalry and infantry, who had already served in three or even four campaigns. Bold, smart, and capable, they demonstrate the value of their training and are ready to lead their troops under any conditions and in any country. Subalterns in British cavalry regiments sometimes get to experience a bit of active service as transport officers, signaling officers, war correspondents, or on the staff; but actually leading the men they trained in peacetime in the field is a prospect that isn't worth considering. For the young man who wants to have a good time, spend a few years enjoying military camaraderie, and find something to occupy his time, the British cavalry is a good fit. However, for the youth who aims to become a professional soldier, an expert in warfare, a specialist in practical tactics, and who seeks a tough life of adventure and true brotherhood in arms, I would suggest choosing a regiment on the frontier, like those excellent ones I've seen, the Guides and the 11th Bengal Lancers.
I am aware that those who criticise an existing state of things ought to be prepared with some constructive legislation which would remedy the evils they denounce. Though it is unlikely that the Government of India will take my advice, either wholly or in good part, I hereby exhort them to quit the folly of a "penny wise" policy, and to adhere consistently to the principles of employing British and native troops in India in a regular proportion. That is to say, that when two native cavalry regiments have been sent on service across the frontier, the third cavalry regiment so sent shall be British.
I understand that those who criticize the current situation need to come up with some effective legislation to address the problems they point out. Even though it's unlikely that the Government of India will take my advice fully or in part, I urge them to stop the foolish "penny wise" approach and consistently follow the principle of using British and local troops in India in a regular ratio. This means that when two local cavalry regiments are sent to serve across the border, the third cavalry regiment sent should be British.
Besides this, in order to give cavalry officers as many opportunities of seeing active service as possible, subalterns should be allowed to volunteer for emergency employment with native cavalry. I have talked to several officers who command native cavalry regiments, and they tell me that such an arrangement would work excellently, and that, as they are always short of officers, it would supply a want. I would suggest that subalterns should, with the approval of their colonels, be attached to the native regiment, and after passing in Hindustani and being reported as qualified to serve with the native troops, be considered available for employment as described. I shall be told there are financial difficulties. I do not believe this. There are plenty of cavalry subalterns whose eagerness to see service is so strong, that they would submit to any arrangement that the rapacity of Government might impose. Indeed there is no reason that an actual economy should not be effected. The sums of money that the Indian Government offer, as rewards for officers who can speak Hindustani, have not hitherto tempted many cavalry officers to make a study of the language. Here is an incentive, more powerful and costing nothing.
Besides this, to give cavalry officers as many chances to see active service as possible, junior officers should be allowed to volunteer for emergency assignments with local cavalry. I've talked to several officers who lead local cavalry regiments, and they tell me that this setup would work very well, and since they're always short on officers, it would fill a gap. I suggest that junior officers, with their colonels' approval, be attached to the local regiment, and after proving their proficiency in Hindustani and being deemed fit to serve with the local troops, be seen as available for the roles mentioned. I expect I’ll be told there are financial challenges. I don’t believe that's true. There are plenty of cavalry junior officers whose desire to serve is so strong that they would accept any arrangement the government might impose. In fact, there’s no reason actual savings couldn’t be achieved. The amounts of money the Indian Government offers as rewards for officers who can speak Hindustani haven’t previously encouraged many cavalry officers to learn the language. Here’s a motivation that’s even more compelling and costs nothing.
To be technical is, I am aware, a serious offence, and I realise that if this book ever obtained so evil a reputation it would be shunned, as the House of Commons is shunned on a Service night. I have strayed far away from the Malakand Field Force into the tangled paths of military controversy, and I must beg the reader to forgive, as he will surely forget, what has been written.
To be overly technical is, I know, a serious offense, and I understand that if this book ever got a bad reputation, it would be avoided like the House of Commons is on a Service night. I've wandered far from the Malakand Field Force into the complicated world of military debate, and I ask the reader to forgive, as they'll surely forget, what has been written.
The fighting described in the last chapter, and the continual drain of disease, had again filled the field hospitals, and in order to preserve the mobility of the force, it was decided to send all sick and wounded down to the base at once. The journey—over 100 miles by road—would take nearly a fortnight, and the jolting and heat made such an experience a painful and weary one to injured men. But the stern necessities of war render these things inevitable, and the desire of the men to get nearer home soothes much of their suffering. The convoy of sick and wounded was to be escorted as far as the Panjkora River by the Royal West Kent, who were themselves in need of some recuperation. To campaign in India without tents is always a trial to a British regiment; and when it is moved to the front from some unhealthy station like Peshawar, Delhi, or Mian Mir, and the men are saturated with fever and weakened by the summer heats, the sick list becomes long and serious. Typhoid from drinking surface water, and the other various kinds of fever which follow exposure to the heats of the day or the chills of the night, soon take a hundred men from the fighting strength, and the general of an Indian frontier force has to watch with equal care the movements of the enemy and the fluctuations of the hospital returns. As soon, therefore, as Sir Bindon Blood saw that the Mamunds were desirous of peace, and that no further operations against them were probable, he sent one of his British regiments to their tents near the Panjkora.
The fighting described in the last chapter, along with the ongoing toll of disease, had once again filled the field hospitals. To maintain the mobility of the force, it was decided to send all sick and wounded down to the base at once. The journey—over 100 miles by road—would take nearly two weeks, and the jolting and heat made it a painful and exhausting experience for the injured. However, the harsh realities of war make such situations unavoidable, and the soldiers' desire to get closer to home alleviates much of their suffering. The convoy of sick and wounded was to be escorted as far as the Panjkora River by the Royal West Kent, who also needed some recovery time. Campaigning in India without tents is always a challenge for a British regiment; and when they are moved to the front from unhealthy locations like Peshawar, Delhi, or Mian Mir, and the soldiers are already affected by fever and drained by the summer heat, the sick list becomes long and concerning. Typhoid from drinking contaminated water, along with other various fevers that arise from the heat of the day or the chill of the night, quickly takes many men out of the fighting force. The general of an Indian frontier force has to carefully monitor both the enemy's movements and the hospital updates. Therefore, as soon as Sir Bindon Blood realized that the Mamunds were looking for peace and that further operations against them were unlikely, he sent one of his British regiments to their tents near the Panjkora.
About sixty wounded men from the actions of 30th September and 3rd October, and the same number of sick, formed the bulk of the convoy. The slight cases are carried on camels, in cradles made by cutting a native bedstead in two, and called "Kajawas." The more serious cases are carried in doolies or litters, protected from the sun by white curtains, and borne by four natives. Those who are well enough ride on mules. The infantry escort is disposed along the line with every precaution that can be suggested, but the danger of an attack upon the long straggling string of doolies and animals in difficult and broken ground is a very real and terrible one.
About sixty injured men from the events of September 30th and October 3rd, along with about the same number who were sick, made up most of the convoy. The mild cases are carried on camels in cradles made by slicing a local bed in half, known as "Kajawas." The more serious cases are transported in doolies or litters, shielded from the sun by white curtains, and carried by four locals. Those who are well enough ride on mules. The infantry escort is spread out along the line with every precaution imaginable, but the threat of an attack on the long, scattered line of doolies and animals through challenging and uneven terrain is a very real and frightening concern.
The cheeriness and patience of the wounded men exceeds belief. Perhaps it is due to a realisation of the proximity in which they have stood to death; perhaps partly to that feeling of relief with which a man turns for a spell from war to peace. In any case it is remarkable. A poor fellow—a private in the Buffs—was hit at Zagai, and had his arm amputated at the shoulder. I expressed my sympathy, and he replied, philosophically: "You can't make omelettes without breaking eggs," and after a pause added, with much satisfaction, "The regiment did well that day." He came of a fighting stock, but I could not help speculating on the possible future which awaited him. Discharge from the service as medically unfit, some miserable pension insufficient to command any pleasures but those of drink, a loafer's life, and a pauper's grave. Perhaps the regiment—the officers, that is to say—would succeed in getting him work, and would from their own resources supplement his pension. But what a wretched and discreditable system is that, by which the richest nation in the world neglects the soldiers who have served it well, and which leaves to newspaper philanthropy, to local institutions, and to private charity, a burden which ought to be proudly borne by the State.
The cheerfulness and patience of the wounded men are incredible. Maybe it’s because they realize how close they’ve come to death, or maybe it’s the relief of moving from war to peace, even for a little while. Either way, it’s impressive. A poor guy—a private in the Buffs—was injured at Zagai, and he had his arm amputated at the shoulder. I expressed my sympathy, and he replied, thoughtfully: "You can’t make omelettes without breaking eggs," and after a moment, he added, with great satisfaction, "The regiment did well that day." He came from a fighting family, but I couldn’t help wondering about the future that awaited him. Discharged from the service as medically unfit, stuck with a meager pension that would only allow for the pleasures of drinking, living a life of idleness, and ending up in a pauper’s grave. Maybe the regiment—the officers, that is—would manage to help him find work and would supplement his pension from their own funds. But what a terrible and shameful system it is, by which the richest nation in the world neglects the soldiers who served it well, leaving the burden to newspaper philanthropy, local institutions, and private charity, when it should be something the State proudly supports.
Starting at six, the column reached Jar, a march of eight miles, at about ten o'clock. Here we were joined by a wing of the 24th Punjaub Infantry, who were coming up to relieve the Royal West Kents. The camp at Jar has the disadvantage of being commanded by a hill to the north, and the Salarzais, another pestilent tribe, whose name alone is an infliction, delight to show their valour by firing at the troops during the night. Of course this could be prevented by moving the camp out of range of this hill. But then, unfortunately, it would be commanded by another hill to the south, from which the Shamozai section of the Utman Khels—to whom my former remarks also apply—would be able to amuse themselves. The inconvenience of the situation had therefore to be faced.
Starting at six, the column arrived at Jar, having marched eight miles, around ten o'clock. We were joined here by a battalion of the 24th Punjaub Infantry, who were coming to relieve the Royal West Kents. The camp at Jar has the drawback of being overlooked by a hill to the north, and the Salarzais, another troublesome tribe, whose name alone is a burden, take pleasure in demonstrating their bravery by shooting at the troops during the night. Of course, this could be avoided by relocating the camp out of range of that hill. But then, unfortunately, it would be overlooked by another hill to the south, from which the Shamozai section of the Utman Khels—who are also the subject of my previous comments—would find it entertaining. Therefore, we had to deal with the inconvenience of the situation.
We had not been long in camp before the eldest son of the Khan of Jar, who had been comparatively loyal during the operations, came to inform the colonel in command that there would be "sniping" that night. Certain evil men, he said, had declared their intention of destroying the force, but he, the heir-apparent to the Khanate of Jar, and the ally of the Empress, would protect us. Four pickets of his own regular army should watch the camp, that our slumbers might not be disturbed, and when challenged by the sentries, they would reply, "chokidar" (watchman). This all seemed very satisfactory, but we entrenched ourselves as usual, not, as we explained, because we doubted our protector's powers or inclinations, buy merely as a matter of form.
We hadn’t been in camp long before the oldest son of the Khan of Jar, who had been fairly loyal during the operations, came to tell the colonel in charge that there would be “sniping” that night. He said some bad guys had announced their plan to attack the force, but he, the heir to the Khanate of Jar, and an ally of the Empress, would keep us safe. Four patrols of his own regular army would watch the camp so that our sleep wouldn’t be interrupted, and when the sentries challenged them, they would respond with “chokidar” (watchman). This all sounded good, but we set up fortifications as usual, not because we doubted our protector’s abilities or intentions, but just as a formality.
At midnight precisely, the camp was awakened by a dozen shots in rapid succession. The khan's pickets could be heard expostulating with the enemy, who replied by jeers and bitter remarks.
At exactly midnight, the camp was roused by a dozen shots fired in quick succession. The khan's guards could be heard arguing with the enemy, who responded with taunts and harsh comments.
The firing continued for an hour, when the "snipers," having satisfied their honour, relieved their feelings and expended their cartridges, went away rejoicing. The troops throughout remained silent, and vouchsafed no reply.
The shooting went on for an hour, and the "snipers," feeling like they had upheld their honor, let out their emotions and used up their ammo, left feeling happy. The troops stayed quiet and didn’t respond at all.
It may seem difficult to believe that fifty bullets could fall in a camp, only 100 yards square—crowded with animals and men—without any other result than to hit a single mule in the tail. Such was, however, the fact. This shows of what value, a little active service is to the soldier. The first time he is under fire, he imagines himself to be in great danger. He thinks that every bullet is going to hit him, and that every shot is aimed at him. Assuredly he will be killed in a moment. If he goes through this ordeal once or twice, he begins to get some idea of the odds in his favour. He has heard lots of bullets and they have not hurt him. He will get home safely to his tea this evening, just as he did the last time. He becomes a very much more effective fighting machine.
It may sound hard to believe that fifty bullets could fall in a camp, only 100 yards square—packed with animals and people—without hitting anything except a single mule in the tail. But that was the reality. This highlights how valuable a little active service is for a soldier. The first time he’s under fire, he thinks he’s in serious danger. He believes that every bullet is meant for him and that every shot is aimed directly at him. He’s certain he’ll be killed any moment. After going through this experience once or twice, he starts to understand the odds are in his favor. He hears plenty of bullets, and they haven’t harmed him. He’ll make it home for tea this evening, just like he did last time. He becomes a much more effective fighting machine.
From a military point of view, the perpetual frontier wars in one corner or other of the Empire are of the greatest value. This fact may one day be proved, should our soldiers ever be brought into contact with some peace-trained, conscript army, in anything like equal numbers.
From a military perspective, the ongoing frontier wars in various parts of the Empire are extremely valuable. This fact might one day be demonstrated, particularly if our soldiers ever face off against a conscript army that has been trained for peace, with numbers that are at least comparable.
Though the firing produced very little effect on the troops—most of whom had been through the experience several times before—it was a severe trial to the wounded, whose nerves, shattered by pain and weakness, were unable to bear the strain. The surgeon in charge—Major Tyrell—told me that the poor fellows quivered at every shot as if in anticipation of a blow. A bullet in the leg will made a brave man a coward. A blow on the head will make a wise man a fool. Indeed I have read that a sufficiency of absinthe can make a good man a knave. The triumph of mind over matter does not seem to be quite complete as yet.
Though the gunfire had very little impact on the troops—most of whom had gone through this several times before—it was a tough ordeal for the wounded, whose nerves, already frayed by pain and weakness, couldn't handle the pressure. The surgeon in charge—Major Tyrell—told me that the poor guys flinched at every shot as if bracing for a hit. A bullet in the leg can turn a brave man into a coward. A blow to the head can turn a wise man into a fool. In fact, I've read that enough absinthe can turn a good man into a rogue. The triumph of mind over matter doesn't seem to be fully realized yet.
I saw a strange thing happen, while the firing was going on, which may amuse those who take an interest in the habits and development of animals. Just in front of my tent, which was open, was a clear space, occupied by a flock of goats and sheep. The brilliant moonlight made everything plainly visible. Every time a bullet whistled over them or struck the ground near, they ducked and bobbed in evident terror. An officer, who also noticed this, told me it was the first time they had been under fire; and I have been wondering ever since, whether this explains their fear, or makes it more inexplicable.
I witnessed something unusual while the shooting was happening that might interest those curious about animal behavior. Right in front of my open tent was a clear area filled with a group of goats and sheep. The bright moonlight made everything easy to see. Each time a bullet whizzed over them or hit the ground nearby, they flinched and jumped in clear fear. An officer, who also saw this, mentioned it was the first time they had experienced gunfire; and I've been wondering ever since if this explains their fear or makes it even more puzzling.
I have devoted a good deal in this chapter to the account of the "sniping" at Jar on the night of the 9th of October, and, perhaps, a critic may inquire, why so much should be written about so common an incident. It is, however, because this night firing is so common a feature, that I feel no picture of the war on the Indian frontier would be complete without some account of it.
I’ve spent a lot of time in this chapter discussing the "sniping" at Jar on the night of October 9th, and some might wonder why so much attention is given to such a typical event. However, because nighttime firing is such a regular occurrence, I believe no portrayal of the war on the Indian frontier would be complete without some mention of it.
The next day we crossed the Panjkora River, and I started to ride down the line of communications to the base at Nowshera. At each stage some of the comforts of civilisation and peace reappeared. At Panjkora we touched the telegraph wire; at Sarai were fresh potatoes; ice was to be had at Chakdara; a comfortable bed at the Malakand; and at length, at Nowshera, the railway. But how little these things matter after all. When they are at hand, they seem indispensable, but when they cannot be obtained, they are hardly missed. A little plain food, and a philosophic temperament, are the only necessities of life.
The next day we crossed the Panjkora River, and I started riding down the supply route to the base at Nowshera. At each stop, some of the comforts of civilization and peace came back. We found the telegraph wire at Panjkora; there were fresh potatoes at Sarai; ice was available at Chakdara; a comfy bed awaited at the Malakand; and finally, at Nowshera, the railway. But in the end, these things matter so little. When they’re around, they seem essential, but when they’re out of reach, you hardly miss them. A bit of simple food and a laid-back attitude are really all you need in life.
I shall not take the reader farther from the scene of action. He is free and his imagination may lead him back to the highland valleys, where he may continue for a space among camps and men, and observe the conclusion of the drama.
I won't take the reader further from the action. You're free, and your imagination can take you back to the highland valleys, where you can spend some time among camps and people and see how the story ends.
CHAPTER XVI: SUBMISSION
"Their eyes were sunken and weary With a sort of listless woe, And they looked from their desolate eyrie Over the plains below. "Two had wounds from a sabre, And one from an Enfield Ball." "Rajpoot Rebels," LYALL.
"Their eyes were sunken and tired With a kind of aimless sorrow, And they gazed from their empty nest Over the fields below. "Two had cuts from a saber, And one from an Enfield bullet." "Rajpoot Rebels," LYALL.
At last the negotiations with the Mamunds began to reach a conclusion. The tribe were really desirous of peace, and prepared to make any sacrifices to induce the brigades to leave the valley. The Khan of Khar now proved of valuable assistance. He consistently urged them to make peace with the Sirkar, and assured them that the troops would not go away until they had their rifles back. Finally the Mamunds said they would get the rifles. But the path of repentance was a stony one. On the very night that the tribesmen decided for peace at any price, a thousand warlike Afghans, spoiling for a fight, arrived from the Kunar Valley, on the other side of the mountains, and announced their intention of attacking the camp at once. The Mamunds expostulated with them. The retainers of the Khan of Khar implored them not to be so rash. In the end these unwelcome allies were persuaded to depart. But that night the camp was warned that an attack was probable. The inlying pickets were accordingly doubled, and every man slept in his clothes, so as to be ready. The pathos of the situation was provided by the fact, that the Mamunds were guarding us from our enemies. The wretched tribe, rather than face a renewal of hostilities, had posted pickets all round the camp to drive away "snipers" and other assailants. Their sincerity was beyond suspicion.
Finally, the negotiations with the Mamunds were nearing a conclusion. The tribe genuinely wanted peace and were willing to make any sacrifices to persuade the brigades to leave the valley. The Khan of Khar was now proving to be a valuable ally. He consistently encouraged them to make peace with the Sirkar and reassured them that the troops wouldn't leave until they got their rifles back. Eventually, the Mamunds agreed to retrieve the rifles. But the road to repentance was a difficult one. On the very night the tribesmen chose peace at any cost, a thousand battle-ready Afghans, eager for a fight, arrived from the Kunar Valley on the other side of the mountains and declared their intention to attack the camp immediately. The Mamunds urged them to reconsider. The followers of the Khan of Khar begged them not to act so recklessly. In the end, these unwelcome allies were convinced to leave. However, that night, the camp was alerted that an attack was likely. The inner pickets were doubled, and every man slept in his clothes, ready for action. The poignancy of the situation was highlighted by the fact that the Mamunds were protecting us from our enemies. The unfortunate tribe, rather than risk a renewal of hostilities, had set up pickets all around the camp to fend off "snipers" and other attackers. Their sincerity was beyond question.
The next day the first instalment of rifles was surrendered. Fifteen Martini-Henrys taken on the 16th from the 35th Sikhs were brought into camp, by the Khan of Khar's men, and deposited in front of the general's tent. Nearly all were hacked and marked by sword cuts, showing that their owners, the Sikhs, had perished fighting to the last. Perhaps, these firearms had cost more in blood and treasure than any others ever made. The remainder of the twenty-one were promised later, and have since all been surrendered. But the rifles as they lay on the ground were a bitter comment on the economic aspect of the "Forward Policy." These tribes have nothing to surrender but their arms. To extort these few, had taken a month, had cost many lives, and thousands of pounds. It had been as bad a bargain as was ever made. People talk glibly of "the total disarmament of the frontier tribes" as being the obvious policy. No doubt such a result would be most desirable. But to obtain it would be as painful and as tedious an undertaking, as to extract the stings of a swarm of hornets, with naked fingers.
The next day, the first batch of rifles was handed over. Fifteen Martini-Henry rifles, taken on the 16th from the 35th Sikhs, were brought into camp by the Khan of Khar's men and laid in front of the general's tent. Almost all of them were damaged and marked with sword cuts, showing that their owners, the Sikhs, had fought bravely to the end. Perhaps these weapons cost more in blood and resources than any others ever created. The rest of the twenty-one were promised later and have since all been surrendered. But the rifles lying on the ground were a harsh reminder of the economic side of the "Forward Policy." These tribes have nothing to give up except their weapons. It took a month and cost many lives and thousands of pounds to extract these few. It was as poor a deal as could be made. People talk easily about the "total disarmament of the frontier tribes" as if it’s the obvious policy. No doubt such an outcome would be very desirable. But achieving it would be as painful and tedious as trying to remove the stings from a swarm of hornets with bare hands.
After the surrender of the rifles, the discussion of terms proceeded with smoothness. Full jirgahs were sent to the camp from the tribe, and gradually a definite understanding was reached. The tribesmen bewailed the losses they had sustained. Why, they asked, had the Sirkar visited them so heavily? Why, replied Major Deane, had they broken the peace and attacked the camp? The elders of the tribe, following the practice of all communities, threw the blame on their "young men." These had done the evil, they declared. All had paid the penalty. At length definite terms were agreed to, and a full durbar was arranged for the 11th of the month for their ratification.
After the surrender of the rifles, discussions about the terms went smoothly. Full councils were sent from the tribe to the camp, and gradually a clear understanding was reached. The tribesmen mourned the losses they had suffered. They asked why the government had treated them so harshly. Major Deane replied, asking why they had broken the peace and attacked the camp. The tribe's elders, following the usual custom, blamed their "young men." They claimed these young men were responsible for the wrongdoing, and everyone ended up facing the consequences. Eventually, definite terms were agreed upon, and a full meeting was scheduled for the 11th of the month to ratify them.
Accordingly on that date, at about one o'clock in the afternoon, a large and representative jirgah of Mamunds, accompanied by the Khans of Khar, Jar and Nawagai, arrived at the village of Nawa Kila, about half a mile from the camp. At three o'clock Sir Bindon Blood, with Major Deane, Chief Political Officer; Mr. Davis, Assistant Political Officer; most of the Headquarters staff, and a few other officers, started, escorted by a troop of the Guides Cavalry, for the durbar. The general on arrival shook hands with the friendly khans, much to their satisfaction, and took a seat which had been provided. The tribesmen formed three sides of a square. The friendly khans were on the left with their retainers. The Mamund jirgahs filled two other sides. Sir Bindon Blood, with Major Deane on his left and his officers around him, occupied the fourth side.
On that date, around one o'clock in the afternoon, a large and representative jirgah of Mamunds, along with the Khans of Khar, Jar, and Nawagai, arrived at the village of Nawa Kila, about half a mile from the camp. At three o'clock, Sir Bindon Blood, with Major Deane, the Chief Political Officer; Mr. Davis, the Assistant Political Officer; most of the Headquarters staff, and a few other officers, set out, escorted by a troop of the Guides Cavalry, for the durbar. Upon arrival, the general shook hands with the friendly khans, which pleased them greatly, and took a seat that had been arranged for him. The tribesmen formed three sides of a square. The friendly khans were on the left with their retainers. The Mamund jirgahs filled two other sides. Sir Bindon Blood, with Major Deane on his left and his officers around him, occupied the fourth side.
Then the Mamunds solemnly tendered their submission. They expressed their deep regret at their action, and deplored the disasters that had befallen them. They declared, they had only fought because they feared annexation. They agreed to expel the followers of Umra Khan from the valley. They gave security for the rifles that had not yet been surrendered. They were then informed that as they had suffered severe punishment and had submitted, the Sirkar would exact no fine or further penalty from them. At this they showed signs of gratification. The durbar, which had lasted fifteen minutes, was ended by the whole of the tribesmen swearing with uplifted hands to adhere to the terms and keep the peace. They were then dismissed.
Then the Mamunds solemnly offered their submission. They expressed their deep regret for their actions and mourned the disasters that had occurred. They stated they had only fought because they were afraid of being annexed. They agreed to remove the followers of Umra Khan from the valley. They provided security for the rifles that hadn't been surrendered yet. They were then told that since they had already faced serious punishment and had submitted, the government would impose no fine or further penalty on them. At this, they showed signs of relief. The meeting, which lasted fifteen minutes, ended with all the tribesmen raising their hands and swearing to uphold the terms and maintain peace. They were then dismissed.
The losses sustained by the Mamunds in the fighting were ascertained to be 350 killed, besides the wounded, with whom the hill villages were all crowded, and who probably amounted to 700 or 800. This estimate takes no account of the casualties among the transfrontier tribesmen, which were presumably considerable, but regarding which no reliable information could be obtained. Sir Bindon Blood offered them medical aid for their wounded, but this they declined. They could not understand the motive, and feared a stratagem. What the sufferings of these wretched men must have been, without antiseptics or anaesthetics, is terrible to think of. Perhaps, however, vigorous constitutions and the keen air of the mountains were Nature's substitutes.
The Mamunds suffered losses of about 350 killed in the fighting, not counting the wounded, who filled the hill villages and likely numbered around 700 to 800. This figure doesn’t account for the casualties among the cross-border tribesmen, which were probably significant, but no reliable information was available on that. Sir Bindon Blood offered medical assistance for their wounded, but they refused it, not understanding the intention and fearing it was a trick. It's hard to imagine the suffering these unfortunate men endured without antiseptics or anesthetics. However, perhaps their strong health and the fresh mountain air served as nature’s alternatives.
Thus the episode of the Mamund Valley came to an end. On the morning of the 12th, the troops moved out of the camp at Inayat Kila for the last time, and the long line of men, guns and transport animals, trailed slowly away across the plain of Khar. The tribesmen gathered on the hills to watch the departure of their enemies, but whatever feelings of satisfaction they may have felt at the spectacle, were dissipated when they turned their eyes towards their valley. Not a tower, not a fort was to be seen. The villages were destroyed. The crops had been trampled down. They had lost heavily in killed and wounded, and the winter was at hand. No defiant shots pursued the retiring column. The ferocious Mamunds were weary of war.
Thus the episode of the Mamund Valley came to an end. On the morning of the 12th, the troops left the camp at Inayat Kila for the last time, and the long line of soldiers, artillery, and supply animals slowly moved away across the plain of Khar. The tribesmen gathered on the hills to watch their enemies depart, but any satisfaction they might have felt at the sight vanished when they looked towards their valley. Not a tower, not a fort could be seen. The villages were destroyed. The crops had been trampled down. They had suffered heavy losses in killed and wounded, and winter was approaching. No defiant shots pursued the retreating column. The fierce Mamunds were tired of war.
And as the soldiers marched away, their reflections could not have been wholly triumphant. For a month they had held Inayat Kila, and during that month they had been constantly fighting. The Mamunds were crushed. The Imperial power had been asserted, but the cost was heavy. Thirty-one officers and 251 men had been killed and wounded out of a fighting force that had on no occasion exceeded 1200 men.
And as the soldiers marched away, their feelings couldn't have been entirely victorious. For a month, they had held Inayat Kila, and during that time, they had been continuously fighting. The Mamunds were defeated. The Empire's authority had been established, but the price was high. Thirty-one officers and 251 men had been killed or injured out of a fighting force that never exceeded 1,200 men.
The casualties of General Jeffrey's brigade in the Mamund Valley were as follows:—
The casualties of General Jeffrey's brigade in the Mamund Valley were as follows:—
British Officers.... Killed or died of wounds 7 " " .... Wounded.... 17 " Soldiers.... Killed .... 7 " " .... Wounded.... 41 Native Officers .... Killed .... 0 " " .... Wounded.... 7 " Soldiers .... Killed .... 48 " " .... Wounded.... 147 Followers ...... ..... 8 —— Total..... 282 Horses and mules..... ..... 150
British Officers.... Killed or died from wounds 7 " " .... Wounded.... 17 " Soldiers.... Killed .... 7 " " .... Wounded.... 41 Native Officers .... Killed .... 0 " " .... Wounded.... 7 " Soldiers .... Killed .... 48 " " .... Wounded.... 147 Followers ...... ..... 8 —— Total..... 282 Horses and mules..... ..... 150
The main cause of this long list of casualties was, as I have already written, the proximity of the Afghan border. But it would be unjust and ungenerous to deny to the people of the Mamund Valley that reputation for courage, tactical skill and marksmanship, which they have so well deserved. During an indefinite period they had brawled and fought in the unpenetrated gloom of barbarism. At length they struck a blow at civilisation, and civilisation, though compelled to record the odious vices that the fierce light of scientific war exposed, will yet ungrudgingly admit that they are a brave and warlike race. Their name will live in the minds of men for some years, even in this busy century, and there are families in England who will never forget it. But perhaps the tribesmen, sitting sullenly on the hillsides and contemplating the ruin of their habitations, did not realise all this, or if they did, still felt regret at having tried conclusions with the British Raj. Their fame had cost them dear. Indeed, as we have been told, "nothing is so expensive as glory."
The main reason for this long list of casualties was, as I mentioned earlier, the nearby Afghan border. However, it would be unfair and unkind to deny the people of the Mamund Valley their well-earned reputation for bravery, tactical skill, and marksmanship. For a long time, they had fought in the dark realities of chaos. Eventually, they challenged civilization, and while civilization must acknowledge the ugly truths that the harsh light of modern warfare revealed, it will still readily recognize that they are a courageous and warrior-like people. Their name will be remembered for years, even in this fast-paced century, and there are families in England who will never forget it. But perhaps the tribesmen, sitting gloomily on the hills and reflecting on the destruction of their homes, didn’t fully grasp this, or even if they did, they still felt regret for standing against the British Raj. Their fame had come at a great cost. Indeed, as we've heard, "nothing is so expensive as glory."
The troops camped on the night of the 12th at Jar, and on the following day moved up the Salarzai Valley to Matashah. Here they remained for nearly a week. This tribe, terrified by the punishment of the Mamunds, made no regular opposition, though the camp was fired into regularly every night by a few hot-blooded "snipers." Several horses and mules were hit, and a sowar in the Guides Cavalry was wounded. The reconnaissances in force, which were sent out daily to the farther end of the valley, were not resisted in any way, and the tribal jirgahs used every effort to collect the rifles which they had been ordered to surrender. By the 19th all were given up, and on the 20th the troops moved back to Jar. There Sir Bindon Blood received the submission of the Utman Khels, who brought in the weapons demanded from them, and paid a fine as an indemnity for attacking the Malakand and Chakdara.
The troops set up camp on the night of the 12th at Jar, and the next day they advanced up the Salarzai Valley to Matashah. They stayed there for almost a week. This tribe, frightened by the punishment of the Mamunds, didn’t put up any organized resistance, although a few hot-headed "snipers" fired into the camp every night. Several horses and mules were shot, and a soldier in the Guides Cavalry was injured. The reconnaissance missions sent out daily to the far end of the valley faced no resistance at all, and the tribal councils worked hard to gather the rifles they had been told to hand over. By the 19th, all were surrendered, and on the 20th, the troops returned to Jar. There, Sir Bindon Blood accepted the submission of the Utman Khels, who brought in the requested weapons and paid a fine for attacking Malakand and Chakdara.
The soldiers, who were still in a fighting mood, watched with impatience the political negotiations which produced so peaceful a triumph.
The soldiers, who were still ready for a fight, watched the political negotiations that led to such a peaceful victory with impatience.
All Indian military commanders, from Lord Clive and Lord Clive's times downwards, have inveighed against the practice of attaching civil officers to field forces. It has been said, frequently with truth, that they hamper the military operations, and by interfering with the generals, infuse a spirit of vacillation into the plans. Although the political officers of the Malakand Field Force were always personally popular with their military comrades, there were many who criticised their official actions, and disapproved of their presence. The duties of the civil officers, in a campaign, are twofold: firstly, to negotiate, and secondly, to collect information. It would seem that for the first of these duties they are indispensable. The difficult language and peculiar characters of the tribesmen are the study of a lifetime. A knowledge of the local conditions, of the power and influence of the khans, or other rulers of the people; of the general history and traditions of the country, is a task which must be entirely specialised. Rough and ready methods are excellent while the tribes resist, but something more is required when they are anxious to submit. Men are needed who understand the whole question, and all the details of the quarrel, between the natives and the Government, and who can in some measure appreciate both points of view. I do not believe that such are to be found in the army. The military profession is alone sufficient to engross the attention of the most able and accomplished man.
All Indian military commanders, from the era of Lord Clive onward, have criticized the practice of attaching civil officers to field forces. It has often been said, and frequently proven true, that these officers hinder military operations and disrupt the generals, introducing uncertainty into strategic plans. While the political officers of the Malakand Field Force were personally well-liked by their military counterparts, many still criticized their official actions and disapproved of their presence. The duties of civil officers in a campaign are twofold: first, to negotiate, and second, to gather information. It seems they are essential for the first duty. The complex language and unique characteristics of the tribesmen require a lifetime of study. Understanding local conditions, as well as the power and influence of the khans or other local leaders; and the overall history and traditions of the region necessitates specialized knowledge. Simple and direct methods work well when the tribes are resisting, but something more is needed when they are willing to submit. People are needed who understand the full scope of the issue and all the details of the conflict between the locals and the government, and who can appreciate both perspectives. I don’t believe such individuals can be found in the army. The military profession alone is enough to occupy the focus of even the most capable and accomplished person.
Besides this I cannot forget how many quiet nights the 2nd Brigade enjoyed at Inayat Kila when the "snipers" were driven away by the friendly pickets; how many fresh eggs and water melons were procured, and how easily letters and messages were carried about the country [As correspondent of the Pioneer, I invariably availed myself of this method of sending the press telegrams to the telegraph office at Panjkora, and though the route lay through twenty miles of the enemy's country, these messages not only never miscarried, but on several occasions arrived before the official despatches or any heliographed news. By similar agency the bodies of Lieutenant-Colonel O'Bryen and Lieutenant Browne-Clayton, killed in the attack upon Agrah on the 30th of September, were safely and swiftly conveyed to Malakand for burial.] through the relations which the political officers, Mr. Davis and Mr. Gunter, maintained, under very difficult circumstances, with these tribesmen, who were not actually fighting us.
Besides this, I can’t forget how many peaceful nights the 2nd Brigade had at Inayat Kila when the "snipers" were driven away by the friendly pickets; how many fresh eggs and watermelons were obtained, and how easily letters and messages were delivered across the country. As a correspondent for the Pioneer, I always took advantage of this method to send press telegrams to the telegraph office at Panjkora, and even though the route went through twenty miles of enemy territory, these messages not only never got lost, but on several occasions arrived before the official dispatches or any heliographed news. Similarly, the bodies of Lieutenant-Colonel O'Bryen and Lieutenant Browne-Clayton, who were killed in the attack on Agrah on September 30th, were safely and quickly transported to Malakand for burial, thanks to the connections that the political officers, Mr. Davis and Mr. Gunter, maintained with these tribesmen, who were not actually fighting us, despite the very difficult circumstances.
Respecting the second duty, it is difficult to believe that the collection of information as to the numbers and intentions of the enemy would not be better and more appropriately carried out by the Intelligence Department and the cavalry. Civil officers should not be expected to understand what kind of military information a general requires. It is not their business. I am aware that Mr. Davis procured the most correct intelligence about the great night attack at Nawagai, and thus gave ample warning to Sir Bindon Blood. But on the other hand the scanty information available about the Mamunds, previous to the action of the 16th, was the main cause of the severe loss sustained on that day. Besides, the incessant rumours of a night attack on Inayat Kila, kept the whole force in their boots about three nights each week. Civil officers should discharge diplomatic duties, and military officers the conduct of war. And the collection of information is one of the most important of military duties. Our Pathan Sepoys, the Intelligence Branch, and an enterprising cavalry, should obtain all the facts that a general requires to use in his plans. At least the responsibility can thus be definitely assigned.
Respecting the second duty, it’s hard to believe that gathering information on the enemy’s numbers and intentions wouldn’t be better handled by the Intelligence Department and the cavalry. Civil officers shouldn’t be expected to understand what kind of military information a general needs. That’s not their job. I know that Mr. Davis got the most accurate intelligence about the major night attack at Nawagai and gave Sir Bindon Blood plenty of warning. But on the flip side, the limited information available about the Mamunds before the action on the 16th was the main reason for the heavy losses that day. Plus, the constant rumors of a night attack on Inayat Kila kept the entire force on edge for about three nights every week. Civil officers should focus on diplomatic duties, and military officers should handle warfare. Collecting information is one of the most important military responsibilities. Our Pathan Sepoys, the Intelligence Branch, and a proactive cavalry should gather all the facts a general needs to plan effectively. At the very least, this way, we can clearly assign responsibility.
On one point, however, I have no doubts. The political officers must be under the control of the General directing the operations. There must be no "Imperium in imperio." In a Field Force one man only can command—and all in it must be under his authority. Differences, creating difficulties and leading to disasters, will arise whenever the political officers are empowered to make arrangements with the tribesmen, without consulting and sometimes without even informing the man on whose decisions the success of the war and the lives of the soldiers directly depend.
There is one thing I’m sure of. The political officers must operate under the authority of the General in charge of the operations. There should be no "Imperium in imperio." In a Field Force, only one person can be in command—and everyone must fall under their authority. Problems that cause difficulties and can lead to disasters will occur whenever political officers are allowed to make deals with the tribesmen without consulting, and sometimes even without informing, the person whose decisions directly impact the success of the war and the lives of the soldiers.
The subject is a difficult one to discuss, without wounding the feelings of those gallant men, who take all the risks of war, while the campaign lasts, and, when it is over, live in equal peril of their lives among the savage populations, whose dispositions they study, and whose tempers they watch. I am glad to have done with it.
The topic is tough to talk about without hurting the feelings of those brave men who face all the dangers of war while it's happening, and who, when it's over, live in constant danger among the wild populations they observe and whose moods they monitor. I'm relieved to be done with it.
During the stay of the brigades in Bajaur, there had been several cases of desertion among the Afridi Sepoys. On one occasion five men of the 24th Punjaub Infantry, who were out on picket, departed in a body, and taking their arms with them set off towards Tirah and the Khyber Pass. As I have recorded several instances of gallantry and conduct among the Afridis and Pathans in our ranks, it is only fitting that the reverse of the medal should be shown. The reader, who may be interested in the characters of the subject races of the Empire, and of the native soldiers, on whom so much depends, will perhaps pardon a somewhat long digression on the subject of Pathans and Sikhs.
During the brigades' time in Bajaur, there were several instances of desertion among the Afridi soldiers. One time, five men from the 24th Punjab Infantry, who were on guard duty, left together, taking their weapons and heading towards Tirah and the Khyber Pass. Since I've noted several acts of bravery and good behavior among the Afridis and Pathans in our ranks, it's only right to also highlight the negative aspects. The reader, who may be curious about the characters of the various groups within the Empire and the native soldiers on whom so much relies, might forgive a slightly lengthy detour into the topic of Pathans and Sikhs.
It should not be forgotten by those who make wholesale assertions of treachery and untrustworthiness against the Afridi and Pathan soldiers, that these men are placed in a very strange and false position. They are asked to fight against their countrymen and co-religionists. On the one side are accumulated all the forces of fanaticism, patriotism and natural ties. On the other military associations stand alone. It is no doubt a grievous thing to be false to an oath of allegiance, but there are other obligations not less sacred. To respect an oath is a duty which the individual owes to society. Yet, who would by his evidence send a brother to the gallows? The ties of nature are older and take precedence of all other human laws. When the Pathan is invited to suppress his fellow-countrymen, or even to remain a spectator of their suppression, he finds himself in a situation at which, in the words of Burke, "Morality is perplexed, reason staggered, and from which affrighted nature recoils."
It shouldn't be overlooked by those who make sweeping claims of betrayal and untrustworthiness against the Afridi and Pathan soldiers that these men are in a very strange and unfair situation. They are being asked to fight against their fellow countrymen and co-religionists. On one side are all the forces of fanaticism, patriotism, and natural connections. On the other side, military associations stand alone. It's undoubtedly a serious matter to betray an oath of loyalty, but there are other commitments that are equally sacred. Upholding an oath is a duty that individuals owe to society. Yet, who would willingly go against their own family and send a brother to his death? Natural bonds are older and take precedence over all other human laws. When a Pathan is asked to suppress his compatriots, or even just to watch as they are suppressed, he finds himself in a situation where, as Burke said, "Morality is perplexed, reason staggered, and from which affrighted nature recoils."
There are many on the frontier who realise these things, and who sympathise with the Afridi soldier in his dilemma. An officer of the Guides Infantry, of long experience and considerable distinction, who commands both Sikhs and Afridis, and has led both many times in action, writes as follows: "Personally, I don't blame any Afridis who desert to go and defend their own country, now that we have invaded it, and I think it is only natural and proper that they should want to do so."
There are many people on the frontier who understand these things and sympathize with the Afridi soldier in his tough situation. An officer of the Guides Infantry, with extensive experience and significant distinction, who commands both Sikhs and Afridis and has led them into battle many times, writes: "Personally, I don't blame any Afridis who desert to go and defend their own country now that we've invaded it, and I think it's only natural and right that they would want to do that."
Such an opinion may be taken as typical of the views of a great number of officers, who have some title to speak on the subject, as it is one on which their lives might at any moment depend.
Such a viewpoint reflects the views of many officers who are qualified to speak on the matter, as it is something that their lives could depend on at any moment.
The Sikh is the guardian of the Marches. He was originally invented to combat the Pathan. His religion was designed to be diametrically opposed to Mahommedanism. It was a shrewd act of policy. Fanaticism was met by fanaticism. Religious abhorrence was added to racial hatred. The Pathan invaders were rolled back to the mountains, and the Sikhs established themselves at Lahore and Peshawar. The strong contrast, and much of the animosity, remain to-day. The Sikh wears his hair down to his waist; the Pathan shaves his head. The Sikh drinks what he will; the Pathan is an abstainer. The Sikh is burnt after death; the Pathan would be thus deprived of Paradise. As a soldier the Pathan is a finer shot, a hardier man, a better marcher, especially on the hillside, and possibly an even more brilliant fighter. He relies more on instinct than education: war is in his blood; he is a born marksman, but he is dirty, lazy and a spendthrift.
The Sikh is the protector of the borders. He was originally created to fight against the Pathan. His religion was intentionally set up to be completely opposite to Islam. It was a clever political move. Fanaticism was countered by fanaticism. Religious hatred was added to racial animosity. The Pathan invaders were pushed back to the mountains, and the Sikhs settled in Lahore and Peshawar. The strong differences, and much of the hostility, still exist today. The Sikh lets his hair grow down to his waist; the Pathan shaves his head. The Sikh drinks what he likes; the Pathan abstains. The Sikh is cremated after death; the Pathan believes this would deny him Paradise. As a soldier, the Pathan is a better marksman, a tougher individual, and a better marcher, especially on hills, and possibly an even more skilled fighter. He depends more on instinct than formal training: war is in his nature; he is a natural shooter, but he is unkempt, lazy, and a poor manager of money.
In the Sikh the more civilised man appears. He does not shoot naturally, but he learns by patient practice. He is not so tough as the Pathan, but he delights in feats of strength—wrestling, running, or swimming. He is a much cleaner soldier and more careful. He is frequently parsimonious, and always thrifty, and does not generally feed himself as well as the Pathan. [Indeed in some regiments the pay of very thin Sikhs is given them in the form of food, and they have to be carefully watched by their officers till they get fat and strong.]
In the Sikh, the more civilized man stands out. He doesn’t shoot instinctively, but instead learns through dedicated practice. He may not be as rugged as the Pathan, but he takes pleasure in displays of strength—like wrestling, running, or swimming. He is a cleaner soldier and more diligent. He can be quite frugal, always watching his expenses, and he usually doesn’t eat as well as the Pathan. [In fact, in some regiments, the pay of very thin Sikhs is given in the form of food, and their officers have to keep a close eye on them until they gain weight and strength.]
There are some who say that the Sikh will go on under circumstances which will dishearten and discourage his rival, and that if the latter has more dash he has less stamina. The assertion is not supported by facts. In 1895, when Lieut.-Colonel Battye was killed near the Panjkora River and the Guides were hard pressed, the subadar of the Afridi company, turning to his countrymen, shouted: "Now, then, Afridi folk of the Corps of Guides, the Commanding Officer's killed, now's the time to charge!" and the British officers had the greatest difficulty in restraining these impetuous soldiers from leaving their position, and rushing to certain death. The story recalls the speech of the famous cavalry colonel at the action of Tamai, when the squares were seen to be broken, and an excited and demoralised correspondent galloped wildly up to the squadrons, declaring that all was lost. "How do you mean, 'all's lost'? Don't you see the 10th Hussars are here?" There are men in the world who derive as stern an exultation from the proximity of disaster and ruin as others from success, and who are more magnificent in defeat than others are in victory. Such spirits are undoubtedly to be found among the Afridis and Pathans.
Some people say that Sikhs will keep going in situations that would dishearten and discourage their rivals, and that while the latter might have more flair, they lack endurance. This claim isn't backed by facts. In 1895, when Lieutenant Colonel Battye was killed near the Panjkora River and the Guides faced intense pressure, the subadar of the Afridi company turned to his fellow soldiers and shouted, "Now, Afridi folks of the Corps of Guides, the Commanding Officer's dead, it's time to charge!" The British officers had a hard time stopping these eager soldiers from rushing into certain death. This story reminds me of the famous cavalry colonel during the battle of Tamai, when the squares were broken, and a frantic, demoralized correspondent rode up to the squadrons, yelling that all was lost. "What do you mean, 'all is lost'? Don’t you see the 10th Hussars are here?" There are people in the world who find a harsh kind of exhilaration in the face of disaster and ruin, just as others find joy in success, and who display more greatness in defeat than others do in victory. Such spirits can definitely be found among the Afridis and Pathans.
I will quote, in concluding this discussion, the opinion of an old Gurkha subadar who had seen much fighting. He said that he liked the Sikhs better, but would sooner have Afridis with him at a pinch than any other breed of men in India. It is comfortable to reflect, that both are among the soldiers of the Queen.
I want to end this discussion by quoting an experienced Gurkha subadar who had seen a lot of action. He said that he preferred the Sikhs, but if he really needed help, he would rather have Afridis by his side than anyone else in India. It’s reassuring to think that both groups are part of the Queen’s soldiers.
Although there were no Gurkhas in the Malakand Field Force, it is impossible to consider Indian fighting races without alluding to these wicked little men. In appearance they resemble a bronze Japanese. Small, active and fierce, ever with a cheery grin on their broad faces, they combine the dash of the Pathan with the discipline of the Sikh. They spend all their money on food, and, unhampered by religion, drink, smoke and swear like the British soldier, in whose eyes they find more favour than any other—as he regards them—breed of "niggers." They are pure mercenaries, and, while they welcome the dangers, they dislike the prolongation of a campaign, being equally eager to get back to their wives and to the big meat meals of peace time.
Although there were no Gurkhas in the Malakand Field Force, it’s hard to talk about Indian fighting groups without mentioning these brave little men. They look like a bronze version of a Japanese person. Small, quick, and fierce, always wearing a cheerful grin on their broad faces, they mix the boldness of the Pathan with the discipline of the Sikh. They spend all their money on food, and without the restrictions of religion, they drink, smoke, and swear just like British soldiers, who appreciate them more than any other group they see as "niggers." They are purely mercenaries and, while they welcome danger, they don’t like long campaigns, eager to return to their wives and the big meals of peacetime.
After the Utman Khels had been induced to comply with the terms, the brigades recrossed the Panjkora River, and then marching by easy stages down the line of communications, returned to the Malakand. The Guides, moving back to Mardan, went into cantonments again, and turned in a moment from war to peace. The Buffs, bitterly disappointed at having lost their chance of joining in the Tirah expedition, remained at Malakand in garrison. A considerable force was retained near Jalala, to await the issue of the operations against the Afridis, and to be ready to move against the Bunerwals, should an expedition be necessary.
After the Utman Khels agreed to the terms, the brigades crossed back over the Panjkora River and then gradually marched down the supply route, returning to the Malakand. The Guides went back to Mardan, re-entered their cantonments, and shifted from war mode to peacetime. The Buffs, feeling really let down about missing their chance to join the Tirah expedition, stayed in Malakand as part of the garrison. A sizable force remained near Jalala to wait for the results of the operations against the Afridis and to be ready to move against the Bunerwals if needed.
Here we leave the Malakand Field Force. It may be that there is yet another chapter of its history which remains to be written, and that the fine regiments of which it is composed will, under their trusted commander, have other opportunities of playing the great game of war. If that be so, the reader shall decide whether the account shall prolong the tale I have told, or whether the task shall fall to another hand. [It is an excellent instance of the capricious and haphazard manner in which honours and rewards are bestowed in the army, that the operations in the Mamund Valley and throughout Bajaur are commemorated by no distinctive clasp. The losses sustained by the Brigade were indisputably most severe. The result was successful. The conduct of the troops has been officially commended. Yet the soldiers who were engaged in all the rough fighting I have described in the last eight chapters have been excluded from any of the special clasps which have been struck. They share the general clasp with every man who crossed the frontier and with some thousands who never saw a shot fired.]
Here we leave the Malakand Field Force. It’s possible that there’s still another chapter in its history waiting to be written, and that the excellent regiments it comprises, under their trusted commander, will have more chances to engage in the great game of war. If that’s the case, the reader will decide whether to continue the story I’ve told or if it should be left to someone else. [It's a perfect example of the random and unpredictable way honors and awards are given in the army that the operations in the Mamund Valley and throughout Bajaur have no special clasp to commemorate them. The losses suffered by the Brigade were undeniably severe. The outcome was successful. The conduct of the troops has been officially praised. Yet, the soldiers who fought in all the tough battles I’ve described in the last eight chapters have been left out of any of the special clasps that have been issued. They receive the general clasp with every man who crossed the frontier and with thousands who never fired a shot.]
CHAPTER XVII: MILITARY OBSERVATIONS
"... And thou hast talk'd Of sallies and retires, of trenches, tents, Of palisadoes, frontiers, parapets, Of basilisks, of cannon, culverin." "Henry IV.," Part I., Act ii., Sc.3.
"... And you have talked About attacks and retreats, trenches, tents, Fences, borders, walls, Of cannons, guns, and artillery." "Henry IV.," Part I., Act ii., Sc.3.
It may at first seem that a chapter wholly devoted to military considerations is inappropriate to a book which, if it is to enjoy any measure of success, must be read by many unconnected with the army. But I remember that in these days it is necessary for every one, who means to be well informed, to have a superficial knowledge of every one else's business. Encouraged also by what Mr. Gladstone has called "the growing militarism of the times," I hope that, avoiding technicalities, it may be of some general interest to glance for a moment at the frontier war from a purely professional point of view. My observations must be taken as applying to the theatre of the war I have described, but I do not doubt that many of them will be applicable to the whole frontier.
It might initially seem odd to have a chapter entirely focused on military issues in a book that needs to appeal to a wide audience, many of whom have no connection to the army. However, I believe that nowadays, it's important for everyone who wants to stay informed to have at least a basic understanding of various fields. Also encouraged by what Mr. Gladstone referred to as "the growing militarism of the times," I hope that, without getting too technical, a brief look at the frontier war from a purely professional perspective will be of general interest. My observations relate specifically to the area of the war I've discussed, but I believe many of them will be relevant to the entire frontier.
The first and most important consideration is transport. Nobody who has not seen for himself can realise what a great matter this is. I well recall my amazement, when watching a camel convoy more than a mile and a half long, escorted by half a battalion of infantry. I was informed that it contained only two days' supplies for one brigade. People talk lightly of moving columns hither and thither, as if they were mobile groups of men, who had only to march about the country and fight the enemy wherever found, and very few understand that an army is a ponderous mass which drags painfully after it a long chain of advanced depots, stages, rest camps, and communications, by which it is securely fastened to a stationary base. In these valleys, where wheeled traffic is impossible, the difficulties and cost of moving supplies are enormous; and as none, or very few, are to be obtained within the country, the consideration is paramount. Mule transport is for many reasons superior to camel transport. The mule moves faster and can traverse more difficult ground. He is also more hardy and keeps in better condition. When Sir Bindon Blood began his advance against the Mohmands he equipped his 2nd Brigade entirely with mules. It was thus far more mobile, and was available for any rapid movement that might become necessary. To mix the two—camels and mules—appears to combine the disadvantages of both, and destroy the superiority of either.
The first and most important factor is transportation. Anyone who hasn't seen it firsthand can't understand how vital this issue is. I vividly remember being amazed when I saw a camel convoy over a mile and a half long, accompanied by half a battalion of infantry. I was told that it carried only two days' worth of supplies for one brigade. People casually talk about moving columns here and there as if they were simple groups of men who can just march around and fight the enemy wherever they find them, but very few realize that an army is a massive entity that painfully drags behind it a long chain of supply depots, rest stops, and communication lines, all linked securely to a stationary base. In these valleys, where wheeled vehicles can't operate, the challenges and costs of transporting supplies are enormous; and since very few supplies can be sourced locally, this becomes a critical concern. Mule transport is, for many reasons, superior to camel transport. Mules move faster and can handle tougher terrain. They are also hardier and maintain better condition. When Sir Bindon Blood launched his advance against the Mohmands, he equipped his 2nd Brigade entirely with mules. This made it significantly more mobile and ready for any quick movements that might be needed. Mixing camels and mules seems to combine the drawbacks of both and eliminate the advantages of each.
I have already described the Indian service camp and the "sniping" without which no night across the frontier could be complete. I shall therefore only notice two points, which were previously omitted, as they looked suspiciously technical. As the night firing is sometimes varied by more serious attacks, and even actual assaults and sword rushes, it is thought advisable to have the ditch of the entrenchment towards the enemy. Modern weapons notwithstanding, the ultimate appeal is to the bayonet, and the advantage of being on the higher ground is then considerable.
I have already talked about the Indian service camp and the "sniping" that makes every night across the border complete. So, I’ll just mention two points that I didn’t bring up before because they seemed too technical. Since the nighttime firing can sometimes be mixed with more serious attacks, including actual assaults and sword charges, it’s considered wise to position the ditch of the entrenchment facing the enemy. Even with modern weapons, the final resort is still the bayonet, and having the higher ground is definitely a big advantage.
When a battery forms part of the line round a camp, infantry soldiers should be placed between the guns. Artillery officers do not like this; but, though they are very good fellows, there are some things in which it is not well to give way to them. Every one is prone to over-estimate the power of his arm.
When a battery is part of the perimeter around a camp, infantry soldiers should be positioned between the guns. Artillery officers don't prefer this; however, even though they’re great guys, there are some situations where it's not wise to yield to them. Everyone tends to overrate the strength of their capabilities.
In the Mamund Valley all the fighting occurred in capturing villages, which lay in rocky and broken ground in the hollows of the mountains, and were defended by a swarm of active riflemen. Against the quickly moving figures of the enemy it proved almost useless to fire volleys. The tribesmen would dart from rock to rock, exposing themselves only for an instant, and before the attention of a section could be directed to them and the rifles aimed, the chance and the target would have vanished together. Better results were obtained by picking out good shots and giving them permission to fire when they saw their opportunity, without waiting for the word of command. But speaking generally, infantry should push on to the attack with the bayonet without wasting much time in firing, which can only result in their being delayed under the fire of a well-posted enemy.
In the Mamund Valley, all the fighting happened when trying to capture villages set in rocky and uneven terrain within the mountain hollows, which were defended by a swarm of agile riflemen. Firing volleys against the swiftly moving enemy proved almost pointless. The tribesmen would leap from rock to rock, exposing themselves only for a moment, and before a section could aim their rifles, the chance and the target would be gone. Better results came from identifying skilled shooters and allowing them to fire when they saw an opening, without waiting for a command. However, in general, infantry should advance to attack with the bayonet instead of wasting time firing, as this only delays them under the fire of a well-positioned enemy.
After the capture and destruction of the village, the troops had always to return to camp, and a retirement became necessary. The difficulty of executing such an operation in the face of an active and numerous enemy, armed with modern rifles, was great. I had the opportunity of witnessing six of these retirements from the rear companies. Five were fortunate and one was disastrous, but all were attended with loss, and as experienced officers have informed me, with danger. As long as no one is hit everything is successful, but as soon as a few men are wounded, the difficulties begin. No sooner has a point been left—a knoll, a patch of corn, some rocks, or any other incident of ground—than it is seized by the enemy. With their excellent rifles, they kill or wound two or three of the retiring company, whose somewhat close formation makes them a good mark. Now, in civilised war these wounded would be left on the ground, and matters arranged next day by parley. But on the frontier, where no quarter is asked or given, to carry away the wounded is a sacred duty. It is also the strenuous endeavour of every regiment to carry away their dead. The vile and horrid mutilations which the tribesmen inflict on all bodies that fall into their hands, and the insults to which they expose them, add, to unphilosophic minds, another terror to death. Now, it takes at least four men, and very often more, to carry away a body. Observe the result. Every man hit, means five rifles withdrawn from the firing line. Ten men hit, puts a company out of action, as far as fighting power is concerned. The watchful enemy press. The groups of men bearing the injured are excellent targets. Presently the rear-guard is encumbered with wounded. Then a vigorous charge with swords is pushed home. Thus, a disaster occurs.
After the capture and destruction of the village, the troops always had to return to camp, making a retreat necessary. It was very difficult to execute such an operation while facing a large and active enemy armed with modern rifles. I had the chance to witness six of these retreats from the rear companies. Five were successful and one was disastrous, but all came with losses, and as experienced officers have told me, with danger. As long as no one gets hit, everything seems successful, but once a few soldiers are wounded, the difficulties start. No sooner has a location been abandoned—a hill, a patch of corn, some rocks, or any other feature—than the enemy takes it over. With their advanced rifles, they can kill or injure two or three of the retreating soldiers, whose somewhat close formation makes them easy targets. In a conventional war, these wounded soldiers would be left behind, and arrangements would be made the next day through negotiations. But on the frontier, where no mercy is expected or given, it is a sacred duty to carry away the wounded. Every regiment also strives to bring back their dead. The gruesome and awful mutilations that the tribesmen inflict on any bodies they find, along with the insults they subject them to, add another layer of fear to death for those who aren't accepting of such realities. It takes at least four men, often more, to carry away a body. Consider the consequences. Every soldier hit means five rifles are taken out of the firing line. Ten men hit effectively takes a company out of action regarding their fighting capability. The alert enemy pushes forward. The groups of men carrying the injured become easy targets. Soon enough, the rear guard is burdened with wounded soldiers. Then a fierce charge with swords is launched. This leads to disaster.
Watching the progress of events, sometimes from one regiment, sometimes from another, I observed several ways by which these difficulties could be avoided. The Guides, long skilled in frontier war, were the most valuable instructors. As the enemy seize every point as soon as it is left, all retirements should be masked by leaving two or three men behind from each company. These keep up a brisk fire, and after the whole company have taken up a new position, or have nearly done so, they run back and join them. Besides this, the fire of one company in retiring should always be arranged to cover another, and at no moment in a withdrawal should the firing ever cease. The covering company should be actually in position before the rear company begins to move, and should open fire at once. I was particularly struck on 18th September by the retirement of the Guides Infantry. These principles were carried out with such skill and thoroughness that, though the enemy pressed severely, only one man was wounded. The way in which Major Campbell, the commanding officer, availed himself of the advantages of retiring down two spurs and bringing a cross fire to bear to cover the alternate retirements, resembled some intricate chess problem, rather than a military evolution.
Watching the events unfold, sometimes from one regiment and sometimes from another, I noticed several ways to avoid these difficulties. The Guides, experienced in frontier warfare, were the best instructors. Since the enemy occupies every spot as soon as it’s abandoned, all retreats should be concealed by leaving two or three men from each company behind. They maintain a steady fire, and once the entire company has moved to a new position, or is nearly finished doing so, they rejoin the rest. Additionally, the firing from one company during a retreat should always be arranged to cover another, and at no point during a withdrawal should the firing ever stop. The covering company should be properly positioned before the rear company starts to move and should begin firing immediately. I was particularly impressed on September 18th by how the Guides Infantry withdrew. These strategies were executed with such skill and precision that, although the enemy pressed hard, only one man was injured. Major Campbell, the commanding officer, used the advantages of retreating down two spurs and creating a crossfire to support the alternating retreats in a way that resembled a complex chess problem rather than a military maneuver.
The power of the new Lee-Metford rifle with the new Dum-Dum bullet—it is now called, though not officially, the "ek-dum" [Hindustani for "at once."] bullet—is tremendous. The soldiers who have used it have the utmost confidence in their weapon. Up to 500 yards there is no difficulty about judging the range, as it shoots quite straight, or, technically speaking, has a flat trajectory. This is of the greatest value. Of the bullet it may be said, that its stopping power is all that could be desired. The Dum-Dum bullet, though not explosive, is expansive. The original Lee-Metford bullet was a pellet of lead covered by a nickel case with an opening at the base. In the improved bullet this outer case has been drawn backward, making the hole in the base a little smaller and leaving the lead at the tip exposed. The result is a wonderful and from the technical point of view a beautiful machine. On striking a bone this causes the bullet to "set up" or spread out, and it then tears and splinters everything before it, causing wounds which in the body must be generally mortal and in any limb necessitate amputation. Continental critics have asked whether such a bullet is not a violation of the Geneva or St. Petersburg Conventions; but no clause of these international agreements forbids expansive bullets, and the only provision on the subject is that shells less than a certain size shall not be employed. I would observe that bullets are primarily intended to kill, and that these bullets do their duty most effectually, without causing any more pain to those struck by them, than the ordinary lead variety. As the enemy obtained some Lee-Metford rifles and Dum-Dum ammunition during the progress of the fighting, information on this latter point is forthcoming. The sensation is described as similar to that produced by any bullet—a violent numbing blow, followed by a sense of injury and weakness, but little actual pain at the time. Indeed, now-a-days, very few people are so unfortunate as to suffer much pain from wounds, except during the period of recovery. A man is hit. In a quarter of an hour, that is to say, before the shock has passed away and the pain begins, he is usually at the dressing station. Here he is given morphia injections, which reduce all sensations to a uniform dullness. In this state he remains until he is placed under chloroform and operated on.
The power of the new Lee-Metford rifle with the new Dum-Dum bullet—now unofficially called the "ek-dum" [Hindustani for "at once"] bullet—is incredible. The soldiers who have used it are completely confident in their weapon. Up to 500 yards, there’s no issue with judging the range, as it shoots very straight, or technically speaking, has a flat trajectory. This is extremely valuable. The bullet has all the stopping power you could want. The Dum-Dum bullet, while not explosive, is designed to expand. The original Lee-Metford bullet was a lead pellet covered by a nickel case with an opening at the base. In the improved bullet, this outer case has been pulled back, making the hole in the base a bit smaller and exposing the lead at the tip. The result is a remarkably effective and mechanically impressive design. When it strikes a bone, it causes the bullet to expand, tearing and splintering everything in its path, leading to wounds that are usually fatal in the body and will often require amputation in any limb. Critics on the continent have questioned whether such a bullet violates the Geneva or St. Petersburg Conventions; however, none of these international agreements prohibit expanding bullets, and the only rule regarding this is that shells below a certain size cannot be used. I would point out that bullets are primarily meant to kill, and these bullets do their job very effectively, causing no more pain to those hit by them than the regular lead bullets do. Since the enemy managed to get some Lee-Metford rifles and Dum-Dum ammunition during the fighting, we have information on this last point. The experience is described as similar to any bullet impact—a harsh numbing blow, followed by a sense of injury and weakness, but minimal actual pain at the moment. In fact, nowadays, very few people are unfortunate enough to suffer much pain from wounds, except during the recovery period. A man gets hit. In about fifteen minutes, meaning before the shock passes and the pain kicks in, he’s usually at the dressing station. Here, he receives morphine injections to dull all sensations to a consistent numbness. He stays in this state until he is put under chloroform for surgery.
The necessity for having the officers in the same dress as the men, was apparent to all who watched the operations. The conspicuous figure which a British officer in his helmet presented in contrast to the native soldiers in their turbans, drew a well-aimed fire in his direction. Of course, in British regiments, the difference is not nearly so marked. Nevertheless, at close quarters the keen-eyed tribesmen always made an especial mark of the officers, distinguishing them chiefly, I think, by the fact that they do not carry rifles. The following story may show how evident this was:—
The need for officers to dress like the soldiers was clear to anyone observing the operations. The noticeable sight of a British officer in his helmet, compared to the local soldiers in their turbans, made him a target for focused fire. In British regiments, the difference isn’t as obvious. Still, up close, the sharp-eyed tribesmen consistently aimed for the officers, mostly because they didn’t carry rifles. The story that follows illustrates just how clear this was:—
When the Buffs were marching down to Panjkora, they passed the Royal West Kent coming up to relieve them at Inayat Kila. A private in the up-going regiment asked a friend in the Buffs what it was like at the front. "Oh," replied the latter, "you'll be all right so long as you don't go near no officers, nor no white stones." Whether the advice was taken is not recorded, but it was certainly sound, for three days later—on 30th September—in those companies of the Royal West Kent regiment that were engaged in the village of Agrah, eight out of eleven officers were hit or grazed by bullets.
When the Buffs were heading down to Panjkora, they saw the Royal West Kent coming up to take their place at Inayat Kila. A private in the incoming regiment asked a friend in the Buffs what it was like at the front. "Oh," the friend replied, "you'll be fine as long as you stay away from any officers and any white stones." Whether or not the advice was heeded isn't recorded, but it was definitely wise because three days later—on September 30th—in the companies of the Royal West Kent regiment that were involved in the village of Agrah, eight out of eleven officers were hit or grazed by bullets.
The fatigues experienced by troops in mountain warfare are so great, that every effort has to be made to lighten the soldier's load. At the same time the more ammunition he carries on his person the better. Mules laden with cartridge-boxes are very likely to be shot, and fall into the hands of the enemy. In this manner over 6000 rounds were lost on the 16th of September by the two companies of Sikhs whose retirement I have described.
The exhaustion faced by soldiers in mountain warfare is so intense that every effort must be made to reduce the soldier's load. At the same time, the more ammunition they carry, the better. Mules loaded with ammo boxes are very likely to be shot and captured by the enemy. This way, over 6000 rounds were lost on September 16th by the two companies of Sikhs whose withdrawal I've detailed.
The thick leather belts, pouches, and valise equipment of British infantry are unnecessarily heavy. I have heard many officers suggest having them made of web. The argument against this is that the web wears out. That objection could be met by having a large supply of these equipments at the base and issuing fresh ones as soon as the old were unfit for use. It is cheaper to wear out belts than soldiers.
The heavy leather belts, pouches, and gear of British infantry are way too heavy. I've heard many officers propose using webbing instead. The main argument against this is that webbing wears out. This concern could be addressed by keeping a large supply of this gear at the base and distributing new ones as soon as the old ones are no longer usable. It's more cost-effective to wear out belts than soldiers.
Great efforts should be made to give the soldier a piece of chocolate, a small sausage, or something portable and nutritious to carry with him to the field. In a war of long marches, of uncertain fortunes, of retirements often delayed and always pressed, there have been many occasions when regiments and companies have unexpectedly had to stop out all night without food. It is well to remember that the stomach governs the world.
Great efforts should be made to give the soldier some chocolate, a small sausage, or something easy to carry and nutritious for the field. In a war with long marches, uncertain outcomes, and retreats that are often delayed and always rushed, there have been many times when regiments and companies have unexpectedly had to spend the whole night without food. It's important to remember that the stomach controls everything.
The principle of concentrating artillery has long been admitted in Europe. Sir Bindon Blood is the first general who has applied it to mountain warfare in India. It had formerly been the custom to use the guns by twos and threes. As we have seen, at the action of Landakai, the Malakand Field Force had eighteen guns in action, of which twelve were in one line. The fire of this artillery drove the enemy, who were in great strength and an excellent position, from the ground. The infantry attack was accomplished with hardly any loss, and a success was obtained at a cost of a dozen lives which would have been cheap at a hundred.
The idea of focusing artillery has been widely accepted in Europe for a long time. Sir Bindon Blood is the first general to apply this concept to mountain warfare in India. Previously, it was common to use guns in pairs or threes. As we saw at the Battle of Landakai, the Malakand Field Force had eighteen guns in action, with twelve lined up in a single line. The fire from this artillery forced the enemy, who were numerous and well-positioned, off the ground. The infantry attack was carried out with minimal losses, achieving success at the cost of a dozen lives, which would have been a bargain even at a hundred.
After this, it may seem strange if I say that the artillery fire in the Mamund Valley did very little execution. It is nevertheless a fact. The Mamunds are a puny tribe, but they build their houses in the rocks; and against sharpshooters in broken ground, guns can do little. Through field-glasses it was possible to see the enemy dodging behind their rocks, whenever the puffs of smoke from the guns told them that a shell was on its way. Perhaps smokeless powder would have put a stop to this. But in any case, the targets presented to the artillery were extremely bad.
After this, it might sound odd if I say that the artillery fire in the Mamund Valley didn’t cause much damage. But that’s the truth. The Mamunds are a small tribe, but they build their homes in the rocks; and against sharpshooters in rough terrain, artillery doesn’t have much effect. Using field glasses, you could see the enemy ducking behind their rocks whenever the smoke from the guns signaled that a shell was coming their way. Maybe using smokeless powder could have changed this. Still, the targets available for the artillery were really poor.
Where they really were of great service, was not so much in killing the enemy, but in keeping them from occupying certain spurs and knolls. On 30th September, when the Royal West Kent and the 31st Punjaub Infantry were retiring under considerable pressure, the British Mountain Battery moved to within 700 yards of the enemy, and opened a rapid fire of shrapnel on the high ground which commanded the line of retreat, killing such of the tribesmen as were there, and absolutely forbidding the hill to their companions.
Where they were really helpful wasn't so much in defeating the enemy, but in preventing them from taking certain hills and ridges. On September 30th, when the Royal West Kent and the 31st Punjab Infantry were retreating under significant pressure, the British Mountain Battery moved within 700 yards of the enemy and started a rapid fire of shrapnel on the high ground that overlooked the retreat route, killing the tribesmen who were present and completely blocking access to the hill for their allies.
In all rearguard actions among the mountains the employment of artillery is imperative. Even two guns may materially assist the extrication of the infantry from the peaks and crags of the hillside, and prevent by timely shells the tribesmen from seizing each point as soon as it is evacuated. But there is no reason why the artillery should be stinted, and at least two batteries, if available, should accompany a brigade to the attack.
In all defensive actions in the mountains, using artillery is essential. Even just two guns can significantly help the infantry get out of the high peaks and cliffs and stop the local tribes from taking over each spot as soon as it's left. However, there's no reason to hold back on the artillery, and at least two batteries, if possible, should go with a brigade into battle.
Signalling by heliograph was throughout the operations of the greatest value. I had always realised the advantages of a semi-permanent line of signal stations along the communications to the telegraph, but I had doubted the practicability of using such complicated arrangements in action. In this torrid country, where the sun is always shining, the heliograph is always useful. As soon as any hill was taken, communication was established with the brigadier, and no difficulty seemed to be met with, even while the attack was in progress, in sending messages quickly and clearly. In a country intersected by frequent ravines, over which a horse can move but slowly and painfully, it is the surest, the quickest, and indeed the only means of intercommunication. I am delighted to testify to these things, because I had formerly been a scoffer.
Signaling with a heliograph was incredibly valuable throughout the operations. I always understood the benefits of having a semi-permanent line of signal stations along the communication routes to the telegraph, but I had doubted the practicality of using such complex setups in action. In this scorching region, where the sun is constantly shining, the heliograph is always effective. As soon as we captured any hill, we established communication with the brigadier, and we faced no difficulties in sending messages quickly and clearly, even while the attack was ongoing. In a land crisscrossed by frequent ravines, where a horse can move slowly and painfully, it is the most reliable, fastest, and indeed the only means of communication. I'm thrilled to share this, as I previously had my doubts.
I have touched on infantry and artillery, and, though a previous chapter has been almost wholly devoted to the cavalry, I cannot resist the desire to get back to the horses and the lances again. The question of sword or lance as the cavalryman's weapon has long been argued, and it may be of interest to consider what are the views of those whose experience is the most recent. Though I have had no opportunity of witnessing the use of the lance, I have heard the opinions of many officers both of the Guides and the 11th Bengal Lancers. All admit or assert that the lance is in this warfare the better weapon. It kills with more certainty and convenience, and there is less danger of the horseman being cut down. As to length, the general opinion seems to be in favour of a shorter spear. This, with a counter poise at the butt, gives as good a reach and is much more useful for close quarters. Major Beatson, one of the most distinguished cavalry officers on the frontier, is a strong advocate of this. Either the pennon should be knotted, or a boss of some sort affixed about eighteen inches below the point. Unless this be done there is a danger of the lance penetrating too far, when it either gets broken or allows the enemy to wriggle up and strike the lancer. This last actually happened on several occasions.
I've talked about infantry and artillery, and while a previous chapter was nearly all about cavalry, I can't help but want to return to horses and lances. The debate over whether a sword or lance is the better weapon for cavalry has been ongoing, and it might be interesting to look at the opinions of those with the most recent experience. Although I haven't had the chance to see the lance in action, I've heard from many officers from the Guides and the 11th Bengal Lancers. They all agree that the lance is the superior weapon in this type of warfare. It’s more reliable and easier to use, and there's less risk of the horseman being taken down. Regarding size, the general consensus leans toward a shorter spear. This, along with a counterweight at the butt, provides a good reach and is much more practical for close-quarters combat. Major Beatson, one of the most respected cavalry officers on the frontier, strongly supports this idea. Either the pennon should be knotted, or a knob of some kind should be attached about eighteen inches below the tip. If this isn’t done, there's a risk of the lance going in too deep, which can either break it or give the enemy a chance to get close and attack the lancer. This has actually happened several times.
Now, in considering the question to what extent a squadron should be armed with lances, the system adopted by the Guides may be of interest. In this warfare it is very often necessary for the cavalryman to dismount and use his carbine. The lance then gets in the way and has to be tied to the saddle. This takes time, and there is usually not much time to spare in cavalry skirmishing. The Guides compromise matters by giving one man in every four a lance. This man, when the others dismount, stays in the saddle and holds their horses. They also give the outer sections of each squadron lances, and these, too, remain mounted, as the drill-book enjoins. But I become too technical.
Now, when it comes to the question of how much a squadron should be armed with lances, the method used by the Guides might be relevant. In this type of warfare, it’s often necessary for cavalry soldiers to dismount and use their carbines. The lance can get in the way and has to be tied to the saddle. This takes time, and there usually isn't a lot of time to spare during cavalry skirmishes. The Guides find a middle ground by giving one person in every four a lance. This person stays mounted and holds the horses when the others dismount. They also provide lances to the outer sections of each squadron, which also remain mounted, as the drill manual instructs. But I'm getting too technical.
I pass for a moment to combined tactics. In frontier warfare Providence is on the side of the good band-o-bust [arrangements]. There are no scenic effects or great opportunities, and the Brigadier who leaves the mountains with as good a reputation as he entered them has proved himself an able, sensible man. The general who avoids all "dash," who never starts in the morning looking for a fight and without any definite intention, who does not attempt heroic achievements, and who keeps his eye on his watch, will have few casualties and little glory. For the enemy do not become formidable until a mistake has been made. The public who do not believe in military operations without bloodshed may be unattentive. His subordinate officers may complain that they have had no fighting. But in the consciousness of duty skillfully performed and of human life preserved he will find a high reward.
I want to briefly discuss combined tactics. In border conflicts, luck tends to favor the well-organized teams. There aren’t any dramatic moments or major chances, and the officer who leaves the mountains with the same good reputation he entered with has shown himself to be capable and sensible. The general who stays away from all bravado, who doesn’t set out each morning looking for a fight without a clear plan, who avoids attempting heroic feats, and who keeps track of time, will have few casualties and little recognition. The enemy only becomes a real threat when a mistake happens. The public, who may not understand military operations without casualties, can be indifferent. His subordinate officers might complain about the lack of combat. But in the satisfaction of having done his duty well and saved lives, he will find great reward.
A general review of the frontier war will, I think, show the great disadvantages to which regular troops are exposed in fighting an active enterprising enemy that can move faster and shoot better, who knows the country and who knows the ranges. The terrible losses inflicted on the tribesmen in the Swat Valley show how easily disciplined troops can brush away the bravest savages in the open. But on the hillside all is changed, and the observer will be struck by the weakness rather than the strength of modern weapons. Daring riflemen, individually superior to the soldiers, and able to support the greatest fatigues, can always inflict loss, although they cannot bar their path.
A general overview of the frontier war will, I think, reveal the significant disadvantages regular troops face when battling an active, resourceful enemy that can move faster and shoot better, who knows the terrain and understands the distances. The heavy losses suffered by the tribesmen in the Swat Valley demonstrate how easily disciplined troops can overpower brave warriors in open combat. However, on the hillsides, everything changes, and the observer will notice the weaknesses rather than the strengths of modern weapons. Bold riflemen, who are individually superior to the soldiers and can endure great hardships, can always inflict damage, even though they cannot completely block their progress.
The military problem with which the Spaniards are confronted in Cuba is in many points similar to that presented in the Afghan valleys; a roadless, broken and undeveloped country; an absence of any strategic points; a well-armed enemy with great mobility and modern rifles, who adopts guerilla tactics. The results in either case are, that the troops can march anywhere, and do anything, except catch the enemy; and that all their movements must be attended with loss.
The military issue the Spaniards face in Cuba is quite similar to the one in the Afghan valleys: a rugged, undeveloped country without any roads; a lack of strategic locations; a well-armed enemy with high mobility and modern rifles who uses guerrilla tactics. In both scenarios, the troops can move wherever they want and do whatever they like, except actually capture the enemy, and every action they take results in losses.
If the question of subduing the tribes be regarded from a purely military standpoint, if time were no object, and there was no danger of a lengthy operation being interrupted by a change of policy at home, it would appear that the efforts of commanders should be, to induce the tribesmen to assume the offensive. On this point I must limit my remarks to the flat-bottomed valleys of Swat and Bajaur. To coerce a tribe like the Mamunds, a mixed brigade might camp at the entrance to the valley, and as at Inayat Kila, entrench itself very strongly. The squadron of cavalry could patrol the valley daily in complete security, as the tribesmen would not dare to leave the hills. All sowing of crops and agricultural work would be stopped. The natives would retaliate by firing into the camp at night. This would cause loss; but if every one were to dig a good hole to sleep in, and if the officers were made to have dinner before sundown, and forbidden to walk about except on duty after dark, there is no reason why the loss should be severe. At length the tribesmen, infuriated by the occupation of their valley, and perhaps rendered desperate by the approach of famine and winter, would make a tremendous attempt to storm the camp. With a strong entrenchment, a wire trip to break a rush, and modern rifles, they would be driven off with great slaughter, and once severely punished would probably beg for terms. If not, the process would be continued until they did so.
If we look at the issue of controlling the tribes purely from a military perspective, assuming time isn't a factor and there's no risk of a change in strategy back home interrupting the operation, it seems commanders should work to get the tribesmen to take the offensive. I’ll focus my comments on the flat-bottomed valleys of Swat and Bajaur. To pressure a tribe like the Mamunds, a mixed brigade could set up camp at the valley entrance and, like at Inayat Kila, create strong fortifications. A cavalry unit could patrol the valley daily with complete safety, as the tribesmen wouldn’t dare come down from the hills. All farming activities would cease. The locals would retaliate by shooting into the camp at night. This would result in losses, but if everyone dug a solid hole to sleep in, and if the officers had dinner before sunset and were only allowed to move around on duty after dark, there’s no reason the losses should be significant. Eventually, the tribesmen, furious about the occupation of their valley and likely driven to desperation by famine and winter, would make a desperate attempt to storm the camp. With strong fortifications, a wire trap to stop a charge, and modern rifles, they would be repelled with heavy casualties, and after facing a severe defeat, they would likely plead for terms. If they didn’t, the same strategy would continue until they did.
Such a military policy would cost about the same in money as the vigorous methods I have described, as though smaller numbers of troops might be employed, they would have to remain mobilised and in the field for a longer period. But the loss in personnel would be much less. As good an example of the success of this method as can be found, is provided by Sir Bindon Blood's tactics at Nawagai, when, being too weak to attack the enemy himself, he encouraged them to attack him, and then beat them off with great loss.
Such a military policy would cost approximately the same amount of money as the aggressive strategies I’ve discussed. Although fewer troops might be used, they would need to stay mobilized and in the field for a longer time. However, the loss of personnel would be much lower. A great example of the success of this approach is Sir Bindon Blood’s tactics at Nawagai. When he was too weak to attack the enemy himself, he provoked them into attacking him and then led his forces to repel them with significant losses.
From the point which we have now reached, it is possible, and perhaps not undesirable, to take a rapid yet sweeping glance of the larger military problems of the day. We have for some years adopted the "short service" system. It is a continental system. It has many disadvantages. Troops raised under it suffer from youth, want of training and lack of regimental associations. But on the Continent it has this one, paramount recommendation: it provides enormous numbers. The active army is merely a machine for manufacturing soldiers quickly, and passing them into the reserves, to be stored until they are wanted. European nations deal with soldiers only in masses. Great armies of men, not necessarily of a high standard of courage and training, but armed with deadly weapons, are directed against one another, under varying strategical conditions. Before they can rebound, thousands are slaughtered and a great battle has been won or lost. The average courage of the two nations may perhaps have been decided. The essence of the continental system is its gigantic scale.
From where we currently stand, it’s possible, and perhaps even useful, to quickly look at the bigger military issues of today. For several years now, we've implemented the "short service" system. This is a system used in continental Europe. It comes with many drawbacks. Troops raised under this system often lack experience, training, and strong regimental ties. However, the key advantage on the Continent is that it generates a huge number of soldiers. The active army basically acts as a rapid production line for soldiers, sending them into reserves for later use. European countries handle soldiers in large groups. Massive armies, which might not necessarily have exceptional levels of bravery or training but are equipped with lethal weapons, face off against each other under different strategic conditions. Before they can recover, thousands are lost and a major battle is either won or lost. The average bravery of the two nations may have been impacted. The core feature of the continental system is its enormous scale.
We have adopted this system in all respects but one, and that the vital one. We have got the poor quality, without the great quantity. We have, by the short service system, increased our numbers a little, and decreased our standard a good deal. The reason that this system, which is so well adapted to continental requirements, confers no advantages upon us is obvious. Our army is recruited by a voluntary system. Short service and conscription are inseparable. For this reason, several stern soldiers advocate conscription. But many words will have to be spoken, many votes voted, and perhaps many blows struck before the British people would submit to such an abridgment of their liberties, or such a drag upon their commerce. It will be time to make such sacrifices when the English Channel runs dry.
We’ve adopted this system in every way except one, and that’s the crucial one. We have poor quality without the high quantity. Through the short service system, we’ve increased our numbers a bit, but lowered our standards significantly. The reason this system, which works so well for continental needs, doesn’t benefit us is clear. Our army is built on voluntary enlistment. Short service and conscription go hand in hand. Because of this, some tough soldiers support conscription. But it will take a lot of discussion, many votes, and possibly even some conflict before the British people agree to such a restriction of their freedoms or such a burden on their trade. It would only be time to make such sacrifices when the English Channel runs dry.
Without conscription we cannot have great numbers. It should therefore be our endeavour to have those we possess of the best quality; and our situation and needs enforce this view. Our soldiers are not required to operate in great masses, but very often to fight hand to hand. Their campaigns are not fought in temperate climates and civilised countries. They are sent beyond the seas to Africa or the Indian frontier, and there, under a hot sun and in a pestilential land, they are engaged in individual combat with athletic savages. They are not old enough for the work.
Without conscription, we can’t have large numbers. So, we should aim to have the best quality among those we do have; our circumstances and needs make this clear. Our soldiers don’t need to fight in large groups, but often have to engage in close combat. Their campaigns aren't fought in temperate climates or civilized countries. They’re sent overseas to Africa or the Indian frontier, where, under a scorching sun and in unhealthy conditions, they face off individually against strong opponents. They're not mature enough for this work.
Young as they are, their superior weapons and the prestige of the dominant race enable them to maintain their superiority over the native troops. But in the present war several incidents have occurred, unimportant, insignificant, it is true, but which, in the interests of Imperial expediency, are better forgotten. The native regiments are ten years older than the British regiments. Many of their men have seen service and have been under fire. Some of them have several medals. All, of course, are habituated to the natural conditions. It is evident how many advantages they enjoy. It is also apparent how very serious the consequences would be if they imagined they possessed any superiority. That such an assumption should even be possible is a menace to our very existence in India. Intrinsic merit is the only title of a dominant race to its possessions. If we fail in this it is not because our spirit is old and grown weak, but because our soldiers are young, and not yet grown strong.
Young as they are, their advanced weapons and the prestige of the dominant race allow them to keep their edge over the local troops. However, in the current war, a few incidents have happened—minor and unimportant, it’s true—that are better off forgotten for the sake of Imperial interests. The local regiments are ten years older than the British ones. Many of their soldiers have seen combat and have been in the line of fire. Some even have multiple medals. Naturally, all are used to the local conditions. It's clear how many advantages they have. It's also clear how serious the consequences would be if they thought they had any superiority. The fact that such a belief could even exist is a threat to our very presence in India. True merit is the only justification for a dominant race to hold onto its possessions. If we fail in this, it’s not because our spirit has grown weak with age, but because our soldiers are young and still gaining strength.
Boys of twenty-one and twenty-two are expected to compete on equal terms with Sikhs and Gurkhas of thirty, fully developed and in the prime of life. It is an unfair test. That they should have held their own is a splendid tribute to the vigour of our race. The experiment is dangerous, and it is also expensive. We continue to make it because the idea is still cherished that British armies will one day again play a part in continental war. When the people of the United Kingdom are foolish enough to allow their little army to be ground to fragments between continental myriads, they will deserve all the misfortunes that will inevitably come upon them.
Young men who are twenty-one and twenty-two are expected to compete on the same level as Sikhs and Gurkhas who are thirty, fully mature and in their prime. This is an unfair challenge. The fact that they have managed to hold their own is a remarkable testament to the strength of our race. The experiment is risky and costly. We keep pursuing it because the belief persists that British armies will one day again be involved in continental warfare. When the people of the United Kingdom are reckless enough to let their small army be overwhelmed by continental forces, they will deserve all the misfortunes that will inevitably come their way.
I am aware that these arguments are neither original nor new. I have merely arranged them. I am also aware that there are able, brilliant men who have spent their lives in the service of the State, who do not take the views I have quoted. The question has been regarded from an Indian point of view. There is probably no colonel in India, who commands a British regiment, who would not like to see his men five years older. It may be that the Indian opinion on the subject is based only on partial information, and warped by local circumstances. Still I have thought it right to submit it to the consideration of the public, at a time when the army has been filling such a prominent position, not only in the Jubilee procession and the frontier war, but also in the estimates presented to the House of Commons.
I know that these arguments aren't original or new. I've just put them together. I also understand that there are capable, brilliant individuals who have dedicated their lives to serving the State and who don’t share the views I’ve mentioned. The question has been looked at from an Indian perspective. It's likely that no colonel in India, who leads a British regiment, wouldn’t want his men to be five years older. Indian opinions on this topic might be based on limited information and influenced by local conditions. Still, I thought it was important to share it with the public at a time when the army has been playing such a significant role, not just in the Jubilee procession and the frontier war, but also in the budget presented to the House of Commons.
Passing from the concrete to the abstract, it may not be unfitting that these pages, which have recorded so many valiant deeds, should contain some brief inquiry into the nature of those motives which induce men to expose themselves to great hazards, and to remain in situations of danger. The circumstances of war contain every element that can shake the nerves. The whizzing of the projectiles; the shouts and yells of a numerous and savage enemy; the piteous aspect of the wounded, covered with blood and sometimes crying out in pain; the spurts of dust which on all sides show where Fate is stepping—these are the sights and sounds which assail soldiers, whose development and education enable them to fully appreciate their significance. And yet the courage of the soldier is the commonest of virtues. Thousands of men, drawn at random from the population, are found to control the instinct of self-preservation. Nor is this courage peculiar to any particular nation. Courage is not only common, but cosmopolitan. But such are the apparent contradictions of life, that this virtue, which so many seem to possess, all hold the highest. There is probably no man, however miserable, who would not writhe at being exposed a coward. Why should the common be precious? What is the explanation?
Shifting from the concrete to the abstract, it seems fitting that these pages, which have documented so many brave acts, should include a brief exploration of the reasons behind why people risk their lives and stay in dangerous situations. The realities of war feature every aspect that can rattle the nerves. The sound of projectiles whizzing by; the cries and shouts of a large, fierce enemy; the heart-wrenching sight of the wounded, covered in blood and sometimes screaming in pain; the bursts of dust indicating where danger is lurking—these are the sights and sounds that confront soldiers, who have the ability to fully grasp their significance due to their training and experiences. Yet, the bravery of a soldier is one of the most common virtues. Thousands of men, chosen at random from the general population, are found to suppress their instinct for self-preservation. This bravery is not limited to any specific nation. Courage is not only widespread but also universal. However, life’s apparent contradictions show that this virtue, which many seem to possess, is held in the highest regard by all. There’s likely no person, no matter how wretched, who wouldn’t feel agony at being labeled a coward. Why should something common be so valued? What’s the reasoning behind it?
It appears to be this. The courage of the soldier is not really contempt for physical evils and indifference to danger. It is a more or less successful attempt to simulate these habits of mind. Most men aspire to be good actors in the play. There are a few who are so perfect that they do not seem to be actors at all. This is the ideal after which the rest are striving. It is one very rarely attained.
It seems like this. A soldier's courage isn't simply about looking down on physical threats and not caring about danger. It's more about trying to convincingly imitate that mindset. Most guys want to be great performers in this role. There are a few who are so good that they don't come across as actors at all. This is what everyone else is aiming for. It's an ideal that is very rarely achieved.
Three principal influences combine to assist men in their attempts: preparation, vanity and sentiment. The first includes all the force of discipline and training. The soldier has for years contemplated the possibility of being under fire. He has wondered vaguely what kind of an experience it would be. He has seen many who have gone through it and returned safely. His curiosity is excited. Presently comes the occasion. By road and railway he approaches daily nearer to the scene. His mind becomes familiar with the prospect. His comrades are in the same situation. Habit, behind which force of circumstances is concealed, makes him conform. At length the hour arrives. He observes the darting puffs of smoke in the distance. He listens to the sounds that are in the air. Perhaps he hears something strike with a thud and sees a soldier near him collapse like a shot pheasant. He realises that it may be his turn next. Fear grips him by the throat.
Three main influences come together to help men in their attempts: preparation, vanity, and sentiment. The first includes all the power of discipline and training. The soldier has spent years thinking about the possibility of being under fire. He has wondered what that experience would be like. He has seen many who have gone through it and returned safely. His curiosity is piqued. Soon, the moment arrives. By road and rail, he gets closer to the scene day by day. His mind becomes familiar with the prospect. His comrades are in the same position. Habit, masked by the force of circumstances, makes him go along with it. Finally, the hour comes. He sees the quick puffs of smoke in the distance. He listens to the sounds in the air. Maybe he hears something hit with a thud and sees a soldier next to him collapse like a shot bird. He realizes it might be his turn next. Fear tightens its grip around his throat.
Then vanity, the vice which promotes so many virtues, asserts itself. He looks at his comrades and they at him. So far he has shown no sign of weakness. He thinks, they are thinking him brave. The dearly longed-for reputation glitters before his eyes. He executes the orders he receives.
Then vanity, the vice that encourages so many virtues, takes over. He looks at his friends, and they look back at him. So far, he hasn’t shown any signs of weakness. He thinks they view him as brave. The reputation he has longed for sparkles in front of him. He carries out the orders he gets.
But something else is needed to made a hero. Some other influence must help him through the harder trials and more severe ordeals which may befall him. It is sentiment which makes the difference in the end. Those who doubt should stroll to the camp fire one night and listen to the soldiers' songs. Every one clings to something that he thinks is high and noble, or that raises him above the rest of the world in the hour of need. Perhaps he remembers that he is sprung from an ancient stock, and of a race that has always known how to die; or more probably it is something smaller and more intimate; the regiment, whatever it is called—"The Gordons," "The Buffs," "The Queen's,"—and so nursing the name—only the unofficial name of an infantry battalion after all—he accomplishes great things and maintains the honour and the Empire of the British people.
But something else is needed to make a hero. Some other influence must help him through the tougher challenges and more intense trials that may come his way. It’s sentiment that makes the difference in the end. Those who are skeptical should take a walk to the campfire one night and listen to the soldiers' songs. Everyone holds on to something they believe is noble or that lifts them above the rest of the world when it matters most. Maybe they remember that they come from an ancient lineage and a race that has always known how to face death; or more likely, it’s something smaller and more personal—the regiment, whatever it’s called—“The Gordons,” “The Buffs,” “The Queen’s”—and by cherishing that name— just the unofficial title of an infantry battalion after all—he achieves great things and upholds the honor and the Empire of the British people.
It may be worth while, in the matter of names, to observe the advantages to a regiment of a monosyllabic appellation. Every one will remember Lieut.-Colonel Mathias' speech to the Gordons. Imagine for a moment that speech addressed to some regiment saddled with a fantastic title on the territorial system, as, for instance, Mr. Kipling's famous regiment, "The Princess Hohenzollern-Sigmaringen-Anspach's Merthyr Tydvilshire Own Royal Loyal Light Infantry." With the old numbers all started on equal terms.
It might be useful to consider the benefits of a one-syllable name for a regiment. Everyone remembers Lieutenant Colonel Mathias' speech to the Gordons. Just picture that speech being delivered to a regiment burdened with a complicated name based on the territorial system, like Mr. Kipling's well-known regiment, "The Princess Hohenzollern-Sigmaringen-Anspach's Merthyr Tydvilshire Own Royal Loyal Light Infantry." With the old numbers, everyone began on the same level.
This has been perhaps a cold-blooded chapter. We have considered men as targets; tribesmen, fighting for their homes and hills, have been regarded only as the objective of an attack; killed and wounded human beings, merely as the waste of war. We have even attempted to analyse the high and noble virtue of courage, in the hopes of learning how it may be manufactured.
This has probably been a ruthless chapter. We've viewed men as targets; tribespeople, fighting for their homes and land, have been seen only as the goal of an attack; killed and injured individuals, simply as the collateral damage of war. We've even tried to break down the great and noble quality of courage, hoping to figure out how it can be produced.
The philosopher may observe with pity, and the philanthropist deplore with pain, that the attention of so many minds should be directed to the scientific destruction of the human species; but practical people in a business-like age will remember that they live in a world of men—not angels—and regulate their conduct accordingly.
The philosopher might feel pity, and the philanthropist might mourn with sadness, that so many minds focus on the scientific destruction of humanity; but practical people in a pragmatic age will remember that they live among humans—not angels—and act accordingly.
CHAPTER XVIII. AND LAST.: THE RIDDLE OF THE FRONTIER
"Myself when young did eagerly frequent Doctor and saint, and heard great argument About it and about, but evermore Came out by the same door wherein I went." OMAR KHAYYAM.
"When I was young, I often visited doctors and saints, listening to their big debates about it and everything else, but every time I ended up leaving through the same door I entered." OMAR KHAYYAM.
These pages, which have chronicled a variety of small incidents, have hitherto concerned themselves little with the great matters out of which those incidents have arisen. As an opening chapter should lead the reader to expect the considerations that the book contains, so the conclusion should express the opinion he might form from the perusal. When, at an earlier period, I refrained from discussing the question of frontier policy, I declared that its consideration was only postponed until a more propitious moment. That moment now presents itself. There will not be wanting those who will remind me, that in this matter my opinion is not supported by age or experience. To such I shall reply, that if what is written is false or foolish, neither age nor experience should fortify it; and if it is true, it needs no such support. The propositions of Euclid would be no less indisputable were they propounded by an infant or an idiot.
These pages, which have documented various small incidents, have so far paid little attention to the larger issues that these incidents stem from. Just like an introductory chapter should set up the reader for what’s in the book, the conclusion should reflect the opinion they might form after reading. Earlier, when I chose not to discuss the question of frontier policy, I mentioned that I would come back to it at a more suitable time. That time has now arrived. Some might remind me that my opinion lacks the backing of age or experience. To those individuals, I will say that if what I’ve written is false or foolish, then age or experience won’t make it any better; and if it’s true, it doesn’t need that kind of support. The principles of Euclid would remain just as undeniable, whether presented by a child or a fool.
The inquirer sees the vast question unfold itself with feelings like those with which the fisherman in the old story watched the genius he had unwittingly released, rise from the bottle in clouds of smoke, which overspread the whole sky. Every moment the subject appears not only wider but deeper. When I reflect on the great number of diverse and often conflicting facts which may be assembled under every head—military, economic, political or moral—and consider the accumulations of specialised and technical knowledge necessary for their proper appreciation, I am convinced that to compass the whole is beyond the mind and memory of man. Of such a question it is difficult to take broad views, and dangerous to generalise. Still less is it possible, as many people appear to imagine, to settle it with a phrase or an epigram. A point is reached where all relation between detail and proportion is lost. It is a picture of such great size that to see it all, it is necessary to stand so far off that neither colours nor figures are distinguishable. By constantly changing the point of view, some true perspective is possible, and even then the conception must be twisted and distorted, by the imperfections of the mental mirror.
The inquirer watches the huge question unfold in a way similar to how the fisherman in the old story saw the genie he accidentally released rise from the bottle in clouds of smoke that filled the entire sky. Each moment, the topic seems not only broader but also deeper. When I think about the vast number of different and often conflicting facts that can be gathered under various categories—military, economic, political, or moral—and consider the specialized knowledge needed to understand them properly, I am convinced that grasping the whole is beyond any person's mind or memory. It's hard to take a wide perspective on such a question, and it's risky to generalize. It’s even less possible, as many seem to think, to resolve it with just a phrase or a clever saying. There comes a point where the connection between detail and proportion is lost. It's such a vast picture that to see it all, you need to stand so far back that you can't distinguish colors or figures. By constantly shifting your viewpoint, some true perspective can be achieved, but even then, the understanding has to be bent and twisted by the flaws of our mental reflection.
Sensible of the magnitude of the task, and conscious of my own weakness, I propose to examine in a spirit of cautious inquiry and of tolerance the present "Forward Policy," and thence to approach the main question, to the answer of which that policy is only a guess.
Aware of how big the task is and recognizing my own limitations, I plan to look at the current "Forward Policy" with careful consideration and an open mind, and from there, to tackle the main question, which that policy only attempts to address.
I must revert to a period when the British power, having conquered the plains of India and subdued its sovereigns, paused at the foot of the Himalayas and turned its tireless energy to internal progress and development. The "line of the mountains" formed a frontier as plain and intelligible as that which defines the limits of the sea. To the south lay the British Empire in India; to the north were warlike tribes, barbarous, unapproachable, irreclaimable; and far beyond these, lay the other great Power of Asia.
I need to go back to a time when British power had taken over the plains of India and brought its rulers under control. They then stopped at the base of the Himalayas and focused their endless energy on internal progress and development. The "line of the mountains" was as clear and understandable as the border that separates land from sea. To the south was the British Empire in India; to the north were fierce tribes that were uncivilized, unreachable, and impossible to change; and far beyond them was another major power in Asia.
It was long the wisdom of Anglo-Indian statesmen to preserve a situation which contained so many elements of finality, and so many guarantees of peace. When the northern savages, impelled by fanaticism or allured by plunder, descended from the mountains and invaded the plains, they were met by equal courage and superior discipline, and driven in disorder to their confines. But this was found to be an inadequate deterrent, and the purely defensive principle had to be modified in favor of that system of punitive expeditions which has been derided as the policy of "Butcher and Bolt."
It has long been the belief of Anglo-Indian leaders to maintain a situation that had so many elements of finality and guarantees of peace. When the northern tribes, driven by fanaticism or tempted by loot, descended from the mountains and invaded the plains, they were met with equal bravery and better discipline, and were pushed back in disarray to their own territory. However, this was found to be an ineffective deterrent, and the purely defensive approach had to be adjusted to favor a system of punitive expeditions that has been mocked as the "Butcher and Bolt" policy.
Gradually, as the circumstances altered, the methods of dealing with them changed. The punitive expeditions had awakened an intense hostility among the tribesmen. The intrigues of Russia had for some time been watched with alarm by the Indian Government. As long as the border could remain a "No-man's land"—as it were a "great gulf fixed"—all was well; but if any power was to be supreme, that power must neither be Russia nor Afghanistan. ["We shall consider it from the first incumbent upon the Government of India to prevent, at any cost, the establishment within this outlying country of the political preponderance of any other power."—Letter from Government of India to the Secretary of State, No.49, 28th February, 1879.] The predominance of Russian influence in these territories would give them the power to invade India at their discretion, with what chances of success need not be here discussed. The predominance of Afghan influence would make the Amir master of the situation, and enable him to blackmail the Indian Government indefinitely. A change of policy, a departure from the old frontier line, presented itself with increasing force to responsible men. To-day we see the evils that have resulted from that change. The dangers that inspired it have been modified.
Gradually, as the situation changed, the ways of dealing with it also evolved. The punitive missions had sparked a strong resentment among the tribesmen. The Indian Government had been closely watching Russia's activities with growing concern for some time. As long as the border remained a "No-man's land"—essentially a "great gulf fixed"—everything was fine; but if any power were to dominate, it must not be Russia or Afghanistan. ["We shall consider it from the first incumbent upon the Government of India to prevent, at any cost, the establishment within this outlying country of the political preponderance of any other power."—Letter from Government of India to the Secretary of State, No.49, 28th February, 1879.] If Russian influence dominated in these areas, it would give them the ability to invade India at will, and the chances of success need not be debated here. If Afghan influence prevailed, the Amir would control the situation and could hold the Indian Government hostage indefinitely. A change in policy, moving away from the traditional border approach, was increasingly recognized by responsible leaders. Today, we can see the problems that arose from that shift. The threats that prompted it have changed.
For some years the opinion in favour of an advance grew steadily among those in power in India. In 1876 a decisive step was taken. Roused by the efforts of the Amir to obtain the suzerainty of the Pathan tribes, Lord Lytton's Government stretched a hand through Cashmere towards Chitral, and the Mehtar of that State became the vassal, nominally of the Maharaja of Cashmere, but practically of the Imperial Government. The avowed object was to ultimately secure the effectual command of the passes of the Hindu Kush. [Despatch No.17, 11th June, 1877.] The British Ministry, the famous ministry of Lord Beaconsfield, approved the action and endorsed the policy. Again, in 1879, the Vice-regal Government, in an official despatch, declared their intention of acquiring, "through the ruler of Cashmere, the power of making such political and military arrangements as will effectually command the passes of the Hindu Kush." [Despatch No.49, 28th February, 1879.] "If," so runs the despatch, "we *extend and by degrees consolidate our influence* [The italics are mine] over this country, and if we resolve that no foreign interference can be permitted on this side of the mountains or within the drainage system of the Indus, we shall have laid down a natural line of frontier, which is distinct, intelligible and likely to be respected." [Despatch No.49, 28th February, 1879.]
For several years, support for an advance grew steadily among those in power in India. In 1876, a decisive step was taken. Motivated by the Amir's efforts to gain control over the Pathan tribes, Lord Lytton's Government reached out through Kashmir towards Chitral, making the Mehtar of that region a vassal, nominally under the Maharaja of Kashmir but effectively under the Imperial Government. The stated goal was to ultimately ensure effective control over the passes of the Hindu Kush. [Despatch No.17, 11th June, 1877.] The British Ministry, under the well-known leadership of Lord Beaconsfield, approved this action and endorsed the policy. Again, in 1879, the Vice-regal Government, in an official despatch, declared their intention to acquire, "through the ruler of Kashmir, the power of making such political and military arrangements as will effectively command the passes of the Hindu Kush." [Despatch No.49, 28th February, 1879.] "If," the despatch states, "we *extend and by degrees consolidate our influence* [The italics are mine] over this country, and if we determine that no foreign interference can be allowed on this side of the mountains or within the Indus's drainage system, we will have established a natural line of frontier that is clear, understandable, and likely to be respected." [Despatch No.49, 28th February, 1879.]
No declaration of policy or intention could have been more explicit. The words to "extend and consolidate our influence" can, when applied to barbarous peoples, have no other meaning than ultimate annexation. Thus the scheme of an advance from the plains of India into the mountain region, which had long been maturing in men's minds and which was shaped and outlined by many small emergencies and expedients, was clearly proclaimed. The forward movement had begun. A fresh and powerful impulse was imparted after the termination of Lord Ripon's viceroyalty. The open aggression which characterised the Russian frontier policy of '84 and '85 had been met by a supine apathy and indifference to the interests of the State, which deserved, and which, had the issues been less important, might have received actual punishment. It was natural that his immediate successors should strive to dissociate themselves from the follies and the blunders of those years. The spirit of reaction led to the final abandonment of the venerable policy of non-intervention. Instead of the "line of the mountains," it was now maintained that the passes through them must be held. This is the so-called "Forward Policy." It is a policy which aims at obtaining the frontier—Gilgit, Chitral, Jelalabad, Kandahar.
No statement of policy or intention could have been clearer. The phrase "extend and consolidate our influence" when used regarding uncivilized peoples, can only mean eventual annexation. Therefore, the plan to advance from the plains of India into the mountainous region, which had long been developing in people's minds and was shaped by various small situations and strategies, was clearly announced. The movement forward had started. A new and strong motivation was given after Lord Ripon's time as viceroy ended. The open aggression that marked the Russian frontier policy in '84 and '85 was met with a weak apathy and indifference to the state's interests, which deserved, and might have received actual punishment if the stakes had been lower. It was natural for his immediate successors to try to distance themselves from the mistakes and errors of those years. This reactionary spirit led to the complete abandonment of the long-standing policy of non-intervention. Instead of focusing on the "line of the mountains," it was now argued that the passes through them must be secured. This is known as the "Forward Policy." It's a strategy that aims to control the frontier—Gilgit, Chitral, Jelalabad, Kandahar.
In pursuance of that policy we have been led to build many frontier forts, to construct roads, to annex territories, and to enter upon more intimate relations with the border tribes. The most marked incident in that policy has been the retention of Chitral. This act was regarded by the tribesmen as a menace to their independence, and by the priesthood as the prelude to a general annexation. Nor were they wrong, for such is the avowed aim of the "Forward Policy." The result of the retention of Chitral has been, as I have already described, that the priesthood, knowing that their authority would be weakened by civilisation, have used their religious influence on the people to foment a general rising.
In line with that policy, we have built many frontier forts, constructed roads, annexed territories, and established closer relations with the border tribes. The most significant event in that policy has been holding onto Chitral. The tribesmen saw this as a threat to their independence, while the religious leaders viewed it as the start of a widespread annexation. They weren't wrong, as that is the stated goal of the "Forward Policy." As I have already described, the consequence of keeping Chitral has been that the religious leaders, aware that their authority would be undermined by modernization, have used their influence to incite a general uprising among the people.
It is useless to discuss the Chitral question independently. If the "Forward Policy" be justified, then the annexation of Chitral, its logical outcome, is also justified. The bye and the main plots stand or fall together.
It’s pointless to talk about the Chitral issue on its own. If the "Forward Policy" makes sense, then the annexation of Chitral—its natural result—also makes sense. The side issues and the main topic rise or fall together.
So far then we have advanced and have been resisted. The "Forward Policy" has brought an increase of territory, a nearer approach to what is presumably a better frontier line and—war. All this was to have been expected. It may be said of the present system that it precludes the possibility of peace. Isolated posts have been formed in the midst of races notoriously passionate, reckless and warlike. They are challenges. When they are assailed by the tribesmen, relieving and punitive expeditions become necessary. All this is the outcome of a recognised policy, and was doubtless foreseen by those who initiated it. What may be called strange is that the forts should be badly constructed—cramped, as the Malakand positions; commanded, like Chakdara; without flank defences, as at Saraghari; without proper garrisons, as in the Khyber. This is a side issue and accidental. The rest of the situation has been deliberately created.
So far, we've made progress but faced resistance. The "Forward Policy" has led to more territory, a closer approach to what seems like a better border, and—war. All of this was probably to be expected. It's fair to say that the current system makes peace impossible. Isolated outposts have been established in areas with people known for being passionate, reckless, and warlike. These outposts are provocations. When they come under attack from local tribes, rescue and retaliation missions become necessary. All of this is a result of a recognized policy and was likely anticipated by those who put it in place. What’s odd is that the forts are poorly constructed—crowded, like the positions at Malakand; easily targeted, like Chakdara; lacking side defenses, as at Saraghari; and without adequate garrisons, as seen in the Khyber. This is a minor detail and accidental. The rest of the situation has been intentionally created.
The possibility of a great combination among the border tribes was indeed not contemplated. Separated by distance, and divided by faction, it was anticipated they could be dealt with in detail. On this point we have been undeceived.
The idea of a strong alliance among the border tribes was definitely not considered. They were separated by distance and divided by different groups, so it was expected that they could be handled one by one. We have been proven wrong on this matter.
That period of war and disturbance which was the inevitable first consequence of the "Forward Policy" must in any case have been disturbed and expensive. Regarded from an economic standpoint, the trade of the frontier valleys will never pay a shilling in the pound on the military expenditure necessary to preserve order. Morally, it is unfortunate for the tribesmen that our spheres of influence clash with their spheres of existence. Even on the military question, a purely technical question, as to whether an advanced frontier line is desirable or not, opinion is divided. Lord Roberts says one thing; Mr. Morley another.
That time of war and upheaval, which was the unavoidable first result of the "Forward Policy," was bound to be troubling and costly. From an economic perspective, trade in the frontier valleys will never cover even a penny of the military expenses needed to maintain order. Morally, it's unfortunate for the tribes that our areas of influence overlap with their ways of life. Even regarding the military aspect—whether having a more advanced frontier line is a good idea—opinions differ. Lord Roberts thinks one way, while Mr. Morley thinks another.
There is no lack of arguments against the "Forward Policy." There are many who opposed its initiation. There are many who oppose it now; who think that nothing should have lured the Government of India beyond their natural frontier line, and who maintain that it would have been both practical and philosophic had they said: "Over all the plains of India will we cast our rule. There we will place our governors and magistrates; our words shall be respected and our laws obeyed. But that region, where the land rises like the waves of a sea, shall serve us as a channel of stormy waters to divide us from our foes and rivals."
There are plenty of arguments against the "Forward Policy." Many people opposed it when it started, and many still do. They believe nothing should have pushed the Government of India beyond their natural borders and that it would have been both practical and wise to say: "We will extend our rule over all the plains of India. There we will appoint our governors and magistrates; our words will be respected, and our laws will be followed. But that area, where the land rises like ocean waves, will act as a barrier of turbulent waters to keep us separated from our enemies and rivals."
But it is futile to engage in the controversies of the past. There are sufficient in the present, and it is with the present we are concerned.
But it's pointless to get involved in the controversies of the past. There are plenty in the present, and it's the present that matters to us.
We have crossed the Rubicon. In the opinion of all those who know most about the case, the forward movement is now beyond recall. Indeed, when the intense hostility of the Border tribes, the uncertain attitude of the Amir, the possibilities of further Russian aggression and the state of feeling in India are considered, it is difficult to dispute this judgment. Successive Indian Administrations have urged, successive English Cabinets have admitted, the necessity of finding a definite and a defensible frontier. The old line has been left, and between that line and an advanced line continuous with Afghan territory, and south of which all shall be reduced to law and order, there does not appear to be any prospect of a peaceful and permanent settlement.
We’ve crossed the Rubicon. According to everyone who understands the situation best, our progress is now irreversible. In fact, when you consider the strong hostility from the Border tribes, the uncertain position of the Amir, the potential for more Russian aggression, and the mood in India, it’s hard to argue against this conclusion. Previous Indian governments have urged it, and successive British Cabinets have acknowledged the need for a clear and defensible border. The old border is now behind us, and between that border and the new line that connects with Afghan territory, where everything must be brought under law and order, there seems to be no chance of achieving a peaceful and lasting solution.
The responsibility of placing us in this position rests with those who first forsook the old frontier policy of holding the "line of the mountains." The historian of the future, with impartial pen and a more complete knowledge, must pronounce on the wisdom of their act. In the meantime it should be remembered of these great men, that they left their public offices amid the applause and admiration of their contemporaries, and, "in the full tide of successful experiment." Nor can so much be said of all those who have assailed them. Those who decided, have accepted the responsibility, and have defended their action. But I am inclined to think that the rulers of India, ten years ago or a hundred years ago, were as much the sport of circumstances as their successors are to-day.
The responsibility for putting us in this situation lies with those who initially abandoned the old frontier policy of maintaining the "line of the mountains." Future historians, with unbiased perspectives and a more complete understanding, will need to assess the wisdom of their decision. In the meantime, we should remember that these great leaders left their positions amid the praise and admiration of their peers, and during a time of great success. Not everyone who criticized them can claim the same. Those who made the decisions have taken on the responsibility and stood by their choices. But I tend to believe that the leaders of India, whether ten years ago or a hundred years ago, were just as much at the mercy of circumstances as their successors are today.
Let us return to the present and our own affairs. We have embarked on stormy and perilous waters. The strong current of events forbids return. The sooner the farther shore is reached, the sooner will the dangers and discomforts of the voyage be over. All are anxious to make the land. The suggestions as to the course are numerous. There are some, bad and nervous sailors perhaps, who insist upon returning, although they are told it is impossible, and who would sink the ship sooner than go on, were they not outnumbered by their shipmates. While they are delaying, the current bears us towards more disturbed waters and more rocky landing places.
Let's return to the present and our own situation. We've set sail into stormy and dangerous waters. The strong current of events makes it impossible to go back. The quicker we reach the other side, the sooner the dangers and discomforts of this journey will be over. Everyone is eager to make it to shore. There are many suggestions about how to navigate. Some, likely nervous and inexperienced sailors, insist on turning back, even though they're told it can't be done, and they would rather sink the ship than continue, if not for their larger group of crewmates. While they hesitate, the current is pulling us toward even more troubled waters and rougher shores.
There are others who call out for "Full steam ahead," and would accomplish the passage at once, whatever the risks. But alas! The ship is run out of coal and can only spread its sails to the varying breezes, take advantage of favorable tides, and must needs lie to when the waves are high.
There are others who shout "Full steam ahead," wanting to push through immediately, no matter the risks. But unfortunately, the ship has run out of coal and can only unfurl its sails to catch the varying winds, make use of favorable tides, and must simply hold still when the waves are high.
But the sensible passenger may, though he knows the difficulties of the voyage and the dangers of the sea, fairly ask the man at the wheel to keep a true and constant course. He may with reason and justice insist that, whatever the delays which the storms or accidents may cause, the head of the vessel shall be consistently pointed towards the distant port, and that come what will she shall not be allowed to drift aimlessly hither and thither on the chance of fetching up somewhere some day.
But a reasonable passenger might, even knowing the challenges of the journey and the risks of the ocean, justifiably ask the person steering the ship to maintain a steady and true course. They can rightly demand that, no matter the delays caused by storms or accidents, the ship's direction should always be aimed at the distant port, and that no matter what happens, it shouldn’t be allowed to wander aimlessly without a clear destination.
The "Full steam ahead" method would be undoubtedly the most desirable. This is the military view. Mobilise, it is urged, a nice field force, and operate at leisure in the frontier valleys, until they are as safe and civilised as Hyde Park. Nor need this course necessarily involve the extermination of the inhabitants. Military rule is the rule best suited to the character and comprehension of the tribesmen. They will soon recognise the futility of resistance, and will gradually welcome the increase of wealth and comfort that will follow a stable government. Besides this, we shall obtain a definite frontier almost immediately. Only one real objection has been advanced against this plan. But it is a crushing one, and it constitutes the most serious argument against the whole "Forward Policy." It is this: we have neither the troops nor the money to carry it out.
The "Full steam ahead" approach would definitely be the most desirable. This reflects the military perspective. It’s suggested to deploy a solid field force and work steadily in the border areas until they are as secure and civilized as Hyde Park. This strategy doesn’t necessarily mean we have to eliminate the local people. Military rule is actually the best fit for the character and understanding of the tribes. They will quickly see that fighting back is pointless and will eventually embrace the wealth and comfort that come with a stable government. Additionally, we would quickly establish a clear border. However, there is one major objection to this plan. It’s a significant one and serves as the strongest argument against the entire "Forward Policy." The issue is that we simply don’t have the troops or the funds to make it happen.
The inevitable alternative is the present system, a system which the war has interrupted, but to which we must return at its close; a system of gradual advance, of political intrigue among the tribes, of subsidies and small expeditions.
The only alternative we have is the current system, which the war has disturbed, but we need to go back to it once the war ends; a system of slow progress, of political maneuvering among the tribes, of financial support and minor military missions.
Though this policy is slow, painful and somewhat undignified, there is no reason that it should not be sure and strong. But it must be consistently pursued. Dynamite in the hands of a child is not more dangerous than a strong policy weakly carried out. The reproach which may be justly laid upon the rulers of India, whether at home or abroad, is that while they recognise the facts, they shrink from the legitimate conclusions.
Though this policy is slow, painful, and somewhat humiliating, there's no reason it can't be solid and effective. But it needs to be pursued consistently. Dynamite in the hands of a child is no more dangerous than a strong policy that isn't executed properly. The criticism that can justifiably be directed at the rulers of India, whether at home or abroad, is that while they acknowledge the facts, they hesitate to act on the rightful conclusions.
They know they cannot turn back. They fully intend to go on. Yet they fear to admit the situation, to frankly lay their case before the country, and trust to the good sense and courage of an ancient democracy. The result is, that they tie their hands by ridiculous and unnecessary proclamations, such as that which preceded the Chitral expedition of 1895. The political officers who watch the frontier tribes are expected to obtain authority by force of personal character, yet strictly according to regulations, and to combine individuality with uniformity. And sometimes this timidity leads to such dismal acts of folly as the desertion of the Khyber forts.
They know they can't go back. They fully plan to move forward. Yet, they are afraid to admit the reality of the situation, to openly present their case to the country, and to rely on the good sense and courage of a long-established democracy. As a result, they restrict themselves with pointless and unnecessary declarations, like the one made before the Chitral expedition of 1895. The political officers monitoring the frontier tribes are expected to gain authority through their personal character, while still adhering strictly to the rules, and to blend individuality with uniformity. Sometimes, this hesitation leads to such foolish actions as abandoning the Khyber forts.
But in spite of all obstacles and errors there is a steady advance, which may be accelerated, and made easier, by many small reforms. These questions of detail approach so near the province of the specialist, that I shall not attempt to enumerate or discuss them. It is suggested among other things that wider powers should be given to the political officers, in their ordinary duties of peace. Others advocate occasional demonstrations of troops, to impress the tribesmen with the fact that those they see are not the full strength of the Sirkar. Bolder minds have hinted at transplanting young Pathans, and educating them in India after the custom of the Romans. But this last appears to be suitable to a classic rather than a Christian age.
But despite all the obstacles and mistakes, there is a steady progress that can be sped up and made easier through various small reforms. These detailed issues are so closely related to the experts' field that I won’t try to list or discuss them. It’s suggested, among other things, that political officers should be given broader powers in their regular peacekeeping duties. Some people argue for occasional military displays to remind the tribesmen that the soldiers they see are not the full strength of the government. More daring thinkers have proposed relocating young Pathans and educating them in India, modeled after Roman practices. However, this last idea seems more fitting for a classic era than for a modern Christian one.
From a general survey of the people and the country, it would seem that silver makes a better weapon than steel. A system of subsidies must tend to improve our relations with the tribes, enlist their interests on the side of law and order, and by increasing their wealth, lessen their barbarism. In the matter of the supply of arms the Government would find it cheaper to enter the market as a purchaser, and have agents to outbid the tribesmen, rather than to employ soldiers. As water finds its own level, so the laws of economics will infallibly bring commodities to the highest bidder. Doubtless there are many other lessons which the present war will have taught. These may lighten a task which, though long and heavy, is not beyond the powers or pluck of the British people.
From a general look at the people and the country, it seems that silver is a more effective weapon than steel. A system of subsidies should help improve our relationships with the tribes, align their interests with law and order, and by increasing their wealth, reduce their barbarism. When it comes to supplying arms, the Government would find it cheaper to enter the market as a buyer and have agents outbid the tribesmen, rather than relying on soldiers. Just like water finds its own level, the laws of economics will inevitably bring goods to the highest bidder. There are surely many other lessons that the current war will have taught. These may help ease a task that, while long and difficult, is not beyond the abilities or courage of the British people.
We are at present in a transition stage, nor is the manner nor occasion of the end in sight. Still this is no time to despair. I have often noticed in these Afghan valleys, that they seem to be entirely surrounded by the hills, and to have no exit. But as the column has advanced, a gap gradually becomes visible and a pass appears. Sometimes it is steep and difficult, sometimes it is held by the enemy and must be forced, but I have never seen a valley that had not a way out. That way we shall ultimately find, if we march with the firm but prudent step of men who know the dangers; but, conscious of their skill and discipline, do not doubt their ability to deal with them as they shall arise. In such a spirit I would leave the subject, with one farewell glance.
We are currently in a transitional phase, and we can’t see how or when it will end. However, this isn’t a time to lose hope. I’ve often noticed in these Afghan valleys that they seem completely surrounded by hills, without any way out. But as we move forward, a gap gradually becomes visible, and a pass reveals itself. Sometimes it’s steep and tough to navigate, and at times, it’s occupied by the enemy and needs to be taken, but I’ve never seen a valley without an exit. We will eventually find our way out if we proceed with the steady yet careful approach of people who recognize the risks but trust in their skills and training to handle whatever challenges come up. With that mindset, I’ll leave this topic with one last look.
Looking on the story of the great frontier war; at all that has been told, and all that others may tell, there must be many who to-day will only deplore the losses of brave soldiers and hard-earned money. But those who from some future age shall, by steady light of history, dispassionately review the whole situation, its causes, results and occasion, may find other reflections, as serious perhaps, but less mournful. The year 1897, in the annals of the British people, was marked by a declaration to the whole world of their faith in the higher destinies of their race. If a strong man, when the wine sparkles at the feast and the lights are bright, boasts of his prowess, it is well he should have an opportunity of showing in the cold and grey of the morning that he is no idle braggart. And unborn arbiters, with a wider knowledge, and more developed brains, may trace in recent events the influence of that mysterious Power which, directing the progress of our species, and regulating the rise and fall of Empires, has afforded that opportunity to a people, of whom at least it may be said, that they have added to the happiness, the learning and the liberties of mankind.
Looking back at the story of the great frontier war, considering everything that has been said and all that others may say, many today will only lament the losses of brave soldiers and hard-earned money. However, those in the future who examine the whole situation—its causes, outcomes, and events—with a clear view of history might have different thoughts, maybe just as serious but less sorrowful. The year 1897 was significant in British history, marked by a declaration to the entire world of their belief in the greater destiny of their people. If a strong man boasts of his strength when the wine sparkles at the feast and the lights shine brightly, it is only fair that he has a chance to prove in the cold light of day that he isn’t just an empty braggart. Future judges, with broader knowledge and more developed minds, may see in recent events the influence of that mysterious Power which guides the progress of humanity and regulates the rise and fall of Empires, providing such an opportunity to a people who can at least be said to have contributed to the happiness, knowledge, and freedoms of mankind.
APPENDIX. EXTRACTS FROM OFFICIAL DESPATCHES.
APPENDIX. EXCERPTS FROM OFFICIAL DISPATCHES.
THE ATTACK ON THE MALAKAND. 26th July — 1st August, 1897. FROM THE DESPATCH OF BRIGADIER-GENERAL W.H. MEIKLEJOHN, C.B., C.M.G. FORWARDED TO THE ADJUTANT-GENERAL IN INDIA BY SIR BINDON BLOOD.
THE ATTACK ON THE MALAKAND. July 26th - August 1st, 1897. FROM THE REPORT OF BRIGADIER-GENERAL W.H. MEIKLEJOHN, C.B., C.M.G. SENT TO THE ADJUTANT-GENERAL IN INDIA BY SIR BINDON BLOOD.
43. All have done well, but I should like to bring before His Excellency for favorable consideration the following names of officers and men:—
43. Everyone has performed admirably, but I would like to present the following names of officers and personnel to His Excellency for favorable consideration:—
24th Punjaub Infantry.
24th Punjab Infantry.
Lieut.-Colonel J. Lamb, who, on the first alarm being sounded on the night of the 26th July, had taken prompt action in reinforcing the outpost line held by his regiment, and later was of great assistance in directing the defence of the central enclosure, till he was severely wounded.
Lieut.-Colonel J. Lamb, who, when the first alarm rang out on the night of July 26th, quickly took action to strengthen the outpost line held by his regiment, and later played a crucial role in coordinating the defense of the central enclosure, until he was seriously injured.
Captain H.F. Holland showed great courage in assisting to drive a number of the enemy out of the central enclosure, and was severely wounded in doing so.
Captain H.F. Holland displayed immense bravery in helping to force several enemies out of the central enclosure and was seriously injured while doing so.
I would especially wish to mention Lieutenant S.H. Climo, who commanded the 24th Punjaub Infantry after Lieut.-Colonel Lamb and Captain Holland had been wounded. This officer has shown soldierly qualities and ability of the highest order. He has commanded the regiment with dash and enterprise, and shown a spirit and example which has been followed by all ranks. I trust His Excellency will be pleased to favourably notice Lieutenant Climo, who has proved himself an officer who will do well in any position, and is well worthy of promotion.
I want to particularly highlight Lieutenant S.H. Climo, who led the 24th Punjaub Infantry after Lieut.-Colonel Lamb and Captain Holland were injured. This officer has demonstrated exceptional soldierly qualities and skills. He has commanded the regiment with enthusiasm and initiative, and has displayed a spirit and example that everyone has followed. I hope His Excellency will kindly recognize Lieutenant Climo, who has shown that he can excel in any role and truly deserves a promotion.
Lieutenant A.K. Rawlins has behaved well all through. I would recommend him to His Excellency for the plucky way in which he went to the fort on the 26th July to bring reinforcements, and again for the dash he showed in leading his men on the 27th and 28th, of which Lieutenant Climo speaks most highly.
Lieutenant A.K. Rawlins has performed admirably throughout. I would recommend him to His Excellency for the brave way he went to the fort on July 26th to bring back reinforcements, and again for the courage he displayed in leading his men on the 27th and 28th, which Lieutenant Climo commends highly.
Lieutenant E.W. Costello, 22nd Punjaub Infantry, temporarily attached to the 24th Punjaub Infantry, has behaved exceedingly well, and is the subject of a separate recommendation.
Lieutenant E.W. Costello, 22nd Punjaub Infantry, temporarily attached to the 24th Punjaub Infantry, has performed exceptionally well and is the subject of a separate recommendation.
31st Punjaub Infantry.
31st Punjab Infantry.
Major M.I. Gibbs, who commanded the regiment in the absence of Major O'Bryen, with skill and in every way to my satisfaction.
Major M.I. Gibbs, who led the regiment while Major O'Bryen was away, did so with skill and fully met my expectations.
Lieutenant H.B. Ford, Acting-Adjutant, 31st Punjaub Infantry, rendered valuable assistance in helping to bring in a wounded Sepoy during the withdrawal from north camp. He also behaved with courage in resisting an attack of the enemy on the night of the 28th, when he was severely wounded.
Lieutenant H.B. Ford, Acting Adjutant of the 31st Punjab Infantry, provided crucial help in bringing in an injured Sepoy during the retreat from the north camp. He also showed bravery in fighting off an enemy attack on the night of the 28th, when he sustained serious injuries.
Surgeon-Lieutenant J.H. Hugo, attached to 31st Punjaub Infantry, rendered valuable service on the night of the 28th in saving Lieutenant H.B. Ford from bleeding to death. Lieutenant Ford was wounded and a branch of an artery was cut. There were no means of securing the artery, and Surgeon-Lieutenant Hugo for two hours stopped the bleeding by compressing the artery with his fingers. Had he not had the strength to do so, Lieutenant Ford must have died. Early in the morning, thinking that the enemy had effected an entrance into camp, Surgeon-Lieutenant Hugo picked up Lieutenant Ford with one arm, and, still holding the artery with the fingers of the other hand, carried him to a place of safety.
Surgeon-Lieutenant J.H. Hugo, serving with the 31st Punjaub Infantry, provided crucial assistance on the night of the 28th by preventing Lieutenant H.B. Ford from bleeding to death. Lieutenant Ford had been injured, and a branch of an artery was severed. There were no ways to secure the artery, so for two hours, Surgeon-Lieutenant Hugo stopped the bleeding by applying pressure with his fingers. If he hadn't had the strength to do this, Lieutenant Ford would have certainly died. Early in the morning, believing the enemy had breached the camp, Surgeon-Lieutenant Hugo scooped up Lieutenant Ford with one arm while still applying pressure to the artery with his other hand, carrying him to safety.
45th (Rattray's) Sikhs.
45th Sikhs (Rattray's).
Colonel H.A. Sawyer was away on leave when hostilities broke out, but he returned on the 29th and took over command of the regiment from Lieut.-Colonel McRae, and from that time rendered me every assistance.
Colonel H.A. Sawyer was on leave when the fighting started, but he came back on the 29th and took command of the regiment from Lieut.-Colonel McRae, and from then on, he provided me with all the help I needed.
I would specially bring to the notice of His Excellency the Commander-in-chief the name of Lieut.-Colonel H.N. McRae, who commanded the regiment on the 26th, 27th and 28th. His prompt action in seizing the gorge at the top of the Buddhist road on the night of the 26th, and the gallant way in which he held it, undoubtedly saved the camp from being rushed on that side. For this, and for the able way in which he commanded the regiment during the first three days of the fighting, I would commend him to His Excellency's favorable consideration.
I would like to specifically highlight the name of Lieutenant Colonel H.N. McRae to His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief. He led the regiment on the 26th, 27th, and 28th. His quick decision to take control of the gorge at the top of the Buddhist road on the night of the 26th, along with the brave manner in which he defended it, definitely prevented the camp from being overwhelmed from that side. For this, and for the skilled way he led the regiment during the first three days of fighting, I recommend him for His Excellency's favorable consideration.
Also Lieutenant R.M. Barff, Officiating-Adjutant of the regiment, who, Lieut.-Colonel McRae reports, behaved with great courage and rendered him valuable assistance.
Also, Lieutenant R.M. Barff, the Acting Adjutant of the regiment, who Lieutenant Colonel McRae reports behaved with great courage and provided him with valuable support.
The Guides.
The Guides.
I also wish to bring the name of Lieut.-Colonel R.B. Adams of the Guides to His Excellency's notice. The prompt way in which the corps mobilised, and their grand march, reflect great credit on him and the corps. Since arrival at the Malakand on the 27th July and till the morning of the 1st August, Lieut.-Colonel Adams was in command of the lower camp, i.e., that occupied by central and left position, and in the execution of this command, and the arrangements he made for improving the defenses, he gave me every satisfaction. I have also to express my appreciation of the way in which he conducted the cavalry reconnaissance on the 1st August, on which occasion his horse was shot under him.
I also want to bring to His Excellency's attention the name of Lieutenant Colonel R.B. Adams of the Guides. The quick way the corps mobilized and their impressive march reflect great credit on him and the unit. Since arriving at Malakand on July 27th and until the morning of August 1st, Lieutenant Colonel Adams was in charge of the lower camp, which was occupied by the central and left positions. In executing this command and improving the defenses, he met my expectations completely. I also want to express my appreciation for how he handled the cavalry reconnaissance on August 1st, during which his horse was shot out from under him.
Great credit is due to Lieutenant P.C. Eliott-Lockhart, who was in command of the Guides Infantry, for bringing up the regiment from Mardan to Malakand in such good condition after their trying march.
Great credit goes to Lieutenant P.C. Eliott-Lockhart, who led the Guides Infantry, for getting the regiment from Mardan to Malakand in such good shape after their tough march.
Captain G.M. Baldwin, D.S.O., behaved with great courage and coolness during the reconnaissance of the 1st August, and though severely wounded by a sword cut on the head, he remained on the ground and continued to lead his men.
Captain G.M. Baldwin, D.S.O., showed immense bravery and composure during the reconnaissance on August 1st. Even after being seriously injured by a sword cut to the head, he stayed on the ground and kept leading his men.
Lieutenant H.L.S. Maclean also behaved with courage, and displayed an excellent example on the night of the 28th July, when he was severely wounded.
Lieutenant H.L.S. Maclean also showed bravery and set a great example on the night of July 28th, when he was seriously injured.
11th Bengal Lancers.
11th Bengal Lancers.
Major S. Beatson commanded the squadron, 11th Bengal Lancers, which arrived at Malakand on the 29th, and led them with great skill and dash on the occasion of the reconnaissance on the 1st August.
Major S. Beatson was in charge of the 11th Bengal Lancers, which arrived at Malakand on the 29th. He led them with impressive skill and enthusiasm during the reconnaissance on August 1st.
No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery.
No. 8 Bengal Mountain Battery.
Lieutenant F.A. Wynter was the only officer with No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery from the 26th till the 30th July, and he commanded it during that time, when all the severest of the fighting was going on, with great ability, and has proved himself a good soldier. I should like especially to mention him for His Excellency's consideration. The battery did excellent work all through.
Lieutenant F.A. Wynter was the only officer with No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery from July 26th to July 30th, and he led it during that period when the toughest fighting was happening, demonstrating great skill and proving himself to be a capable soldier. I want to specifically highlight him for His Excellency's consideration. The battery performed excellently throughout.
No.5 Company Queen's Own Madras Sappers and Miners.
No.5 Company Queen's Own Madras Sappers and Miners.
Lieutenant A.R. Winsloe, R.E., commanded the company from the 27th July till the 1st August to my entire satisfaction. His services in strengthening the defences were invaluable.
Lieutenant A.R. Winsloe, R.E., led the company from July 27th to August 1st to my complete satisfaction. His contributions to strengthening the defenses were essential.
Lieutenant F.W. Watling, R.E., was in command of the company in the absence of Captain Johnson on the 26th, and commanded it well until he was wounded in gallantly trying to resist a charge of the enemy. After Lieutenant Watling was wounded the command of the company for the remainder of the night of the 26th, and till Lieutenant Winsloe returned on the 27th, devolved on Lieutenant E.N. Manley, R.E. He performed his duties with great credit, and afterwards was of great assistance, by his zeal and his exertions, to Lieutenant Winsloe.
Lieutenant F.W. Watling, R.E., was in charge of the company when Captain Johnson was absent on the 26th, and he led it effectively until he was injured while bravely trying to fend off an enemy charge. Once Lieutenant Watling was wounded, Lieutenant E.N. Manley, R.E. took over command for the rest of the night on the 26th until Lieutenant Winsloe returned on the 27th. He performed his duties admirably and later provided significant support to Lieutenant Winsloe with his enthusiasm and efforts.
Medical Staff.
Healthcare Team.
Brigade-Surgeon-Lieut.-Colonel F.A. Smyth was most zealous, and performed his duties to my satisfaction. He volunteered to perform the duties of Provost Marshal, and did so for a short time during the illness of Lieutenant H.E. Cotterill.
Brigade-Surgeon-Lieut.-Colonel F.A. Smyth was very dedicated and fulfilled his responsibilities to my satisfaction. He stepped up to take on the role of Provost Marshal and did so for a brief period while Lieutenant H.E. Cotterill was ill.
The arrangements made by Surgeon-Major S. Hassand, Senior Medical Officer, 38th Native Field Hospital, and the indefatigable attention and care with which he devoted himself to the wounded, deserve great praise. The list of casualties is large, and Surgeon-Major Hassand has been untiring in his exertions for their relief. I hope His Excellency will think fit to consider his services favourably.
The preparations made by Surgeon-Major S. Hassand, Senior Medical Officer, 38th Native Field Hospital, and the relentless dedication and care he showed to the wounded deserve high praise. The number of casualties is substantial, and Surgeon-Major Hassand has worked tirelessly for their relief. I hope His Excellency will choose to recognize his services positively.
Surgeon-Captain T.A.O. Langston, 38th Native Field Hospital, rendered valuable assistance in attending to the wounded under a heavy fire on the night of the 26th and each following night, and behaved with courage and devotion in carrying out his duties under very exceptional circumstances. Surgeon-Lieutenant W. Carr has worked night and day in the hospitals, in trying to alleviate the sufferings of the wounded, and has most ably and efficiently aided Surgeon-Major Hassand.
Surgeon-Captain T.A.O. Langston, 38th Native Field Hospital, provided crucial help in treating the wounded while under heavy fire on the night of the 26th and every night after that, showing bravery and dedication in carrying out his responsibilities in extremely challenging conditions. Surgeon-Lieutenant W. Carr has been working tirelessly in the hospitals, trying to ease the pain of the injured, and has effectively supported Surgeon-Major Hassand.
Brigade Staff.
Brigade Team.
Major L. Herbert, my Deputy Assistant Adjutant and Quartermaster-General, was of the greatest assistance to me by the zeal and energy with which he performed his duties from the moment the news of the approach of the enemy was received till he was severely wounded while standing next to me in the enclosure of the Sappers and Miners' camp on the night of the 26th. Since being wounded, he has carried on all his office duties on his bed. I would wish to commend his gallant conduct for the favorable consideration of the Commander-in-Chief.
Major L. Herbert, my Deputy Assistant Adjutant and Quartermaster-General, was incredibly helpful to me through his enthusiasm and dedication in performing his duties from the moment we learned about the enemy's approach until he was seriously injured while standing next to me in the Sappers and Miners' camp on the night of the 26th. Since being wounded, he has continued to handle all his office responsibilities from his bed. I would like to recognize his brave actions for the Commander-in-Chief's favorable consideration.
Although Major H.A. Deane is in no way under my authority, I feel I am under a great obligation to him for the valuable assistance he rendered me with his advice and for volunteering to put himself at my disposal with the object of carrying on the active duties of Deputy Assistant Adjutant-General, when Major Herbert was wounded. He was indefatigable in assisting me in every way he could, and I am anxious to put on record my grateful appreciation of the services he rendered me.
Although Major H.A. Deane isn't my subordinate, I feel a strong sense of gratitude towards him for the invaluable help he provided with his advice and for offering to assist me by taking on the active responsibilities of Deputy Assistant Adjutant-General when Major Herbert was injured. He worked tirelessly to support me in every possible way, and I want to make sure I express my sincere appreciation for the services he rendered.
44. The above list of names may appear to be somewhat long; but I would point out that the fighting was almost constant for a week, and was of such a close nature as to demand incessant exertion from every officer in the force, and to elicit constant acts of courage and gallant example which cannot be overlooked.
44. The list of names above might seem a bit long; however, I should note that the fighting was nearly continuous for a week and was so intense that it required constant effort from every officer in the unit, leading to countless acts of bravery and exemplary conduct that shouldn't be ignored.
45. I would not like to close this despatch without paying a tribute to the memory of a fine soldier, and charming companion whose death the whole force deplores.
45. I want to end this message by honoring the memory of a great soldier and wonderful companion whose death is mourned by the entire force.
Major W.W. Taylor had behaved with the greatest gallantry and dash in meeting the enemy's first charge with Lieut.-Colonel McRae, and, had he lived, he would undoubtedly distinguished himself in his career. His loss in a heavy one to his regiment, and to the Service, and there is no one in the brigade who does not mourn him as a friend.
Major W.W. Taylor had shown incredible bravery and daring when he faced the enemy's first attack alongside Lieut.-Colonel McRae, and if he had survived, he would have certainly made a name for himself in his career. His loss is significant for his regiment and the Service, and everyone in the brigade mourns him as a friend.
I have also to deplore the death of Honorary-Lieutenant L. Manley, who as my Commissariat Officer had rendered me great assistance, and who died fighting manfully. His loss is a very serious one to the brigade.
I also regret the death of Honorary-Lieutenant L. Manley, who served as my Commissariat Officer and helped me significantly, and who died bravely in battle. His loss is a huge blow to the brigade.
46. I attach separately, for favorable consideration, a list of native officers, non-commissioned officers and men, who have done especially good service; some of whom I have therein recommended for the order of merit.
46. I’m attaching a separate list for your consideration of native officers, non-commissioned officers, and men who have provided exceptional service; some of them I have recommended for the order of merit.
I trust these recommendations will meet with the favorable consideration of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief.
I hope these recommendations will be positively received by His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief.
THE RELIEF OF CHAKDARA 2ND AUGUST, 1897 FROM THE DESPATCH OF MAJOR-GENERAL SIR BINDON BLOOD, K.C.B.
THE RELIEF OF CHAKDARA 2ND AUGUST, 1897 FROM THE DISPATCH OF MAJOR-GENERAL SIR BINDON BLOOD, K.C.B.
19. I have the honour to invite the special attention of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief in India to the good services of the following officers during the operations described above, namely:—
19. I have the honor to bring to the special attention of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief in India the excellent service of the following officers during the operations mentioned above, namely:—
Brigadier-General W.H. Meiklejohn, C.B., C.M.G., carried out his duties in command of the force which relieved Chakdara Fort with great gallantry and judgment.
Brigadier-General W.H. Meiklejohn, C.B., C.M.G., performed his duties in charge of the force that relieved Chakdara Fort with remarkable bravery and wisdom.
Colonel A.J.F. Reid, Officiating Colonel on the Staff, Malakand Brigade, afforded me valuable assistance by carrying out the rearrangement of the defensive posts at the Malakand on the 1st August, after the Relieving Force had been drawn from them, and in making the preparations for Colonel T.H. Goldney's attack on the 2nd.
Colonel A.J.F. Reid, the Acting Colonel on the Staff of the Malakand Brigade, provided me with great help by reorganizing the defensive positions at Malakand on August 1st, after the Relieving Force had withdrawn from them, and in preparing for Colonel T.H. Goldney's attack on the 2nd.
Colonel T.H. Goldney, 35th Sikhs, disposed and led the troops on the morning of the 2nd in the successful attack on the hill, since named after him, in a most judicious and satisfactory manner.
Colonel T.H. Goldney, 35th Sikhs, organized and directed the troops on the morning of the 2nd in a successful attack on the hill, which was later named after him, in a very strategic and effective way.
Major E.A.P. Hobday, R.A., was most energetic and indefatigable in assisting Colonel A.J.F. Reid and me in carrying out the multifarious work which had to be done at the Malakand, and in the Swat Valley on the 1st, 2nd and 3rd.
Major E.A.P. Hobday, R.A., was extremely energetic and tireless in helping Colonel A.J.F. Reid and me with the various tasks that needed to be accomplished at Malakand and in the Swat Valley on the 1st, 2nd, and 3rd.
Brigadier-General Meiklejohn reports favourably on the following officers who were under his command during the operations above detailed, viz:—
Brigadier-General Meiklejohn gives a positive report on the following officers who were under his command during the operations mentioned above, namely:—
Captain G.F.H. Dillon, 40th Pathans, who acted as Staff Officer to the Relieving Force, showed great readiness and resource, and his assistance was of the utmost value.
Captain G.F.H. Dillon, 40th Pathans, who served as Staff Officer to the Relieving Force, demonstrated impressive readiness and resourcefulness, and his help was incredibly valuable.
Lieutenants C.R. Gaunt, 4th Dragoon Guards, Orderly Officer, and E. Christian, Royal Scots Fusiliers, Signalling Officer, carried out their duties most satisfactorily.
Lieutenants C.R. Gaunt, 4th Dragoon Guards, Orderly Officer, and E. Christian, Royal Scots Fusiliers, Signalling Officer, performed their duties very well.
Lieut.-Colonel R.B. Adams, Queen's Own Corps of Guides, commanded the cavalry (four squadrons) with the Relieving Force in the most gallant and judicious manner.
Lieut.-Colonel R.B. Adams, Queen's Own Corps of Guides, led the cavalry (four squadrons) in the Relieving Force with great bravery and insight.
The following officers commanding units and detachments of the Reliving Force are stated by Brigidier-General Meiklejohn to have carried out their duties in a thoroughly capable and satisfactory manner, viz.:—
The following officers in charge of units and detachments of the Relieving Force are reported by Brigadier General Meiklejohn to have performed their duties in a completely competent and satisfactory way, namely:—
Colonel H.A. Sawyer, 45th Sikhs.
Colonel H.A. Sawyer, 45th Sikhs.
Major Stuart Beatson, 11th Bengal Lancers.
Major Stuart Beatson, 11th Bengal Lancers.
Captain A.H.C. Birch, R.A. (8th Bengal Mountain Battery).
Captain A.H.C. Birch, R.A. (8th Bengal Mountain Battery).
Lieutenant G. de H. Smith, 2nd Regiment, Central India Horse, attached to Queen's Own Corps of Guides (cavalry).
Lieutenant G. de H. Smith, 2nd Regiment, Central India Horse, assigned to the Queen's Own Corps of Guides (cavalry).
Lieutenant A.R. Winsloe, R.E. (No.5 Company Queen's Own Sapper's and Miners).
Lieutenant A.R. Winsloe, R.E. (No. 5 Company Queen's Own Sappers and Miners).
Lieutenant P.C. Eliott-Lockhart, Queen's Own Corps of Guides (infantry).
Lieutenant P.C. Eliott-Lockhart, Queen's Own Corps of Guides (infantry).
Surgeon-General H.F. Whitchurch, V.C., attended to the wounded under fire throughout the fighting.
Surgeon General H.F. Whitchurch, V.C., cared for the injured while under fire during the fighting.
The following officers under Colonel T.H. Goldney's command led their detachments under my own observation with gallantry and judgment, viz.:—
The following officers under Colonel T.H. Goldney's command led their detachments with bravery and good judgment, as I personally observed:—
Lieut.-Colonel L.J.E. Bradshaw, 35th Sikhs.
Lieutenant Colonel L.J.E. Bradshaw, 35th Sikhs.
Captain L.C.H. Stainforth, 38th Dogras.
Captain L.C.H. Stainforth, 38th Dogras.
Jemader Nawab, who commanded two guns of No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery in support of Colonel Goldney's attack, attracted my favorable notice by his smartness, quickness and thorough knowledge of his work.
Jemader Nawab, who commanded two guns of the No. 8 Bengal Mountain Battery in support of Colonel Goldney's attack, caught my attention with his efficiency, speed, and deep understanding of his responsibilities.
I would also wish to bring to His Excellency's notice the good work done by Major H. Burney, Gordon Highlanders, Assistant Adjutant-General; Major H. Burney, Gordon Highlanders, Assistant Adjutant-General; Major H. Wharry, D.S.O., Chief Commissariat Officer, and Captain A.B. Dunsterville, 1st Battalion East Surrey Regiment, my Aide-de-Camp; the only officers of the Divisional Staff of my force who had arrived at the Malakand on the 2nd August. These officers worked very hard and were of great use to me.
I also want to highlight the excellent work done by Major H. Burney, Gordon Highlanders, Assistant Adjutant-General; Major H. Burney, Gordon Highlanders, Assistant Adjutant-General; Major H. Wharry, D.S.O., Chief Commissariat Officer; and Captain A.B. Dunsterville, 1st Battalion East Surrey Regiment, my Aide-de-Camp. They were the only officers from my Divisional Staff who reached Malakand on August 2nd. These officers worked really hard and were extremely helpful to me.
20. Major H.A. Deane, C.S.I., Political Agent, Dir and Swat, was not in any way under my orders during the operations above described, but notwithstanding, I hope I may be permitted to express the obligations under which I lie to him for valuable information and general assistance which he gave me.
20. Major H.A. Deane, C.S.I., Political Agent for Dir and Swat, was not under my command during the previously mentioned operations, but I would like to acknowledge the significant help and valuable information he provided to me.
THE DEFENCE OF CHAKDARA. 26TH JULY—2ND AUGUST, 1897. FROM THE DESPATCH OF MAJOR-GENERAL SIR BINDON BLOOD, K.C.B.
THE DEFENSE OF CHAKDARA. JULY 26TH – AUGUST 2ND, 1897. FROM THE DISPATCH OF MAJOR-GENERAL SIR BINDON BLOOD, K.C.B.
15. During the fighting above described, the conduct of the whole of the garrison, whether fighting men, departmental details, or followers, is reported to have been most gallant. Not the least marked display of courage and constancy was that made by the small detachment in the signal tower, who were without water for the last eighteen hours of the siege. The signallers, under No.2729, Lance-Naik Vir Singh, 45th Sikhs, who set a brilliant example, behaved throughout in a most courageous manner; one of them, No.2829, Sepoy Prem Singh, climbing several times out of a window in the tower with a heliograph, and signaling outside to the Malakand under a hot fire from sungars in every direction.
15. During the fighting described above, the entire garrison, including soldiers, support staff, and followers, is reported to have shown incredible bravery. A notable example of courage and determination came from the small team in the signal tower, who went without water for the last eighteen hours of the siege. The signallers, led by No.2729, Lance-Naik Vir Singh from the 45th Sikhs, set a shining example and acted bravely throughout; one of them, No.2829, Sepoy Prem Singh, climbed out of a window in the tower multiple times with a heliograph, signaling outside to the Malakand while under heavy fire from positions all around.
16. I would beg to recommend all the British and native officers who took part in the defence I have described for the favorable consideration of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief as under, viz.:—
16. I would like to recommend all the British and local officers who participated in the defense I mentioned for the favorable consideration of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief as follows:—
Captain H. Wright, 11th Bengal Lancers, who, with his detachment of forty sabres of his regiment, made the gallant ride through the enemy from the Malakand to Chakdara Fort, on the morning of the 27th July, and commanded the garrison from that morning till its relief on the 2nd August.
Captain H. Wright, 11th Bengal Lancers, who, with his team of forty cavalry from his regiment, bravely rode through the enemy from Malakand to Chakdara Fort on the morning of July 27th, and led the garrison from that morning until it was relieved on August 2nd.
Captain D. Baker, 2nd Bombay Infantry, who rode to Chakdara Fort with Captain Wright, and made himself most useful. Lieutenant H.B. Rattray, 45th Sikhs, who commanded the garrison from the commencement of the attack on the 26th July till the arrival of Captain Wright the next day, and is reported by that officer to have been the life and soul of the defence. 2nd Lieutenant J.L. Wheatley, 45th Sikhs, had charge of the gun and Maxim detachments, and it was largely owing to his care and judgment that these weapons were so effective in the defence.
Captain D. Baker, 2nd Bombay Infantry, who rode to Chakdara Fort with Captain Wright, was extremely helpful. Lieutenant H.B. Rattray, 45th Sikhs, commanded the garrison from the start of the attack on July 26th until Captain Wright arrived the next day, and that officer reported him to be the driving force behind the defense. 2nd Lieutenant J.L. Wheatley, 45th Sikhs, was in charge of the gun and Maxim teams, and it was largely due to his care and judgment that these weapons were so effective in the defense.
Lieutenant A.B. Minchin, 25th Punjaub Infantry, Assistant Political Agent, was in the fort throughout the siege, and was most useful.
Lieutenant A.B. Minchin, 25th Punjaub Infantry, Assistant Political Agent, was in the fort during the entire siege and was really helpful.
Ressaidar Tilok Singh, 11th Bengal Lancers, accompanied Captain Wright in his ride of the 27th July, and is very favorably mentioned by that officer.
Ressaidar Tilok Singh from the 11th Bengal Lancers rode with Captain Wright on July 27th and is highly praised by that officer.
Jemadar Sudama commanded the detachment of the 21st Bengal Lancers who were at Chakdara Fort on the 26th July, and was present throughout the siege, and is also very favorably reported on.
Jemadar Sudama led the group of the 21st Bengal Lancers stationed at Chakdara Fort on July 26th and was present throughout the siege, receiving very positive reports.
Subadar Jwala Singh, 45th Sikhs, was present throughout the siege, and showed great intelligence and readiness of resource, as well as courage and coolness, under fire.
Subadar Jwala Singh, 45th Sikhs, was present throughout the siege and demonstrated great intelligence and resourcefulness, along with courage and composure under fire.
Jemadar Ala Singh, 45th Sikhs, had command of the sections on the parapet of the river fort, and showed conspicuous courage and coolness under heavy fire.
Jemadar Ala Singh of the 45th Sikhs was in charge of the teams on the parapet of the river fort and demonstrated remarkable bravery and composure under intense fire.
Lieutenant Rattray reports that No.522 Hospital Assistant Piara Singh, 11th Bengal Lancers, rendered valuable assistance, not only in the sortie on the 2nd, and at other times in bringing up ammunition, etc., to the men on the parapets under fire.
Lieutenant Rattray reports that No.522 Hospital Assistant Piara Singh, 11th Bengal Lancers, provided valuable help, not only during the mission on the 2nd but also at other times by bringing ammunition and supplies to the men on the front lines while under fire.
17. I shall further have the honor, in a separate communication, to submit, for the favorable consideration of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief, the names of several non-commissioned officers and men who distinguished themselves during the siege of Chakdara Fort, in view of their being granted the order of merit, should His Excellency think them deserving of that distinction.
17. I will also have the honor, in a separate message, to submit for the favorable consideration of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief the names of several non-commissioned officers and soldiers who distinguished themselves during the siege of Chakdara Fort, in hopes that they may be awarded the order of merit if His Excellency finds them deserving of that recognition.
From Major-General Sir B. Blood, K.C.B., Commanding the Malakand Field Force, to the Adjutant-General in India,—No.5, "Despatches, Malakand Field Force,"—Dated 27th October, 1897.
From Major-General Sir B. Blood, K.C.B., Commanding the Malakand Field Force, to the Adjutant-General in India,—No.5, "Despatches, Malakand Field Force,"—Dated 27th October, 1897.
I regret to find that in my report, "Despatches, Malakand Field Force," No.3, of the 20th August, 1897, I omitted to include the name of Surgeon-Captain E.V. Hugo, Indian Medical Service, amongst those of the officers recommended to the favorable consideration of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief for their services during the recent defence of Chakdara Fort. I now have great pleasure in stating that Surgeon-General Hugo served with distinction throughout the defence in question, and in recommending him for favorable consideration accordingly.
I regret to say that in my report, "Despatches, Malakand Field Force," No. 3, dated August 20, 1897, I forgot to include the name of Surgeon-Captain E.V. Hugo from the Indian Medical Service among the officers recommended for the favorable consideration of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief for their services during the recent defense of Chakdara Fort. I am now pleased to state that Surgeon-General Hugo served with distinction throughout the defense in question, and I recommend him for favorable consideration accordingly.
ACTION OF LANDAKAI AND EXPEDITION INTO UPPER SWAT. AUGUST, 1987. FROM THE DESPATCHES OF MAJOR-GENERAL SIR BINDON BLOOD, K.C.B.
ACTION OF LANDAKAI AND EXPEDITION INTO UPPER SWAT. AUGUST, 1987. FROM THE DISPATCHES OF MAJOR-GENERAL SIR BINDON BLOOD, K.C.B.
32. In concluding this part of my report, I would wish to express my admiration of the fine soldierly qualities exhibited by all ranks of the special force which I led into Upper Swat. They fought the action at Landakai in a brilliant manner, working over high hills, under a burning sun, with the greatest alacrity, and showing everywhere the greatest keenness to close with the enemy. They carried out admirably the trying duties necessitated by marching in hot weather with a transport train of more than 2000 mules, and they endured with perfect cheerfulness the discomforts of several nights' bivouac in heavy rain. The officers of the Divisional Staff and of by personal staff who were with me, [Major H.H. Burney, Assistant Adjutant-General (Gordon Highlanders); Lieut.-Colonel A. Masters, Assistant Quartermaster-General (2nd Regiment Central India Horse); Captain H.E. Stanton, Deputy Assistant Quartermaster-General, Intelligence Branch (Royal Artillery); Colonel W. Aitken, Colonel on the Staff, Royal Artillery; Captain H.D. Grier, Adjutant, R.A.; Major E. Blunt, Senior Officer of Royal Engineers; Captain E.W.M. Norie, Superintendent, Army Signalling (Middlesex Regiment); Captain C.G.F. Edwards, Provost Marshal (5th Punjaub Cavalry); Captain A.B. Dunsterville, A.D.C. (1st Battalion East Surrey Regiment); Captain A.R. Dick, Orderly Officer. BRIGADE STAFF.—Major E.A.P. Hobday, Deputy Assistant Adjutant-General (Royal Artillery); Captain G.F.H. Dillon, Deputy Assistant Quartermaster-General (40th Bengal Infantry); Captain C.H. Beville, Commissariat Transport Department; Captain J.M. Camilleri, in charge of Transport (13th Bengal Infantry); Surgeon-Lieut.-Colonel J.T.B. Bookey, I.M.S.; Lieutenant C.R. Gaunt, Orderly officer, 4th Dragoon Guards. COMMANDING OFFICERS OF DIVISIONAL TROOPS.—Lieut.-Colonel R.B. Adams, Queen's Own Corps of Guides; Major C.A. Anderson, 10th Field Battery, Royal Artillery; Major M.F. Fegan, No.7 Mountain Battery, Royal Artillery; Captain A.H.C. Birch, No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery; Captain E.P. Johnson, No.5 Company Queen's Own Sappers and Miners.] Brigadier-General W.H. Meiklejohn, C.B., C.M.G., and his staff, and the several heads of departments and commanding officers of Divisional Troops, all carried out their duties in an entirely satisfactory manner.
32. To wrap up this section of my report, I want to express my admiration for the excellent soldierly qualities displayed by all members of the special force I led into Upper Swat. They fought at Landakai with remarkable skill, maneuvering over steep hills under the blazing sun with great enthusiasm and showing a strong desire to engage the enemy. They executed the challenging tasks of marching in hot weather with a transport train of over 2000 mules admirably, and they endured the discomforts of several nights spent in heavy rain with a positive attitude. The officers from the Divisional Staff and my personal staff who were with me—[Major H.H. Burney, Assistant Adjutant-General (Gordon Highlanders); Lieut.-Colonel A. Masters, Assistant Quartermaster-General (2nd Regiment Central India Horse); Captain H.E. Stanton, Deputy Assistant Quartermaster-General, Intelligence Branch (Royal Artillery); Colonel W. Aitken, Colonel on the Staff, Royal Artillery; Captain H.D. Grier, Adjutant, R.A.; Major E. Blunt, Senior Officer of Royal Engineers; Captain E.W.M. Norie, Superintendent, Army Signalling (Middlesex Regiment); Captain C.G.F. Edwards, Provost Marshal (5th Punjaub Cavalry); Captain A.B. Dunsterville, A.D.C. (1st Battalion East Surrey Regiment); Captain A.R. Dick, Orderly Officer. BRIGADE STAFF.—Major E.A.P. Hobday, Deputy Assistant Adjutant-General (Royal Artillery); Captain G.F.H. Dillon, Deputy Assistant Quartermaster-General (40th Bengal Infantry); Captain C.H. Beville, Commissariat Transport Department; Captain J.M. Camilleri, in charge of Transport (13th Bengal Infantry); Surgeon-Lieut.-Colonel J.T.B. Bookey, I.M.S.; Lieutenant C.R. Gaunt, Orderly officer, 4th Dragoon Guards. COMMANDING OFFICERS OF DIVISIONAL TROOPS.—Lieut.-Colonel R.B. Adams, Queen's Own Corps of Guides; Major C.A. Anderson, 10th Field Battery, Royal Artillery; Major M.F. Fegan, No.7 Mountain Battery, Royal Artillery; Captain A.H.C. Birch, No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery; Captain E.P. Johnson, No.5 Company Queen's Own Sappers and Miners.] Brigadier-General W.H. Meiklejohn, C.B., C.M.G., and his team, along with the various department heads and commanding officers of Divisional Troops, all performed their duties exceptionally well.
Major H.A. Deane, Political Agent, and his assistant, Lieutenant A.B. Minchin, gave valuable assistance in collecting intelligence and supplies.
Major H.A. Deane, Political Agent, and his assistant, Lieutenant A.B. Minchin, provided valuable help in gathering intelligence and supplies.
33. While the operations above described were in progress, a diversion was made towards the southern border of the Buner country from Mardan by the 1st Reserve Brigade, which, on its headquarters leaving Mardan, came under my command as the 3rd Brigade, Malakand Field Force.
33. While the operations mentioned above were underway, a diversion was made towards the southern border of the Buner region from Mardan by the 1st Reserve Brigade, which, after its headquarters left Mardan, came under my command as the 3rd Brigade, Malakand Field Force.
34. A force [1st Battalion Highland Light Infantry, under Lieut.-Colonel R.D.B. Rutherford; 39th Garhwal Rifles, under Lieut.-Colonel B.C. Greaves; No.3 Company Bombay Sappers and Miners, under Captain C.E. Baddeley, R.E.; one squadron 10th Bengal Lancers, under Captain W.L. Maxwell; two guns No.1 Mountain Battery, Royal Artillery, under Lieutenant H.L.N. Beynon, R.A.] under Brigadier-General J. Wodehouse, C.B., C.M.G., was concentrated on the 17th August at Rustum, eighteen miles north-east of Mardan, and about four miles from the Buner border, with the object of acting as a containing force, and so preventing the sections of the Bunerwhals who had not already committed themselves against us from joining in opposition to our advance into Upper Swat.
34. A force [1st Battalion Highland Light Infantry, led by Lieut.-Colonel R.D.B. Rutherford; 39th Garhwal Rifles, led by Lieut.-Colonel B.C. Greaves; No.3 Company Bombay Sappers and Miners, led by Captain C.E. Baddeley, R.E.; one squadron 10th Bengal Lancers, led by Captain W.L. Maxwell; two guns from No.1 Mountain Battery, Royal Artillery, led by Lieutenant H.L.N. Beynon, R.A.] under Brigadier-General J. Wodehouse, C.B., C.M.G., was gathered on August 17th at Rustum, eighteen miles northeast of Mardan and about four miles from the Buner border. The goal was to act as a containment force to prevent the groups of Bunerwhals who had not yet opposed us from joining in resistance to our advance into Upper Swat.
35. The presence of this force had the desired effect, and Brigadier-General Wodehouse and his staff made good use of the time they spent at Rustum in acquiring valuable information about several of the passes in the neighborhood.
35. This force had the intended impact, and Brigadier-General Wodehouse and his team took advantage of their time at Rustum to gather important information about several nearby passes.
36. Brigadier-General Wodehouse states that throughout the operations of his force, which involved considerable fatigue and exposure to heat and rain, the spirit of his troops left nothing to be desired. He makes special mention of the work of No.3 Company Bombay Sappers and Miners, under Captain C.E. Baddeley, R.E. He also reports very favourably on the assistance given him by Lieutenant C.P. Down, Assistant Commissioner, and has expressed to me a high opinion of that officer's abilities and acquirements, particularly of his proficiency in the local vernacular.
36. Brigadier-General Wodehouse says that during the operations of his force, which involved a lot of fatigue and exposure to heat and rain, the morale of his troops was outstanding. He specifically highlights the work of No.3 Company Bombay Sappers and Miners, led by Captain C.E. Baddeley, R.E. He also gives positive feedback on the support he received from Lieutenant C.P. Down, Assistant Commissioner, and has expressed a high regard for that officer's skills and knowledge, especially his fluency in the local language.
THE ACTION OF 16TH SEPTEMBER. FROM SIR BINDON BLOOD'S DESPATCH CONTAINING THE SUMMARY OF BRIGADIER-GENERAL JEFFREY'S REPORT OF THE ACTION
THE ACTION OF 16TH SEPTEMBER. FROM SIR BINDON BLOOD'S DESPATCH CONTAINING THE SUMMARY OF BRIGADIER-GENERAL JEFFREY'S REPORT OF THE ACTION
27. The behavior of the troops throughout this trying day was very good. The steadiness and discipline shown by the 1st Battalion of the Buffs, under Lieu.-Colonel Ommnanney, were admirable, while Brigadier-General Jeffreys has specially commended the gallantry with which the Guides Infantry, under Major Campbell, brought off Captain Ryder's detachment of the 35th Sikhs, carrying the wounded on their backs under a heavy fire. He has further strongly endorsed Major Campbell's favourable mention of the courage and judgment shown by Captain G.B. Hodson, and Lieutenant H.W. Codrington, of the Guides, who commanded the companies of the battalion which were chiefly in contact with the enemy; the gallantry of Surgeon-Captain J. Fisher, Indian Medical Service, who made a most determined, though unsuccessful, attempt to take medical aid to the wounded of Captain Ryder's detachment through a hot fire; of Surgeon-Lieutenant E.L. Perry, Indian Medical Service; of Jemadar Sikander Khan of the Guides, and of several non-commissioned officers and Sepoys of the same corps, regarding whom I have had the honour to make a separate communication.
27. The troops' performance on this challenging day was commendable. The stability and discipline demonstrated by the 1st Battalion of the Buffs, led by Lieutenant Colonel Ommnanney, were impressive. Brigadier General Jeffreys specifically praised the bravery with which the Guides Infantry, under Major Campbell, rescued Captain Ryder's detachment of the 35th Sikhs, carrying the wounded on their backs despite heavy gunfire. He also strongly supported Major Campbell's positive remarks about the courage and judgment displayed by Captain G.B. Hodson and Lieutenant H.W. Codrington of the Guides, who led the companies that were primarily engaged with the enemy. Additionally, the bravery of Surgeon Captain J. Fisher, Indian Medical Service, who made a determined yet unsuccessful effort to reach Captain Ryder's wounded troops under intense fire, and Surgeon Lieutenant E.L. Perry, Indian Medical Service, was noteworthy. Jemadar Sikander Khan of the Guides and several non-commissioned officers and Sepoys from the same unit also distinguished themselves, about whom I have the honor of submitting a separate report.
28. Brigadier-General Jeffreys has also described in very favorable terms the gallant and valuable work done on this day by Captain Cole and his squadron of the 11th Bengal Lancers. He has commended the conduct of Captain W.I. Ryder and Lieutenant O.G. Gunning, 35th Sikhs, who were both wounded, and of Jemadar Narayan Singh, Havildar Ram Singh and Sepoy Karram Singh [This man's case has formed the subject of a separate communication.] of the same regiment. He has also brought to notice a gallant act of Captain A.H.C. Birch, R.A., commanding No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery, and his trumpeter, Jiwan, in rescuing a wounded Sepoy of the 35th Sikhs, as well as the distinguished gallantry of Jemadars Nawab and Ishar Singh and several non-commissioned officers and men of the same battery, in regard to which I have made separate communications to you.
28. Brigadier-General Jeffreys has also praised the brave and valuable work done on this day by Captain Cole and his squadron of the 11th Bengal Lancers. He has acknowledged the actions of Captain W.I. Ryder and Lieutenant O.G. Gunning from the 35th Sikhs, both of whom were injured, and of Jemadar Narayan Singh, Havildar Ram Singh, and Sepoy Karram Singh [This man's case has formed the subject of a separate communication.] from the same regiment. He also highlighted a heroic act by Captain A.H.C. Birch, R.A., who commands No.8 Bengal Mountain Battery, and his trumpeter, Jiwan, for rescuing a wounded Sepoy from the 35th Sikhs, as well as the remarkable bravery of Jemadars Nawab and Ishar Singh and several non-commissioned officers and soldiers from the same battery, about which I have sent you separate communications.
29. Brigadier-General Jeffreys further refers in the strongest terms of commendation to the gallant conduct of Lieutenants T.C. Watson [twice wounded in attempting to clear the village] and J.M.C. Colvin, R.E., and of the handful of men of the Buffs and No.4 Company Bengal Sappers and Miners, who spent the night of the 16th-17th with him in the village of Bilot. The conduct of these officers and men [of whom six were killed and eighteen wounded on this occasion, out of a total of fifty-four] in entering the village several times in the dark in face of a heavy fire directed upon them at close quarters, seems deserving of the highest recognition, and I have consequently made a special communication to you on the subject. Brigadier-General Jeffreys has also commended the gallant conduct of his Deputy Assistant Adjutant-General, [The remainder of Brigadier-General Jeffrey's staff was with the main body when it got separated from them.] Major E.O.F. Hamilton, 1st Battalion the Queen's Royal West Surrey Regiment; and finally, he has praised the courage and resolution of Lieutenant W.L.S. Churchill, 4th Hussars, the correspondent of the Pioneer Newspaper with the force, who made himself useful at a critical moment.
29. Brigadier-General Jeffreys praises the brave actions of Lieutenants T.C. Watson [who was wounded twice while trying to secure the village] and J.M.C. Colvin, R.E., as well as the small group of men from the Buffs and No. 4 Company Bengal Sappers and Miners, who spent the night of the 16th-17th with him in the village of Bilot. The actions of these officers and soldiers [six were killed and eighteen wounded during this event, out of a total of fifty-four] in entering the village multiple times in the dark, facing heavy fire directed at them up close, deserve the highest recognition, and I've sent you a special message about it. Brigadier-General Jeffreys also commended the brave behavior of his Deputy Assistant Adjutant-General, [his other staff members were with the main group when they became separated.] Major E.O.F. Hamilton from the 1st Battalion the Queen's Royal West Surrey Regiment; and finally, he praised the bravery and determination of Lieutenant W.L.S. Churchill from the 4th Hussars, who worked for the Pioneer Newspaper and was instrumental at a crucial moment.
OPERATIONS OF THE MALAKAND FIELD FORCE FROM THE CONCLUDING DESPATCH OF MAJOR-GENERAL SIR BINDON BLOOD, K.C.B.
OPERATIONS OF THE MALAKAND FIELD FORCE FROM THE FINAL REPORT OF MAJOR-GENERAL SIR BINDON BLOOD, K.C.B.
58. The commissariat arrangements under Major H. Wharry, D.S.O., were most successful. The rations were always abundant, and of uniformly good quality; and I may here observe that in five previous campaigns I have never seen the supply of bread anything like so continuously good, as it has been throughout the operations of the Malakand Field Force. No doubt the excellence of the commissariat arrangements has had a great deal to do with the good state of health of the troops, which I have remarked upon.
58. The supply arrangements under Major H. Wharry, D.S.O., were very successful. The rations were always plentiful and consistently good; and I should note that in five previous campaigns I have never seen the supply of bread be so reliably good as it has been during the operations of the Malakand Field Force. Clearly, the quality of the supply arrangements has played a big role in the good health of the troops, which I have mentioned.
59. The transport was most efficient throughout the operations under reference, and its management, under the direction of Captain C.G.R. Thackwell, Divisional Transport Officer, who was most ably and energetically assisted by Veterinary-Captain H.T.W. Mann, Senior Veterinary Officer, was most successful. In proof of this I will cite a report just made to me by Brigadier-General Jeffreys, commanding the 2nd Brigade of my force, that this morning, on inspecting 1265 mules attached his brigade, which have just returned from seven weeks in the field, he found fourteen sore backs, and four animals otherwise unfit for work, or a total of only eighteen disabled animals in all.
59. The transport was very efficient throughout the operations mentioned, and its management, led by Captain C.G.R. Thackwell, the Divisional Transport Officer, who was excellently and energetically assisted by Veterinary-Captain H.T.W. Mann, the Senior Veterinary Officer, was very successful. To prove this, I will mention a report I just received from Brigadier-General Jeffreys, who commands the 2nd Brigade of my force. This morning, while inspecting 1265 mules assigned to his brigade that have just returned from seven weeks in the field, he found fourteen with sore backs and four animals otherwise unfit for work, resulting in a total of only eighteen disabled animals overall.
60. The medical service was carried out in a very satisfactory manner. Some difficulties arose on the transfer of officers and material to the Tirah Expeditionary Force on its formation, especially as large convoys of sick and wounded were on the line of this force at the time, but these difficulties were successfully overcome by Colonel A.J.F. Reid, commanding the Malakand Brigade, who was in charge of the Line, and matters were ultimately restored to smooth working on the arrival of Surgeon-Colonel J.C.G. Carmichael, Indian Medical Service, who is now Principal Medical Officer of the Force.
60. The medical service was carried out very effectively. Some challenges came up during the transfer of officers and supplies to the Tirah Expeditionary Force upon its formation, especially since there were large convoys of sick and wounded being transported at the same time. However, these challenges were successfully managed by Colonel A.J.F. Reid, who was in charge of the Malakand Brigade and overseeing the Line. Eventually, things returned to normal with the arrival of Surgeon-Colonel J.C.G. Carmichael from the Indian Medical Service, who is now the Principal Medical Officer of the Force.
61. The telegraph arrangements were well carried out by Lieutenant W. Robertson, R.E., under the direction of Mr. C.E. Pitman, C.I.E. The postal service under Mr. H.C. Sheridan was also satisfactory.
61. The telegraph setup was effectively managed by Lieutenant W. Robertson, R.E., under the supervision of Mr. C.E. Pitman, C.I.E. The postal service, led by Mr. H.C. Sheridan, was also satisfactory.
62. The working of the several departments of the Headquarters' staff was most satisfactory and successful. The heads of departments were:—
62. The operations of the different departments of the Headquarters' staff were very satisfactory and successful. The department heads were:—
Major H.H. Burney, Gordon Highlanders, Assistant Adjutant-General.
Major H.H. Burney, Gordon Highlanders, Assistant Adjutant-General.
Lieutenant-Colonel A. Masters, 2nd Regiment Central India Horse, Assistant Quartermaster-General.
Lieutenant-Colonel A. Masters, 2nd Regiment Central India Horse, Assistant Quartermaster-General.
Captain H.E. Stanton, D.S.O., R.A., Deputy Assistant Quartermaster-General (Intelligence).
Captain H.E. Stanton, D.S.O., R.A., Deputy Assistant Quartermaster-General (Intelligence).
Captain E.W.M. Norie, Middlesex Regiment, Superintendent, Army Signalling.
Captain E.W.M. Norie, Middlesex Regiment, Superintendent, Army Signaling.
Surgeon-Colonel J.C.G. Carmichael, Indian Medical Service, Principal Medical Officer.
Surgeon-Colonel J.C.G. Carmichael, Indian Medical Service, Chief Medical Officer.
Lieutenant-Colonel W. Aitken, C.B., R.A., Commanding Royal Artillery.
Lieutenant Colonel W. Aitken, C.B., R.A., Commander of the Royal Artillery.
Colonel J.E. Broadbent, R.E., Commanding Royal Engineers—relieved early in October by Lieutenant-Colonel W. Peacocke, C.M.G., R.E.
Colonel J.E. Broadbent, R.E., Commanding Royal Engineers—was replaced early in October by Lieutenant-Colonel W. Peacocke, C.M.G., R.E.
Captain W.E. Banbury, 25th Madras Infantry, Field Treasure Chest Officer.
Captain W.E. Banbury, 25th Madras Infantry, Field Treasure Chest Officer.
Captain W.W. Cookson, R.A., Ordnance Officer.
Captain W.W. Cookson, R.A., Ordnance Officer.
Major H. Wharry, D.S.O., Staff Corps, Chief Commissariat Officer.
Major H. Wharry, D.S.O., Staff Corps, Chief Commissariat Officer.
Veterinary-Captain H.T.W. Mann, [Wounded in action, 20th September, 1897.] Army Veterinary Department, Senior Veterinary Officer.
Veterinary Captain H.T.W. Mann, [Wounded in action, September 20, 1897.] Army Veterinary Department, Senior Veterinary Officer.
Captain C.L. Robertson, R.E., Survey officer.
Captain C.L. Robertson, R.E., Survey officer.
Captain C.G.F. Edwards, 5th Punjaub Cavalry, Provost Marshal.
Captain C.G.F. Edwards, 5th Punjaub Cavalry, Provost Marshal.
The Rev. L. Klogh, Chaplain.
Rev. L. Klogh, Chaplain.
Lieutenant W. Robertson, R.E., in charge of Telegraphs.
Lieutenant W. Robertson, R.E., in charge of Communications.
63. I am under great obligations to my personal staff—Captain A.B. Dunsterville, 1st Battalion East Surrey Regiment, Aide-de-Camp; Captain A.R. Dick, 2nd Punjaub Cavalry, and Lieutenant Viscount Fincastle, 16th (The Queen's) Lancers.
63. I am very grateful to my personal team—Captain A.B. Dunsterville, 1st Battalion East Surrey Regiment, Aide-de-Camp; Captain A.R. Dick, 2nd Punjaub Cavalry; and Lieutenant Viscount Fincastle, 16th (The Queen's) Lancers.
64. It will have been gathered from the foregoing narrative that the three brigades of the force were ably commanded by Brigadier-Generals W.H. Meiklejohn, C.B., C.M.G., 1st Brigade; P.D. Jeffreys, [Wounded in action, 16th September, 1897.] C.B., 2nd Brigade, and J.H. Wodehouse, C.B., C.M.G., [Wounded in action, 20th September, 1897.] 3rd Brigade, who were efficiently seconded by their staffs. The Line of Communications and the Base were also most efficiently managed by Colonel A.J.F. Reid, Commanding the Malakand Brigade, and by Lieut.-Colonel A.V. Schalch, 11th Bengal Infantry, the Base Commandant, and their respective staffs.
64. From the previous accounts, it’s clear that the three brigades of the force were effectively commanded by Brigadier-Generals W.H. Meiklejohn, C.B., C.M.G., of the 1st Brigade; P.D. Jeffreys, [Wounded in action, 16th September, 1897.] C.B., of the 2nd Brigade; and J.H. Wodehouse, C.B., C.M.G., [Wounded in action, 20th September, 1897.] of the 3rd Brigade, who were well-supported by their staffs. The Line of Communications and the Base were also managed very effectively by Colonel A.J.F. Reid, in charge of the Malakand Brigade, and by Lieut.-Colonel A.V. Schalch, 11th Bengal Infantry, the Base Commandant, along with their respective teams.
65. In my final report on the conclusion of the operations of the force, I shall have the honour to bring the services of the officers above briefly referred to more fully to the notice of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief.
65. In my final report on the conclusion of the operations of the force, I will have the honor of fully bringing the services of the officers mentioned above to the attention of His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief.
66. Major H.A. Deane, C.S.I., Political Agent, Dur, Chitral and Swat, was in separate and independent charge of the political arrangements connected with the operations I have described, as far as Nawagai. He accompanied my headquarters to Ghosam, where I left him on the 12th September, and rejoined me at Inayat Kila on the 4th October. He gave much assistance in arranging for the collection of local supplies.
66. Major H.A. Deane, C.S.I., Political Agent for Dur, Chitral, and Swat, was in charge of the political planning related to the operations I've described, up to Nawagai. He traveled with my headquarters to Ghosam, where I left him on September 12, and he rejoined me at Inayat Kila on October 4. He was really helpful in organizing the collection of local supplies.
67. Mr. W.S. Davis was my political officer throughout the operations beyond Nawagai, and in the Mamund Valley prior to Major Deane's return to my headquarters on the 4th October. He carried out his duties to my complete satisfaction. His native assistant, Khan Bahadur Ibrahim Kham, also made himself very useful.
67. Mr. W.S. Davis was my political officer during the operations beyond Nawagai and in the Mamund Valley before Major Deane returned to my headquarters on October 4th. He performed his duties to my complete satisfaction. His local assistant, Khan Bahadur Ibrahim Kham, was also very helpful.
END OF TEXT
END OF TEXT
Download ePUB
If you like this ebook, consider a donation!